Books / Alberuni's India_vol.1

1. Alberuni's India_vol.1

Page 1

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

AN ACCOUNT OF THE RELIGION, PHILOSOPHY, LITERATURE, GEOGRAPHY, CHRONOLOGY, ASTRONOMY, CUSTONS, LAWS AND ASTROLOGY OF INDIA ABOUT A.D. 1030.

Eln English Edition, wit metes and 3ndices.

BY

DR. EDWARD C. SACHAU, Professor in the Royal U'niversity of Berlin, and Principal of the Seminary for Oriental Languages; Member of the Royal Academy of Berlin, and Corresponding Member of the Imperial Academy of Vienna Honorary Member of the Asiatic Society of Creat Britain and Ireland, London, and of the American Oriental Society, Cambridge, U.S.A.

IN TWO VOLUMES.

VOL I.

LONDON

KEGAN PAUL, TRENCHI, TRÜBNER & CO. LID DRYDEN HOUSE, GERRARD STREET, W. 1910

Page 2

Dcdicateo

TC

CHARLES SCHEFER,

MEMBRE DE L'INSTITUT, PARIS

AS

A HOMAGE BOTH TO

THE MAN AND THE SCHOLAR.

Page 3

PREFACE.

I.

THE literary history of the East represents the court of Mahmud King Mahmud at Ghazna, the leading monarch of Asiatic dausi. and Fii-

history between A.D. 997-1030, as having been a centre of literature, and of poetry in particular. There were four hundred poets chanting in his halls and gardens, at their head famous Unsuri, invested with the recently created dignity of a poet-laureate, who by his verdict opened the way to royal favour for rising talents ; there was grand Firdausi, composing his heroic epos by the special orders of the king, with many more kindred spirits. Unfortunately history knows very little of all this, save the fact that Persian poets flocked together in Ghazna, trying their kasidas on the king, his minis- ters and generals. History paints Mahmud as a suc- cessful warrior, but ignores him as a Mæcenas, With the sole exception of the lucubrations of bombastic Utbi, all contemporary records, the Malamat of Abû- Nasr Mishkani, the Tabakat of his secretary Baihaki, the chronicles of Mulla Muhammad Ghaznavi, Mahmud Warrak, and others, have perished, or not yet come to light, and the attempts at a literary history dating from a time 300-400 years later, the so-called Tadhkiras, weigh very light in the scale of matter-of-fact examina- tion, failing almost invariably whenever they are applied to for information on some detail of ancient Persian literature. However this may be, Unsuri, the pane- vii

Page 4

V111 PREFACE.

gyrist, does not seem to have missed the sun of royal favour, whilst Firdausi, immortal Firdausi, had to fly in disguise to evade the doom of being trampled to death by elephants. Attracted by the rising fortune of the young emperor, he seems to have repaired to his court only a year after his enthronisation, i.e. A.D. 998. But when he had finished his Shahnama, and found himself disappointed in his hopes for reward, he flung at him his famous satire, and fled into peaceless exile (A.D. 1010).1 In the case of the king rersus the poet the king has lost. As long as Firdausî retains the place of honour accorded to him in the history of the world's mental achievements, the stigma will cling to the name of Mahmud, that he who hoarded up perhaps more worldly treasures than were ever hoarded up, did not know how to honour a poet destined for immor- tality. And how did the author of this work, as remark- able among the prose compositions of the East as the Shahnama in poetry, fare with the royal Mæcenas of Ghazna? Mahmud Alberuni, or, as his compatriots called him, Abû and Albe- runi. Raihan, was born A.D. 973, in the territory of modern Khiva, then called Khwarizm, or Chorasmia in anti- quity.2 Early distinguishing himself in science and literature, he played a political part as councillor of the ruling prince of his native country of the Ma'muni family. The counsels he gave do not seem always to have suited the plans of King Mahmud at Ghazna, who was looking out for a pretext for interfering in the affairs of independent Khiva, although its rulers were his own near relatives. This pretext was furnished by a military emeute.

1 Cf. J. Moll, Le Livre des Rois, traduit, &c. Publie par Mme. Moll, 1876, préface, pp. xl. seq. 2 There is a reminiscence of his native country, i. 166, where he speaks of a kind of measure used in Khwarizm.

Page 5

PREFACE. ix

Mahmud marched into the country, not without some fighting, established there one of his generals as provin- cial governor, and soon returned to Ghazna with much booty and a great part of the Khiva troops, together with the princes of the deposed family of Ma'mun and the leading men of the country as prisoners of war or V as hostages. Among the last was Abû-Raihan Muham- mad Ibn Ahmad Alberuni. This happened in the spring and summer of A.D. 1017. The Chorasmian princes were sent to distant fortresses as prisoners of state, the Chorasmian soldiers were incorporated in Malmud's Indian army ; and Al- beruni-what treatment did he experience at Ghazua? From the very outset it is not likely that both the king and bis chancellor, Abmad Ibn Hasan Maimandi, sbould have accorded special favours to a man whom they knew to have been their political antagonist for years. The latter, the same man who had been the cause of the tragic catastrophe in the life of Firdausî, was in office under Mabmud from A.D. 1007-1025, and a second time under his son and successor, Mas'ud, from 1030- 1033. There is nothing to tell us that Alberuni was ever in the service of the state or court in Ghazna. A friend of his and companion of his exile, the Christian philosopher and physician from Bagdad, Abulkhair Alkhammar, seems to have practised in Ghazna his medical profession. Alberuni probably enjoyed the reputation of a great munojjim, i.c. astrologer-astrono- mer, and perhaps it was in this quality that he had relations to the court and its head, as Tycho de Brahe to the Emperor Rudolf. When writing the 'Irdtka, thirteen years after his involuntary immigration to Afghanistan, he was a master of astrologs, both ac- cording to the Greek and the Hindu system, and indeed Eastern writers of later centuries seem to consider him as having been the court astrologer of King Mahmud. In a book written five hundred years later (v. Chresto-

Page 6

x PREFACE.

mathie Persane, &e., par Ch. Schefer, Paris, 1883, i. p. 107 of the Persian text), there is a story of a practical joke which Mahmûd played on Alberuni as an astrolo- ger. Whether this be historic truth or a late invention, anyhow the story does not throw much light on the author's situation in a period of his life which is the most interesting to us, that one, namely, when he commenced to study India, Sanskrit and Sanskrit literature. Historic tradition failing us, we are reduced to a single source of information-the author's work-and must examine to what degree his personal relations are indicated by his own words. When he wrote, King Muhmud had been dead only a few weeks. Le roi est mort-but to whom was Vive le roi to be addressed ? Two heirs claimed the throne, Muhammad and Masud, and were marching against each other to settle their claims by the sword. Under these circumstances it comes out as a characteristic fact that the book has no dedication whatever, either to the memory of Mah- mûd, or to one of the rival princes, or to any of the indifferent or non-political princes of the royal house. As a cautious politician, he awaited the issue of the contest; but when the dice had been thrown, and Mas'ud was firmly established on the throne of his father, he at once hastened to dedicate to him the greatest work of his life, the Canon Masudicus. If he had been affected by any feeling of sincere gratitude, he might have erected in the 'Ivotka a monument to the memory of the dead king, under whose rule he had made the necessary preparatory studies, and might, have praised him as the great propagator of Islam, without probably incurring any risk. He has not done so, and the terms in which he speaks of Mahmud throughout his book are not such as a man would use when speak- ing of a deceased person who had been his benefactor. He is called simply The Amir Mahmud, ii. 13 (Arabic

Page 7

PREFACE xi

text, p. 208, 9), The Amir Mahmud, may God's merey be with him, i. 116 (text, p. 56, 8), The Amir Mahmad, may the grace of God be with him, ii. 103 (text, p. 252, 1I). The title Amfr was nothing very complimentary. It had been borne by his ancestors when they were simply generals and provincial governors in the service of the Samani king of Transoxiana and Khurasan. Speaking of Mahmud and his father Sabuktagin, the author says, Yamin-aldaula Mahmud, may God's mercy be with them, i. 22 (text, p. 1I, 9). He had received the title Yamin- aldaula, i.c. The right hand of the dynasty (of the Khalif), from the Khalif, as a recognition of the legiti- macy of his rule, resembling the investiture of the German Emperor by the Pope in the Middle Ages. Lastly. we find at ii. 2 (text, p. 203, 20) the foilowing terms: " The strongest of the pillars (of Islam), the pattern of a Sultan, Muhmud, the lion of the world and the rarity of the age, may God's mercy be with him." Whoever knows the style of Oriental authors when speaking of crowned heads, the style of their prefaces, which attains the height of absurdity at the court of the Moghul emperors at Delhi, will agree with me that the manner in which the author mentions the dead king is cold, cold in the extreme; that the words of praise bestowed upon him are meagre and stiff, a poor sort of praise for a man who had been the first man in Islam, and the founder of Islam in India; lastly, that the phrases of benediction which are appended to his name, according to a general custom of Islam, are the same as the author would have employed when speak- ing of any acquaintance of bis in common life who had died. He says of Mahmûd (i. 22): "He utterly ruined the prosperity of the country (of India), and performed those wonderful exploits by which the Hindus became like atoms of dust scattered in all directions, and like a tale of old in the mouth of the people." To criticise these words from a Muslim point of view, the passage of

Page 8

X11 PREFACE.

the ruining of the prosperity of the country was per- fectly out of place in the glorification of a Ghâzi like Mahmûd. That it was not at all against the moral principles of Alberuni to write such dedications to princes is shown by two other publications of his, with dedications which exhibit the cnstomary Byzantinism of the time. In the preface of the " Chronology of Ancient Nations" (trans- lated, &c., by Edward Sachau, London, 1879), he extols with abundant praise the prince of Hyrcania or Jurjan, Shams-almaali, who was a dwarf by the side of giant Mahmûd. The studied character of the neglect of Malimud in the 'Ivdtka comes out more strongly if we compare the unmerited praise which Alberuni lavishes upon his son and successor. The preface of his Cunon Masudicus is a farrago of high-sounding words in honour of King Mas ud, who was a drunkard, and lost in less than a decennium most of what his father's sword and policy had gained in thirty-three years. The tenor of this preface, taken from the mannscript of the Royal Library in Berlin, is as follows :- To thosewholead the conimunity of the believers in the place of the Prophet and by the help of the Word of God belongs "the king, the lord majestic and venerated, the helper of the representative of God, the furtherer of the law of God, the protector of the slaves of God, who punishes the enemies of God, Abu-Sa'id Masud Ibn Yamin-aldaula and 'Amin-almilla Mahmud-may God give him a long life, and let him perpetually rise to glorious and memorable deeds. For a confirmation of what we here say of him lies in the fact that God, on considering the matter, restored the right (i.c. the right of being ruled by Masud) to his people, after it had been concealed. God brought it to light. After he had been in distress, God helped him. After he had been rejected, God raised him, and brought him the empire and the rule, after people from all sides had tried to get posses-

Page 9

PREFACE.

sion of it, speaking: 'How should he come to rule over us, as we have a better right to the rule than he?' But then they received (from God) an answer in the event (lit. sign) which followed. God carried out HIis promise relating to him (Mas ud), giving him the inheri- tance without his asking for it, as He gave the inheri- tance of David to Solomon without reserve. (That is, the dead King Mahmud had proclaimed as his successor his son Muhammad, not Mas'ud, but the latter contested the will of his father, and in the following contest with his brother he was the winner.) If God had not chosen him, the hearts of men would not have been gained (?) for him, and the intrignes of his enemies would not have missed their aim. In short, the souls of men hastened to meet him in order to live under his shadow. The order of God was an act of predestination, and his becoming king was written in the Book of Books in heaven (from all eternity). "He-may God make his rule everlasting !- has conferred upon me a favour which was a high distinc- tion to me, and has placed me under the obligation of everlasting gratitude. For although a benefactor may dispense with the thank-offerings for his deeds, &c., a sound heart inspires those who receive them with the fear that they might be lost (to general notice), and lays upon them the obligation of spreading them and making them known in the world. But already, before I received this favour, I shared with the inhabitants of all his countries the blessings of his rule, of peace and justice. However, then the speciol service (towards his Majesty) became incumbent upon me, after (until that time) obeying in general (his Majesty) had been incumbent on me. (This means, probably, that Mas'ud conferred a special benefit (a pension ?) on the author, not immediately after he had come to the throne, but some time later.) Is it not he who has enabled me for the rest of my life (Alberuni was then sixty-one years

Page 10

xiv PREFACE.

old) to devote myself entirely to the service of science, as he let me dwell under the shadow of his power and let the cloud of his favour rain on me, always personally distinguishing and befriending me, &c .? And with regard to this (the favour conferred upon me), he has deigned to send his orders to the treasury and the ministry, which certainly is the utmost that kings can do for their subjects. May God Almighty reward him both in this and in yonder world," &c. Thereupon, finding that his Majesty did not require his actual service, and besides, finding that science stood in the highest favour with him, he composes a book on astronomy, to which he had been addicted all his life, and adorns it with the name of his Majesty, calling it Canon Masudicus (Alkanitn Almas udi), &c. To put the phrases of this preface into plain language, the author was in favour with King Masud; he had access to the court-living, probably, near it-and received an income which enabled him to devote him- self entirely to his scientific work. Besides, all this appears as a new state of things, the reverse of which had been the case under the king's predecessor, his father, Mahmud. We do not know the year in which this change in the life of Alberuni was brought about. Perhaps it was in some way connected with the fact that the chancellor, Maimandi, died A.D. 1033, and that after him one Abu-Nasr Ahmad Ibn Muhammad Ibn 'Abdussamad became chancellor, who before, i.e. from 1017 to 1033, had administered Khwarizm, the native country of Alberuni. He and Maimandi had been political antagonists-not so he and 'Abdussamad. The difference of the author's condition, as it appears to have been under Mas'ûd, from what it was under Mahmud when he prepared the 'Iroua, is further illus- trated by certain passages in the book itself. When speaking of the difficulties with which he had to grapple in his efforts to learn everything about India, he con-

Page 11

PREFACE. XV

tinues: " What scholar, however, has the same favour- able opportunities of studying this subject as I have? That would be only the case with one to whom the grace of God accords, what it did not accord to me, a perfectly free disposal of his own doings and goings; for it bas never fallen to my lot in my own doings and goings to be perfectly independent, nor to be invested with sufficient power to dispose and to order as I thought best. However, I thank God for that which He has bestowed upon me, and which must be con- sidered as sufficient for the purpose " (i. 24). These lines seem to say that the author, both at Ghazna and in India, at Multan, Peshavar, &c., had the opportunity of conversing with pandits, of procuring their help, and of buying books; that, however, in other directions he was not his own master, but had to obey a higher will ; and lastly, that he was not a man in authority. In another place (i. 152) he explains that art and science require the protection of kings. "For they alone could free the minds of scholars from the daily anxieties for the necessities of life, and stimulate their energies to earn more fame and favour, the yearning for which is the pith and marrow of human nature. The present times, however, are not of this kind. They are the very opposite, and therefore it is quite impossible that a new science or any new kind of research should arise in our days. What we have of sciences is nothing but the scanty remains of bygone better times." Com- pare with this a dictum quoted (i. 188): "The scholars are well aware of the use of money, but the rich are ignorant of the nobility of science." These are not the words of an author who basks in the sunshine of royal protection. The time he speaks of is the time of Mahmûd, and it is Mahmud whom he accuses of having failed in the duties of a protector of art and science imposed upon him by his royal office. Firdausî, in his satire (Mohl, i. préf. p. xlv.), calls

Page 12

xvi PREFACE.

him "un roi qui n'a ni foi ni loi ni manières" (royales); and he says: "Si le roi avait eté un homme digne de renom, il aurait honore le savoir," &c. It is most remarkable to what degree Firdausi and Alberuni agree in their judgment of the king. To neither of them had he been a Mæcenas. In the absence of positive information, we have tried to form a chain of combinations from which we may infer, with a tolerable degree of certainty, that our author, during the thirteen years of his life from 1017 to 1030, after he had been carried from his native country to the centre of Malimud's realm, did not enjoy the favours of the king and his leading men; that he stayed in different parts of India (as a companion of the princes of his native country?), probably in the character of a hostage or political prisoner kept on hononrable terms; that he spent his leisure in the study of India; and that he had no official inducement or encouragement for this study, nor any hope of royal reward. A radical change in all this takes place with the accession of Mas ud. There is no more complaint of the time and its ruler. Alberuni is all glee and exultation about the royal favours and support accorded to him and to his studies. He now wrote the greatest work of his life,1 and with a swelling heart and overflowing words he proclaims in the preface the praise of his benefactor. Living in Ghazna, he seems to have for- gotten India to a great extent. For in the Canon Masudicus he rarely refers to India; its chapter on Hindu eras does not prove any progress of his studies beyond that which he exhibits in the 'Ivotka, and at the end of it he is even capable of confounding the era 1 The Canon Masudicus, extant in four good copies in European libraries, waits for the patronage of some Academy of Sciences or some Government, and for the combination of two scholars, an astronomer and an Arabic philologist, for the purpose of an edition and translation.

Page 13

PREFACE. XV11

of the astronomers, as used in the Khandakhdyaka of Brahmagupta, with the Guptakala. If the author and his countrymen had suffered and Theauthor's were still suffering from the oppression of King Mal- India. interest in

mûd, the Hindus were in the same position, and per- haps it was this community of mishap which inspired him with sympathy for them. And certainly the Hindus and their world of thought have a paramount, fascinating interest for him, and he inquires with the greatest predilection into every Indian subject, how- soever heathenish it may be, as though he were treating of the most important questions for the sonls of Muham- madans,-of free-will and predestination, of future reward and punishment, of the creation or eternity of the Word of God, &c. To Mahmud the Hindus were infidels, to be dispatched to hell as soon as they refused to be plun ered. To go on expeditions and to fill the treasury with gold, not to make lasting conquests of territories, was the real object of his famous expeditions; and it was with this view that he cut his way throngh enormous distances to the richest temples of India at Taneshar, Mathura, Kanoj, and Somanath. 'To Alberui the Hindus were excellent philosophers, good mathematicians and astronomers, though he naïvely believes himself to be superior to them, and disdains to be put on a level with them (i. 23).1 He does not conceal whatever he considers wrong and unpractical with them, but he duly appreciates their mental achievements, takes the greatest pains to appropriate them to himself, even such as could not be of any use to him or to his readers, e.g. Sanskrit metrics; and whenever he hits upon sometbing that is noble and grand both in science and in practical life, he never fails to lay it before his readers with warm-hearted words of approbation. Speaking of the construction of the ponds at holy bathing-places, he says: "In this 1 For a similar trait of self-confidence cf. i. 277, last lines. VOL. I.

Page 14

XV111 PREFACE.

they have attained a very high degree of art, so that our people (the Muslims), when they see them, wonder at them, and are unable to describe them, much less to / construct anything like them " (ii. 144). Apparently Alberuni felt a strong inclination towards Indian philosophy. He seems to have thought that the philosophers both in ancient Greece and India, whom he most carefully and repeatedly distinguishes from the ignorant, image-loving crowd, held in reality the very same ideas, the same as seem to have been his own, i.e. those of a pure monotheism; that, in fact, originally all men were alike pure and virtuous, worshipping one sole Almighty God, but that the dark passions of the crowd in the course of time had given rise to the difference of religion, of philosophical and political persuasions, and of idolatry. "The first cause of idolatry was the desire of commemorating the dead and of consoling the living ; but on this basis it has developed, and has finally become a foul and pernicious abuse " (i. 124). He seems to have revelled in the pure theories of the Bhagoradyit@, and it deserves to be noticed that he twice mentions the saying of Vyasa, " Learn twenty- five (i.e., the elements of existence) by distinctions, &c. Afterwards adhere to whatever religion you like; your end will be salvation " (i. 44, and also i. 104). In one case he even goes so far as to speak of Hindu scholars as "enjoying the help of God," which to a Muslim means as much as inspired by God, guided by divinc inspiration (ii. 108). These words are an addition of the author's in his paraphrase of the Brihatsamhita of Varâbamihira, v. S. There can be scarcely any doubt that Muslims of later times would have found fault with him for going to such length in his interest for those heathenish doctrines, and it is a singular fact that Alberuni wrote under a prince who burned and impaled the Karmatians (cf. note to i. 31). Still he was a Muslim; whether Sunni or Shi'a

Page 15

PREFACE. XIX

cannot be gathered from the 'Ivotkd. He sometimes takes an occasion for pointing out to the reader the superiority of Islam over Brahmanic India. He con- trasts the democratic eqnality of men with the castes of India, the matrimonial law of Islam with degraded forms of it in India, the cleanliness and decency of Muslims with filthy customs of the Hindus. With all this, his recognition of Islam is not withont a tacit reserve. He dares not attack Islam, but he attacks the Arabs. In his work on chronology he reproaches the ancient Muslims with having destroyed the civilisation of Eran, and gives us to understand that the ancient Arabs were certainly nothing better than the Zoroastrian Eranians. So too in the 'Ivotkd, whenever he speaks of a dark side in Hfindu life, he at once turns round sharply to compare the manners of the ancient Arabs, and to declare that they were quite as bad, if not worse. This could only be meant as a hint to the Muslim reader not to be too haughty towards the poor bewildered Ilindu, trodden down by the savage hordes of King Malmud, and not to forget that the founders of Islam, too, were certainly no angels. Independent in his thoughts about religion and The author,s philosophy, he is a friend of clear, determined, and manly character.

words. He abhors half-truths, veiled words, and waver- ing action. Everywhere he comes forward as a champion of his conviction with the courage of a man. As in religion and philosophy, so too in politics. There are some remarkable sentences of political philosophy in the introductions to chapters ix, and lxxi. As a poli- tician of a highly conservative stamp, he stands up for throne and altar, and declares that "their union represents the highest development of human society, all that men can possibly desire " (i. 99). IIe is capable of admiring the mildness of the law of the Gospel: "To offer to him who has beaten your cheek the other cheek also, to bless your enemy and to pray for him. Upon

Page 16

xx PREFACE.

my life, this is a noble philosophy; but the people of this world are not all philosophers. Most of them are ignorant and erring, who cannot be kept on the straight road save by the sword and the whip. And, indeed, ever since Constantine the Victorious became a Chris- tian, both sword and whip have ever been employed, for without them it would be impossible to rule" (ii. 161). Although a scholar by profession, he is capable of taking the practical side of a case, and he applauds the Khalif Muaviya for having sold the golden gods of Sicily to the princes of Sindh for money's worth, instead of destroying them as heathen abominations, as bigoted Muslims would probably have liked him to do. His preaching the union of throne and altar does not prevent him from speaking with undisguised contempt of the "preconcerted tricks of the priests " having the purpose of enthralling the ignorant crowd (i. 123). He is a stern judge both of himself and of others. Himself perfectly sincere, it is sincerity which he demands from others. Whenever he does not fully understand a subject, or only knows part of it, he will at once tell the reader so, either asking the reader's pardon for his ignorance, or promising, though a man of fifty-eight years, to continue his labours and to publish their results in time, as though he were acting under a moral responsibility to the public. He always sharply draws the limits of his knowledge; and although he has only a smattering of the metrical system of the Hindus, he communicates whatever little he knows, guided by the principle that the best must not be the enemy of the better (i. 200, 6-9), as though he were afraid that he should not live long enough to finish the study in question. He is not a friend of those who hate to avow their ignorance by a frank I do not Inow" (i. 177), and he is roused to strong indignation whenever he meets with want of sincerity. If Brahma- gupta teaches two theories of the eclipses, the popular

Page 17

PREFACE. XX1

one of the dragon Rahu's devouring the luminous body, and the scientific one, he certainly committed the sin against conscience from undue concessions to the priests of the nation, and from fear of a fate like that which befell Socrates when he came into collision with the persuasions of the majority of his countrymen. Cf. chapter lix. In another place he accuses Brahma- gupta of injustice and rudeness to his predecessor, Aryabhata (i. 376). He finds in the works of Vara- hamihira by the side of honest scientific work sentences which sonnd to him "like the ravings of & madman" (ii. 117), bnt he is kind enough to suggest that behind those passages there is perhaps an esoteric meaning, unknown to him, but more to the credit of the author. When, however, Varahamihira seems to exceed all limits of common sense, Alberuni thinks that " to such things silencc is the only proper ansuer" (ii. 114). Iis professional zeal, and the principle that leurning is the fruit of repetition (ii. 198), sometimes induce him to indulge in repetitions, and his thorongh honesty sometimes misleads him to use harsh and even rude words. He cordially hates the verbosity of Indian authors or versifiers,1 who use lots of words where a single one would be sufficient. He calls it "mere nonsense-a means of keeping people in the dark and throwing an air of mystery abont the subject. And in any case this copiousness (of words denoting the same thing) offers painful difficulties to those who want to learn the whole langnage, and only results in a sheer waste of time" (i. 229, 299, 19). He twice explains the origin of the Dibajat, i.e. Maledives and Laccadives (i. 233 ; ii. 106), twice the configuration of the borders of the Indian Ocean (i. 197, 270). Whenever he suspects humbug, he is not backward in calling it by the right name. Thinking of the horrid practices of Rasâyana, i.e. the art of making gold, of 1 Cf. his sarcasms on the versifying bias of Hindu authors, i. 137.

Page 18

XX11 PREFACE.

making old people young, &c., he bursts out into sarcastic words which are more coarse in the original than in my translation (i. 189). In eloquent words he utters his indignation on the same subject (i. 193): " The greediness of the ignorant Hindu princes for gold- making does not know any limit," &c. There is a spark of grim humour in his words on i. 237, where he criti- cises the cosmographic ravings of a Hindu author: "We, on our part, found it already troublesome enough to enumerate all the seven seas, together with the seven earths, and now this author thinks he can make the subject more easy and pleasant to us by inventing some more earths below those already enumerated by our- selves!" And when jugglers from Kanoj lectured to him on chronology, the stern scholar seems to have been moved to something like a grin. "I used great care in examining every single one of them, in repeating the same questions at different times in a different order and context. But lo! what different answers did I get! God is all-wise " (ii. 129). The ten- In the opening of his book Alberuni gives an account dency of his work. of the circumstances which suggested to him the idea of writing the 'Ivotka. Once the conversation with a friend of his, else unknown, ran on the then existing literature on the history of religion and philosophy, its merits and demerits. When, in particular, the literature on the belief of the Hindus came to be criti- cised, Alberuni maintained that all of it was second- hand and thoroughly uncritical. To verify the matter, his friend once more examines the books in question, which results in his agreeing with our author, and his asking him to fill up this gap in the Arabic literature of the time. The book he has produced is not a polemi- cal one. He will not convert the Hindus, nor lend a direct help to missionary zealots. He will simply describe Hinduism, without identifying himself with it. He takes care to inform the reader that he is not respon-

Page 19

PREFACE. XX111

sible for whatsoever repugnant detail he has to relate, but the Hindus themselves. He gives a repertory of information on Indian subjects, destined for the use of those who lived in peaceable intercourse with them, and wished to have an insight into their mode and world of thought (i. 7; ii. 246). The author has nothing in common with the Muham- madan Ghazi who wanted to convert the Hindus or to kill them, and his book scarcely reminds the reader of the incessant war between Islam and India, during which it had been prepared, and by which the possi- bility of writing such a book had first been given. It is like a magic island of quiet, impartial research in the midst of a world of clashing swords, burning towns, and plundered temples. The object which the author had in view, and never for a moment lost sight of, was to afford the necessary information and training to "any one (in Islam) who wants to converse with the Hindus, and to discuss with them questions of religion, science, or literature, on the rery basis of their own cirili- sution " (ii. 246). It is difficult to say what kind of readers Alberuni had, The author or expected to have, not only for the 'Ivduka, but for all readers. and his

his other publications on Indian subjects. Probably educated, and not bigoted or fanatical Muslims in Sindh, in parts of the Panjab, where they were living by the side of Hindus and in daily intercourse with them ; perhaps, also, for such in Kabul, the suburb of which had still a Hindu population in the second half of the tenth century, Ghazna, and other parts of Afghanistan. When speak- ing of the Pulisasiddhanta, a standard work on astro- nomy, he says : " A translation of his (Pulisa's) whole work into Arabic has not hitherto yet been undertaken, because in his mathematical problems there is an evi- dent religious and theological tendency " 1 (i. 375). He 1 Alberuni does not seem to have shared these scruples, for he translated it into Arabic (ef. i. 154).

Page 20

xxiv PREFACE.

does not tell us what this particular tendency was to which the readers objected, but we learn so much from this note that in his time, and probably also in his neighbourhood, there were circles of educated men who had an interest in getting the scientific works of India translated into Arabic, who at the same time were suffi- ciently familiar with the subject-matter to criticise the various representations of the same subject, and to give the preference to one, to the exclusion of another. That our author had a certain public among Hindus seems to be indicated by the fact that he composed some publications for people in Kashmîr ; ef. preface to the edition of the text, p. xx. These relations to Kashmir are very difficult to understand, as Muslims had not yet conquered the country, nor entered it to any extent, and as the author himself (i. 206) relates that it was closed to intercourse with all strangers save a few Jews. Whatever the interest of Muslims for the literature of and on India may have been, we are under the impression that this kind of literature has never taken deep root ; for after Alberuni's death, in A.D. 1048, there is no more original work in this field ; and even Alberuni, when he wrote, was quite alone in the field. Enumerating the difficulties which beset his study of India, he says: " I found it very hard to work into the subject, although I have a great liking for it, in which respect I stand quite alone in my time," &c. (i. 24). And certainly we do not know of any Indianist like him, before his time or after. The author's In general it is the method of our author not to speak methor. himself, but to let the Hindus speak, giving extensive quotations from their classical authors. He presents a picture of Indian civilisation as painted by the Hindus themselves. Many chapters, not all, open with a short characteristic introduction of a general nature. The body of most chapters consists of three parts. The first is a précis of the question, as the author understands it.

Page 21

PREFACE. XXV

The second part brings forward the doctrines of the Hindus, quotations from Sanskrit books in the chapters on religion, philosophy, astronomy, aud astrology, and other kinds of information which had been communi- cated to him by word of mouth, or things which he had himself observed in the chapters on literature, historic chronology, geography, law, manners, and cus- toms. In the third part he does the same as Megas- thenes had already done ; he tries to bring the sometimes very exotic subject nearer to the understanding of his readers by comparing it with the theories of ancient Greece, and by other comparisons. As au example of this kind of arrangement, ef. Chapter v. In the dis- position of every single chapter, as well as in the sequence of the chapters, a perspicuous, well-considered plan is apparent. There is no patchwork nor anything superfluous, and the words fit to the subject as close as possible. We seem to recognise the professional mathe- matician in the perspicuity and classical order through- out the whole composition, and there was scarcely an occasion for him to excuse himself, as he does at the end of Chapter i. (i. 26), for not being able everywhere strictly to adhere to the geometrical method, as he was sometimes compelled to introduce an unknown factor, because the explanation could only be given in a later part of the book. He does not blindly accept the traditions of former Theanthor's ages; he wants to understand and to criticise them. He mind. critical

wants to sift the wheat from the chaff, and he will discard everything that militates against the laws of nature and of reason. The reader will remember that Alberuni was also a physical scholar, and had published works on most departments of natural science, optics, mechanics, mineralogy, and chemistry ; ef. his geolo- gical speculation on the indications of India once having been a sea (i. 198), and a characteristic specimen of his natural philosophy (i. 400). That he believed in the

Page 22

XXV1 PREFACE.

action of the planets on the sublunary world I take for certain, though he nowhere says so. It would hardly be intelligible why he should have spent so much time and labour on the study of Greek and Indian astrology if he had not believed in the truth of the thing. He gives a sketch of Indian astrology in Chapter lxxx., because Muslim readers "are not acquainted with the Hindu methods of astrology, and have never had an opportunity of studying an Indian book " (ii. 211). Bardesanes, a Syrian philosopher and poet in the second half of the second Christian century, condemned astrology in plain and weighty words. Alberuni did not rise to this height, remaining entangled in the notions of Greek astrology. He did not believe in alchemy, for he distinguishes between such of its practices as are of a chemical or mineralogical character, and such as are intentional deceit, which he condemns in the strongest possible terms (i. 187). He criticises manuscript tradition like a modern philologist. He sometimes supposes the text to be corrupt, and inquires into the cause of the corruption; he discusses various readings, and proposes emenda- tions. He guesses at lacunce, criticises different transla- tions, and complains of the carelessness and ignorance of the copyists (ii. 76; i. 162-163). He is aware that Indian works, badly translated and carelessly copied by the successive copyists, very soon degenerate to such a degree that an Indian author would hardly recognise his own work, if it were presented to him in such a garb. All these complaints are perfectly true, particu- larly as regards the proper names. That in his essays at emendation he sometimes went astray, that, e.g. he was not prepared fully to do justice to Brahmagupta, will readily be excused by the fact that at his time it was next to impossible to learn Sanskrit with a suffi- cient degree of accuracy and completeness.

Page 23

PREFACE. xxvii

When I drew the first sketch of the life of Alberuni ten years ago, I cherished the hope that more materials for his biography would come to light in the libraries of both the East and West. This has not been the case, so far as I am aware. To gain an estimate of his character we must try to read between the lines of his books, and to glean whatever minute indications may there be found. A picture of his character cannot therefore at the present be anything but very imperfect, and a detailed appreciation of his services iu the ad- vancement of science cannot be undertaken until all the numerous works of his pen have been studied and rendered accessible to the learned world. The principal domain of his work included astronomy, mathematics, chronology, mathematical geography, physics, chemistry, and mineralogy. By the side of this professional work he composed about twenty books on India, both transla- tions and original compositions, and a number of tales and legends, mostly derived from the ancient lore of Eran and India. As probably most valuable contribu- tions to the historic literature of the time, we must mention his history of his native country Khwarizm, and the history of the famous sect of the Karmatians, the loss of both of which is much to be deplored.

II.

The court of the Khalifs of the house of Omayya at On the ori- Damascus does not seem to have been a home for Arabic gines of

literature. Except for the practical necessities of ad- literature.

ministration, they had no desire for the civilisation of Greece, Egypt, or l'ersia, their thoughts being engrossed by war and politics and the amassing of wealth. Pro- bably they had a certain predilection for poetry common to all Arabs, but they did not think of encouraging historiography, much to their own disadvantage. In many ways these Arab princes, only recently emerged

Page 24

xxviii PREFACE.

from the rocky wilderness of the Hijaz, and suddenly raised to imperial power, retained much of the great Bedouin Shaikh of the desert. Several of them, shun- ning Damascus, preferred to stay in the desert or on its border, and we may surmise that in their house- holds at Rusafa and Khunasara there was scarcely more thought of literature than at present in the halls of Ibn Arrashid, the wily head of the Shammar at Hail. The cradle of Arabic literature is not Damascus, but Bagdad, and the protection necessary for its rise and growth was afforded by the Khalifs of the house of Abbas, whose Arab nature has been modified by the influence of Eranian civilisation during a long stay in Khurâsân. The foundation of Arabic literature was laid between A.D. 750 and 850. It is only the tradition relating to their religion and prophet and poetry that is peculiar to the Arabs; everything else is of foreign descent. The development of a large literature, with numerous ramifications, is chiefly the work of foreigners, carried out with foreign materials, as in Rome the origines of the national literature mostly point to Greek sources. Greece, Persia, and India were taxed to help the sterility of the Arab mind. What Greece has contributed by lending its Aristotle, Ptolemy, and Harpocrates is known in general. A de- tailed description of the influx and spread of Greek literature would mark a memorable progress in Oriental philology. Such a work may be undertaken with some chance of success by one who is familiar with the state of Greek literature at the centres of learning during the last centuries of Greek heathendom, although he would have to struggle against the lamentable fact that most Arabic books of this most ancient period are lost, and probably lost for ever. Persian ele- ment in What did Persia, or rather the Sasanian empire, over- Arabic literature. run by the Arab hordes, offer to its victors in literature ?

Page 25

PREFACE. XXIx

It left to the east of the Khalifate the language of administration, the use of which during the following centuries, till recent times, was probably never much discontinued. It was this Perso-Sasanian language of administration which passed into the use of the smaller Eastern dynasties, reared under the Abbaside Khalifs, and became the language of literature at the court of one of those dynasties, that of the Sâmâni kings of Transoxiana and Khurasan. Thus it has come to pass that the dialect of one of the most western parts of Eran first emerged as the language of literature in its farthest east. In a similar way modern German is an offspring of the language used in the chanceries of the Luxembourg emperors of Germany. The bulk of the narrative literature, tales, legends, novels, came to the Arabs in translations from the Per- sian, e.g. the "Thousand and One Nights," the stories told by the mouth of animals, like Kalila and Dimna, pro- bably all of Buddhistic origin, portions of the national lore of Eran, taken from the Khudainama,or Lord's Book, and afterwards immortalised by Firdausi; but more than anything else love-stories. All this was the fashion under the Abbaside Khalifs, and is said to have attained the height of popularity during the rule of Almuktadir, A.D. 908-932. Besides, much favour was apparently bestowed upon didactic, parænetic compositions, mostly clothed in the garb of a testament of this or that Sasanian king or sage, e.g. Anushirvan and his minister Buzurju- mihr, likewise upon collections of moralistic apothegms. All this was translated from l'ersian, or pretended to be so. Books on the science of war, the knowledge of weapons, the veterinary art, falconry, and the various methods of divination, and some books on medicine and de rebus venereis, were likewise borrowed from the Persians. It is noteworthy that, on the other hand, there are very few traces of the exact sciences, such as mathematics and astronomy, among the Sasanian Per-

Page 26

xxx PREFACE.

sians. Either they had only little of this kind, or the Arabs did not choose to get it translated. An author by the name of 'Ali Ibn Ziyad Altamimi is said to have translated from Persian a book, Zij- alshahriyar, which, to judge by the title, must have been a system of astronomy. It seems to have been extant when Alberuni wrote his work on chronology ; vide "Chronology of Ancient Nations," translated, &c., by Edward Sachan, London, 1876, p. 6, and note p. 368. Perhaps it was from this source that the famous Alkh- warizmi drew his knowledge of Persian astronomy, which he is said to have exhibited in his extract from the Brahmasiddhanta, composed by order of the Khalif Ma'mun. For we are expressly told (vide Gildemeister, Scriptorum Arabum de rebus Indicis loci, &c., p. 101) that he used the media, i.c. the mean places of the planets as fixed by Brahmagupta, whilst in other things he deviated from him, giving the equations of the planetary revolutions according to the theory of the Persians, and the declination of the sun according to I'tolemy. Of what kind this Persian astronomy was we do not know, but we must assume that it was of a scientific character, based on observation and compu- tation, else Alkhwarizmi would not have introduced its results into his own work. Of the terminology of Arabian astronomy, the word jnusahar= Caput draconis, is probably of Sasanian origin (gaocithra), as well as the word ztj (= canon), i.c. a collection of astro- nomical tables with the necessary explanations, perhaps also lardaj, kardaja, a measure in geometry equal to #5 of the circumference of a circle, if it be identical with the Persian karda, i.c. cut.

Indian elc- What India has contributed reached Bagdad by two ments in Arabic different roads. P'art has come directly in translations literature. from the Sanskrit, part has travelled through Eran, having originally been translated from Sanskrit (Pali ? Prakrit ?) into Persian, and farther from Persian into

Page 27

PREFACE. XXX1

Arabic. In this way, e.g. the fables of Kolilo ond Dimna have been communicated to the Arabs, and a book on medicine, probably the famous Curaka. Cf. Fihrist, p. 303. In this communication between India and Bagdad we must not only distinguish between two different roads, but also between two different periods. As Sindh was nnder the actual rule of the Khalif Mansur (A.D 753-774), there came embassies from that part of India to Bagdad, and among them scholars, who brought along with them two books, the Brahmasid- dhanta to Brahmagupta (Sindbind), and his Khanda- khadyaka (Arkand). With the help of these pandits, Alfazari, perhaps also Yakub Ibn Tarik, translated them. Both works have been largely used, and have exercised a great influence. It was on this occasion that the Arabs first became acquainted with a scientific system of astronomy. They learned from Brahmagnpta earlier than from I'tolemy. Another influx of Hindu learning took place under Harun, A.D. 786-SoS. The ministerial family Barmak, then at the zenith of their power, had come with the ruling dynasty from Balkh, where an ancestor of theirs had been an official in the Buddhistic temple Nonbrhar, i.e. nara vihara =the new temple (or monastery). The name Barmak is said to be of Indian descent, meaning paramuka, i.e. the superior (abbot of the rihara ?). Cf. Kern, Geschichte dcs Buddhismus in Indien, ii. 445, 543- Of course, the Barmak family had been converted, but their contemporaries never thought much of their pro- fession of Islam, nor regarded it as genuine. Induced probably by family traditions, they sent scholars to India, there to study medicine and pharmacology. Be- sides, they engaged Hindu scholars to come to Bagdad, made them the chief physicians of their hospitals, and ordered them to translate from Sanskrit into Arabic books on medicine, pharmacology, toxicology, philo-

Page 28

XXX11 PREFACE.

sophy, astrology, and other subjects. Still in later centuries Muslim scholars sometimes travelled for the same purposes as the emissaries of the Barmak, e.g. Almuwaffak not long before Alberuni's time (Codex Vindobonensis, sive medici Abu Mansur liber fundamen- torum pharmacologice, ed. Seligmann, Vienna, 1859, pp. 6, 10, and 15, 9). Soon afterwards, when Sindh was no longer politically dependent upon Bagdad, all this intercourse ceased en- tirely. Arabic literature turned off into other channels. There is no more mention of the presence of Hindu scholars at Bagdad nor of translations of the Sanskrit. Greek learning had already won an omnipotent sway over the mind of the Arabs, being communicated to them by the labours of Nestorian physicians, the philo- sophers of Harran, and Christian scholars in Syria and other parts of the Khalifate. Of the more ancient or Indo-Arabian stratum of scientific literature nothing has reached our time save a number of titles of books, many of them in such a corrupt form as to baffle all attempts at decipherment. Among the Hindu physicians of this time one ne o ?! is mentioned, i.e. the son of DHN, director of the hos- pital of the Barmaks in Bagdad. This name may be Dhanya or Dhanin, chosen probably on account of its etymological relationship with the name Dhanvantari, the name of the mythical physician of the gods in Manu's law-book and the epos (ef. A. Weber, Indische Litteraturgeschichte, pp. 284, 287). A similar relation seems to exist between the names Kanka, that of a physician of the same period, and Kankayana, an authority in Indian medicine (cf. Weber, l. c., pp. 287 note, and 284 note, 302). The name by, that of an author of a book on drinkables, may be identical with Atri, mentioned as a medical author by Weber, l. c., p. 288. There was a book by one bo (also written sla) on

Page 29

PREFACE. xxxiii

wisdom or philosophy (ef. Fihrist, p. 305). According to Middle-Indian phonetics this name is= redaryasa.1 A man of this name, also called Vyâsa or Bâdarayana, is, according to the literary tradition of India, the originator of the Vedanta school of philosophy (ef. Colebroke, Essays, i. 352), and this will remind the reader that in the Arabian Sufism the Indian Vedânta philosophy reappears. Further, an author .oL, Sudbrm,2 is mentioned, unfortunately without an indication of the contents of his book. Alberuni (i. 157) mentions one Satya as the author of a jataka (cf. Weber, l. c., p. 278), and this name is perhaps an abbreviation of that one here mentioned, i.c. Sutyararmon. A work on astrology is attributed to one Jexie, SNGHL (ride Fihrist, p. 271), likewise enumerated by Alberuni in a list of names (i. 158). The Indian equivalent of this name is not certain (ef. note to i. 158). There is also mentioned a book on the signs of swords by one b, probably identical with Vyaghra, which occurs as a name of Indian authors (ef. i. Fihrist, p. 315). The famous Buddha legend in Christian garb, most commonly called Joosaph and Borlanm, bears in Fihrist, p. 300, the title بوياسف وبلوهر . The former word is gene- rally explained as Bodhisattra, although there is no law in Indian phonetics which admits the change of sattra to saf. The second name is that of Buddha's spiritual teacher and guide, in fact, his purohita, and with this word I am inclined to identify the signs in question, i.e. aL. What Ibn Wadih in his chronicle (ed. by Hontsma) relates of India, on pp. 92-106, is not of much value. His words on p. 105, "the king &,S = Ghosha, who 1 Benfey in Kalilag und Damnag, Einleitung, p. xliii. note 3. The word has received currency in the form Bidpai. 2 Cf. Benfey, l. c., Einleitung, p. xl. VOL. I. C

Page 30

xxxiv PREFACE.

lived in the time of Sindbad the sage, and this Ghosha composed the book on the cunning of the women," are perhaps an indication of some fables of Buddhaghosha having been translated into Arabic. Besides books on astronomy, mathematics (lJ1 dl), astrology, chiefly jatakas, on medicine and pharmacology, the Arabs translated Indian works on snakes (sarparidy), on poison (visharidya), on all kinds of auguring, on talismans, on the veterinary art, de arte amandi, numerous tales, a life of Buddha, books on logic and philosophy in general, on ethics, politics, and on the science of war. Many Arab authors took up the subjects communicated to them by the Hindus and worked them ont in original compositions, commen- taries, and extracts. A favourite subject of theirs was Indian mathematics, the knowledge of which became far spread by the publications of Alkindi and many others. The smaller dynasties which in later times tore the sovereignty over certain eastern countries of the Khali- fate out of the hands of the successors of Mansur and Harun, did not continue their literary commerce with India. The Bant-Laith (A.D. 872-903), owning great part of Afghanistan together with Ghazna, were the neighbours of Hindus, but their name is in no way connected with the history of literature. For the Buyide princes who ruled over Western Persia and Babylonia between A.D. 932 and 1055, the fables of Kalila and Dimna were translated. Of all these princely houses, no doubt, the Samanides, who held almost the whole east of the Khalifate under their sway during 892-999, had most relations with the Hindus, those in Kabul, the Panjab, and Sindh; and their minister, Aljaihanî, probably had collected much information about India. Originally the slave of the Samanides, then their general and provincial governor, Alptagin, made himself practically independent in Ghazna a few

Page 31

PREFACE. xxxV

years before Alberuni was born, and his successor, Sabuktagin, Mahmud's father, paved the road for the war with India (i. 22), and for the lasting establish- ment of Islam in India. Some of the books that had been translated under The anthor's the first Abbaside Khalifs were extant in the library stndy of India before of Alberuni when he wrote the 'Ivowa, the Brahma- he wrote the present siddhanta or Sindhind, and the Khandakhadyaka or book,

Arkand in the editions of Alfazari and of Yakub Ibn Tarik, the Caraka in the edition of 'Ali Ibn Zain, and the Pancatantra or Kalila and Dimna. He also used an Arabic translation of the Karanasaro by Vitteśvara (ii. 55), but we do not learn from him whether this was an old translation or a modern one made in Alberuni's time. These books offered to Alberuni-he complains of it repeatedly-the same difficulties as to us, viz., besides the faults of the translators, a considerable corruption of the text by the negligence of the copyists, more particularly as regards the proper names. When Alberuni entered India, he probably had a good general knowledge of Indian mathematics, astro- nomy, and chronology, acquired by the study of Brahmna- gupta and his Arabian editors. What Hindu anthor was his teacher and that of the Arabs in pure mathe- matics ( الحساب الهندى )isnot known. Besides A lfazari and Yakub Ibn Tarik, he learned from Alkhwarizmi, something from Abulhasan of Ahwaz, things of little value from Alkindf and Abu-Mashar of Balkh, and single details from the famons book of Aljaihâni. Of other sources which he has used in the 'Ivota, he quotes : (1.) A Muhammadan canon called Alharkan, i.e. ahargana. I cannot trace the history of the book, but suppose that it was a practical handbook of chronology for the purpose of converting Arabian and Persian dates into Indian ones and vice versa, which had perhaps been necessitated by the wants of the administration under Sabuktagin and Mahmud. The name of the anthor is

Page 32

XXXV1 PREFACE.

not mentioned. (2.) Abu Ahmad Ibn Catlaghtagin, quoted i. 317 as having computed the latitudes of Karli and Taneshar. Two other authorities on astronomical subjects are quoted, but not in relation to Indian astronomy, Muhammad Ibn Ishak, from Saralhs, ii. 15, and a book called Ghurrat-alzijat, perhaps derived from an Indian source, as the name is identical with Karanatilaka. The author is perhaps Abu-Muhammad Alnaib from Âmul (ef. note to ii. 90). In India Alberuni recommenced his study of Indian astronomy, this time not from translations, but from Sanskrit originals, and we here meet with the remark- able fact that the works which about A.D. 770 had been the standard in India still held the same high position A.D. 1020, viz., the works of Brahmagupta. Assisted by learned pandits, he tried to translate them, as also the Pulisasiddhanta (vide preface to the edition of the text, § 5), and when he composed the 'Ivotkd, he had already come forward with several books devoted to special points of Indian astronomy. As such he quotes :- (1.) A treatise on the determination of the lunar stations or nakshatras, ii. 83. (2.) The Khayal-alkusfaini, which contained, pro- bably beside other things, a description of the Yogo theory, ii. 208. (3.) A book called The Arabic Khandakhadyakn, on the same subject as the preceding one, ii. 208. (4.) A book containing a description of the Karanas, the title of which is not mentioned, ii. 194. (5.) A treatise on the various systems of numeration, as used by different nations, i. 174, which probably described also the related Indian subjects. (6.) A book called " Key of Astronomy," on the ques- tion whether the sun rotates round the earth or the earth round the sun, i. 277. We may suppose that in

Page 33

PREFACE. XXXV11

this book he had also made use of the notions of Indian astronomers. (7.) Lastly, several publications on the different methods for the computation of geographical longitude, i. 315. He does not mention their titles, nor whether they had any relation to Hindu methods of calculation. Perfectly at home in all departments of Indian astro- nomy and chronology, he began to write the 'Ivoa. In the chapters on these subjects he continues a literary movement which at his time had already gone on for centuries; but he surpassed his predecessors by going back upon the original Sanskrit sources, trying to check his pandits by whatever Sanskrit he had contrived to learn, by making new and more accurate translations, and by his conscientious method of testing the data of the Indian astronomers by calculation. His work repre- sents a scientific renaissance in comparison with the aspirations of the scholars working in Bagdad under the first Abbaside Khalifs. Alberuni seems to think that Indian astrology had not been transferred into the more ancient Arabic literature, as we may conclude from his introduction to Chapter lxxx. : "Our fellow-believers in these (Muslim) countries are not acquainted with the Hindu methods of astrology, and have never had an opportunity of studying an Indian book on the subject," ii. 211. We cannot prove that the works of Varahamihira, e.g. his Brihatsamhita and Laghujatakam, which Alberuni was translating, had already been accessible to the Arabs at the time of Mansur, but we are inclined to think that Alberuni's judgment on this head is too sweeping, for books on astrology, and particularly on jataka, had already been translated in the early days of the Abba- side rule. Cf. Fihrist, pp. 270, 271. As regards Indian medicine, we can only say that Alberuni does not seem to have made a special study of it, for he simply uses the then current translation of

Page 34

xxxviii PREFACE.

Caraka, although complaining of its incorrectness, i.' 159, 162, 382. He has translated a Sanskrit treatise on loathsome diseases into Arabic (ef. preface to the edition of the original, p. xxi. No. 18), but we do not know whether before the 'Ivoua or after it. What first induced Alberuni to write the Ivotka was not the wish to enlighten his countrymen on Indian astronomy in particular, but to present them with an impartial description of the Indian theological and philosophical doctrines on a broad basis, with every detail pertaining to them. So he himself says both at the beginning and end of the book. Perhaps on this subject he could give his readers more perfectly new information than on any other, for, according to his own statement, he had in this only one predecessor, Aleranshahrî. Not knowing him or that authority which he follows, i.e. Zurkan, we cannot form an estimate as to how far Alberuni's strictures on jthem (i. 7) are founded. Though there can hardly be any doubt that Indian philosophy in one or other of its principal forms had been communicated to the Arabs already in the first period, it seems to have been some- thing entirely new when Alberuni produced before his compatriots or fellow-believers the Samkhya by Kapila, and the Book of Putanjali in good Arabic translations. It was this particular work which admirably qualified him to write the corresponding chapters of the 'Ivoukd. The philosophy of India seems to have fascinated his mind, and the noble ideas of the Bhugavadgita pro- bably came near to the standard of his own persua- sions. Perhaps it was he who first introduced this gem of Sanskrit literature into the world of Muslim readers. As regards the Puranas, Alberuni was perhaps the first Muslim who took up the study of them. At all events, we cannot trace any acquaintance with them on the part of the Arabs before his time. Of the litera-

Page 35

PREFACE. xxxIX

ture of fables, he knew the Pancatantra in the Arabic edition of Ibn Almukaffa. Judging Alberuni in relation to his predecessors, we come to the conclusion that his work formed a most marked progress. His description of Hindu philosophy was probably unparalleled. His system of chronology and astronomy was more complete and accurate than had ever before been given. His communications from the Puranas were probably entirely new to his readers, as also the important chapters on literature, manners, festivals, actnal geography, and the much-quoted chap- ter on historic chronology. He once quotes Râzi, with whose works he was intimately acquainted, and some Sûfî philosophers, but from neither of them could he learn much about India. In the following pages we give a list of the Sanskrit His Sanskrit books quoted in the 'Ινδικά :- sources.

Sources of the chapters on theology and philosophy : Satmkhya, by Kapila ; Book of Patanjuli ; Gita, i.e. some edition of the Bhagarudgtta. He seems to have used more sources of a similar nature, but he does not quote from them. Sources of a Pauranic kind : Vishnu-Dharma, Vishņu- Purana, Matsyu-Purana, Vayu-Purana, Aditya-Puraņa. Sources of the chapters on astronomy, chronology, geography, and astrology : Pulisasiddhanta ; Bruhma- siddhnta, Khandukhadyuka, Uttarakhuņdukhadyaka, by Brahmagupta; Commentary of the Khandulhad- yaka, by Balabhadra, perhaps also some other work of his ; Brihatsamhita, Pancasiddhantika, Brihat-jatakum, Laghu-jatakum, by Varahamihira ; Commentary of the Brihatsarihittt, a book called Srudhara (perhaps Surrn- dhurw), by Utpala, from Kashmir ; a book by Aryabhata, junior; Kuranasdra, by Vitteśvara; Karuņatilaka, by Vijayanandin ; Sripala ; Book of the Rishi (sic) Bhuvuna- kośa; Book of the Brahmun Bhuttila ; Book of Durlubha,

Page 36

xl PREFACE.

from Multan; Bool: of Jirasarman ; Book of Samaya ; Book of Aulintta (?), the son of Sahawi (?); The Minor Manasa, by Puñcala; Srdhava (Sarvadhara?), by Mahadeva Candrabija; Calendar from Kashmir. As regards some of these authors, Śripala, Jivasar- man, Samaya (?), and Auliatta (?), the nature of the quotations leaves it uncertain whether Alberuni quoted from books of theirs or from oral communications which he had received from them. Source on medicine : Caraka, in the Arabic edition of 'Alî Ibn Zain, from Tabaristan. In the chapter on metrics, a lexicographic work by one Haribhata (?), and regarding elephants a "Book on the Medicine of Elephants," are quoted. His communications from the Mahabharata and Ramayana, and the way in which he speaks of them, do not give us the impression that he had these books before him. He had some information of Jaina origin, but does not mention his source (Âryabhata, jun .? ) Once he quotes Mann's Dharmasastra, but in a manner which makes me doubt whether he took the words directly from the book itself.1 The quotations which he has made from these sources are, some of them, very extensive, e.g. those from the Bhagavadgita. In the chapter on literature he men- tions many more books than those here enumerated, but does not tell us whether he made use of them for the 'Ivotd. Sometimes he mentions Hindu individuals as his informants, e.g. those from Somanath, i. 161, 165, and from Kanoj, i. 165; ii. 129. In Chapter i. the author speaks at large of the radical difference between Muslims and Hindus in everything, and tries to account for it both by the history of India and by the peculiarities of the national character of its inhabitants (i. 17 seg.). Everything in India is just

1 The places where mention of these books occurs are given in Index I. Cf. also the annotations on single cases.

Page 37

PREFACE. xli

the reverse of what it is in Islam, "and if ever a custom of theirs resembles one of ours, it has certainly just the opposite meaning " (i. 179). Much more certainly than to Alberuni, India would seem a land of wonders and monstrosities to most of his readers. Therefore, in order to show that there were other nations who held and hold similar notions, he compares Greek philosophy, chiefly that of Plato, and tries to illustrate Hindu notions by those of the Greeks, and thereby to bring them nearer to the understanding of his readers. The role which Greek literature plays in Alberuni's Greck and work in the distant country of the Paktyes and Gandhari lels. other paral-

is a singular fact in the history of civilisation. Plato before the doors of India, perhaps in India itself ! A considerable portion of the then extant Greek literature had found its way into the library of Alberuni, who uses it in the most conscientious and appreciative way, and takes from it choice passages to confront Greek thought with Indian. And more than this: on the part of his readers he seems to presuppose not only that they were acquainted with them, but also gave them the credit of first-rate authorities. Not knowing Greek or Syriac, he read them in Arabic translations, some of which reflect much credit upon their authors. The books he quotes are these :-

Plato, Phædo. Timcus, an edition with a commentary. Leges. In the copy of it there was an appendix relating to the pedigree of Hippokrates. Proclus, Commentary on Timcus (different from the extant one). Aristotle, only short references to his Physicu and Mctuphysica. Letter to Alexander. Johannes Grammaticus, Contra Proclum. Alexander of Aphrodisias, Commentary on Aristotle's uoun άκρόασις. Apollonius of Tyana. Porphyry, Liber historiurum philosophorum (?). Ammonius.

Page 38

xlii PREFACE.

Aratus, Phænomenu, with a commentary. Galenus, Protrepticus. περί συνθέσεως φαρμάκων των κατά τόπους. περί συνθέσεως φαρμάκων κατά γένη. Commentary on the Apophthegms of Hippokrates. De indole aninue. Book of the Proof. Ptolemy, Almagest. Geography. Kitab-almanshurât. Pseudo-Kallisthenes, Alexander romance. Scholia to the Ars grammatica of Dionysius Thrax. A synchronistic bistory, resembling in part that of Johannes Malalas, in part the Chronicon of Eusebius. Cf. notes to i. 112, 105.

The other analogies which he draws, not taken frou Greek, but from Zoroastrian, Christian, Jewish, Mani- chæan, and Sufi sources, are not very numerous. He refers only rarely to Eranian traditions ; ef. Index II. (Persian traditions and Zoroastrian). Most of the notes on Christian, Jewish, and Manichæan subjects may have been taken from the book of Eranshahrî (ef. his own words, i. 6, 7), although he knew Christianity from personal experience, and probably also from the communications of his learned friends Abulkhair Al- khammarand Abu-Sahl Almasihi, both Christians from the farther west (ef. Chronologie Oricntalischer Volker, Einleitung, p. xxxii.). The interest he has in Manî's doctrines and books seems rather strange. We are not acquainted with the history of the remnants of Mani- chæism in those days and countries, but cannot help thinking that the quotations from Mani's " Book of Mysteries " and Thesaurus Vivificationis do not justify Alberuni's judgment in this direction. He seems to have seen in them venerable documents of a high antiquity, instead of the syncretistic ravings of a would- be prophet. That he was perfectly right in comparing the Sûfî philosophy-he derives the word from oodia, i. 33-

Page 39

PREFACE. xliii

with certain doctrines of the Hindus is apparent to any one who is aware of the essential identity of the systems of the Greek Neo-Pythagoreans, the Hindu Vedanta philosophers, and the Sufis of the Muslim world. The authors whom he quotes, Abu Yazid Albistami and Abu Bakr Alshibli, are well-known representatives of Sufism. Cf. note to i. 87, 88. As far as the present state of research allows one to judge, the work of Alberuni has not been continued. In astronomy he seems by his Canon Masudicus to represent the height, and at the same time the end, of the independent development of this science among the Arabs. But numerous scholars toiled on in his wake, whilst in the study of India, and for the translation of the standard works of Sanskrit literature, he never had a successor before the days of the Emperor Akbar. There followed some authors who copied from his 'Ivouka, but there was none who could carry on the work in his spirit and method after he had died, eighteen years after the composition of the 'Ivdtkd. We must here mention two anthors who lived not long after him, under the same dynasty, and probably in the same place, Ghazna, viz., Gardêzî (cf. note to ii. 6), who wrote between A.D. 1049 and 1052, and Muhammad Ibn 'Ukail, who wrote between A.D. 1089 and 1099 (ef. note to i. 5). Of the later authors who studied Alberuni's 'Ivdikd and copied from it, the most notorious is Rashid-aldin, who transferred, e.g. the whole geogra- phical Chapter xviii. into his huge chronicle. When Alberuni entered India, times were not favour- India at the able for opening friendly relations with native scholars. time. author's

India recoiled from the touch of the impure barbarians. The Pala dynasty, once ruling over Kabulistan and the Panjab, had disappeared from the theatre of history, and their former dominions were in the firm grasp of King Mahmud and under the administration of his slaves, of Turkish descent. The princes of North-Western

Page 40

xliv PREFACE.

India had been too narrow-minded, too blind in their self-conceit, duly to appreciate the danger threatening from Ghazna, and too little politic in due time to unite for a common defence and repulse of the enemy. Single-handed Anandapala had had to fight it out, and had succumbed ; but the others were to follow, each one in his turn. All those who would not bear the yoke of the mlccchas fed and took up their abode in the neighbouring Hindu empires. Kashmir was stillindependent, and was hermetically sealed to all strangers (i. 206). Anandapala had fled there. Mahmud had tried the conquest of the coun- try, but failed. About the time when Alberuni wrote, the rule passed from the hands of Sangramadeva, A.D. 1007-1030, into those of Anantadeva, A.D. 1030- IOS2. Central and Lower Sindh were rarely meddled with by Mahmud. The country seems to have been split into minor principalities, ruled by petty Muslim dynasties. like the Karmatian dsnasty of Multan, deposed by Mahmùd. In the conditions of the Gurjara empire, the capital of which was Anhilvara or Pattan. the famous expedition of Mahmud to Somanath, A.D. 1025. in some wars re- sembling that of Napoleon to Moscow, does not seem to hare produced any lasting changes. The country was under the sway of the olanki dynasty, who in A.D. 9So had taken the place of the Calukyas. King Camunda fled before Mahmud, who raised another prince of the same house, Devasarman, to the throne; but soon after we find a son of Camunda, Durlabha, as king of Gurjara till A.D. 1037. Malava was ruled by the Pramara dynasty, who, like the kings of Kashmir, had afforded a refuge to a fugitive prince of the Pala dynasty of Kabulistan. Bhojadeva of Malava. ruling between A.D. 997 and 1053. is mentioned by Alberuni. His court at Dhar,

Page 41

PREFACE. x1v

where he had gone from Ujjain, was a rendezvous of the scholars of the time. Kanoj formed at that time part of the realm of the Pâla princes of Gauda or Bengal, who resided in Mongir. During the reign of Rajyapala, Kanoj had been plundered and destroyed by Mahmud, A.D. 1017, in consequence of which a new city farther away from the mlecchas, Bari, had been founded, but does not seem to have grown to any importance. Residing in this place, the King Mahipala tried about A.D. 1026 to consolidate and to extend his empire. Both these rulers are said to have been Buddhists. Cf. Kern, Geschichte des Buddhismus in Indien, ii. 544. The centres of Indian learning were Benares and Kashmir, both inaccessible to a barbarian like Alberuni (i. 22), but in the parts of India under Muslim adminis- tration he seems to have found the pandits he wanted, perhaps also at Ghazna among the prisoners of war. India, as far as known to Alberuni, was Brahmanic, The author not Buddhistic. In the first half of the eleventh cen- dhism. and Bud-

tury all traces of Buddhism in Central Asia, Khurasan, Afghanistan, and North-Western India seem to have disappeared; and it is a remarkable fact that a man of the inquisitive mind of Alberuni knew scarcely any- thing at all about Buddhism, nor had any means for procuring information on the subject. His notes on Buddhism are very scanty, all derived from the book of Eranshahri, who, in his turn, had copied the book of one Zurkân, and this book he seems to indicate to have been a bad one. Cf. i. 7, 249, 326. Buddha is said to be the author of a book called Cudamani (not Gudhamana, as I hare written. i. 158), i.e. Jewel, on the knowledge of the supranaturalistic world. The Buddhists or Shamanians, i.e. sramang, are called Muhammira, which I translate the red-robe wenrers, taking it for identical with raktopata. Cf. note to i. 21.

Page 42

xlvi PREFACE.

Mentioning the trinity of the Buddhistic system, buddha, dharma, sangha, he calls Buddha Buddhodana, which is a mistake for something like the son of Suddho- dana. Cf. note to i. 40 and i. 380, which latter passage is probably derived from the Vishnu-Dharma (on which vide note to i. 54). Of Buddhistic authors there are mentioned Candra, the grammarian, i. 135 (cf. Kern, Geschichte des Bud- dhismus in Indien, ii. 520), Sugriva, the author of an astronomical work, and a pupil of his, i. 156. Of the manners and customs of the Buddhists, only their practice of disposing of their dead by throwing them into flowing water is mentioned, ii. 169. Alberuni speaks (ii. 11) of a building erected by King Kanishka in Peshavar, and called Kanishkacaitya, as existing in his time, most likely identical with that stupa which he is reported to have built in consequence of a prophecy of no less a person than Buddha himself. Cf. Kern, l. c., ii. 187. The word bihar, i.e. vihara, which Alberuni sometimes uses in the meaning of temple and the like, is of Buddhistic origin. Cf. Kern, l. c., ii. 57. Among the various kinds of writing used in India, he enumerates as the last one the " Bhaikshuki, used in Udunpûr in Purradesa. This last is the writing of Buddha," i. 173. Was this Udunpur (we may also read Udannapur) the Buddhistic monastery in Magadha, Udandapuri, that was destroyed by the Muslims, A.D. 1200? Cf. Kern, l. c., ii. 545. The kosmographic views of the Buddhists, as given by Alberuni, i. 249, 326, ought to be examined as to their origin. Perhaps it will be possible to point out the particular Buddhistic book whence they were taken. He speaks twice of an antagonism between Buddha and Zoroaster. If Alberuni had had the same opportunity for travel- ling in India as Hiouen-Tsang had, he would easily have collected plenty of information on Buddhism.

Page 43

PREFACE. xlvii

Considering the meagreness of his notes on this subject, we readily believe that he never found a Buddhistic book, and never knew a Bnddhist " from whom I might have learned their theories," i. 249. His Brahman pan- dits probably knew enough of Buddhism, but did not choose to tell him. Lastly, India, as known to Alberuni, was in matters of religion Vishnuitic (rrishnave), not Sivaitic (srira). Vislinn, or Narayana, is the first god in the pantheon of his Hindu informants and literary authorities, whilst Siva is only incidentally mentioned, and that not always in a favourable manner. This indicates a remarkable change in the religious history of those countries. For the predecessors of Mahmud in the rule over Kabulistan and the Panjab, the Pala dynasty, were worshippers of Śiva (cf. Lassen, Indische Allerthumskunde, 3, 895), as we may judge from their coins, adorned with the image of Nanda, the ox of Siva, and from the etymology of their names. Cf. note to ii. 13, and Lassen, l. e., 3, 915. The image of Nanda reappears a second time on the coins of the last of the descendants of King Mahmud on the throne of Ghazna.

CONCLUSION.

It was in the summer of 1883 that I began to work at the edition and translation of the 'Ivotko, after having fulfilled the literary duties resulting from my journey in Syria and Mesopotamia in 1879 and 1880. A copy of the Arabic manuscript had been prepared in 1872, and collated in Stambul in the hot summer months of 1873. In order to test my comprehension of the book, I translated it into German from beginning to end between February 1883 and February 1884. In the summer of the latter year the last hand was laid to the constitu- tion of the Arabic text as it was to be printed.

Page 44

xlvili PREFACE.

In 1885-86 the edition of the Arabic original was printed. At the same time I translated the whole book a second time, into English, finishing the translation of every single sheet as the original was carried through the press. In 1887 and the first half of 1888 the English trans- lation, with annotations and indices, was printed. My work during all these years was not uninter- rupted. Translating an Arabic book, written in the style of Alberui, into English, is, for a person to whom English is not his mother-tongue, au act of temerity, which, when I was called upon to commit it, gravely affected my conscience to such a degree that I began to falter, and seriously thought of giving up the whole thing alto- gether. But then there rose up before "my mind's ere " the venerable figure of old MacGuckin de Slane, and as he had been gathered to his fathers, I could not get back the word I had given him. Cf. preface to the edition of the Arabic text, p. viii. Assuredly, to do justice to the words of Alberuni would require a com- mand over English like that of Sir Theodore Martin, the translator of " Faust," or Chenery, the translator of Hariri. As. regards my own translation, I can only say I have tried to find common sense in the anthor's language, and to render it as clearly as I could. In this I was greatly assisted by my friend the Rev. Robert Gwynne, Vicar of St. Mary's, Soho, London, whose training in Eastern languages and literature qualified him to co- operate in revising the entire manuscript and correcting the proof sheets. Perhaps it will not be superfluous to point out to the reader who does not know Arabic that this language sometimes exhibits sentences perfectly clear as to the meaning of every single word and the syntactic construc- tion, and nevertheless admitting of entirely different

Page 45

PREFACE. xlix

interpretations. Besides, a first translator who steers out on such a sea, like him who first tries to explain a difficult, hardly legible inscription, exposes himself to many dangers which he would easily have avoided had kind fortune permitted him to follow in the wake of other explorers. Under these circumstances, I do not flatter myself that I have caught the sense of the author everywhere, and I warn the reader not to take a trans- lation, in particular a first translation, from Arabic for more than it is. It is nothing absolute, but only relative in many respects; and if an Indianist does not fiud good Indian thought in my translation, I would advise him to consult the next Arabic philologist he meets. If the two can obtain a better insight into the subject-matter, they are very likely to produce a better rendering of the words. My annotations do not pretend to be a running com- mentary on the book, for that cannot be written except by a professed Iudianist. They contain some informa- tion as to the sources used by Alberuni, and as to those materials which guided me in translating. On the phonetic peculiarities of the Indian words as transcribed by Albernni, the reader may compare a treatise of mine called Indo-Arabische Studien, and presented to the Royal Academy of Berlin on 21st June of this year. My friend Dr. Robert Schram, of the University of Vienna, has examined all the mathematical details of chronology and astronomy. The results of his studies are presented to the reader in the annotations signed with his name. All this is Dr. Schram's special domain, in which he has no equal. My thanks are due to him for leuding me his help in parts of the work where my own attempts at verification, after prolonged exertions in the same direction, proved to be insufficient. Of the two indices, the former contains all words of Indian origin occurring in the book, some pure Sanskrit, some vernacular, others in the form exhibited by the VOL. I.

Page 46

P.REFACE.

Arabic manuscript, howsoever faulty it may be. The reader will perhaps here and there derive some advan- tage from comparing the index of the edition of the Arabic original. The second index contains names of persons and places, &c., mostly of non-Indian origin. It was the Committee of the Oriental Translation Fund, consisting at the time of Osmond de Beanvoir Priaulx, Edward Thomas, James Fergusson, Reinhold Rost, and Theodore Goldsticker, who first proposed to me to translate the 'Ivoika. Thomas, Goldstucker, and Fergusson are beyond the reach of human words, but to O. de Beauvoir Priaulx, Esq., and to Dr. Rost, I desire to express my sincerest gratitude for the generous help and the untiring interest which they have always ac- corded to me, thongh so many years have rolled on since I first pledged to them my word. Lastly, Her Majesty's India Office has extended its patronage from the edition of the Arabic original also to this edition of the work in an English garb. Of the works of my predecessors, the famous publica- tion of Reinaud, the Memoire geographique, historique et scientifique sur l'Inde, Paris, 1849, has been most useful to me. Cf. on this and the labours of my other pre- decessors § 2 of the preface to the edition of the Arabic original. The Sanskrit alphabet has been transliterated in the following way :- n, a, i, î, u, u-ri, ai, au-, kh, g, gh, a-c, ch, j, jh, n-t, th, d, dh, n-t, th, d, dh, n-p, ph, b, bh, m-y, r, l, v-ś, sh, s, h.

EDWARD SACHAU.

BERLIN, August 4, 1888.

Page 47

TABLE OF CONTENTS.

(For Alberuni's Synopsis of the Single Chapters of the Book, vide pp. 9-16.)

VOL. PAGE I. 3. AUTHOR'S PREFACE. 9. SYNOPSIS OF THE EIGHTY CHAPTERS.

  1. CHAPTER I., AUTHOR'S SPECIAL INTRODUCTION.

  2. CHAPTERS II .- XI., ON RELIGION, PHILOSOPHY, AND

RELATED SUBJECTS.

  1. CHAPTERS XII .- XVII., ON LITERATURE, METROLOGY, USAGES, AND RELATED SUBJECTS.

  2. CHAPTERS XVIII .- XXXI., ON GEOGRAPHY, COSMO- GRAPHY, AND ASTRONONY.

319 TO VOL. II. P. 129. CHAPTERS XXXII .- LXII., ON CHRC- NOLOGY, ASTRONOMY, AND RELATED SUBJECTS.

II. 130. CHAPTERS LXIII .- LXXIX., ON MANNERS AND CUS- 7 TOMS, FESTIVALS, AND RELATED SUBJECTS.

  1. CHAPTER LXXX., ON ASTROLOGY.

  2. ANNOTATIONS OF THE TRANSLATOR.

403-431. INDICES.

Page 48

ALBERUNI'S INDIA

AN

ACCURATE DESCRIPTION OF ALL CATEGORIES

OF HINDU THOUGHT,

AS WELL THOSE WHICH ARE ADMISSIBLE AS

THOSE WHICH MUST BE REECTED.

COMPOSED BY

'ABC-ALRAIIAN MUHAMMAD IBN 'AILMAD

ALBÊRÛNÎ.

VOL. I.

Page 49

PREFACE.

IN THE NAME OF GOD, THE COMPASSIONATE, THE Page 2. MERCIFUL.

No one will deny that in questions of historic authen- 1. On tra- ticity hearsay does not eqnal eye-witness ; for in the latter dition, hcar- say and eye- the eye of the observer apprehends the substance of that witness. 2. Thedif- which is observed, both in the time when and in the ferent kinds of reporters. place where it exists, whilst hearsay has its peculiar 3. Praise of truth ful- drawbacks. But for these, it would even be preferable ness. to eye-witness ; for the object of eye-witness can only be actual momentary existence, whilst hearsay comprehends alike the present, the past, and the future, so as to apply in a certain sense both to that which is and to that which is not (i.e. which either has ceased to exist or has not yet come into existence). Written tradition is one of the species of hearsay-we might almost say, the most preferable. How could we know the history of nations but for the everlasting monuments of the pen ? The tradition regarding an event which in itself does not contradict either logical or physical laws will invari- ably depend for its character as true or false upon the character of the reporters, who are influenced by the divergency of interests and all kinds of animosities and antipathies between the various nations. We must distinguish different classes of reporters. One of them tells a lie, as intending to further an

Page 50

4 PREFACE.

interest of his own, either by lauding his family or nation, because he is one of them, or by attacking the family or nation on the opposite side, thinking that thereby he can gain his ends. In both cases he acts from motives of objectionable cupidity and animosity. Another one tells a lie regarding a class of people whom he likes, as being under obligations to them, or whom he hates because something disagreeable has happened between them. Such a reporter is near akin to the first-mentioned one, as he too acts from motives of personal predilection and enmity. Another tells a lie because he is of such a base nature as to aim thereby at some profit, or because he is such a coward as to be afraid of telling the truth. Another tells a lie because it is his nature to lie, and he cannot do otherwise, which proceeds from the essen- tial meanness of his character and the depravity of his innermost being. Lastly, a man may tell a lie from ignorance, blindly following others who told him. If, now, reporters of this kind become so numerous as to represent a certain body of tradition, or if in the course of time they even come to form a consecutive series of communities or nations, both the first reporter and his followers form the connecting links between the hearer and the inventor of the lie; and if the connecting links are eliminated, there remains the originator of the story, one of the various kinds of liars we have enumerated, as the only person with whom we have to deal. That man only is praiseworthy who shrinks from a lie and always adheres to the truth, enjoying credit even among liars, not to mention others. It has been said in the Koran, " Speak the truth, even if it were against yourselves" (Sura, 4, 134); and the Messiah Page 3. expresses himself in the Gospel to this effect : " Do not mind the fury of kings in speaking the truth before them.

Page 51

PREFACE. 5

They only possess your body, but they hare no power over your soul" (ef. St. Matt. x. 18, 19, 28; St. Luke xii. 4). In these words the Messiah orders us to exercise moral courage. For what the crowd calls courage-bravely dashing into the fight or plunging into an abyss of de- struction-is only a species of courage, whilst the genus, far above all species, is to scorn death, whether by word or deed. Now as justice (i.e. being just) is a quality liked and coveted for its own self, for its intrinsic beauty, the same applies to truthfulness, except perhaps in the case of such people as never tasted how sweet it is, or know the truth, but deliberately shun it, like a notorious liar who once was asked if he had ever spoken the truth, and gave the answer, "If I were not afraid to speak the truth, I should say, no." A liar will avoid the path of justice; he will, as matter of preference, side with op- pression and false witness, breach of confidence, fraudu- lent appropriation of the wealth of others, theft, and all the vices which serve to ruin the world and mankind. When I once called upon the master 'Abû-Sahl I. On the 'Abd-Almun'im Ibn 'Ali Ibn Nuh At-tiflisî, may God Muslim defccts of

strengthen him ! I found that he blamed the tendency of religious works on

the author of a book on the Mu tazila sect to misrepresent and philoso- phical doc- their theory. For, according to them, God is omniscient trines. II. Exem- of himself, and this dogma that anthor had expressed in plifed with regard to the such a way as to say that God has no knowledge (like Hindus, Criticism of the knowledge of man), thereby misleading uneducated the book of Erânshahri. people to imagine that, according to the Mu'tazilites, asked to III. Bêrônî

God is ignorant. Praise be to God, who is far above all on the sub- write a book

such and similar unworthy descriptions! Thereupon I ject. IV. He pointed out to the master that precisely the same method states hig method. is much in fashion among those who undertake the task of giving an account of religious and philosophical systems from which they slightly ditfer or to which they are entirely opposed. Such misrepresentation is easily detected in a report about dogmas comprehended within

Page 52

6 PREFACE.

the frame of one single religion, because they are closely related and blended with each other. On the other hand, you would have great difficulty in detecting it in a report about entirely foreign systems of thought totally differing both in principle and details, for such a research is rather an out-of-the-way one, and there are few means of arriving at a thorongh comprehension of it. The same tendency prevails throughout our whole literature on philosophical and religious sects. If such an author is not alive to the requirements of a strictly scientific method, he will procure some superficial information which will satisfy neither the adherents of the doctrine in question nor those who really know it. In such a case, if he be an honest character, he will simply retract and feel ashamed; but if he be so base as not to give due honour to truth, he will persist in litigious wrangling for his own original standing-point. If, on the contrary, an author has the right method, he will do his utmost to deduce the tenets of a sect from their legendary lore, things which people tell him, pleasant enough to listen to, but which he would never dream of taking for true or believing. In order to illustrate the point of our conversation, Page 4. one of those present referred to the religions and doc- trines of the Hindus by way of an example. There- upon I drew their attention to the fact that everything which exists on this subject in our literature is second- hand information which one has copied from the other, a farrago of materials never sifted by the sieve of critical examination. Of all authors of this class, I know only one who had proposed to himself to give a simple and exact report of the subject sine ird ac studio, viz. 'Abû-alabbâs Alerânshahrî. He himself did not believe in any of the then existing religions, but was the sole believer in a religion invented by himself, which he tried to propagate. He has given a very good account of the doctrines of the Jews and Christians as well as

Page 53

PREFACE. 7

of the contents of both the Thora and the Gospel. Besides, he fnrnishes us with a most excellent account of the Manichæans, and of obsolete religions of bygone times which are mentioned in their books. But when he came in his book to speak of the Hindus and the Buddhists, his arrow missed the mark, and in the latter part he went astray through hitting upon the book of Zarkan, the contents of which he incorporated in his own work. That, however, which he has not taken from Zarkan, he himself has heard from common people among Hindus and Buddhists. At a subsequent period the master 'Abu-Sahl studied the books in question a second time, and when he found the matter exactly as I have here described it, he incited me to write down what I know about the Hindus as a help to those who want to discuss religious questions with them, and as a repertory of information to those who want to associate with them. In order to please him I have done so, and written this book on the doctrines of the Hindus, never making any ufounded imputations against those, our religious antagonists, and at the same time not considering it inconsistent with my duties as a Muslim to quote their own words at full length when I thought they would contribute to eluci- date a subject. If the contents of these quotations happen to be utterly heathenish, and the followers of the truth, i.e. the Muslims, find them objectionable, we can only say that such is the belief of the Hindus, and that they themselves are best qualified to defend it. This book is not a polemical one. I shall not produce the arguments of our antagonists in order to refute such of them as I believe to be in the wrong. My book is nothing but a simple historic record of facts. I shall place before the reader the theories of the Hindus exactly as they are, and I shall mention in connection with them similar theories of the Greeks in order to show thre relationship existing between them. For the

Page 54

8 PREFACE.

Greek philosophers, although aiming at truth in the abstract, never in all questions of popular bearing rise much above the customary exoteric expressions and tenets both of their religion and law. Besides Greek ideas we shall only now and then mention those of the Sûfis or of some one or other Christian sect, because in their notions regarding the transmigration of souls and the pantheistic doctrine of the unity of God with crea- tion there is much in common between these systems. I have already translated two books into Arabic, one about the origines and a description of all created beings, called Samikhya, and another about the emanci- pation of the soul from the fetters of the body, called Patañjali (Patañjala ?). These two books contain most of the elements of the belief of the Hindus, but not all the single rules derived therefrom. I hope that the present book will enable the reader to dispense with these two earlier ones, and with other books of the same kind; that it will give a sufficient representation of the subject, and will enable him to make himself thoroughly acqnainted with it-God willing!

Page 55

TABLE OF CONTENTS.

CHAPTER 1.

ON THE HINDUS IN GENERAL, AS AN INTRODUCTION TO OUR Page 5. ACCOUNT OF THEN.

CHAPTER IL.

ON THE BELIEF OF THE HINDUS IN GOD.

CHAPTER I11.

ON THE HIINDU BELIEF AS TO CREATED THINGS, BOTH "INTELLIGIBILIA" AND "SENSIBILIA."

CHAPTER IV.

FROM WHAT CAUSE ACTION ORIGINATES, AND HOW THE SOUL IS CONNECTED WITH MATTER.

CHAPTER V.

ON THE STATE OF THE SOULS, AND THEIR MIGRATIONS THROUGH TIIE WORLD IN THE METEMPSYCHOSIS.

CHAPTER VI.

ON THE DIFFERENT WORLDS, AND ON THE PLACES OF RETRIBUTION IN PARADISE AND HIELL.

CHAPTER VII.

ON THE NATURE OF LIBERATION FROM THE WORLD, AND ON THE PATH LEADING THERETO.

Page 56

IO CONTENTS.

CHAPTER VIII.

ON THE DIFFERENT CLASSES OF CREATED BEINGS, AND ON THEIR NAMES,

CHAPTER IX.

ON THE CASTES, CALLED " COLOURS" (VARNA), AND ON THE CLASSES BELOW THEM.

CHAPTER X.

ON THE SOURCE OF THEIR RELIGIOUS AND CIVIL LAW, ON PROPHETS, AND ON THE QUESTION WIIETHER SINGLE LAWS CAN BE ABROGATED OR NOT.

CHAPTER XI.

ABOUT THE BEGINNING OF IDOL-WORSHIIP, AND A DESCRIPTION OF THE INDIVIDUAL IDOLS.

CHAPTER XII.

ON THE VEDA, THE PURANAS, AND OTHER KINDS OF THEIR NATIONAL LITERATURE.

CIIAPTER XIII.

THEIR GRAMMATICAL AND METRICAL LITERATURE.

CHAPTER XIV.

HINDU LITERATURE IN THE OTHER SCIENCES-ASTRONOMY, ASTROLOGY, ETC.

CHAPTER XV.

NOTES ON HIINDU METROLOGY, INTENDED TO FACILITATE THE UNDERSTANDING OF ALL KINDS OF MEASUREMENTS WHICH OCCUR IN THIS BOOK.

CHAPTER XVI

NOTES ON THE WRITING OF THE HINDUS, ON THEIR ARITH- METIC AND RELATED SUBJECTS, AND ON CERTAIN STRANGE MANNERS AND CUSTOMS OF THEIRS.

CIIAPTER XVII.

ON HINDU SCIENCES WHICH PREY ON THE IGNORANCE OF PEOPLE.

Page 57

CONTENTS. II

CHAPTER XVIII.

VARIOUS NOTES ON THEIR COUNTRY, THEIR RIVERS, AND THEIR OCEAN-ITINERARIES OF THE DISTANCES BETWEEN THEIR SEVERAL KINGDOMS, AND BETWEEN THE BOUNDARIES OF THEIR COUNTRY.

CHAPTER XIX.

ON THE NAMES OF THE PLANETS, THE SIGNS OF THE ZODIAC, THE LUNAR STATIONS, AND RELATED SUBJECTS.

CHAPTER XX. Page 6.

ON THE BRAHMANDA.

CHAPTER XXI.

DESCRIPTION OF EARTH AND HEAVEN ACCORDING TO THE RELIGIOUS VIEWS OF THE HINDUS, BASED UPON THEIR TRADITIONAL LITERATURE.

CHAPTER XXII.

TRADITIONS RELATING TO THE POLE.

CHAPTER XXIII.

ON MOUNT MERU ACCORDING TO THE BELIEF OF TIE AUTHORS OF THE PURANAS AND OF OTHERS.

CHAPTER XXIV.

TRADITIONS OF THE PURANAS REGARDING EACH OF THE SEVEN DVÍPAS.

CHAPTER XXV.

ON THE RIVERS OF INDIA, THEIR SOURCES AND COURSES.

CHAPTER XXVI.

ON THE SHAPE OF HEAVEN AND EARTH ACCORDING TO THE HINDU ASTRONOMERS.

CHAPTER XXVII.

ON THE FIRST TWO MOTIONS OF THE UNIVERSE (THAT FROM EAST TO WEST ACCORDING TO ANCIENT ASTRONOMERS, AND THE PRECESSION OF THE EQUINOXES) BOTH ACCORDING TO THE HINDU ASTRONOMERS AND THE AUTHORS OF THE PURÂŅAS.

Page 58

I2 CONTENTS.

CHAPTER XXVIII.

ON THE DEFINITION OF THE TEN DIRECTIONS.

CHAPTER XXIX.

DEFINITION OF THE INIIABITABLE EARTII ACCORDING TO THE HINDUS.

CHAPTER XXX.

ON LANKA, OR THE CUPOLA OF THE EARTHI.

CHAPTER XXXI.

ON THAT DIFFERENCE OF VARIOUS PLACES WIIICH WE CALL THE DIFFERENCE OF LONGITUDE.

CHAPTER XXXII.

ON THE NOTIONS OF DURATION AND TIME IN GENERAL, AND ON THT REATION OF THE WORLD AND ITS DESTRUCTION.

CHAPTER XXXIII.

ON THE VARIOUS KINDS OF THE DAY OR NYCHTHEMERON, AND ON DAY AND NIGHT IN PARTICULAR.

CHAPTER XXXIV.

ON THE DIVISION OF THE NYCHTHEMERON INTO MINOR PARTICLES OF TIME.

CHAPTER XXXV.

ON THE DIFFERENT KINDS OF MONTHS AND YEARS.

CHAPTER XXXVI.

ON THE FOUR MEASURES OF TIME CALLED MANA.

CHAPTER XXXVII.

ON TIIE PARTS OF THE MONTH AND THE YEAR.

CHAPTER XXXVIII.

ON THE VARIOUS MEASURES OF TIME COMPOSED OF DAYS, THE LIFE OF BRAHMAN INCLUDED.

Page 59

CONTENTS. 13

CHAPTER XXXIX.

ON MEASURES OF TIME WHICH ARE LARGER THAN THE LIFE OF BRAHMAN.

CHAPTER XL.

ON THE SAMDHI, THE INTERVAL BETWEEN TWO PERIODS OF TIME, FORMING THE CONNECTING LINK BETWEEN THEM.

CHAPTER XLI.

DEFINITION OF THE TERMS " KALPA" AND " CATURYUGA," AND Page 7. AN EXPLICATION OF THE ONE BY THE OTHER.

CHAPTER XLII.

ON THE DIVISION OF THE CATURYUGA INTO YUGAS, AND TIIE DIFFERENT OPINIONS REGARDING THE LATTER.

CHAPTER XLIII.

A DESCRIPTION OF THE FOUR YUGAS, AND OF ALL THAT IS EXPECTED TO TAKE PLACE AT THE END OF THE FOURTII YUGA.

CHAPTER XLIV.

ON THE MANVANTARAS.

CHAPTER XLV.

ON THE CONSTELLATION OF THE GREAT BEAR.

CHAPTER XLVI.

ON NARAYANA, IIIS APPEARANCE AT DIFFERENT TIMES, AND HIS NAMES.

CHAPTER XLVII.

ON VASUDEVA AND THE WARS OF THE BHARATA.

CHAPTER XLVIII.

AN EXPLANATION OF THE MEASURE OF AN AKSHAUHINI. _

CHAPTER XLIX.

A SUMMARY DESCRIPTION OF THE ERAS.

Page 60

CONTENTS.

CHAPTER L.

HOW MANY STAR-CYCLES THERE ARE BOTH IN A "KALPA" AND IN A "CATURYUGA."

CHAPTER LI.

AN EXPLANATION OF THE TERMS " ADIIMASA," "UNARATRA," AND THE " AHARGANAS," AS REPRESENTING DIFFERENT SUMS OF DAYS.

CHAPTER LII.

ON THE CALCULATION OF "AHARGANA " IN GENERAL, THAT IS, THE RESOLUTION OF YEARS AND MONTHS INTO DAYS, AND, VICE VERSA, THE COMPOSITION OF YEARS AND MONTHS OUT OF DAYS.

CHAPTER LIII.

ON THE AHARGANA, OR THE RESOLUTION OF YEARS INTO MONTHS, ACCORDING TO SPECIAL RULES WHICH ARE ADOPTED IN THE CALENDARS FOR CERTAIN DATES OR MOMENTS OF TIME.

CHAPTER LIV.

ON THE COMPUTATION OF THE MEAN PLACES OF THE PLANETS.

CHAPTER LV.

ON THE ORDER OF THE PLANETS, THEIR DISTANCES AND SIZES.

CHAPTER LVI.

ON THE STATIONS OF THE MOON.

CHAPTER LVII.

ON THE HELIACAL RISINGS OF THE STARS, AND ON THE CERE- MONIES AND RITES WHICH THE HINDUS PRACTISE AT SUCH A MOMENT.

CHAPTER LVIII.

HOW EBB AND FLOW FOLLOW EACH OTHER IN THE OCEAN.

CHAPTER LIX.

ON THE SOLAR AND LUNAR ECLIPSES.

Page 61

CONTENTS.

CHAPTER IX.

ON THE PARVAN.

CHAPTER LXI.

ON THE DOMINANTS OF THE DIFFERENT MEASURES OF TINE IN BOTH RELIGIOUS AND ASTRONOMICAL RELATIONS, AND ON CONNECTED SUBJECTS.

CHAPTER LXII.

ON THE SIXTY YEARS-SAMVATSARA, ALSO CALLED Page 8. "SHASHTYABDA."

CHAPTER LXIII.

ON THAT WHICH ESPECIALLY CONCERNS THE BRAHMANS, AND WHAT THEY ARE OBLIGED TO DO DURING THEIR WHOLE ~ LIFE.

CHAPTER LXIV.

ON THE RITES AND CUSTOMS WIICH THE OTHER CASTES, BESIDES THE LRAHMANS, PRACTISE DURING THEIR LIFETIME.

CHAPTER LXV.

ON TIE SACRIFICES.

CHAPTER LXVI.

ON PILGRIMAGE AND THE VISITING OF SACRED PLACES.

CHAPTER LXVII.

ON ALMS, AND HOW A MAN MUST SPEND WHAT HE EARNS.

CHAPTER LXVIII.

ON WHAT IS ALLOWED AND FORBIDDEN IN EATING AND DRINKING.

CHAPTER LXIX.

ON MATRIMONY, THE MENSTRUAL COURSES, EMBRYOS, AND CHILDBED.

Page 62

16 CONTENTS.

CHAPTER LXX.

ON LAWSUITS.

CHAPTER LXXI.

ON PUNISHMENTS AND EXPIATIONS.

CHAPTER LXXII.

ON INHERITANCE, AND WHAT CLAIM THE DECEASED PERSON HAS ON IT.

CHAPTER LXXIII.

ABOUT WHAT IS DUE TO THE BODIES OF THE DEAD AND OF THE LIVING (THAT IS, ABOUT BURYING AND SUICIDE).

CHAPTER LXXIV.

ON FASTING, AND THE VARIOUS KINDS OF IT.

CHAPTER LXXV.

ON THE DETERMINATION OF THE FAST-DAYS.

CHAPTER LXXVI.

ON THE FESTIVALS AND FESTIVE DAYS.

CHAPTER LXXVII.

ON DAYS WHICH ARE HELD IN SPECIAL VENERATION, ON LUCKY AND UNLUCKY TIMES, AND ON SUCH TIMES AS ARE PAR- TICULARLY FAVOURABLE FOR ACQUIRING IN THEM BLISS IN HEAVEN.

CHAPTER LXXVIII.

ON THE KARAŅAS.

CHAPTER LXXIX.

ON THE YOGAS.

CHAPTER LXXX.

ON THE INTRODUCTORY PRINCIPLES OF HINDU ASTROLOGY, WITH A SHORT DESCRIPTION OF THEIR METHODS OF ASTROLOGICAL CALCULATIONS.

Page 63

I7

CHAPTER I.

ON THE HINDUS IN GENERAL, AS AN INTRODUCTION P'age 9. TO OUR ACCOUNT OF THEM.

BEFORE entering on our exposition, we must form an Descrip- adequate idea of that which renders it so particularly dif- barriers tioh of the

ficult to penetrate to the essential nature of any Indian parate the which sc-

subject. The knowledge of these difficulties will either Hindus from the facilitate the progress of our work, or serve as an apology Muslims and mnakc for any shortcomings of ours. For the reader must it so parti- cularly dif- always bear in mind that the Hindns, ertirely differ ficult for a Muslim to from us in every respect, many a subject appearing Indian intricate and obscure which would be peifectly ciea- subject. if there were more connection between us. The barriers which separate Muslims and Hindus rest on different | causes. First, they differ from us in everything which other First rea- nations have in common. son : Dif- And here we first mention ference of the language, although the difference of language also guage and the lan-

exists between other nations. If you want to conquer cular its parti-

this difficulty (i.e. to learn Sanskrit), you will not find nature.

it easy, because the language is of an enormous range, both in words and inflections, something like the Arabic, calling one and the same thing by various names, both original and derived, and using one and the same word for a variety of subjects, which, in order to be properly understood, must be distinguished from each other by various qualifying epithets. For nobody could distinguish between the various meanings of a word unless he understands the context in which it M VOL. I.

Page 64

I8 ALBERUNPS INDIA.

occurs, and its relation both to the following and the preceding parts of the sentence. The Hindus, like other people, boast of this enormous range of their lan- guage, whilst in reality it is a defect. Further, the language is divided into a neglected vernacular one, only in use among the common people, and a classical one, only in use among the npper and educated classes, which is much cultivated, and subject to the rules of grammatical inflection and etymology, and to all the niceties of grammar and rhetoric. Besides, some of the sounds (consonants) of which the language is composed are neither identical with the sounds of Arabic and P'ersian, nor resemble them in any way. Ourtongue and uvula could scarcely manage to correctly pronounce them, nor our ears in hearing to distinguish them from similar sounds, nor could we transliterate them with our characters. It is very diffeult, therafore. to express an Indian word in our writing, for in order to fix the pronunciation we must change our oribographical points and signs, and must pronounce the case-endings either according to the common Arabic rules or according to special rules adapted for the purpose. Add to this that the Indian scribes are careless, and do not take pains to produce correct and well-collated copies. In consequence, the highest results of the author's mental development are lost by their negli- gence, and his book becomes already in the first or second copy so full of fanlts, that the text appears as something entirely new, which neither a scholar nor one familiar with the subject, whether Hindu or Muslim, could any longer understand. It will sufficiently illus- trate the matter if we tell the reader that we have sometimes written down a word from the mouth of Hindus, taking the greatest pains to fix its pronuncia- tion, and that afterwards when we repeated it to them, they had great difliculty in recognising it.

Page 65

CHAPTER I. 19

As in other foreign tongues, so also in Sanskrit. two or three consonants may follow each other without an intervening vowel-consonants which in our Persian gramnatical system are considered as having a hidden vowel. Since most Sanskrit words and names begin with such consonants without vowels, we find it very difficult to pronounce them. Besides, the scientific books of the Hindus are com- posed in various favourite metres, by which they intend, considering that the books soon become corrupted by additions and omissions, to preserve them exactly as Page ic. they are, in order to facilitate their being learned by heart, because they consider as canonical only that which is known by heart, not that which exists in writing. Now it is well known that in all metrical compositions there is much misty and constrained phraseology merely intended to fill up the metre and serving as a kind of patchwork, and this necessitates a certain amount of verbosity. This is also one of the reasous why a word has sometimes one meaning and sometimes another. From all this it will appear that the metrical form of literary composition is one of the causes which make the study of Sanskrit literature so particularly difficult. Secondly, they totally differ from us in religion, as Second rca- we believe in nothing in which they believe, and cice religious son: Ther

versa. On the whole, there is very little disputing prejudices.

about theological topics among themselves; at the ntmost, they fight with words, but they will never stake their soul or body or their property on religions contro- versy. On the contrary, all their fanaticism is directed against those who do not belong to them-against all foreigners. They call them mleccha, i.e. impure, and forbid havingj any connection with them, be it by intermarriage or any other kind of relationship, or by sitting, eating, and drinking with them, because

Page 66

20 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

thereby, they think, they would be polluted. They consider as impure anything which touches the fire and the water of a foreigner; and no household can exist without these two elements. Besides, they never desire that a thing which once has been polluted should be purified and thus recovered, as, under ordinary cir- cumstances, if anybody or anything has become unclean, he or it would strive to regain the state of purity. They are not allowed to receive anybody who does not belong to them, even if he wished it, or was inclined to their religion. This, too, renders any connection with them quite impossible, and constitutes the widest gulf between us and them. Third rea- In the third place, in all manners and usages they son : The radical dif- differ from us to snch a degree as to frighten their ference of their man- children with us, with our dress, and our ways and ners and eustoms. customs, and as to declare us to be devil's breed, and our doings as the very opposite of all that is good and proper. By the by, we must confess, in order to be just, that a similar depreciation of foreigners not only prevails among us and the Hindus, but is common to all nations towards each other. I recollect a Hindu who wreaked his vengeance on us for the following reason :- Some Hindu king had perished at the hand of an enemy of his who had marched against him from our country. After his death there was born a child to him, which succeeded him, by the name of Sagara. On coming of age, the young man asked his mother about his father, and then she told him what had hap- pened. Now he was inflamed with hatred, marched out of his country into the country of the enemy, and plentifully satiated his thirst of vengeance upon them. After having become tired of slaughtering, he compelled the survivors to dress in our dress, which was meant as an ignominious punishment for them. When I heard of it, I felt thankful that he was gracious enough not

Page 67

CHAPTER I. 2I

to compel us to Indiani e ourselves and to adopt llindu dress and manners. Another circumstance which increased the already Fourth rea- existing antagonism between Hindus and foreigners is sion of the son : Aver.

that the so-called Shamaniyya (Buddhists), though they Buddhists towards the cordially hate the Brahmans, still are nearer akin to the West, countries of

them than to others. In former times, Khurasan, Persis, whencethey had been 'Irak, Mosul, the country up to the frontier of Syria, ex pelled. Firstinroads was Buddhistic, but then Zarathustra went forth from of the Mus- lims into Adharbaijan and preached Magism in Balkh (Baktra). India. His doctrine came into favour with King Gushtasp, and his son Isfendiyad spread the new faith both in east and west, both by force and by treaties. He founded fire-temples through his whole empire, from the frontiers of China to those of the Greek empire. Page I. The succeeding kings made their religion (i.c. Zoroas- trianism) the obligatory state-religion for Persis and 'Irak. In consequence, the Buddhists were banished from those countries, and had to emigrate to the coun- tries east of Balkh. There are some Magians up to the present time in India, where they are called Maga. From that time dates their aversion towards the coun- tries of Khnrasan. But then came Islam; the Persian empire perished, and the repugnance of the Hindus against foreigners increased more and more when the Muslims began to make their inroads into their country ; for Muhammad Ibn Elkasim Ibn Elmunabbih entered Sindh from the side of Sijistn (Sakastene)andconquered the cities of Bahmanwh and Mulasthana, the former of which he called Al-mansura, the latter Al-ma'mura. He entered India proper, and penetrated even as far as Kanauj, marched through the country of Gandhara, and on his way back, through the confines of Kashmir, some- times fighting sword in hand, sometimes gaining his ends by treaties, leaving to the people their ancient belief, except in the case of those who wanted to become Mus- lims. All these events planted a deeply rooted hatred in their hearts.

Page 68

22 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Muham- Now in the following times no Muslim conqueror quest of the passed beyond the frontier of Kabul and the river Sindh madan con-

country by Manmud, until the days of the Turks, when they seized the power in Ghazna under the Samani dynasty, and the supreme power fell to the lot of Nasir-addaula Sabuktagin. This prince chose the holy war as his calling, and there- fore called himself Al-ghazt (i.e. warring on the road of Allal). In the interest of his successors he constructed, in order to weaken the Indian frontier, those roads on which afterwards his son Yamin-addaula Mahmûd marched into India during a period of thirty years and more. God be merciful to both father and son! Mah- mud utterly ruined the prosperity of the country, and performed there wonderful exploits, by which the Hindus became like atoms of dust scattered in all directions, and like a tale of old in the mouth of the people. Their scattered remains cherish, of course, the most inveterate aversion towards all Muslims. This is the reason, too, why Hindu sciences have retired far away from those parts of the country conquered by js, and have fled to places which our hand cannot yet reach, to Kashmir, Benares, and other places. And there the antagonism between them and all foreigners receives more and more nourishment both from political and religious sources. Fifth rea- In the fifth place, there are other causes, the mention- son : The self-coneeit of the Hin- ing of which sounds like a satire-peculiarities of their dus, and national character, deeply rooted in them, but manifest preciation of to everybody. We can only say, folly is an illness for their de- anything foreign. which there is no medicine, and the Hindus believe that there is no country but theirs, no nation like theirs, no kings like theirs, no religion like theirs, no science like theirs. They are haughty, foolishly vain, self-conceited, and stolid. They are by nature niggardly in communi- cating that which they know, and they take the greatest possible care to withhold it from men of another caste among their own people, still much more, of course,

Page 69

CHAPTER I.

from any foreigner. According to their belief, there is no other country on earth but theirs, no other race of man but theirs, and no created beings besides them have any knowledge or science whatsoever. Their haughti- ness is such that, if you tell them of any science or scholar in Khurasan and Persis, they will think you to be both an ignoramus and a liar. If they travelled and mixed with other nations, they would soon change their mind, for their ancestors were not as narrow-minded as the present generation is. One of their scholars, Varahamihira, in a passage where he calls on the people to honour the Brahmans, says : " The Greeks, though impure, must be honoured, since they were trained in sciences, and therein excelled others. What, then, are we to say of a Brahman, if he combines with his Page 12. purity the height of science?" In former times, the Hindus used to acknowledge that the progress of science due to the Greeks is much more important than that which is due to themselves. But from this passage of Varahamihira alone yon see what a self-lauding man he is, whilst he gives himself airs as doing justicc to others. At first I stood to their astronomers in the relation of a pupil to his master, being a stranger among them and not acquainted with their peculiar national and traditional methods of science. On having made some progress, I began to show them the elements on which this science rests, to point out to them some rules of logical deduction and the scientific methods of all mathematics, and then they flocked together round me from all parts, wondering, and most eager to learn from me, asking me at the same time from what Hindu master I had learnt those things, whilst in reality I showed them what they were worth, and thought myself a great deal superior to them, disdaining to be put on a level with them. They almost thought me to be a sorcerer, and when speaking of me to their leading men in their native tongue, they spoke of me as the sca or as

Page 70

24 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

the water which is so acid that vinegar in comparison is sweet. Personal Now such is the state of things in India. I have relations of the author. found it very hard to work my way into the subject, although I have a great liking for it, in which respect I stand quite alone in my time, and although I do not spare either trouble or money in collecting Sanskrit books from places where I supposed they were likely to be found, and in procuring for myself, even from very remote places, Hindu scholars who understand them and are able to teach me. What scholar, however, has the same favourable opportunities of studying this sub- ject as I have? That would be only the case with one to whom the grace of God accords, what it did not accord to me, a perfectly free disposal of his own doings and goings; for it has never fallen to my lot in my own doings and goings to be perfectly independent, nor to be invested with sufficient power to dispose and to order as I thought best. However, I thank God for that which He has bestowed upon me, and which must be considered as sufficient for the purpose. The author The heathen Greeks, before the rise of Christianity, declarcs his intention of held much the same opinions as the Hindus; their comparing Greek educated classes thonght much the same as those of theories, because of the Hindus; their common people held the same their being near akin, idolatrous views as those of the Hindus. There- and of their strictly fore I like to confront the theories of the one nation scientific character as with those of the other simply on account of their contrasted with thoseof close relationship, not in order to correct them. For the Hindus. that which is not the truth (i.e. the true belief or monotheism) does not admit of any correction, and all heathenism, whether Greek or Indian, is in its pith and marrow one and the same belief, because it is only a deviation from the truth. The Greeks, however, had philosophers who, living in their conntry, discovered and worked out for them the elements of science, not of popular superstition, for it is the object of the upper

Page 71

CHAPTER I.

classes to be guided by the results of science, whilst the common crowd will always be inclined to plunge into wrong-headed wrangling, as long as they are not kept down by fear of punishment. Think of Socrates when he opposed the crowd of his nation as to their idolatry and did not want to call the stars gods! At once eleven of the twelve judges of the Athenians agreed on a sen- tence of death, and Socrates died faithful to the truth. The Hindus had no men of this stamp both capable and willing to bring sciences to a classical perfection. Therefore you mostly find that even the so-called scientific theorems of the Hindus are in a state of utter confusion, devoid of any logical order, and in the last in- stancealwaysmixed upwith the sillynotionsof the crowd, c.g. immense numbers, enormous spaces of time, and all kinds of religious dogmas, which the vulgar belief does not admit of being called into question. Therefore it is a prevailing practice among the Hindus jurare in verba magistri ; and I can only compare their mathema- tical and astronomical literature, as far as I know it, to a mixture of pearl shells and sour dates, or of pearls Page 13. and dung, or of costly crystals and common pebbles. Both kinds of things are equal in their eyes, since they cannot raise themselves to the methods of a strictly scientific deduction. In most parts of my work I simply relate without The anthor's criticising, unless there be a special reason for doing so. methnd.

I mention the necessary Sanskrit names and technical terms once where the context of our explanation de- mands it. If the word is an original one, the meaning of which can be rendered in Arabic, I only use the corresponding Arabic word; if, however, the Sanskrit word be more practical, we keep this, trying to trans-' literate it as accurately as possible. If the word is a secondary or derived one, but in general use, we also keep it, though there be a corresponding term in Arabic, but before using it we explain its signification. In

Page 72

26 ALBERUNPS INDIA.

this way we have tried to facilitate the understanding of the terminology. Lastly, we observe that we cannot always in our discussions strictly adhere to the geometrical method, only referring to that which precedes and never to that which follows, as we must sometimes introduce in a chapter an unknown factor, the explanation of which can only be given in a later part of the book, God helping us!

Page 73

( 27 )

CHAPTER II.

ON THE BELIEF OF THE HINDUS IN GOD.

THE belief of educated and uneducated people differs in The nature every nation ; for the former strive to conceive abstract of God.

ideas and to define general principles, whilst the latter do not pass beyond the apprehension of the senses, and are content with derived rules, without caring for de- tails, especially in questions of religion and law, regard- ing which opinions and interests are divided. The Bindus believe with regard to God that he is one, eternal, without beginning and end, acting by free- will, almighty, all-wise, living, giving life, ruling. pre- serving ; one who in his sovereignty is unique, beyond all likeness and unlikeness, and that he does not re- semble anything nor does anything resemble him. In order to illustrate this we shall produce some extracts from their literature, lest the reader should think that our account is nothing but hearsay. In the book of Patanjali the pupil asks : Qnotation "Who is the worshipped one, by the worship of whom Patanjali. from

blessing is obtained ? " The master says : "It is he who, being eternal and unique, does not for his part stand in need of any human action for which he might give as a recompense either a blissful repose, which is hoped and longed for, or a troubled existence, which is feared and dreaded. He is unattainable to thought, being sublime beyond all unlikeness which is abhorrent and all likeness which is sympathetic. He

Page 74

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

by his essence knows from all eternity. Knowledge, in the human sense of the term, has as its object that which was unknown before, whilst not knowing does not at any time or in any condition apply to God." Further the pupil speaks : "Do you attribute to him other qualities besides those you have mentioned?" The master says : "He is height, absolute in the idea, not in space, for he is sublime beyond all existence in any space. He is the pure absolute good, longed for by every created being. He is the knowledge free from the defilement of forgetfulness and not-knowing." The pupil speaks : " Do you attribute to him speech or not?" The master says : " As he knows, he no doubt also speaks." The pupil asks : "If he speaks because he knows, what, then, is the difference between him and the knowing sages who have spoken of their knowing ?" The master says : "The difference between them is time, for they have learned in time and spoken in time, after having been not-knowing and not-speaking. By speech they hare transferred their knowledge to others. Therefore their speaking and acquiring knowledge take place in time. And as divine matters have no connection with time, God is knowing, speaking from eternity. It was he who spoke to Brahman, and to others of the first beings in different ways. On the one he bestowed a book; for the other he opened a door, a means of communi- cating with him; a third one he inspired so that he obtained by cogitation what God bestowed upon him." The pupil asks: "Whence has he this knowing?" The master answers :

Page 75

CHAPTER II.

"His knowing is the same from all eternity, for ever and ever. As he has never been not-knowing, he is knowing of himself, having never acquired any know- ledge which he did not possess before. He speaks in the Veda which he sent down upon Brahman: "Praise and cclebrate him whe has spoken the Veda, rnd was before the Veda.'" The pupil asks : "How do you worship him to whom the perception of the senses cannot attain ? " The master says : " Ilis name proves his existence, for where there is a report there must be something to which it refers, and where there is a name there must be something which is named. He is hidden to the senses and umnperceiv- able by them. However, the soul perceives him, and thought comprehends his qualities. This meditation is identical with worshipping him exclusively, and by practising it uninterruptedly beatitude is obtained." In this way the Hindus express themselves in this very famous book.

The following passage is taken from the book Gita, Quofation a part of the book Bharata, from the conversation be- from the book Gita. tween Vasudeva and Arjuna :- "I am the universe, without a beginning by being born, or without an end by dying. I do not aim by whatever I do at any recompense. I do not specially belong to one class of beings to the exclusion of others, as if I were the friend of one and the enemy of others. I have given to each one in my creation what is suffi- cient for him in all his functions. Therefore whoever knows me in this capacity, and tries to become similar to me by keeping desire apart from his action, his fetters will be loosened, and he will easily be saved and freed." This passage reminds one of the definition of philo-

Page 76

30 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

sophy as the striving to becomc as much as possible simi- lar to God. Further, Vasudeva speaks in the same book :- " It is desire which causes most men to take refuge with God for their wants. But if you examine their case closely, yon will find that they are very far from having an accurate knowledge of him; for God is not apparent to every one, so that he might perceive him with his senses. Therefore they do not know him. Some of them do not pass beyond what their senses perceive ; some pass beyond this, but stop at the know- ledge of the laws of nature, without learning that above them there is one who did not give birth nor was born, the essence of whose being has not been comprehended by the knowledge of any one, while his knowledge com prehends everything." On the The Hindus differ among themselves as to the defini- notions of the action tion of what is action. Some who make God the source and the agent. of action consider him as the universal cause ; for as the existence of the aycnts derives from him, he is the cause of their action, and in consequence it is his own action coming into existence through their inter- mediation. Others do not derive action from God, but from other sources, considering them as the particular causes which in the last instance-according to external observation-produce the action in question. Quotation In the book Samkhya the devotee speaks : " Has there fromn the bnok Stnkhyv. been a difference of opinion about action and the agent, or not ?" The sage speaks: "Some people say that the soul is not alive and the matter not living; that God, who is self-sufficing, is he who unites them and separates them Page 15. from each other; that therefore in reality he himself is the agent. Action proceeds from him in such a way that he causes both the soul and the matter to move, like as that which is living and powerful moves that which is dead and weak.

Page 77

CHAPTER II. 31

" Others say that the nnion of action and the ayent is effected by nature, and that such is the usnal process in everything that increases and decreases. "Others say the agent is the soul, because in the Veda it is said, ' Every being comes from P'urusha.' According to others, the agent is time, for the world is tied to time as a sheep is tied to a strong cord, so that its motion depends upon whether the cord is drawn tight or slackened. Still others say that action is nothing but a recompense for something which has been done before. " All these opinions are wrong. The truth is, that action entirely belongs to matter, for matter binds the soul, causes it to wander about in different shapes, and then sets it free. Therefore matter is the agent, all that belongs to matter helps it to accomplish action. But the soul is not an agent, because it is devoid of the different faculties." This is what educated people believe about God. Philosophi. They call him tscara, i.e. self-suflicing, beneficent, who cal and vnl- gar notions gives without receiving. They consider the unity of nature of about the

God as absolute, but that everything beside God which God. may appear as a unity is really a plurality of things. The existence of God they consider as a real existence, because everything that exists exists through him. It is not impossible to think that the existing beings are not and that he is, but it is impossible to think that he is not and that they are. If we now pass from the ideas of the educated people among the Hindus to those of the common people, we must first state that they present a great variety. Some of them are simply abominable, but similar errors also occur in other religions. Nay, even in Islam we must de- cidedly disapprove, e.g. of the anthropomorphic doctrines, the teachings of the Jabriyya sect, the prohibition of the discussion of religious topics, and such like. Every religious sentence destined for the people at large must

Page 78

32 ALBERUNPS INDIA.

be carefully worded, as the following example shows. Some Hindu scholar calls God a point, meaning to say thereby that the qualities of bodies do not apply to him. Now some uneducated man reads this and imagines, God is as small as & point, and he does not find out what the word point in this sentence was really intended to express. He will not even stop with this offensive comparison, but will describe God as much larger, and will say,"Heis twelve fingers longand ten fingers broad." l'raise be to God, who is far above measure and number ! Further, if an uneducated man hears what we have mentioned, that God comprehends the universe so that nothing is concealed from him, he will at once imagine that this comprehending is effected by means of eye- sight; that eyesight is only possible by means of an eye, and that two eyes are better than only one; and in con- sequence he will describe God as having a thousand eyes, meaning to describe his omniscience. Similar hideous fictions are sometimes met with among the llindus, especially among those castes who are not allowed to occupy themselves with science, of whom we shall speak hereafter.

Page 79

33

CHAPTER III.

ON THE HINDU BELIEF AS TO CREATED THINGS, BOTH "INTELLIGIBILIA" AND " SENSIBILIA."

ON this subject the ancient Greeks held nearly the Notins of same view as the llindus, at all events in those times and the Shfi the Greeks

before philosophy rose high among them under the care philoso- phers as to of the seven so-called pillars of wisdom, viz. Solon of Carse. the Firrt

Athens, Bias of Priene, Periander of Corinth, Thales of Miletus, Chilon of Lacedæmon, Pittacus of Lesbos, and Cleobulus of Lindos, and their successors. Some of Page 16. them thought that all things are one, and this one thing is according to some ro AavOarar, according to others i Sevajus ; that e.g. man has only this prerogative before a stone and the inanimate world, that he is by one degree nearer than they to the First Cuuse. But this he would not be anything better than they. Others think that only the First Cause has real exist- ence, because it alone is self-suflicing, whilst everything else absolutely requires it; that a thing which for its existence stands in need of something else has only a dream-life, no real life, and that reality is only that one and first being (the First Cause). This is also the theory of the Sufis, i.e. the suges, Origin of for suf means in Greek wisdom (ooia). Therefore a Sofi. the word

philosopher is called pailasopa (idecodos), i.e. loving wisdom. When in Islam persons adopted something like the doctrines of these philosophers, they also adopted their name; but some people did not understand the meaning of the word, and erroneously combined it with VOL. I. C

Page 80

34 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

the Arabic word suffa, as if the Suft (= ddooodot) were identical with the so-called ' Ahl-assuffa among the com- panions of Mubammad. In later times the word was corrupted by misspelling, so that finally it was taken for a derivation from suf, i.e. the wool of goats. Abu-alfath Albustî made a laudable effort to avoid this mistake when he said, " From olden times people have differed as to the meaning of the word sutfi, and have thought it a derivative from suf, i.c. wool. I, for my part, understand by the word a youth who is safi, i.e. pure. This saft has become suff, and in this form the name of a class of thinkers, the Suff." F'urther, the same Greeks think that the existing world is only one thing; that the First Cause appears in it under various shapes; that the power of the First Cause is inherent in the parts of the world under dif- ferent circumstances, which cause a certain difference of the things of the world notwithstanding their original unity. Others thonght that he who turns with his whole being towards the First Cause, striving to become as much as possible similar to it, will become united with it after having passed the intermediate stages, and stripped of all appendages and impediments. Similar views are also held by the Suft, because of the similarity of the dogma. As to the souls and spirits, the Greeks think that they exist by themselves before they enter bodies; that they exist in certain numbers and groups, which stand in various relations to each other, knowing each other and not knowing ; that they, whilst staying in bodies, earn by the actions of their free-will that lot which awaits them after their separation from the bodies, i.c. the faculty of ruling the world in various ways. Therefore they called them gods, built temples in their Galenus. names and offered them sacrifices; as Galenus says in his book called προτρεπτικός είς τας τέχνας: "Excel-

Page 81

CHAPTER III. 35

lent men have obtained the honour of being reckoned among the deified beings only for the noble spirit in which they cultivated the arts, not for their prowess in wrestling and discus-throwing. E.g. Asclepius and Dionysos, whether they were originally human beings in bygone times and afterwards deified, or were divine beings from the very beginning, deserved in any case the greatest of honours, because the one taught man- Pagc 17. kind the science of medicine, the other the art of the cultivation of the vine." Galenus says in his commentary on the aphorisms of Hippocrates: "As regards the offerings to Asclepius, we have never heard that anybody offered him a goat, because the weaving of goat's-hair is not easy, and much goat's-meat produces epilepsy, since the humours of the goats are bad. People only offer him a cock, as also Hippocrates has done. For this divine man acquired for mankind the art of medicine, which is much superior to that which . Dionysos and Demeter have invented, i.e. the wine and the cereals whence bread is prepared. Therefore cereals are called by the name of Demeter and the vine is called by the name of Dionysos." Plato says in his Timcus: "The Oeot whom the Plato. barbariaus call gods, because of their not dying, are the Buipoves, whilst they call the god the first god." Further he says: "God spoke to the gods, 'You are not of yourselves exempt from destruction. Only you will not perish by death. You have obtained from my will at the time when I created you, the firmest covenant.'" In another passage of the same book he says: "God is in the single number ; there are no gods in the plural number." These quotations prove that the Greeks call in general god everything that is glorious and noble, and the like usage exists among many nations. They go

Page 82

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

even so far as to call gods the mountains, the seas, &c. Secondly, they apply the term yod in a special seuse to the First Cause, to the angels, and to their souls. According to a third usage, P'lato calls gods the Sekinut (= Mocoat). But on this subject the terms of the interpreters are not perfectly clear; in consequence of which we only know the name, but not what it Johanues means. Johannes Grammaticus says in his refutation Gramma- ticns. of Proclus: "The Greeks gave the name of gods to the visible bodies in heaven, as many barbarians do. Afterwards, when they came to philosophise on the abstract ideas of the world of thought, they called these by the name of gods." Hence we must necessarily infer that being deified means something like the state of angels, according to our notions. This Galenus says in clear words Galems. in the same book: "If it is true that Asclepius was a man in bygone times, and that then God deigned to make him one of the. angels, everything else is idle talk." In another passage of the same book he says: "God spoke to Lycurgus, 'I am in doubt concerning you, whether to call you a man or an angel, but I incline to the latter.'" Ditference There are, however, certain expressions which are of denomi- nating Gud offensive according to the notions of one religion, whilst in Arabic, Hebrew, they are admissible according to those of another, which and Syriac. may pass in one language, whilst they are rejected by another. To this class belongs the word upotheusis, which has a bad sound in the ears of Muslims. If we consider the use of the word god in the Arabic language, we find that all the names by which the pure truth, i.e. Page 18. Allâh, has been named, may somehow or other be applied to other beings besides him, except the word Allah, which only applies to God, and which has been called his greatest name. If we consider the use of the word in llebrew and

Page 83

CHAPTER III. 37

Syriac, in which two languages the sacred books before the Koran were revealed, we find that in the Thora and the following books of prophets which are reckoned with the Thora as one whole, that word Rabb corre- sponds to the word Allah in Arabic, in so far as it can- not in a genitive construction be applied to anybody besides God, and you cannot say the rabb of the house, the rabb of the property (which in Arabic is allowed). And, secondly, we find that the word 'Eloah in Hebrew corresponds in its usage there to the word Rabb in Arabic (i.c. that in Hebrew the word hox may apply to other beings but God, like the word >, in Arabic). The following passages occur in those books :- " The sons of Elohim came in unto the daughters of men " (Gen. vi. 4), before the deluge, and cohabited with them. "Satan entered together with the sons of Elohim into their meeting " (Job i. 6). In the Thora of Moses God speaks to him : " I have made thee a god to Pharaoh " (Exod. vii. I). In the 82d l'salm of the Psalter of David the fol- lowing occnrs: "God standeth in the congregation of the gods" (Ps. lxxxii. I), i.e. of the angels. In the Thora the idols are called foreign gods. If the Thora had not forbidden to worship any other being but God, if it had not forbidden people to prostrate themselves before the idols, nay, even to mention them and to think of them, one might infer from this expres- sion (forcign gods) that the order of the Bible refers only to the abolition of forcign gods, which would mean gods that are not Hebrew ones (as if the Hebrews had adored national gods, in opposition to the gods of their neighbours). The nations round Palestine were idol worshippers like the heathen Greeks, and the Israelites always rebelled against God by worshipping the idol of Baal (lit. Ba'la) and the idol of Ashtaroth, i.e. Venns. From all this it is evident that the Hebrews used to

434611

Page 84

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

apply the term being god, grammatically a term like being king, to the angels, to the souls invested with divine power (v. p. 34); by way of comparison, also, to the images which were made to represent the bodies of those beings; lastly, metaphorically, to kings and to other great men. Passing from the word God to those of father and son, we must state that Islam is not liberal in the use of them; for in Arabic the word son means nearly always as much as a child in the natural order of things, and from the ideas involved in parentage and birth can never be derived any expression meaning the Eternal Lord of creation. Other languages, however, take much more liberty in this respect; so that if people address a man by father, it is nearly the same as if they addressed him by sir. As is well known, phrases of this kind have become so prevalent among the Christians, that anybody who does not always use the words father and son in addressiug people would scarcely be considered as one of them. By the son they understand most especially Jesus, bnt apply it also to others besides him. It is Jesns who orders his disciples to say in prayer, "O our father which art in heaven" (St. Matt. vi. 9); and informing them of his approaching death, he says that he is going to his father and to their father (St. John xx. 17). In most of his speeches he explains the word the son as meaning himself, that he is the son of man. Besides the Christians, the Jews too use similar ex- Page 19. pressions; for the 2d Book of Kings relates that God consoled David for the loss of his son, who had been borne to him by the wife of Uriah, and promised him another son from her, whom he would adopt as his oun son (I Chron. xxi. 9, 10). If the use of the Hebrew language admits that Salomo is by adoption a son of God, it is admissible that he who adopted was a father, viz. God.

Page 85

CHAPTER III. 39

The Manichæans stand in a near relationship to the Note on Christians. Mani expresses himself in a similar way in chæans. the Mani-

the book called Kanz-al'ihya (Thesaurus Vivificationis) : " The resplendent hosts will be called young women and virgins, fathers and mothers, sons, brothers, and sisters, becanse such is the custom in the books of the prophets. In the country of joy there is neither male nor female, nor are there organs of generation. All are invested with living bodies. Since they have divine bodies, they do not differ from each other in weakness and force, in length and shortness, in figure and looks; they are like similar lamps, which are lighted by the same lamp, and which are nonrished by the same material. The canse of this kind of name-giving arises, in the last instance, from the rivalry of the two realms in mixing up with each other. When the low dark realm rose from the abyss of chaos, and was seen by the high resplendent realm as consisting of pairs of male and female beings, the latter gave similar outward forms to its own chil- dren, who started to fight that other world, so that it placed in the fight one kind of beings opposite the same kind of the other world." The edncated among the Hindns abhor anthropo- morphisms of this kind, but the crowd and the mem- bers of the single sects nse them most extensively. They go even beyond all we have hitherto mentioned, so as to speak of wife, son, danghter, of the rendering pregnant and other physical processes, all in connection with God. They are even so little pions, that, when speaking of these things, they do not even abstain from silly and unbecoming langnage. However, nobody minds these classes and their theories, thongh they be nnmerons. The main and most essential point of the Notions of Hindn world of thought is that which the Brahmans catedl Hin- the edu-

think and believe, for they are specially trained for pre- ereated dus. All

serving and maintaining their religion. beings are And this it is a unity. which we shall explain, viz. the belief of the Brahmans.

Page 86

40 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Regarding the whole creation (To ov), they think that it is a unity, as has already been declared, because Vasudeva speaks in the book called Gita: " To speak accurately, we must say that all things are divine; for Vishnu made himself the earth that the living beings should rest thereupon ; he made himself water to nourish them thereby; he made himself fire and wind in order to make them grow; and he made himself the heart of every single being. He presented them with recollec- tion and knowledge and the two opposite qualities, as is mentioned in the Veda." How much does this resemble the expression of the author of the book of Apollonius, De Causis Rerum, as if the one had been taken from the other! He says: "There is in all men a divine power, by which all things, both material and immaterial, are apprehended." Thus in Persian the immaterial Lord is called Khudha, and in a derivative sense the word is also used to mean a man, i.e. a human lord. Purusha. I. Those Hindus who prefer clear and accurate defi- nitions to vague allusions call the soul purusha, which means man, because it is the living element in the existing world. Life is the only attribute which they give to it. They describe it as alternately knowing and not knowing, as not knowing ev pafe (actually), and as knowing ev Svvapa (potentially), gaining know- ledge by acquisition. The not-knowing of purusha is Page 20. the cause why action comes into existence, and its knowing is the cause why action ceases. II. Next follows the general matter, i.c. the abstract Avyakta. "An, which they call avyakta, i.e. a shapeless thing. It is dead, but has three powers potentially, not actnally, which are called sattra, rajas, and tamas. I have heard that Buddhodana (sic), in speaking to his adherents the Shamanians, calls them buddha, dharma, sangha, as it were intelligence, religion, and ignorance (sic). The first power is rest and goodness, and hence come existing

Page 87

CHAPTER III. 41

and growing. The second is exertion and fatigue, and hence come firmness and duration. The third is languor and irresolution, and hence come ruin and perishing. Therefore the first power is attributed to the angels, the second to men, the third to the animals. The ideas before, afterwards, and thereupon may be predicated of all these things only in the sense of a certain sequence and on account of the inadequacy of language, but not so as to indicate any ordinary notions of time. III. Matter proceeding from dvvapus into rpagis under vsakta and the various shapes and with the three primary forces Prakrīti.

is called vyakta, i.e. having shape, whilst the union of the abstract ixn and of the shaped matter is called prakriti. This term, however, is of no use to us ; we do not want to speak of an abstract matter, the term matter alone being sufficient for us, since the one does not exist without the other. IV. Next comes nature, which they call ahankara. Ahankara. The word is derived from the ideas of overpowering, de- wcloping, and self-asscrtion, because matter when assum- ing shape causes things to develop into new forms, and this growing consists in the changing of a foreign ele- ment and assimilating it to the growing one. Hence it is as if Nature were trying to overpower those other or foreign elements in this process of changing them, and were subduing that which is changed. V .- IX. As a matter of course, each compound pre- Mababhuta supposes simple elements from which it is compounded and into which it is resolved again. The universal existences in the world are the five elements, i.e. accord- ing to the Hindus: heaven, wind, fire, water, and earth. They are called mahubhuta, i.e. huving great natures. They do not think, as other people do, that the fire is a hot dry body near the bottom of the ether. They understand by fire the common fire on earth which comes from an inflammation of smoke. The Vayu Annetation Purana says : " In the beginning were earth, water, wind, Purang. from Fayu

Page 88

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

and heaven. Brahman, on seeing sparks under the earth, brought them forward and divided them into three parts: the first, parthiva, is the common fire, which requires wood and is extinguished by water ; the second is divya, i.e. the sun; the third, vidyut, i.e. the lightning. The sun attracts the water ; the lightning shines through the water. In the animals, also, there is fire in the midst of moist substances, which serve to nonrish the fire and do not extinguish it." Pañca X .- XIV. As these elements are compound, they pre- mataras. Page 21. suppose simple ones which are called pañca mataras, i.c. five mothers. They describe them as the functions of the senses. The simple element of heaven is sabda, i.e. that which is heard; that of the wind is sparsa, i.e. that which is touched; that of the fire is rupa, i.e. that which is seen; that of the water is rasa, i.c. that which is tasted; and that of the earth is gandha, i.e. that which is smelled. With each of these mahabhuta elements (earth, water, &c.) they connect, firstly, one of the panca-matras elements, as we have here shown ; and, secondly, all those which have been attributed to the mahabhata elements previously mentioned. So the earth has all five qualities; the water has them minus the smelling (= four qualities) ; the fire has them minus the smelling and tasting (i.e. three qualities) ; the wind has them minus smelling, tasting, and seeing (i.c. two qualities); heaven has them minus smelling, tast- ing, seeing, and touching (i.e. one quality). I do not know what the Hindus mean by bringing sound into relation with heaven. Perhaps they mean something similar to what Homer, the poet of the ancient Greeks, said, " Those invested with the seven melo- dies speak and give answer to cach other in a pleasant tone." Thereby he meant the seven planets; as another poet says. " The spheres endowed with different melodies are seven, moring cternally, praising the Creator, for it is he who holds them and embraces them unto the farthest end of the starless sphere."

Page 89

CHAPTER III. 43

Porphyry says in his book on the opimions of the most prominent philosophers about the nature of the sphere : "The heavenly bodies moring about in forms and shapes and with wonderful melodies, which are fixed for ever, as Pythagoras and Diogenes have ex- plained, point to their Creator, who is without eqnal and without shape. People say that Diogenes had such subtle senses that he, and he alone, could hear the sound of the motion of the sphere." All these expressions are rather hints than clear speech, but admitting of a correct interpretation on a scientific basis. Some successor of those philosophers, one of those who did not grasp the full truth, says: "Sight is watery, hearing airy, smelling fiery, tasting earthy, and touching is what the soul bestows upon everybody by uniting itself with it." I suppose this philosopher connects the sight with the water because he had heard of the moist substances of the eye and of their different classes (lacuna); he refers the smelling to the fire on account of frankincense and smoke; the fasting to the earth because of his nourishment which the earth yields him. As, then, the four elements are finished, he is compelled for the fifth sense, the touch- ing, to have recourse to the soul. The result of all these elements which we have enu- merated, i.e. a compound of all of them, is the animal. The Hindus consider the plants as a species of animal as Plato also thinks that the plants have a sense, because they have the faculty of distinguishing between that which suits them and that which is detrimental to them. The animal is an animal as distinguished from a stone by virtue of its possession of the senses. XV .- XIX. The senses are five, called indriyani, the Imdriyani. hearing by the ear, the seeing by the eye, the smelling by the nose, the tasting by the tongue, and the touching by the skin. XX. Next follows the will, which directs the senses Mansa,

Page 90

44 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

in the exercise of their various functions, and which dwells in the heart. Therefore they call it manas. Karmendri- XXI .- XXV. The animal nature is rendered perfect yâņi. by five necessary functions, which they call karmendri- Page 22. yani, i.e. the senses of action. The former senses bring about learning and knowledge, the latter action and work. We shall call them the neccssaria. They are : I. To produce a sound for any of the different wants and wishes a man may have; 2. To throw the hands with force, in order to draw towards or to put away; 3. To walk with the feet, in order to seek something or to fly from it; 4, 5. The ejection of the superfluous elements of nourishment by means of the two openings created for the purpose. Recapitula- The whole of these elements are twenty-five, viz. :- tion of the twenty-five I. The general soul. elements. 2. The abstract ύλη. 3. The shaped matter. 4. The overpowering nature. 5-9. The simple mothers. 10-14. The primary elements. 15-19. The senses of apperception. 20. The directing will. 21-25. The instrumental necessaria. The totality of these elements is called tattra, and all knowledge is restricted to them. Therefore Vyasa the son of Parasara speaks : " Learn twenty-five by dis- tinctions, definitions, and divisions, as you learn a logical syllogism, and something which is a certainty, not merely studying with the tongue. Afterwards adhere to whatever religion you like; your end will be salvation."

Page 91

( 45 )

CHATTER_IS

FROM WHAT CAUSE ACTION ORIGINATES, AND HOW THE SOUL IS CONNECTED WITH MATTER.

VOLUNTARY actions cannot originate in the body of any The soul animal, unless the body be living and exist in close con- be united longing to

tact with that which is living of itself, i.e. the soul. body, is so with the

The Hindus maintain that the soul is ev apage, not intermedi- united by

ev Ervape, ignorant of its own essential nature and of ary spirits. its material substratum, longing to apprehend what it does not know, and believing that it cannot exist unless by matter. As, therefore, it longs for the good which is duration, and wishes to learn that which is hidden from it, it starts off in order to be united with matter. However, substances which are dense and such as are tennous, if they have these qualities in the very highest degree, can mix together only by means of interme- diary elements which stand in a certain relation to each of the two. Thus the air is the medium be- tween fire and water, which are opposed to each other by these two qualities, for the air is related to the fire in tenuity and to the water in density, and by either of these qualities it renders the one capable of mixing with the other. Now, there is no greater antithesis than that between body and not-body. Therefore the soul, being what it is, cannot obtain the fulfilment of its wish but by similar media, spirits which derive their existence from the matres simpliccs in the worlds called Bharloka, Bhuvarloka, and Svarloka. The Hindus call them tenuous bodics over which the soul rises like the

Page 92

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

sun over the earth, in order to distinguish them from the dense bodies which derive their existence from the common five elements. The soul, in consequence of this union with the media, uses them as its vehicles. Thus the image of the sun, though he is only one, is re- presented in many mirrors which are placed opposite to bim, as also in the water of vessels placed opposite. The sun is seen alike in each mirror and each vessel, and in each of them his warming and light-giving effect is perceived. When, now, the various bodies, being from their nature compounds of different things, come into exist- ence, being composed of male elements, viz. bones, veins, and sperma, and of female elements, viz. flesh, - Page 23. blood, and hair, and being thus fully prepared to receive life, then those spirits unite themselves with them, and the bodies are to the spirits what castles or fortresses Five winds are to the various affairs of princes. In a farther stage regulating the func- of development five winds enter the bodies. By the tions of the body. first and second of them the inhaling and exhaling are effected, by the third the mixture of the victuals in the stomach, by the fourth the locomotion of the body from one place to the other, by the fifth the transferring of the apperception of the senses from one side of the body to the other. The ditfer- The spirits here mentioned do not, according to the ence of the suuls de- notions of the Hindus, differ from each other in sub- pending upon the stance, but have a precisely identical nature. However, differenee of the bodies their individual characters and manners differ in the and thcir interaction. same measure as the bodies with which they are united differ, on account of the three forces which are in them striving with each other for supremacy, and on account of their harmony being disturbed by the passions of envy and wrath. Snch, then, is the supreme highest cause of the soul's starting off into action. On the other hand, the lowest cause, as proceeding

Page 93

CHAPTER IV. 47

from matter, is this : that matter for its part seeks for On matter perfection, and always prefers that which is better to union with seeking the

that which is less good, viz. proceeding from Sevupes the soul.

into mpagis. In consequence of the vainglory and ambition which are its pith and marrow, matter pro- duces and shows all kinds of possibilities which it contains to its pupil, the soul, and carries it round through all classes of vegetable and animal beings. Hindus compare the soul to a dancing-girl who is clever Ilustrations in her art and knows well what effect each motion and ticnlar kind of this par-

pose of hers has. She is in the presence of a sybarite of union. most eager of enjoying what she has learned. Now she begins to produce the various kinds of her art one after the other under the admiring gaze of the host, until her programme is finished and the eagerness of the spectator has been satisfied. Then she stops suddenly, since she could not produce anything but a repetition; and as a repetition is not wished for, he dismisses her, and action ceases. The close of this kind of relation is illustrated by the following simile : A caravan has been attacked in the desert by robbers, and the members of it have tled in all directions except a blind man and a lame man, who remain on the spot in helplessness, despairing of their escape. After they meet and recognise each other, the lame speaks to the blind : " I cannot move, but I can lead the way, whilst the opposite is the case with you. Thercfore put me on your shoulder and carry me, that I may show you the way and that we may escape together from this calamity." This the blind man did. They obtained their purpose by helping each other, and they left each other on coming out of the desert. Further, the Hindus speak in different ways of the Action of agent, as we have already mentioned. So the Vishau ing from an matter ris-

Purana says: "Matter is the origin of the world. Its position. mnnate dis-

action in the world rises from an innate disposition, as a tree sows its own seed by an innate disposition, not

Page 94

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

intentionally, and the wind cools the water though it only intends blowing. Voluntary action is only due to Vishnu." By the latter expression the author means the living being who is above matter (God). Through him matter becomes an agent toiling for him as a friend toils for a friend without wanting anything for himself. On this theory Mani has built the following sentence : "The Apostles asked Jesus about the life of inanimate nature, whereupon he said, ' If that which is inanimate is separated from the living element which is com- mingled with it, and appears alone by itself, it is again Page 24. inanimate and is not capable of living, whilst the living element which has left it, retaining its vital energy unimpaired, never dies.'" On matter The book of Samkhya derives action from matter, for as the cause of action the difference of forms under which matter appears nccording to the Sam- depends upon the three primary forces, and upon whether khya school of philoso- one or two of them gain the supremacy over the phers. remainder. These forces are the angelic, the human, ' and the animal. The three forces belong only to matter, not to the soul. The task of the soul is to learn the actions of matter like a spectator, resembling a traveller who sits down in a village to repose. Each villager is busy with his own particular work, but he looks at them and considers their doings, disliking some, liking others, and taking an example from them. In this way he is busy without having himself any share in the business going on, and without being the cause which has brought it about. The book of Samkhya brings action into relation with the soul, though the soul has nothing to do with action, only in so far as it resembles a man who happens to get into the company of people whom he does not know. They are robbers returning from a village which they have sacked and destroyed, and he has scarcely marched with them a short distance, when they are overtaken by the avengers. The whole party

Page 95

CHAPTER IV. 49

are taken prisoners, and together with them the inno- cent man is dragged off; and being treated precisely as they are, he receives the same punishment, without having taken part in their action. People say the soul resembles the rain-water which comes down from heaven, always the same and of the same nature. However, if it is gathered in vessels placed for the purpose, vessels of different materials, of gold, silver, glass, earthenware, clay, or bitter-salt earth, it begins to differ in appearance, taste, and smell. Thus the soul does not influence matter in any way, except in this, that it gives matter life by being in close con- tact with it. When, then, matter begins to act, the result is different, in conformity with the one of the three primary forces which happens to preponderate, and conformably to the mutual assistance which the other two latent forces afford to the former. This assistance may be given in various ways, as the fresh oil, the dry wick, and the smoking fire help each other to produce light. The soul is in matter like the rider on a carriage, being attended by the senses, who drive the carriage according to the rider's intentions. But the soul for its part is guided by the intelligence with which it is inspired by God. This intelligence they describe as that by which the reality of things is appre- hended, which shows the way to the knowledge of God, and to such actions as are liked and praised by every- body.

VOL. I. D

Page 96

( 50 )

CHAPTER V.

ON THE STATE OF THE SOULS, AND THEIR MIGRATIONS TIROUGH THE WORLD IN THE METEMPSYCHOSIS.

As the word of confession, "There is no god but God, Mubammad is his prophet," is the shibboleth of Islam, the Trinity that of Christianity, and the institute of the Sabbath that of Judaism, so metempsychosis is the shibboleth of the Hindu religion. Therefore he who does not believe in it does not belong to them, and is not reckoned as one of them. For they hold the following belief :- Beginning, The soul, as long as it has not risen to the highest develop- ment, and absolute intelligence, does not comprehend the totality ultimate result of of objects at once, or, as it were, in no time. Therefore metempsy- chosis. it must explore all particular beings and examine all the Page 25- possibilities of existence; and as their number is, though not unlimited, still an enormous one, the soul wants an enormous space of time in order to finish the contem- plation of such a multiplicity of objects. The sonl acquires knowledge only by the contemplation of the individuals and the species, and of their peculiar actions and conditions. It gains experience from each object, and gathers thereby new knowledge. However, these actions differ in the same measure as the three primary forces differ. Besides, the world is not left without some direction, being led, as it were, by a bridle and directed towards a definite scope. There- fore the imperishable souls wander about in perishable bodies conformably to the difference of their actions, as

Page 97

CHAPTER V. 51

they prove to be good or bad. The object of the migra- tion through the world of reward (i.e. heaven) is to direct the attention of the soul to the good, that it should become desirous of acquiring as much of it as possible. The object of its migration through the world of pun- ishment (i.e. hell) is to direct its attention to the bad and abominable, that it should strive to keep as far as possible aloof from it. The migration begins from low stages, and rises to higher and better ones, not the contrary, as we state on purpose, since the one is a priori as possible as the other. The difference of these lower and higher stages depends upon the difference of the actions, and this again results from the quantitative and qualitative diversity of the temperaments and the various degrees of combinations in which they appear. This migration lasts until the object aimed at has been completely attained both for the soul and matter; the lower aim being the disappearance of the shape of matter, except any such new formation as may appear desirable; the higher aim being the ceasing of the desire of the soul to learn what it did not kuow before, the insight of the soul into the nobility of its own being and its independent existence, its knowing that it can dispense with matter after it has become acquainted with the mean nature of matter and the instability of its shapes, with all that which matter offers to the senses, and with the truth of the tales about its delights. Theu the soul turns away from matter; the connecting links are broken, the union is dissolved. Separation and dissolution take place, and the soul retnrns to its home, carrying with itself as much of the bliss of knowledge as sesame develops grains and blossoms, afterwards never separating from its oil. The intelligent being, intelligence and its object, are united and become one. It is now our duty to produce from their literature

Page 98

52 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Quotations some clear testimonies as to this subject and cognate from the book Gita. theories of other nations. Vasudeva speaks to Arjuna instigating him to the battle, whilst they stand between the two lines: " If you believe in predestination, you must know that neither they nor we are mortal, and do not go away without a return, for the souls are immortal and unchangeable. They migrate through the bodies, while man changes from childhood into youth, into manhood and infirm age, the eud of which is the death of the body. There- after the soul proceeds on its return." Further he says: "How can a man think of death and being killed who knows that the soul is eternal, not having been born and not perishing; that the sonl Page 26. is something stable and constant; that no sword can cut it, no fire burn it, no water extinguish it, and no wind witherit? The soul migrates from its body, afterit has become old, into another, a different one, as the body, when its dress has become old, is clad in another. What then is your sorrow about a soul which does not perish ? If it were perishable, it would be more becoming that you should not sorrow about a thing which may be dis- pensed with, which does not exist, and does not return into existence. But if you look more to your body than to your soul, and are in anxiety about its perish- ing, you must know that all that which is born dies, and that all that which dies returns into another exist- ence. However, both life and death are not your con- cern. They are in the hands of God, from whom all things come and to whom they return." In the further course of conversation Arjuna speaks to Vasudeva : "How did you dare thus to fight Brahman, Brahman who was before the world was and before man was, whilst you are living among us as a being, whose birth and age are known ?" Thereupon Vasudeva answered: " Eternity (pre-exist- ence) is common to both of us and to him. How often

Page 99

CHAPTER V. 53

have we lived together, when I knew the times of our life and death, whilst they were concealed from you ! When "I desire to appear in order to do some good, I array myself in a body, since one cannot be with man except in a human shape." People tell a tale of a king, whose name I have forgotten, who ordered his people after his death to bury his body on a spot where never before had a dead person been buried. Now they sought for such a spot, but could not find it; finally, on finding a rock pro- jecting out of the ocean, they thought they had found what they wanted. But then Vasudeva spoke nnto them, "This king has been burned on this identical rock already many times. But now do as you like; for the king only wanted to give you a lesson, and this aim of his has now been attained." Vasudeva says: "He who hopes for salvation and strives to free himself from the world, but whose heart is not obedient to his wish, will be rewarded for his action in the worlds of those who receive a good re- ward ; but he does not attain his last object on account of his deficiency, therefore he will return to this world, and will be found worthy of entering a new shape of a kind of beings whose special occupation is devotion. Divine inspiration helps him to raise himself in this new sbape by degrees to that which he already wished for in the first shape. His heart begins to comply with his wish; he is more and more purified in the different shapes, until he at last obtains salvation in an uninter- rupted series of new births." Further, Vasudeva says: "If the soul is free from matter, it is knowing ; but as long as it is clad in matter, the soul is not-knowing, on account of the turbid nature of matter. It thinks that it is an agent, and that the actions of the world are prepared for its sake. There- fore it clings to them, and it is stamped with the im- pressions of the senses. When, then, the soul leaves

Page 100

54 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

the body, the traces of the impressions of the senses remain in it, and are not completely eradicated, as it longs for the world of sense and returns towards it. And since it in these stages undergoes changes entirely opposed to each other, it is thereby subject to the influences of the three primary forces. What, therefore, can the soul do, its wing being cut, if it is not suffi- ciently trained and prepared ?" Vasudeva says : "The best of men is the perfectly wise one, for he loves God and God loves him. How many times has he died and been born again! During his whole life he perseveringly seeks for perfection till he obtains it." Viskąn- In the Vishnu-Dharma, Markandeya, speaking of the Dharmn. spiritual beings, says : " Brahman, Karttikeya, son of Mahadeva, Lakshmi, who produced the Amrita, Daksha, who was beaten by Mahâdeva, Umadevi, the wife of Mahadeva, each of them has been in the middle of this Ealpa, and they have been the same already many times," Varâhamibira speaks of the inflnences of the comets, and of the calamities which befall men when they appear. These calamities compel them to emigrate from their homes, lean from exhanstion, moaning over their mishap, leading their children by the hand along the road, and speaking to each other in low tones, " We are punished for the sins of our kings; " where- npon others answer, " Not so. This is the retribntion for what we have done in the former life, before we entered these bodies." Mânî. When Mani was banished from Eranshabr, he went, to India, learned metempsychosis from the Hindus, and transferred it into his own system. He says in the Bool: of Mysteries: " Since the Apostles knew that the souls are immortal, and that in their migrations they array themselves in every form, that they are shaped in every animal, and are cast in the mould of every figure, they

Page 101

CHAPTER V. 55

asked Messiah what would be the end of those soulswhich did not receive the truth nor learn the origin of their existence. Whereupon he said, ' Any weak soul which has not received all that belongs to her of truth perishes without any rest or bliss.'" By perishing Mant means her being punished, not her total disappearance. For in another place he says : " The partisans of Bardesanes think that the living soul rises and is purified in the carcase, not knowing that the latter is the enemy of the soul, that the carcase prevents the soul from rising, that it is a prison, and a painful punishment to the soul. If this human figure were a real existence, its creator would not let it wear out and suffer injury, and would not have compelled it to reproduce itself by the sperma in the uterus." The following passage is taken from the book of Patañjali. Patañjali :- "The soul, being on all sides tied to ignorance, which is the cause of its being fettered, is like rice in its cover. As long as it is there, it is capable of growing and ripening in the tran- sition stages between being born and giving birth itself. But if the cover is taken off the rice, it ceases to develop in this way, and becomes stationary. The retribution of the soul depends on the various kinds of creatures through which it wanders, npon the extent of life, whether it be long or short, and upon the particular kind of its happiness, be it scanty or ample." The pupil asks : " What is the condition of the spirit when it has a claim to a recompense or has committed a crime, and is then entangled in a kind of new birth either in order to receive bliss or to be punished?" The master says : " It migrates according to what it has previously done, fluctuating between happiness Page 28. and misfortune, and alternately experiencing pain or pleasure." The pupil asks: " If a man commits something which

Page 102

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

necessitates a retribution for him in a different shape from that in which he has committed the thing, and if between both stages there is a great interval of time and the matter is forgotten, what then?" The master answers: "It is the nature of action to adhere to the spirit, for action is its product, whilst the body is only an instrument for it. Forgetting does not apply to spiritual matters, for they lie ontside of time, with the nature of which the notions of long and short duration are necessarily connected. Action, by adhering to the spirit, frames its nature and character into a condition similar to that one into which the soul will enter on its next migration. The soul in its purity knows this, thinks of it, and does not forget it; but the light of the soul is covered by the turbid nature of the body as long as it is connected with the body. Then the soul is like a man who remembers a thing which he once knew, but then forgot in consequence of insanity or an illness or some intoxication which overpowered his mind. Do you not observe that little children are in high spirits when people wish them a long life, and are sorry when people imprecate upon them a speedy death? And what would the one thing or the other signify to them, if they had not tasted the sweetness of life and experienced the bitterness of death in former generations through which they had been migrating to undergo the due course of retribution ? " Quotations The ancient Greeks agreed with the Hindus in this from Plato and Proclus. belief. Socrates says in the book Phaedo : "We are reminded in the tales of the ancients that the souls go from here to Hades, and then come from Hades to here; that the living originates from the dead, and that altogether things originate from their contraries. Therefore those who have died are among the living. Our souls lead an existence of their own in Hades. The soul of each man is glad or sorry at something, and contemplates this thing. This impressionable nature

Page 103

CHAPTER V. 57

ties the soul to the body, nails it down in the body, and gives it, as it were, a bodily figure. The soul which is not pure cannot go to Hades. It quits the body still filled with its nature, and then migrates hastily into another body, in which it is, as it were, deposited and made fast. Therefore, it has no share in the living of the company of the unique, pure, divine essence." Further he says: "If the soul is an independent being, our learning is nothing but remembering that which we had learned previously, because our souls were in some place before they appeared in this human figure. When people see a thing to the use of which they were accustomed in childhood, they are under the influence of this impressionability, and a cymbal, for instance, reminds them of the boy who used to beat it, whom they, however, had forgotten. Forgetting is the vanishing of knowledge, and knowing is the soul's remembrance of that which it had learned before it entered the body." Proclus says: "Remembering and forgetting are peculiar to the soul endowed with reason. It is evident that the soul has always existed. Hence it follows that it has always been both knowing and for- Page 29. getting, knowing when it is separated from the body, forgetting when it is in connection with the body. For, being separated from the body, it belongs to the realm of the spirit, and therefore it is knowing; but being connected with the body, it descends from the realm of the spirit, and is exposed to forgetting because of some forcible influence prevailing over it." The same doctrine is professed by those Sufi who shfi teach that this world is a sleeping soul and yonder doctrine.

world a soul awake, and who at the same time admit that God is immanent in certain places-e.g. in heaven -in the seut and the throne of God (mentioned in the Koran). But then there are others who admit that

Page 104

58 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

God is immanent in the whole world, in animals, trees, and the inanimate world, which they call his universal appearance. To those who hold this view, the entering of the souls into various beings in the course of metem- psychosis is of no consequence.

Page 105

( 59 )

CHAPTER VI.

ON THE DIFFERENT WORLDS, AND ON THE PLACES OF RETRIBUTION IN PARADISE AND HELL.

THE Hindus call the world loka. Its primary division The three consists of the upper, the low, and the middle .. The lokos.

upper one is called svarloka, i.e. paradise: the low, nagaloka, i.c. the world of the serpents. which is hell; besides they call it naraloka, and sometimes also patala, i.c. the lowest world. The middle world, that one in which we live, is called madhyaloka and manushyaloka. i.c. the world of men. In the latter, man has to earn, in the upper to receive his reward ; in the low, to receive punishment. A man who deserves to come to srarloka or nugaloka receives there the full recompense of his deeds during a certain length of time corresponding to the duration of his deeds, but in either of them there is only the soul, the soul free from the body. For those who do not deserve to rise to heaven and to sink as low as hell there is another world called tiryag- loka, the irrational world of plants and animals, throngh the individuals of which the soul has to wander in the metempsychosis until it reaches the human being, rising by degrees from the lowest kinds of the vegetable world to the highest classes of the sensitive world. The stay of the soul in this world has one of the following causes : either the award which is due to the soul is not sufticient to raise it into heaven or to sink it into hell, or the soul is in its wanderings on the way back from hell ; for they believe that a soul returning to the human

Page 106

60 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

world from heaven at once adopts a human body, whilst that one which returns there from hell has first to wander about in plants and animals before it reaches the degree of living in a human body. Quotation The Hindus speak in their traditions of a large num- from the Vishņu- ber of hells, of their qualities and their names, and for Purana. each kind of sin they have a special hell. The number of hells is 88,000 according to the Vishņu-Puraina. We shall quote what this book says on the subject :- "The man who makes a false claim and who bears false witness, he who helps these two and he who ridicules people, come into the Raurava hell. "He who sheds innocent blood, who robs others of their rights and plunders them, and who kills cows, comes into Rodha. Those also who strangle people come here. "Whoso kills a Brahman, and he who steals gold, Page 30. and their companions, the princes who do not look after their subjects, he who commits adultery with the family of his teacher, or who lies down with his mother-in-law, come into Taptakumbha. " Whoso connives at the shame of his wife for greedi- ness, commits adultery with his sister or the wife of his son, sells his child, is stingy towards himself with his property in order to save it, comes into Mahajwala. "Whoso is disrespectful to his teacher and is not pleased with him, despises men, commits incest with animals, contemns the Veda and Purânas, or tries to make a gain by means of them in the markets, comes into Savala. "A man who steals and commits tricks, who opposes the straight line of conduct of men, who hates his father, who does not like God and men, who does not honour the gems which God has made glorious, and who considers them to be like other stones, comes into Krimíśa. "Whoso does not honour the rights of parents and

Page 107

CHAPTER VI. 61

grandparents, whoso does not do his duty towards the angels, the maker of arrows and spear-points, come to Lulabhalsha. "The maker of swords and knives comes to Visnsana. "He who conceals his property, being greedy for the presents of the rulers, and the Brahman who sells meat or oil or butter or sauce or wine, come to Adhomnkhu. "Hle who rears cocks and cats, small cattle, pigs, and birds, comes to Rudhirandha. " Public performers and singers in the markets, those who dig wells for drawing water, a man who cohabits with his wife on holy days, who throws fire into the houses of men, who betrays his companion and then receives him, being greedy for his property, come to Rudhira. "lle who takes the honey out of the beehive comes to Vaitaranî. "Whoso takes away by force the property and women of others in the intoxication of youth comes to Krishna. " Whoso cuts down the trees comes to Asipatravara. "The hunter, and the maker of snares aud traps, come to Vahnijuala. " Ie who neglects the customs and rules, and he who violates the laws-and he is the worst of all-come to Sandamsaka." We have given this enumeration only in order to show what kinds of deeds the Hindus abhor as sins. Some Hindus believe that the middle world, that one According for earning, is the human world, and that a man wan- Hindus, the to some

ders about in it, because he has received a reward which migration through does not lead him into heaven, but at the same time plauts and animals saves him from hell. They consider heaven as a higher place of takes the stage, where a man lives in a state of bliss which must hell. be of a certain duration on account of the good deeds he has done. On the contrary, they consider the wan- dering about in plants and animals as a lower stage,

Page 108

62 ALBERUNPS INDIA.

where a man dwells for punishment for a certain length of time, which is thought to correspond to the wretched deeds he has done. People who hold this view do not know of another hell, but this kind of degradation below the degree of living as a human being. Page 31. All these degrees of retribution are necessary for this Moral prin- reason, that the seeking for salvation from the fetters ciples of metempsy- of matter frequently does not proceed on the straight chosis. line which leads to absolute knowledge, but on lines chosen by guessing or chosen because others had chosen them. Not one action of man shall be lost, not even the last of all; it shall be brought to his account after his good and bad actions have been balanced against each other. The retribution, however, is not according to the deed, but according to the intention which a man had in doing it; and a man will receive his reward either in the form in which he lives on earth, or in that form into which his soul will migrate, or in a kind of intermediary state after he has left his shape and has not yet entered a new one. Here now the llindus quit the path of philosophical speculation and turn aside to traditional fables as re- gards the two places where reward or punishment is given, e.y. that man exists there as an incorporeal being, and that after having received the reward of his actions he again returns to a bodily appearance and human shape, in order to be prepared for his further destiny. The Therefore the author of the book Sarlhya does not Saikhyr eriticises consider the reward of paradise a special gain, becanse it mctempsy- chosis. has an end and is not eternal, and because this kind of life resembles the life of this our world; for it is not free from ambition and envy, having in itself various degrees and classes of existence, whilst cupidity and desire do not cease save where there is perfect equality. Sůfi The Sûfi, too, do not consider the stay in paradise a parallel. special gain for another reason, because there the soul delights in other things but the Truth, i.e. God, and its

Page 109

CHAPTER VI.

thoughts are diverted from the Absolute Good by things which are not the Absolute Good. We have already said that, according to the belief of Ou the soul the Hindus, the soul exists in these two places without leaving the body, a body. Bnt this is only the view of the educated aceording to popular among them, who understand by the soul an indepen- views.

dent being. llowever, the lower classes, and those who cannot imagine the existence of the soul without a body, hold about this subject very different views. One is this, that the cause of the agony of death is the soul's waiting for a shape which is to be prepared. It does not quit the body before there has originated a cognate being of similar functions, one of those which nature prepares either as an embryo in a mother's womb or as a seed in the bosom of the earth. Then the soul quits the body in which it has been staying. Others hold the more traditional view that the soul does not wait for such a thing, that it quits its shape on account of its weakness whilst another body has been prepared for it out of the elements. This body is called ntirahika, i.e. that which grous in huste, becanse it does not come into existence by being born. The soul stays in this body a complete year in the greatest agony, no matter whether it has deserved to be rewarded or to be punished. This is like the Barzakh of the Persians, an intermediary stage between the periods of acting and earning and that of receiving award. For this reason the heir of the deceased must, according to Hindu use, fulfil the rites of the year for the deceased, duties which end with the end of the year, for then the soul goes to that place which is prepared for it. We shall now give some extracts from their litera- Quotutious ture to illustrate these ideas. First from the Vishnn from Visknu Purâna. Purna

"Maitreya asked l'arasara about the purpose of hell and the Satkhya schuol. and the punishment in it, whereupon he answered: 'It is for distinguishing the good from the bad, knowledge

Page 110

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Page 32. from iguorance, and for the manifestation of justice. But not every sinner enters hell. Some of them escape hell by previously doing works of repentance and ex- piation. The greatest expiation is uninterruptedly thinking of Vishnu in every action. Others wander about in plants, filthy insects and birds, and abominable dirty creeping things like lice and worms, for such a length of time as they desire it.'" In the book Sainkhya we read: "lle who deserves exaltation and reward will become like one of the angels, mixing with the hosts of spiritual beings, not being prevented from moving freely in the heaveus and from living in the company of their inhabitants, or like one of the eight classes of spiritual beings. But he who deserves humiliation as recompense for sins and crimes will become an animal or a plant, and will wander about until he deserves a reward so as to be saved from punishment, or until he offers himself as expiation, flinging away the vehicle of the body, and thereby attaining salvation." Muslim A theosoph who inclines towards metempsychosis authors on metempsy- says : "The metempsychosis has four degrees: chosis. "I. The transferring, i.e. the procreation as limited to the human species, because it transfers existence from one individual to another ; the opposite of this is- "2. The transforming, which concerns men in parti- cular, since they are transformed into monkeys, pigs, and elephants. "3. A stable condition of existence, like the condition of the plants. This is worse than transferring, because it is a stable condition of life, remains as it is through all time, and lasts as long as the mountains. "4. The dispersing, the opposite of number 3, which applies to the plants that are plucked, and to animals immolated as sacrifice, because they vanish without leaving posterity." Abû-Yakub of Sijistan maintains in his book, called " The disclosing of that which is rciled," that the species

Page 111

CHAPTER VI.

are preserved ; that metemipsychosis always proceeds in one and the same species, never crossing its limits and passing into another species. This was also the opinion of the ancient Greeks; Quotations for Johannes Grammaticus relates as the view of Plato nes Gram- from Johan.

that the rational souls will be clad in the bodies of Plato. maticus and

animals, and that in this regard he followed the-fables of Pythagoras. Socrates says in the book Phædo: "The body is earthy, ponderous, heavy, and the soul, which loves it, wanders about and is attracted towards the place, to which it looks from fear of the shapeless and of Hades, the gathering-place of the souls. They are soiled, and circle round the graves and cemeteries, where souls have been seen appearing in shadowy forms. This phantasmagoria only occurs to such souls as have not been entirely separated, in which there is still a part of that towards which the look is directed." Further be says: " It appears that these are not the souls of the good, but the souls of the wicked, which wander about in these things to make an expiation for the badness of their former kind of rearing. Thus they remain until they are again bound in a body on acconnt of the desire for the bodily shape which has followed them. They will dwell in bodies the character of which is like the character which they had in the world. Whoso, e.g. only cares for eating and drinking will enter the various kinds of asses and wild animals; and he who preferred wrong and oppression will enter the various kinds of wolves, and falcons, and hawks." Further he says about the gathering-places of the souls after death: "If I did not think that I am going first to gods who are wise, ruling, and good, Page 33. then afterwards to men, deceased ones, better than those here, I should be wrong not to be in sorrow about death." Further, Plato says about the two places of reward and VOL. I. E

Page 112

66 ALBERUNPS INDIA.

of punishment : " When a man dies, a daimon, i.c. one of the guardians of hell, leads him to the tribunal of judg- ment, and a guide whose special office it is brings him, to- gether with those assembled there, to Hades, and there he remains the necessary number of many and long cycles of time. Telephos says, 'The road of Hades is an even one.' I, however, say, ' If the road were even or only a single one, a guide conld be dispensed with.' Now that soul which longs for the body, or whose deeds were evil and not just, which resembles souls that have committed murder, flies from there and encloses itself in every species of being until certain times pass by. Thereupon it is brought by necessity to that place which is suitable to it. But the pure soul finds com- panions and guides, gods, and dwells in the places which are suitable to it." Further he says: " Those of the dead who led a middle sort of life travel on a vessel prepared for them over Acheron. After they have received punish- ment and have been purified from crime, they wash and receive honour for the good deeds which they did according to merit. Those, however, who had committed great sins, c.g. the stealing from the sacri- fices of the gods, robberies on a great scale, unjust killing, repeatedly and consciously violating the laws, are thrown into Tartarus, whence they will never be able to escape." Further: "Those who repented of their sins already during their lifetime, and whose crimes were of a some- what lower degree, who, c.g. committed some act of violence against their parents, or committed a murder by mistake, are thrown into Tartarus, being punished there for a whole year; but then the wave throws them out to a place whence they cry to their antagonists, asking them to abstain from further retaliation, that they may be saved from the horrors of punishment. If those now agree, they are saved; if not, they are sent back into

Page 113

CHAPTER VI. 67

Tartarus. And this, their punishment, goes on until their antagonists agree to their demands for being re- lieved. Those whose mode of life was virtuous are liberated from these places on this earth. They feel as though released from prison, and they will inhabit the pure earth." Tartarus is a huge deep ravine or gap into which the rivers flow. All people understand by the punishment of hell the most dreadful things which are known to them, and the Western countries, like Greece, have sometimes to suffer deluges and floods. But the de- scription of Plato indicates a place where there are glaring flames, and it seems that he means the sea or some part of the ocean, in which there is a whirlpool (durdar, a pun upon Tartarus). No doubt these de- scriptions represent the belief of the men of those ages.

Page 114

( 68 )

CHAPTER VIL

ON THE NATURE OF LIBERATION FROM THE WORLD, AND ON TIE PATII LEADING THERETO.

First part: Ir the soul is bound up with the world, and its being Moksha in gencral. bound up has a certain cause, it cannot be liberated from this bond save by the opposite of this identical cause. Now according to the Hindus, as we have already explained (p. 55), the reason of the bond is Page 34. ignorance, and therefore it can only be liberated by kenowledge, by comprehending all things in such a way as to define them both in general and in particular, rendering superfluous any kind of deduction and re- moving all doubts. For the soul distinguishing between things (ra orra) by means of definitions, recognises its own self, and recognises at the same time that it is its noble lot to last for ever, and that it is the vulgar lot of matter to change and to perish in all kinds of shapes. ] Then it dispenses with matter, and perceives that that which it held to be good and delightful is in reality bad and painful. In this manner it attains real know- ledge and turns away from being arrayed in matter. Thereby action ceases, and both matter and soul become free by separating from each other. Moksha ac- The author of the book of Palanjali says: " The con- cording to Putanjalı. centration of thought on the unity of God induces man to notice something besides that with which he is occupied. He who wants God, wants the good for the whole creation without a single exception for any reason whatever; but he who occupies himself exclusively with

Page 115

CHAPTER VII.

his own self, will for its benefit neither inhale, breathe, nor exhale it (srasa and prasvasa). When a man attains to this degree, his spiritual power prevails over his bodily power, and then he is gifted with the faculty of doing eight different things by which detachment is realised ;for a man can only dispense with that which he is able to do, not with that which is outside his grasp. These eight things are :- "I. The faculty in man of making his body so thin that it becomes invisible to the eyes. "2. The faculty of making the body so light that it is indifferent to him whether he treads on thorns or mud or sand. "3. The faculty of making his body so big that it appears in a terrifying miraculous shape. "4. The faculty of realising every wish. "5. The faculty of knowing whatever he wishes. "6. The faculty of becoming the ruler of whatever religious community he desires. "7. That those orer whom he rules are humble and obedient to him. "8. That all distances between a man and any far- away place vanish." The terms of the Shfi as to the knowing being and soff his attaining the stage of knowledge come to the same parallel.

effect, for they maintain that he has two souls-an eternal one, not exposed to change and alteration, by which he knows that which is hidden, the trans- cendental world, and performs wonders } and another, a human soul, which is liable to being changed and being born. (From these and similar views the doctrines of / the Christians do not much differ. The Hindus say : " If a man has the faculty to per- The differ- form these things, he can dispense with them, and will ent degrees of know- reach the goal by degrees, passing throngh several according to ledge

stages :- Patanjali.

" I. The knowledge of things as to their names and

Page 116

70 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

qualities and distinctions, which, however, does not yet afford the knowledge of definitions. "2. Such a knowledge of things as proceeds as far as the definitions by which particulars are classed under the category of universals, but regarding which a man must still practise distinction. "3. This distinction (viveka) disappears, and man comprehends things at once as a whole, but within time. "4. This kind of knowledge is raised above timc, and he who has it can dispense with names and epithets, which are only instruments of human imperfection. In this stage the intellectus and the intelligens unite with the intcllectum, so as to be one and the same thing." This is what Patañjali says about the knowledge which liberates the soul. In Sanskrit they call its liberation Molesha-i.e. the end. By the same term they call the last contact of the eclipsed and eclipsing bodies, or their separation in both lunar and solar eclipses, becanse it is the end of the eclipse, the moment when the two luminaries which were in contact with Page 35- each other separate. According to the Hindus, the organs of the senses have been made for acquiring knowledge, and the plea- snre which they afford has been created to stimulate people to research and investigation, as the pleasure which eating and drinking afford to the taste has been created to preserve the individual by means of nourish- ment. So the pleasure of coitus serves to preserve the species by giving birth to new individnals. If there were not special pleasure in these two functions, man and animals would not practise them for these pur- poses. On know- In the book Gita we read: "Man is created for the ledge ae- cording to purpose of knowing; and because knowing is always the bouk Gita. the same, man has been gifted with the same organs.

Page 117

CHAPTER VII. 71

If man were created for the purpose of acting, his organs would be different, as actions are diferent in consequence of the difference of the threc primary forces. However, bodily nature is bent upon acting on account of its essential opposition to knowing. Besides, it wishes to invest action with pleasures which in reality are pains. But knowledge is such as to leave this nature behind itself prostrated on the earth like an opponent, and removes all darkness from the sonl as an eclipse or clouds are removed from the sun." This resembles the opinion of Socrates, who thinks Quotation that the soul "being with the body, and wishing to Phado. from Plato's

inquire into something, then is deceived by the body. But by cogitations something of its desires becomes clear to it. Therefore, its cogitation takes place in that. time when it is not disturbed by anything like hearing, seeing, or by any pain or pleasure, when it is quite by itself, and has as much as possible quitted the body and its companionship. In particular, the soul of the philosopher scorns the body, and wishes to be separate from it." "If we in this our life did not make use of the body, nor had anything in common with it except in cases of necessity, if we were not inocnlated with its nature, but were perfectly free from it, we should come near Inowledge by getting rest from the ignorance of the body, and we should become pure by knowing our- selves as far as God would permit ns. And it is only right to acknowledge that this is the truth." Now we return and continue onr qnotation from the The process book Gita. of know- ledge ae- " Likewise the other organs of the senses serve for cording to Gita and acquiring knowledge. The Frowing person rejoices in another source. turning them to and fro on the field of knowledge, so that they are his spies. The apprenhension of the senses is different according to time. The senses which serve the heart perceive only that which is present. The

Page 118

72 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

heart reflects over that which is present and remembers also the past. The nature takes hold of the present, claims it for itself in the past, and prepares to wrestle with it in future. The reason understands the nature of a thing, no regard being had of time or date, since past and future are the same for it. Its nearest helpers are reflection and nature; the most distant are the five senses. When the senses bring before reflection some particular object of knowledge, reflection cleans it from the errors of the functions of the senses, and hands it over to reason. Thereupon reason makes universal what was before particular, and communicates it to the soul. Thus the soul comes to know it." Further, the Hindus think that a man becomes know- ing in one of three ways :- I. By being inspired, not in a certain conrse of time, but at once, at birth, and in the cradle, as, e.g. the sage Kapila, for he was born knowing and wise. 2. By being inspired after a certain time, like the children of Brahman, for they were inspired when they came of age. 3. By learning, and after a certain course of time, like all men who learn when their mind ripens. Page 36 Liberation through knowledge can only be obtained Cupidity, wrath, and by abstaining from evil. The branches of evil are many, ignorance are the chief but we may classify them as cupidity, wrath, and ignor- ob tacles to Moksba. ance. If the roots are cut the branches will wither. And here we have first to consider the rule of the two forces of cupidity and wrath, which are the greatest and most pernicions enemies of man, deluding him by the pleasure of eating and the delight of revenge, whilst in reality they are much more likely to lead him into pains and crimes. They make a man similar to the wild beasts and the cattle, nay, even to the demons and devils. Next we have to consider that man must prefer the reasoning force of mind, by which he becomes similar

Page 119

CHAPTER VII. 73

to the highest angels, to the forces of cupidity and wrath; and, lastly, that he must turn away from the actions of the world. He cannot, however, gire up these actions unless he does away with their canses. which are his lust and ambition. Thereby the second of the thrce primary forces is cut away. However, the abstain- ing from action takes place in two different ways :- I. By laziness, procrastination, and ignorance accord- ing to the third forcc. This mode is not desirable, for it will lead to a blamable end. 2. By judicions selection and by preferring that which is better to that which is good, which way leads to a Jaudable end. The abstaining from actions is rendered perfect in this way, that a man quits anything that might occupy him and shuts himself up against it. Thereby he will be enabled to restrain his senses from extraneous objects to such a degree that he does not any more know that there exists anything besides himself, and be enabled to stop all motions, and even the breathing. It is evident that a greedy man strains to effect his object, the man who strains becomes tired, and the tired man pants; so the panting is the result of greediness. If this greediness is removed, the breathing becomes like the breathing of a being living at the bottom of the sea, that does not want breath; and then the heart quietly rests on one thing, viz. the search for liberation and for arriving at the absolute unity. In the book Gita we read: " How is a man to ob- Further tain liberation who disperses his heart and does not from Gito. quotations

concentrate it alone upon God, who does not exclu- sively direct his action towards him? But if a man turns away his cogitation from all other things and concentrates it upon the One, the light of his heart will be steady like the light of a lamp filled with clean oil, standing in a corner where no wind makes it flicker. and he will be occupied in such a degree as not to

Page 120

74 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

perceive anything that gives pain, like heat or cold, knowing that everything besides the One, the Truth, is a vain phantom." In the same book we read: "Pain and pleasure have no effect on the real world, just as the continuous flow of the streams to the ocean does not affect its water. How could anybody ascend this mountain pass save him who has conquered eupidity and wrath and rendered them inert?" On account of what we have explained it is necessary that cogitation should be continnous, not in any way to be defined by number; for a number always de- notes repeated times, and repeated times presuppose a break in the cogitation occurring between two consecu- tive times. This would interrupt the continuity, and would prevent cogitation becoming united with the object of cogitation. And this is not the object kept in view, which is, on the contrary, the continuity of cogitation. This goal is attained either in a single shape, i.e. a single stage of metempsychosis, or in sereral shapes, in this way, that a man perpetually practises virtnous behaviour and accnstoms the soul thereto, so that this virtuous behaviour becomes to it a nature and an essential quality. Virtuous behavionr is that which is described by The nine the religious law. Its principal laws, from which they eommand- Inents of derive many secondary ones, may be summed up in the the Hindu religion. following nine rules :- I. A man shall not kill. 2. Nor lie. 3. Nor steal. 4. Nor whore. Page 37. 5. Nor hoard up treasures. 6. HIe is perpetnally to practise holiness and purity. 7. He is to perform the prescribed fasting without an interruption and to dress poorly.

Page 121

CHAPTER VII. 75

  1. He is to hold fast to the adoration of God with praise and thanks. 9. He is always to have in mind the word om, the word of creation, without pronouncing it. The injunction to abstain from killing as regards animals (No. I) is only a special part of the general order to abstain from doing anything hurtful. Under this head falls also the robbing of another man's goods (No. 3), and the telling lies (No. 2), not to mention the foulness and baseness of so doing. The abstaining from hoarding up (No. 5) means that a man is to give up toil and fatigne; that he who seeks the bounty of God feels sure that he is provided for; and that, starting from the base slavery of material life, we may, by the noble liberty of cogitation, attain eternal bliss. P'ractising purity (No. 6) implies that a man knows the filth of the body, and that he feels called upon to hate it, and to love cleanness of soul. Tormenting oneself by poor dress (No. 7) means that a man should reduce the body, allay its feverish desires, and sharpen its senses. Pythagoras once said to a man who took great care to keep his body in a flonrishing condition and to allow it everything it desired, "Thon art not lazy in bnilding thy prison and making thy fetter as strong as possible." The holding fast to meditation on God and the angels means a kind of familiar intercourse with them. The book Sanikhye says : " Man cannot go beyond anything in the wake of which he marches, it being a scope to him (i.e. thus engrossing his thoughts and detaining him from meditation on God)." The book Gita says: " All that which is the object of a man's continuous meditating and bearing in mind is stamped upon him, so that he even unconsciously is guided by it. Since, now, the time of heath is the time of remembering what we love, the soul on leaving the body is united with that object which we love, and is changed into it."

Page 122

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

However, the reader must not believe that it is only the union of the soul with any forms of life that perish and return into existence that is perfect libcration, for the Qnotations same book, Gita, says: "He who knows when dying that from Gita. God is everything, and that from him everything pro- ceeds, is liberated, though his degree be lower than that of the saints." The same book says : "Seek deliverance from this world by abstaining from any connection with its follies, by having sincere intentions in all actions and when making offerings by fire to God, without any desire for reward and recompense; further, by keeping aloof from mankind." The real meaning of all this is that you should not prefer one because he is your friend to another because he is your enemy, and that you should beware of negligence in sleeping when others are awake, and in waking when others are asleep; for this, too, is a kind of being absent from them, though outwardly you are present with them. Further: Seek deliverance by guarding soul from soul, for the soul is an enemy if it be addicted to lusts; but what an excellent friend it is when it is chaste!" Greek Socrates, caring little for his impending death and and Sufi parallels. being glad at the prospect of coming to his Lord, said : " My degree must not be considered by any one of you lower than that of the swan," of which people say that it is the bird of Apollo, the sun, and that it therefore knows what is hidden ; that is, when feeling that it will soon die, sings more and more melodies from joy at the prospect of coming to its Lord. " At least my joy at my prospect of coming to the object of my adoration must not be less than the joy of this bird." For similar reasons the Sûfi define love as being en- grossed by the creature to the exclusion of God. Second In the book of l'atanjali we read: "We divide the part: The practical path of liberation into three parts :- path leading to Moksha "I. The practical one (kriya-yoga), a process of habitu-

Page 123

CHAPTER VII. 77

ating the senses in a gentle way to detach themselves according to from the external world, and to concentrate themselves viahnu- Putañjali,

upon the internal one, so that they exclusively occupy and Gita. Dharmo,

themselves with God. This is in general the path of him who does not desire anything save what is sufficient Page 38. to sustain life." In the book Vishnu-Dharma we read: "The king Pariksha, of the family of Bhrigu, asked Satanika, the head of an assembly of sages, who stayed with him, for the explanation of some notion regarding the deity, and by way of answer the sage communicated what he had heard from Saunaka, Śannaka from Usanas, and Uśanas from Brahman, as follows: 'God is without first and without last; he has not been born from anything, and he has not borne anything save that of which it is im- possible to say that it is He, and just as impossible to say that it is Not-he. How should I be able to ponder on the absolute good which is an outflow of his benevo- lence, and of the absolute bad which is a product of his wrath ; and how could I know him so as to worship him as is his due, save by turning away from the world in general and by occupying myself exclusively with him, by perpetually cogitating on him ?' " It was objected to him: 'Man is weak and his life is a trifling matter. Ile can hardly bring himself to abstain from the necessities of life, and this prevents him from walking on the path of liberation. If we were living in the first age of mankind, when life extended to thousands of years, and when the world was good because of the non-existence of evil, we might hope that that which is necessary on this path should be done. But since we live in the last age, what, according to your opinion, is there in this revolving world that might protect him against the floods of the ocean and save him from drowning?' "Thereupon Brahman spoke: ' Man wants nourish- ment, shelter, and clothing. Therefore in them there

Page 124

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

is no harm to him. But happiness is only to be found in abstaining from things besides them, from snperfluous and fatiguing actions. Worship God, him alone, and venerate him; approach him in the place of worship with presents like perfumes and flowers; praise him and attach your heart to him so that it never leaves him. Give alms to the Brahmans and to others, and vow to God vows-special ones, like the abstaining from meat; general ones, like fasting. Vow to him ani- mals which you must not hold to be something different from yourselves, so as to feel entitled to kill them. Know that he is everything. Therefore, whatever you do, let it be for his sake; and if you enjoy anything of the vanities of the world, do not forget him in your intentions. If you aim at the fear of God and the faculty of worshipping him, thereby you will obtain liberation, not by anything else.' " The book Gitd says: " He who mortifies his lust does not go beyond the necessary wants; and he who is content with that which is sufficient for the sustaining of life will not be ashamed nor be despised." The same book says: " If man is not without wants as regards the demands of human nature, if he wants nourishment to appease thereby the heat of hunger and exhaustion, sleep in order to meet the injurious influ- ences of fatiguing motions and a couch to rest upon, let the latter be clean and smooth, everywhere equally high above the ground and sufficiently large that he may stretch out his body upon it. Let him have a place of temperate climate, not hurtful by cold nor by heat, and where he is safe against the approach of reptiles. All this helps him to sharpen the functions of his heart, that he may without any interruption con- centrate his cogitation on the unity. For all things besides the necessities of life in the way of eating and clothing are pleasures of a kind which, in reality, are disguised pains. To acquiesce in them is impossible,

Page 125

CHAPTER VII. 79

and would end in the gravest inconvenience. There is pleasure only to him who kills the two intolerable enemies, lust and wrath, already during his life and not l'age 39. when he dies, who derives his rest and bliss from within, not from without ; and who, in the final result, is able altogether to dispense with his senses." Vâsudeva spoke to Arjuna : " If you want the abso- lute good, take care of the nine doors of thy body, and know what is going in and out through them. Constrain thy heart from dispersing its thoughts, and quiet thy soul by thinking of the upper membrane of the child's brain, which is first soft, and then is closed and becomes strong, so that it would seem that there were no more need of it. Do not take perception of the senses for anything but the nature immanent in their organs, and therefore beware of following it." II. The second part of the path of liberation is The path of renunciation (the via omissionis), based on the know- tion as the remineia-

ledge of the evil which exists in the changing things of of the path second part

creation and their vanishing shapes. In consequence arcording to of liberation

the heart shuns them, the longing for them ceases, and Gita.

a man is raised above the three primary forces which are the cause of actions and of their diversity. For he who accurately understands the affairs of the world knows that the good ones among them are evil in reality, and that the bliss which they afford changes in the course of recompense into pains. Therefore he avoids every- thing which might aggravate his condition of being entangled in the world, and which might resnlt in making him stay in the world for a still longer period. The book Gita says: " Men err in what is ordered and what is forbidden. They do not know how to dis- tinguish between good and evil in actions. Therefore, giving up acting altogether and keeping aloof from it, this is the action." The same book says: "The purity of knowledge is high above the purity of all other things, for by know-

Page 126

80 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

ledge ignorance is rooted out and certainty is gained in exchange for doubt, which is a means of torture, for there is no rest for him who doubts." It is evident from this that the first part of the path of liberation is instrumental to the second one. Worship as III. The third part of the path of liberation which is the third part of the to be considered as instrumental to the preceding two path of liberation is worship, for this purpose, that God should help a man according to Gito. to obtain liberation, and deign to consider him worthy of such a shape of existence in the metempsychosis in which he may effect his progress towards beatitude. The author of the book Gita distributes the duties of worship among the body, the voice, and the heart. What the body has to do is fasting, prayer, the fulfil- ment of the law, the service towards the angels and the sages among the Brahmans, keeping clean the body, keeping aloof from killing under all circumstances, and never looking at another man's wife and other property. What the voice has to do is the reciting of the holy texts, praising God, always to speak the truth, to address people mildly, to guide them, and to order them to do good. What the heart has to do is to have straight, honest intentions, to avoid hanghtiness, always to be patient, to keep your senses under control, and to have a cheer- ful mind. On Rasa- The author (Patanjali) adds to the three parts of the yann as a pathlending path of liberation a fourth one of an illusory nature, to Moksha. called Rasayana, consisting of alchemistic tricks with various drugs, intended to realise things which by nature are impossible. We shall speak of these things after- wards (vidle chap. xvii.). They have no other relation to the theory of Moksha but this, that also in the tricks of Rasayana everything depends upon the intention, the well-understood determination to carry them out, this determination resting on the firm belief in them, and resulting in the endeavour to realise them.

Page 127

CHAPTER VII. 8I

According to the Hindus, liberation is union with On the God; for they describe God as a being who can dis- Moksha nature of

pense with hoping for a recompense or with fearing itself.

opposition, unattainable to thought, because he is sub- lime beyond all unlikeness which is abhorrent and all likeness which is sympathetic, knowing himself not by a knowledge which comes to him like an accident, re- garding something which had not in every phase before been known to him. And this same description the Hindus apply to the liberated one, for he is equal to God in all these things except in the matter of beginning, since he has not existed from all eternity, and except this, that before liberation he existed in the world of entanglement, knowing the objects of knowledge only by a phantasmagoric kind of knowing which he had acquired by absolute exertion, whilst the object of his knowing is still covered, as it were, by a veil. On the Page 40. contrary, in the world of liberation all veils are lifted, all covers taken off, and obstacles removed. There the being is ahsolutely knowing, not desirous of learning anything unknown, separated from the soiled percep- tions of the senses, united with the everlasting ideas. Therefore in the end of the book of Patañjali, after the Quotations pupil has asked about the nature of liberation, the jali. from Patañ-

master says: "If you wish, say, Liberation is the cessation of the functions of the threc forces, and their returning to that home whence they had come. Or if you wish, say, It is the return of the soul as a knowing beiug into its own nature." The two men, pupil and master, disagree regarding him who has arrived at the stage of liberation. The anchorite asks in the book of Samkhya, " Why does From not death take place when action ceases?" The sage Samkhya.

replies, "Because the cause of the separation is a certain condition of the soul whilst the spirit is still in the body. Soul and body are separated by a natural condition which severs their union. Frequently when VOL. I. F

Page 128

82 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

the cause of an effect has already ceased or disappeared, the effect itself still goes on for a certain time, slacken- ing, and by and by decreasing, till in the end it ceases totally ; e.g. the silk-weaver drives round his wheel with his mallet until it whirls round rapidly, then he leaves it; however, it does not stand still, though the mallet that drove it round has been removed; the motion of the wheel decreases by little and little, and finally it ceases. It is the same case with the body. After the action of the body has ceased, its effect is still lasting until it arrives, through the various stages of motion and of rest, at the cessation of physical force and of the effect which had originated from preceding canses. Thus liberation is finished when the body has been completely prostrated." From Pa In the book of Patanjali there is a passage which tanjali.i expresses similar ideas. Speaking of a man who re- strains his senses and organs of perception, as the turtle draws in its limbs when it is afraid, he says that "he is not fettered, because the fetter has been loosened, and he is not liberated, because his body is still with him." There is, however, another passage in the same book which does not agree with the theory of liberation as expounded above. He says: "The bodies are the snares of the souls for the purpose of acquiring recompense. He who arrives at the stage of liberation has acquired, in his actual form of existence, the recompense for all the doings of the past. Then he ceases to labour to acquire a title to a recompense in the future. He frees himself from the snare; he can dispense with the parti- cular form of his existence, and moves in it quite freely without being ensnared by it. He has even the faculty of moving wherever he likes, and if he like, he might rise above the face of death. For the thick, cohesive bodies cannot oppose an obstacle to his form of exist- ence (as, e.g. a mountain could not prevent him from

Page 129

CHAPTER VII.

passing through). How, then, could his body oppose an obstacle to his soul ?" Similar views are also met with among the Sufi. Sufi pa- Some Sufi author relates the following story : " A com- rallels,

pany of Sufi came down unto us, and sat down at some distance from us. Then one of them rose, prayed, and on having finished his prayer, turned towards me and spoke : ' O master, do you know here a place fit for ns to dic on?' Now I thought he meant sleeping, and so I pointed out to him a place. The man went there, threw himself on the back of his head, and remained motion- less. Now I rose, went to him and shook him, but lo! he was already cold." The Sufi explains the Koranic verse, " We have made room for him on earth" (Sura 18, 83), in this Page 41. way: "If he wishes, the earth rolls itself up for him; if he wishes, he can walk on the water and in the air, which offer him sufficient resistance so as to enable him to walk, whilst the mountains do not offer him any resistance when he wants to pass through them." We next speak of those who, notwithstanding their On these greatest exertions, do not reach the stage of liberation. wlo do not reach There are several classes of them. The book arkhyt according to Moksha

says: "He who enters upon the world with a virtuous character, who is liberal with what he possesses of the goods of the world, is recompensed in it in this way, that he obtains the fulfilment of his wishes and desires, that he moves about in the world in happiness, happy in body and soul and in all other conditions of life. For in reality good fortune is a recompense for former deeds, done either in the same shape or in some preceding shape. Whoso lives in this world piously but without knowledge will be raised and be rewarded, but not be liberated, because the means of attaining it are want- ing in his case. Whoso is content and acquiesces in possessing the faculty of practising the above-men-

Page 130

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

tioned eight commandments (sic, vide p. 74), whoso glories in them, is successful by means of them, and believes that they are liberation, will remain in the same stage." A parable The following is a parable characterising those who showing people vie with each other in the progress through the various in the various stages of knowledge :- A man is travelling together degrees of knowledge. with his pupils for some business or other towards the end of the night. Then there appears something stand- ing erect before them on the road, the nature of which it is impossible to recognise on account of the darkness of night. The man turns towards his pupils, and asks them, one after the other, what it is? The first says: "I do not know what it is." The second says: " I do not know, and I have no means of learning what it is." The third says: "It is useless to examine what it is, for the rising of the day will reveal it. If it is some- thing terrible, it will disappear at daybreak; if it is something else, the nature of the thing will anyhow be clear to us." Now, none of them had attained to know- ledge, the first, because he was ignorant; the second, because he was incapable, and had no means of know- ing; the third, because he was indolent and acquiesced in his ignorance. The fourth pupil, however, did not give an answer. He stood still, and then he went on in the direction of the object. On coming near, he found that it was pump- kins on which there lay a tangled mass of something. Now he knew that a living man, endowed with free will, does not stand still in his place until such a tangled mass is formed on his head, and he recognised at once that it was a lifeless object standing erect. Further, he could not be sure if it was not a hidden place for some dunghill. So he went quite close to it, struck against it with his foot till it fell to the ground. Thus all doubt having been removed, he returned to his master and gave him the exact account. In such a

Page 131

CHAPTER VII.

way the master obtained the knowledge through the intermediation of his pupils. With regard to similar views of the ancient Greeks Parallels we can quote Ammonius, who relates the following as a authors, from Greek

sentence of Pythagoras : " Let your desire and exertion Ammonius, Plato, and in this world be directed towards the union with the First Proclus

Cause, which is the cause of the cause of your existence, that you may endure for ever. You will be saved from destruction and from being wiped ont; yon will go to the world of the true sense, of the true joy, of the true glory, in everlasting joy and pleasures." Further, l'ythagoras says: " How can yon hope for the state of detachment as long as yon are clad in bodies? And how will you obtain liberation as long as yon are incarcerated in them ?" Ammonins relates: " Empedocles and his successors as far as Heracles (sic) think that the soiled souls always remain commingled with the world until they ask the universal soul for help. The universal soul intercedes for it with the Intelligence, the latter with the Creator. The Creatoraffordssomething of his light to Intelligence; Intelligence affords something of it to the universal soul, which is immanent in this world. Now the soul wishes to be enlightened by Intelligence, until at last the individual sonl recognises the universal soul, unites with it, and is attached to its world. But this is a pro- cess over which many ages must pass. Then the soul comes to a region where there is neither place nor time, nor anything of that which is in the world, like transient fatigue or joy." Socrates says: "The soul on leaving space wanders to the holiness (T0 kabapor) which lives for ever and exists eternally, beiug related to it. It becomes like holiness in duration. because it is by means of something like contact able to receive impressions from holiness. This, its susceptibility to impressions. is called Intelli- yence."

Page 132

86 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Further, Socrates says: "The soul is very similar to the divine substance which does not die nor dissolve, and is the only intelligibile which lasts for ever; the body is the contrary of it. When soul and body unite, nature orders body to serve, the soul to rule; but when they separate, the soul goes to another place than that to which the body goes. There it is happy with things that are suitable to it; it reposes from being circum- scribed in space, rests from folly, impatience, love, fear, and other human evils, on this condition, that it had always been pure and hated the body. If, however, it has sullied itself by connivance with the body, by serving and loving it so that the body was subservient to its lusts and desires, in this case it does not ex- perience anything more real than the species of bodily things (re owparoedes) and the contact with them." Proclus says: "The body in which the rational soul dwells has received the figure of a globe, like the ether and its individual beings. The body in which both the rational and the irrational souls dwell has received an erect figure like man. The body in which only the irrational soul dwells has received a figure erect and curved at the same time, like that of the irrational animals. The body in which there is neither the one nor the other, in which there is nothing but the nourish- ing power, has received an erect figure, but it is at the same time curved and turned upside down, so that the head is planted in the earth, as is the case with the plants. The latter direction being the contrary to that of man, man is a heavenly tree, the root of which is directed towards its home, i.c. heaven, whilst the root of vegetables is directed towards their home, i.e. the earth." Brabman The Hindus hold similar views about nature. Ar- compared to an Asvattha juna asks, "What is Brahman like in the world?" tree accord- ing to Pe- Whereupon Vasudeva answers, "Imagine him like an tanjali. Aśvattha tree." This is a huge precious tree, well

Page 133

CHAPTER VII.

known among them, standing upside down, the roots being above, the branches below. If it has ample nourishment, it becomes quite enormons ; the branches spread far, cling to the soil, and creep into it. Roots and branches above and below resemble each other to such a degree that it is difficult to say which is which. " Brahman is the upper roots of this tree, its trunk is the Veda, its branches are the different doctrines and schools, its leaves are the different modes of inter- pretation ; its nourishment comes from the three forces ; the tree becomes strong and compact throngh the senses. The intelligent being has no other keen desire but that rage 43. of felling this tree, i.e. abstaining from the world and its vanities. When he has succeeded in felling it. he wishes to settle in the place where it has grown, a place in which there is no returning in a further stage of metempsychosis. When he obtains this, he leaves behind himself all the pains of heat and cold, and coming from the light of sun and moon and common fires, he attains to the divine lights." The doctrine of Patanjali is akin to that of the nfi paral- Safi regarding being occupied in meditation on the iels.

Truth (i.e. God), for they say, "As long as yon point to something, you are not a monist; but when the Truth seizes upon the object of your pointing and annihilates it, then there is no longer an indicating person nor an object indicated." There are some passages in their system which show that they believe in the pantheistic union ; e.g. one of them, being asked what is the Truth (God), gave the following answer: " How shonld I not know the being which is I in essence and Not-I in space? If I return once more into existence, thereby I am separated from him; and if I am neglected (i.e. not born anew and sent into the world), thereby I become light and be- come accnstomed to the union" (sic). Abu-Bekr Ash-shibli says: "Cast off all, and you

Page 134

88 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

will attaiu to us completely. Then you will exist; but you will not report about us to others as long as your doing is like onrs." Abu-Yazîd Albistami once being asked how he had attained his stage in Sufism, answered: "I cast off my own self as a serpent casts off its skin. Then I con- sidered my own self, and fonnd that, / was He," i.e. God. The Shfi explain the Koranic passage (Sûra 2, 68), "Then we spoke: Beat him with a part of her," in the following manner: "The order to kill that which is dead in order to give life to it indicates that the heart does not become alive by the lights of knowledge unless the body be killed by ascetic practice to such a degree that it does not any more exist as a reality, but only in a formal way, whilst your heart is a reality on which no object of the formal world has any in- fluence." Further they say: "Between man and God there are a thousand stages of light and darkness. Men exert themselves to pass throngh darkness to light, and when they have attained to the stations of light, there is no return for them."

Page 135

CHAPTER VIIL.

ON THE DIFFERENT CLASSES OF CREATED BEINGS, AND ON THEIR NAMES.

THE subject of this chapter is very difficult to study and The varieus understand accurately, since we Muslims look at it from creatures classcs of

withont, and the Hindus themselves do not work it out snathyd. according to

to scientific perfection. As we, however, want it for the further progress of this treatise. we shall communi- cate all we have heard of it nntil the date of the present book. And first we give an extract from the book Siidhya. "The anchorite spoke: ' How many classes and species are there of living bodies?' "The sage replied : 'There are three classes of them the spiritual ones in the height, men in the middle, and animals in the depth. Their species are fourteen in nnmber, eight of which belong to the spiritnal beings : Brahman, Indra, Prajapati, Sanmya, Gandharva, Yak- sha, Rakshasa, and Pisaca. Five species are those of the animals-cattle, wild beasts, birds, ereeping things, and growing things, i.c. the trees. And, lastly, onr species is represented by man.'" The anthor of the same book has in another part of it given the following ennmeration with different names: " Brahman, Indra, Prajapati, Gandharva, Yaksha, Râk- shasa, Pitaras, Piśâca." The Hindus are people who rarely preserve one and the same order of things, and in their enumeration of things there is mnch that is arbitrary. They use or

Page 136

90 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

invent numbers of names, and who is to hinder or to control them ? In the book Gita, Vasudeva says: "When the first of the three primary forces prevails, it particularly applies itself to developing the intellect, purifying the senses, and producing action for the angels. Blissful rest is one of the consequences of this force, and liberation one of its results. " When the second force prevails, it particularly ap- plies itself to developing cupidity. It will lead to fatigue, and indnce to actions for the Yaksha and Rak- shasa. In this case the recompense will be according to the action. "If the third force prevails, it particularly applies itself to developing ignorance, and making people easily beguiled by their own wishes. Finally, it produces wakefnlness, carelessness, laziness, procrastination in fulfilling duties, and sleeping too long. If man acts, he acts for the classes of the Bhuta and Pisaca, the devils, for the Preta who carry the spirits in the air, not in paradise and not in hell. Lastly, this force will lead to punishment; man will be lowered from the stage of humanity, and will be changed into animals and plants." In another place the same anthor says: " Belief and virtue are in the Deva among the spiritual beings. Therefore that man who resembles them believes in God, clings to him, and longs for him. Unbelief and vice are in the demons called Asura and Rakshasa. That man whe resembles them does not believe in God nor attend to his commandments. He tries to make the world godless, and is occupied with things which are harmful in this world and in the world beyond, and are of no use." The author If we now combine these statements with each other, cight classes it will be evident that there is some confusion both in ennmerates of spiritual beings. the names and in their order. According to the most

Page 137

CHAPTER VIII. 91

popular view of the majority of the Hindus, there are the following eight classes of spiritual beings :- I. The Deva, or angels, to whom the north belongs. They specially belong to the Hindus. People say that Zoroaster made enemies of the Shamaniyya or Bud- dhists by calling the devils by the name of the class of angels which they consider the highest, i.e. Deva. And this usage has been transmitted from Magian times down to the Persian language of our days. 2. Daitya 'danara, the demons who live in the south. To them everybody belongs who opposes the religion of the Hindus and persecutes the cows. Not- withstanding the near relationship which exists between them and the Deva, there is, as Hindus maintain, no end of quarrelling and fighting among them. 3. Gandharra, the musicians and singers who make music before the Deva. Their harlots are called Ap- saras. 4. Yaksha, the treasurers or guardians of the Deva. 5. Rtkshasa, demons of ugly and deformed shapes. 6. Kinnara, having human shapes but horses' heads, being the contrary of the centaurs of the Greek, of whom the lower half has the shape of a horse, the upper half that of a man. The latter fignre is that of the odiacal sign of Arcitenens. 7. Naga, beings in the shape of serpents. 8. Vidyadhara, demon-sorcerers, who exercise a certain witchcraft, but not such a one as to produce permanent results. If we consider this series of beings, we find the Criticisms angelic power at the upper end and the demoniac at the on this list.

lower, and between them there is much interblending. The qualities of these beings are different, inasmuch as they have attained this stage of life in the course of metempsychosis by action, and actions are different on account of the three primary forces. They live very long, since they have entirely stripped off the bodies,

Page 138

92 ALBERUNPS INDIA.

since they are free from all exertion, and are able to do things which are impossible to man. They serve man Page 45- in whatever he desires, and are near him in cases of need. However, we can learn from the extract from Samkhya that this view is not correct. For Brahman, Indra, and Prajapati are not names of species, but of individuals. Brahman and Prajapati very nearly mean the same, but they bear different names on account of some qnality or other. Indra is the ruler of the worlds. Be- sides, Vasndeva enumerates the Yaksha and Rakshasa together in one and the same class of demons, whilst the Puranas represent the Yaksha as guardian-angels and the servants of guardian-angels. On the After all this, we declare that the spiritual beings Devas. which we have mentioned are one category, who have attained their present stage of existence by action dur- ing the time when they were human beings. They have left their bodies behind them, for bodies are weights which impair the power and shorten the duration of life. Their qualities and conditions are different, in the same measure as one or other of the three primary forces prevails over them. The first force is peculiar to the Deva, or angels who live in quietness and bliss. The predominant faculty of their mind is the comprehending of an idea without matter, as it is the predominant faculty of the mind of man to comprehend the idea in matter. The third force is peculiar to the Pisaca and Bhuta, whilst the second is peculiar to the classes between them. The Hindus say that the number of Deva is thirty- three koti or crore, of which eleven belong to Maha- deva. Therefore this number is one of his surnames, and his name itself (Mahadeva) points in this direction. The sum of the number of angels just mentioned would be 330,000,000. Further, they represent the Deva as eating and drink- ing, cohabiting, living and dying, since they exist

Page 139

CHAPTER VIII. 93

within matter, thongh in the most snbtle and most simple kind of it, and since they have attained this by action, not by knowledge. The book l'atañjali relates that Nandikesvara offered many sacrifices to Mahadeva, and was in conseqnence transferred into paradise in his hnman shape; that Indra, the ruler, had intercourse with the wife of Nalmsha the Brahmin, and therefore was changed into a serpent by way of punishment. After the Deva comes the class of the Pitars, the On the Pita- deceased ancestors, and after them the Bhata, human Rtishis. ras and

beings who have attached themselves to the spiritual bcings (Deva), and stand in the middle between them and mankind. He who holds this degree, but withont being free from the body, is called either Rishi or Siddha or Muni, and these differ among themselves according to their qualities. Siddha is he who has attained by his action the faculty to do in the world whatever he likes, bnt who does not aspire further, and does not exert himself on the path leading to liberation. Ile may ascend to the degree of a Rishi. If a Brahmin attains this degree, he is called Brahmarshi ; if the Kshatriya attains it, he is called Rajarshi. It is not possible for the lower classes to attain this degree. Rishis are the sages who, thongh they are only hnman beings, excel the angels on acconnt of their knowledge. Therefore the angels learn from them, and above them there is none but Brahman. After the Brahmarshi and Rajarshi come those classes of the popnlace which exist also among ns, the castes, to whom we shall devote a separate chapter. All these latter beings are ranged under matter. Vishņu the Now, as regards the notion of that which is above Brabman, unty of

matter, we say that the oxy is the middle between and Rudra. Narâyaņa,

matter and the spiritnal divine ideas that are above matter, and that the three primary forces exist in the uxy dynamically (er ovvúpe). So the iln, with all that is comprehended in it, is a bridge from above to below.

Page 140

94 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Any life which circulates in the BXy under the excln- sive influence of the First Cause is called Brahman, P.ge 46. P'rajapati, and by many other names which occur in their religions law and tradition. It is identical with nature in so far as it is active, for all bringing into existence, the creation of the world also, is attributed by them to Brahman. Any life which circulates in the ody under the influ- ence of the second force is called Nurayuna in the tradition of the Hindus, which means nature in so far as it has reached the end of its action, and is now striv- ing to preserve that which has been produced. Thus Narayana strives so to arrange the world that it shonld endure. Any life which circulates in the ily under the influ- ence of the third force is called Mahadeva and Bamkara, but his best-known name is Rudra. His work is destruction and annihilation, like nature in the last stages of activity, when its power slackens. These three beings bear different names, as they cir- culate throngh the varions degrees to above and below, and accordingly their actions are different. But prior to all these beings there is one source whence everything is derived, and in this unity they comprehend all three things, no more separating one from the other. This unity they call Vishnu, a name which more properly designates the middle force ; but sometimes they do not even make a distinction between this middle force and the first cause (i.e. they make Narayana the causa causarum). Here there is an analogy between Hindus and Chris- tians, as the latter distingnish between the Three Per- sons and give them separate names, Father, Son, and Holy Ghost, but unite them into one substance. This is what clearly results from a careful exami- nation of the Hindn doctrines. Of their traditional acconnts, which are full of silly notions, we shall speak

Page 141

CHAPTER VIII. 95

hereafter in the course of our explanation. You must not wonder if the Hindus, in their stories about the class of the Deva, whom we have explained as angels, allow them all sorts of things, unreasonable in them- selves, some perhaps not objectionable, others decidedly objectionable, both of which the theologians of Islam would declare to be incompatible with the dignity and nature of angels. If you compare these traditions with those of the Greek paral- Greeks regarding their own religion, you will cease to about Zeus. lels. Stories

find the Hindu system strange. We have already men- tioned that they called the angels gods (p. 36). Now consider their stories about Zeus, and yon will under- stand the truth of our remark. As for anthropomor- phisms and traits of animal life which they attribute to him, we give the following tradition: "When he was born, his father wanted to devour him ; but his mother took a stone, wrapped rags round it, and gave him the stone to swallow, whereupon he went away." This is also mentioned by Galenus in his Book of Specches, where he relates that P'hilo had in an enigmatical way described the preparation of the φιλώνειον φάρμακον ίn a poem of his by the following words :- "Tuke red hair, difusing sueet odour, the offering to the gods, And of man's blood weigh weights of the number of the mented fuculties."

The poet means five pounds of saffron, because the senses are fire. The weights of the other ingredients of the mixture he describes in similar enigmatic terms, of which Galenus gives a commentary. In the same poem occurs the following verse :- "And of the pseudonymous root which has groun in the distriet in which Zeus was born."

To which Galenus adds: "This is Andropogon Nardus, which bears a false name, because it is called an car of corn, although it is not an ear, but a root. The poet

Page 142

96 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

prescribes that it should be Cretan, because the mytho- logists relate that Zeus was born on the mountain Page 47. AtkTaior in Creta, where his mother concealed him from his father Kronos, that he should not devour him as he had devoured others." Besides, well-known story-books tell that he married certain women one after the other, cohabited with others, doing violence to them and not marrying them ; among them Europa, the danghter of Phonix, who was taken from him by Asterios, king of Crete. After- wards she gave birth to two children from him, Minos and Rhadamanthus. This happened long before the Israelites left the desert and entered Palestine. Another tradition is that he died in Crete, and was buried there at the time of Samson the Israelite, being 780 years of age; that he was called Zeus when he had become old, after he had formerly been called Dios; and that the first who gave him this name was Cecrops, the first king of Athens. It was common to all of them to indulge in their lusts withont any restraint, and to favour the business of the pander; and so far they were not unlike Zoroaster and King Gushtasp when they desired to consolidate the realm and the rule (sic). Chroniclers maintain that Cecrops and his snccessors are the source of all the vices among the Athenians, meaning thereby such things as occur in the story of Alexander, viz. that Nectanebus, king of Egypt, after having fled before Artaxerxes the Black and hiding in the capital of Macedonia, occupied himself with astro- logy and soothsaying; that he beguiled Olympias, the wife of King Philip, who was absent. He cunningly contrived to cohabit with her, showing himself to her in the figure of the god Ammon, as a serpent with two heads like rams' heads. So she became pregnant with Alexander. Philip, on returning, was about to disclaim the paternity, but then he dreamt that it was the child of the god Ammon. Thereupon he recognised the child

Page 143

CHAPTER VIII. 97

as his, and spoke, "Man cannot oppose the gods." The combination of the stars had shown to Nectanebus that he would die at the hands of his son. When then he died at the hands of Alexander from a wound in the neck, he recognised that he was his (Alexander's) father. The tradition of the Greeks is full of similar things. We shall relate similar subjects when speaking of the marriages of the Hindus. Now we return to our subject. Regarding that part Quotations of the nature of Zens which has no connection with Aratos. from

humanity, the Greeks say that he is Jupiter, the son of Saturn; for Saturn alone is eternal, not having been born, according to the philosophers of the Academy, as Galenus says in the Book of Deduction. This is sufli- ciently proved by the book of Aratos on the ducvopera, for he begins with the praise of Zeus:

"We, mankind, do not leave him, nor can we do without him : Of him the roads are full, And the meeting-places of men. He is mild towards them ; He prodnces for them what they wish, and incites them to work. Reminding them of the necessities of life, He indicates to them the times favonrable For digging and ploughing for a good growth, Who has raised the signs and stars in heaven. Therefore we humiliate ourselves before him first and last."

And then be praises the spiritual beings (the Muses). If you compare Greek theology with that of the Hindus, you will find that Brahman is described in the same way as Zeus by Aratos. The author of the commentary on the Pacvopeva of Aratos maintains that he deviated from the custom of the poets of his time in beginning with the gods; that it was his intention to speak of the celestial sphere. Further, he makes reflections on the origin of Asclepins, Page 48. like Galenus, and says: "We should like to know VOL. I. G

Page 144

ALBERUNPS INDIA.

which Zeus Aratos meant, the mystical or the physical one. For the poet Krates called the celestial sphere Zeus, and likewise Homer says:

'As pieces of snow are cut off from Zcus.'"

Aratos calls the ether and the air Zeus in the passage : "The roads and the meeting-places are full of him, and we all must inhale him." Therefore the philosophers of the Stoa maintain that Zeus is the spirit which is dispersed in the dly, and similar to our souls, i.e. the nature which rules every natural body. The author supposes that he is mild, since he is the canse of the good; therefore he is right in maintaining that he has not only created men, but also the gods.

Page 145

( 99 )

CHAPTER IX.

ON THE CASTES, CALLED "COLOURS" (VARNA), AND ON THE CLASSES BELOW THEM.

IF a new order of things in political or social life is Throne and created by a man naturally ambitious of ruling, who altar. by his character and capacity really deserves to be a ruler, a man of firm convictions and unshaken deter- mination, who even in times of reverses is supported by good luck, in so far as people then side with him in recognition of former merits of his, such an order is likely to become consolidated among those for whom it was created, and to continue as firm as the deeply rooted mountains. It will remain among them as a generally recognised rule in all generations through the course of time and the flight of ages. If, then, this new form of state or society rests in some degree on religion, these twins, state and religion, are in perfect harmony, and their union represents the highest development of human society, all that men can possibly desire. The kings of antiquity, who were industriously de- voted to the duties of their office, spent most of their care on the division of their subjects into different classes and orders, which they tried to preserve from intermixture and disorder. Therefore they forbade people of different classes to have intercourse with each other, and laid upon each class a particular kind of work or art and handicraft. They did not allow any- body to transgress the limits of his class, and even

Page 146

100 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

punished those who would not be content with their class. Castes of All this is well illustrated by the history of the the ancient Persians. ancient Chosroes (Khusrau), for they had created great institutions of this kind, which could not be broken through by the special merits of any individual nor by bribery. When Ardashir ben Babak restored the Per- sian empire, he also restored the classes or castes of the population in the following way :- The first class were the knights and princes. The second class the monks, the fire-priests, and the lawyers. The third class the physicians, astronomers, and other men of science. The fourth class the husbandmen and artisans. And within these classes there were subdivisions, dis- tinct from each other, like the species within a genus. All institutions of this kind are like a pedigree, as long as their origin is remembered; but when once their origin has been forgotten, they become, as it were, the stable property of the whole nation, nobody any more questioning its origin. And forgetting is the necessary result of any long period of time, of a long succession of centuries and generations. Among the Hindus institutions of this kind abound. We Muslims, of course, stand entirely on the other side of the question, considering all men as equal, except in piety ; and this is the greatest obstacle which prevents any approach or understanding between Hindus and Muslims. The four The Hindus call their castes varna, i.e. colours, and castes from a genealogical point of view they call them jataka, Page 49. i.e. births. These castes are from the very beginning only four. I. The highest caste are the Brahmana, of whom the books of the Hindus tell that they were created from the head of Brahman. And as Brahman is only another

Page 147

CHAPTER IX. I0I

name for the force called nature, and the head is the highest part of the animal body, the Brahmana are the choice part of the whole genus. Therefore the Hindus consider them as the very best of markind. II. The next caste are the Kehatriys, sho were created, as they say, from the shculders and hands 'of Brahman. Their degree is not much below that of the Brâhmana. III. After them follow the Vaissa, who were created from the thigh of Brahman. IV. The Sudra, who were created from his feet. Between the latter two classes there is no very great distance. Much, however, as these classes differ from each other, they live together in the same towns and villages, mixed together in the same houses and lodgings. After the Sudra follow the people called Antyaja, who Low-caste render various kinds of services, who are not reckoned people.

amongst any caste, but only as members of a certain craft or profession. There are eight classes of them, who freely intermarry with each other, except the fuller. shoemaker, and weaver, for no others would condescend to have anything to do with them. These eight guilds are the fuller, shoemaker, juggler, the basket and shield maker, the sailor, fisherman, the hunter of wild animals and of birds, and the weaver. The four castes do not live together with them in one and the same place. These guilds live near the villages and towns of the four castes, but outside them. The people called Hadi, Doma (Domba), Candala, and Badhatau (sic) are not reckoned amongst any caste or guild. They are occupied with dirty work, like the cleansing of the villages and other services. They are considered as one sole class, and distinguished only by their occupations. In fact, they are considered like illegitimate children; for according to general opinion they descend from a Sudra father and a Brâhmanî

Page 148

102 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

mother as the children of fornication; therefore they are degraded ontcasts. Di fferent The Hindns give to every single man of the four of thecastes castes characterisile names, according to their occn- occupationg and guilds. pations and modes of life. E.y. the Brahmana is in generai calied by this name as long as he does his work staying at home. When he is busy with the service of one fire, he is called ish!in ; if he serves three fires, he is called agnihotrin ; if he besides offers an offering to the fire, he is called dikshita. And as it is with the Brahmana, so is it also with the other castes. Of the classes bencath the castes, the HAdi are the best spoken of, because they keep themselves free from everything unclean. Next follow the Doma, who play on the Inte and sing. The still lower classes practise as a trade killing and the inflicting of judicial punishments. The worst of all are the Badhatan, who not only devour the flesh of dead animals, but even of dogs and other beasts. Customs of Each of the four castes, when eating together, mnst the Brah- mins. form a group for themselves, one gronp not being allowed to comiprise two men of different castes. If, further, in the group of the Brahmana there are two men who live at enmity with each other, and the seat of the one is by the side of the other, they make a barrier between the two seats by placing a board between them, or by spreading a piece of dress, or in some other way; and if there is only a line drawn between them, they are considered as separated. Since it is forbidden to eat the remains of a meal, every single man must have his own food for himself; for if any one of the party who are eating should take of the food from one and the same plate, that which remains in the plate becomes, after the first eater has taken part, to him who Page 50. wants to take as the second, the remains of the meal, and such is forbidden. Such is the condition of the four castes. Arjuna

Page 149

CHAPTER IX. 103

asked about the nature of the four castes and what must be their moral qualities, whereupon Vasudeva answered : "The Brahmana must hare an ample intellect, a quiet heart, truthful speech, much patience; he must be master of his senses, a lover of justice, of evident purity, always directed upon worship, entirely bent upon religion. " The Kshatriya must fill the hearts with terror, must be brave and high-minded, must have ready speech and a liberal band, not minding dangers, only intent upon carrying the great tasks of his calling to a happy end. "The Vaisya is to occupy himself with agriculture, with the acquisition of cattle, and with trade. "The Sudra is to endeavour to render services and attention to each of the preceding classes, in order to make himself liked by them. " If each member of these castes adheres to his cus- toms and usages. he will obtain the happiness he wishes for, supposing that he is not negligent in the worship of God, not forgetting to remember him in his most im- portant avocations. But if anybody wants to quit the works and duties of bis caste and adopt those of another caste. even if it would bring a certain hononr to the latter, it is a sin, because it is a transgression of the rule." Further, Vasudeva speaks, inspiring him with courage to fight the enemy : " Dost thou not know, O man with the long armn, that thou art a Kshatriya; that thy race has been created brave, to rnsh boldly to the charge, to care little for the vicissitudes of time, never to give way whenever their soul has a foreboding of coming misfortune? for only thereby is the reward to be ob- tained. If he conquers, he obtains power and good fortune. If he perishes, he obtains paradise and bliss. Besides, thou showest weakness in the presence of the enemy, and seemest melancholy at the prospect of

Page 150

104 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

killing this host; but it will be infinitely worse if thy name will spread as that of a timid, cowardly man, that thy reputation among the heroes and the experienced warriors will be gone, that thou wilt be out of their sight, and thy name no longer be remembered among them. I do not know a worse pnnishment than such a state. Death is better than to expose thyself to the consequences of ignominy. If, therefore, God has ordered thee to fight, if he has deigned to confer upon thy caste the task of fighting and has created thee for it, carry ont his order and perform his will with a determination which is free from any desire, so that thy action be exclusively devoted to him." Moksha and Hindns differ among themselves as to which of these the various castes, castes is capable of attaining to liberation ; for, according to some, only the Brâhmana and Kshatriya are capable of it, since the others cannot learn the Veda, whilst according to the Hindn philosophers, liberation is common to all castes and to the whole human race, if their intention of obtaining it is perfect. This view is based on the saying of Vysa: "Learn to know the twenty-five things thoroughly. Then yon may follow whatever religion you like; yon will no doubt be liberated." This view is also based on the fact that Vasndeva was a descendant of a Sudra family, and also on the following saying of his, which he addressed to Arjuna: "God distributes recompense without injustice and without partiality. IIe reckons the good as bad if people in doing good forget him; he reckons the bad as good if people in doing bad remem- ber him and do not forget him, whether those people be Vaisya or Śûdra or women. How mnch more will this Page 51. be the case when they are Brâhmana or Kshatriya."

Page 151

( 105

CIIAPTER X.

ON THE SOURCE OF THEIR RELIGIOUS AND CIVIL LAW, ON PROPHETS, AND ON THE QUESTION WHETHER SINGLE LAWS CAN BE ABROGATED OR NOT.

THE ancient Greeks received their religious and civil Law and laws from sages among them who were called to the among the religion

work, and of whom their countrymen believed that founded by Greeks

they received divine help, like Solon. Draco, P'ythagoras, their sages.

Minos, and others. Also their kings did the same; for Mianos (sic), when ruling over the islands of the sea and over the Cretans about two hundred years after Moses, gave them laws, pretending to have received them from Zeus. About the same time aiso Minos (sie) gave his laws. At the time of Darius I., the successor of Cyrus, the Romans sent messengers to the Athenians, and received from them the laws in twelve books, under which they lived till the rule of Pompilius (Numa). This king gave them new laws; he assigned to the year twelve months, whilst up to that time it had only had ten months. It appears that he introduced his innovations against the will of the Romans, for he ordered them to use as instruments of barter in commerce pieces of pottery and hides instead of silver, which seems on his part to betray a certain anger against rebellious subjects. In the first chapter of the Book of Laws of Plato, the Qnotation Athenian stranger says: "Who do yon think was the Laws. from Plato's

Page 152

106 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

first who gave laws to you ? Was he an angel or a man?" The man of Cnossus said: " He was an angel. In truth, with us it was Zeus, but with the Lacedæmonians, as they maintain, the legislator was Apollo." Further, he says in the same chapter: "It is the dnty of the legislator, if he comes from God, to make the acquisition of the greatest virtues and of the highest jnstice the object of his legislation." He describes the laws of the Cretans as rendering perfect the happiness of those who make the proper nse of them, because by them they acquire all the human good which is dependent upon the divine good. The Athenian says in the second chapter of the same book: "The gods, pitying mankind as born for trouble, instituted for them feasts to the gods, the Mnses, Apollo the rnler of the Muses, and to Dionysos, who gave men wine as a remedy against the bitterness of old age, that old men should again be young by forgetting sadness, and by bringing back the character of the soul from the state of affliction to the state of soundness." Further he says : "They have given to men by in- spiration the arrangements for dancing, and the equally weighed rhythm as a reward for fatigues, and that they may become accustomed to live together with them in feasts and joy. . Therefore they call one kind of their music pruises, with an implied allnsion to the prayers to the gods." Such was the case with the Greeks, and it is precisely the same with the Hindus. For they believe that their The Rishis, religious law and its single precepts derive their origin the authors of Hindu from Rishis, their sages, the pillars of their religion, law. Page 52. and not from the prophet, i.e. Narayana, who, when coming into this world, appears in some human figure. But be only comes in order to cut away some evil matter which threatens the world, or to set the world right again when anything has gone wrong. Further, no

Page 153

CHAPTER X. 107

law can be exchanged or replaced by another, for they nse the laws simply as they find them. Therefore they can dispense with prophets, as far as law and worship are concerned, though in other affairs of the creation they sometimes want them. As for the question of the abrogation of laws, it Whether seems that this is not impossible with the Hlindns, for abrogated or laws may be

they say that many things which are now forbidden not.

were allowed before the coming of Vasudeva, e.g. the flesh of cows. Snch changes are necessitated by the change of the nature of man, and by their being too feeble to bear the whole burden of their duties. To these changes also belong the changes of the matri- monial system and of the theory of desrent. For in former times there were three modes of determining descent or relationship : 1. The child born to a man by his legitimate wife is Different the child of the father, as is the custom with us and systems. Inatrimonial

with the Hindus. 2. If a man marries a woman and has a child by her ; if, further, the marriage-contract stipnlates that the children of the woman will belong to her father, the child is considered as the child of its grandfather who made that stipulation, and not as the child of its father who engendered it. 3. If a stranger has a child by a married woman, the child belongs to her husband, since the wife being, as it were, the soil in which the child has grown, is the pro- perty of the husband, always presupposing that the sowing, i.c. the cohabitation, takes place with his con- sent. According to this principle, P'andu was considered as The stors of the son of Santann ; for this king had been cursed by Pandu and Vyasa. an anchorite, and in consequence was unable to cohabit with his wives, which was the more provoking to him as he had not yet any children. Now he asked Vyasa, the son of l'arasara, to procreate for him children from

Page 154

I08 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

his wives in his place. Pandu sent him one, but she was afraid of him when he cohabited with her, and trembled, in consequence of which she conceived a sickly child of yellow hue. Then the king sent him a second woman ; she, too, felt much reverence for him, and wrapped herself up in her veil, and in consequence she gave birth to Dhritarashtra, who was blind and unhealthy. Lastly, he sent him a third woman, whom he enjoined to put aside all fear and reverence with regard to the saint. Laughing and in high spirits, she went in to him, and conceived from him a child of moon-like beauty, who excelled all men in boldness and cunning. Birth of The four sons of Pandn had one wife in common, Vșâsa. who stayed one month with each of them alternately. In the books of the Hindus it is told that Parasara, the hermit, one day travelled in a boat in which there was also a danghter of the boatman. He fell in love with her, tried to seduce her, and finally she yielded; but there was nothing on the bank of the river to hide them from the looks of the people. However, instan- taneously there grew a tamarisk-tree to facilitate their purpose. Now he cohabited with her behind the tama- risk, and made her conceive, whereupon she became pregnant with this his excellent son Vyâsa. All these customs have now been abolished and ab- rogated, and therefore we may infer from their tradi- tion that in principle the abrogation of a law is allowable. Various As regards unnatural kinds of marriage, we must kinds of marriage state that such exist still in our time, as they also with Tihe- tans and existed in the times of Arab heathendom; for the Arabs. people inhabiting the mountains stretching from the region of Panchir into the neighbourhood of Kashmîr live under the rule that several brothers have one wife in common. Among the heathen Arabs, too, marriage was of different kinds :- Page 53. I. An Arab ordered his wife to be sent to a certain

Page 155

CHAPTER X. I09

man to demand sexnal intercourse with him; then he abstained from her during the whole time of her preg- nancy, since he wished to have from her a generons offspring. This is identical with the third kind of . marriage among the Hindus. 2. A second kind was this, that the one Arab said to the other, "Cede me your wife, and I will cede you mine," and thus they exchanged their wives. 3. A third kind is this, that several men cohabited with one wife. When, then, she gave birth to a child, she declared who was the father; and if she did not know it, the fortune-tellers had to know it. 4. The Nilah-elmalt (= matrimonium exosum), i.c. when a man married the widow of his father or of his son, the child of such a marriage was called daizan. This is nearly the same as a certain Jewish marriage, for the Jews have the law that a man must marry the widow of his brother, if the latter has not left children, and create a line of descent for his deceased brother; and the offspring is considered as that of the deceased man, not as that of the real father. Thereby they want to prevent his memory dying out in the world. In Hebrew they call a man who is married in this way Yúbhâm. There was a similar institntion among the Magians. Marringe In the book of Tausar, the great herbadh, addressed to ancicnt among the

Padashvar-girshah, as an answer to his attacks on Iranians,

Ardashir the son of Babak, we find a description of the institution of a man's being married as the substitnte for another man, which existed among the Persians. If a man dies withont leaving male offspring, people are to examine the case. If he leaves a wife, they marry her to his nearest relative. If he does not leave a wife, they marry his danghter or the nearest related woman to the nearest related male of the family. If there is no woman of his family left, they woo by means of the money of the deceased a woman for his

Page 156

110 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

family, and marry her to some male relative. The child of such a marriage is considered as the offspring of the deceased. Whoever neglects this duty and does not fulfil it, kills innumerable souls, since he cuts off the progeny and the name of the deceased to all eternity. We have here given an account of these things in order that the reader may learn by the comparative treatment of the subject how much superior the insti- tutions of Islam are, and how much more plainly this contrast brings out all customs and usages, differing from those of Islam, in their essential foulness.

Page 157

CHAPTER XI.

ABOUT THE BEGINNING OF IDOL-WORSHIIP, AND A DESCRIPTION OF THE INDIVIDUAL IDOLS.

Ir is well known that the popular mind leans towards Origin of the sensible world, and has an aversion to the world of in the idol-worship

abstract thought which is only understood by highly of man. nature

edncated people, of whom in every time and every place there are only few. And as common people will only acquiesce in pictorial representations, many of the leaders of religious communities have so far deviated from the right path as to give such imagery in their books and houses of worship, like the Jews and Chris- tians, and, more than all, the Manichæans. These words of mine would at once receive a suflicient illus- tration if, for example, a picture of the Prophet were made, or of Mekka and the Ka'ba, and were shown to an uneducated man or woman. Their joy in looking at the thing would bring them to kiss the picture, to rub their cheeks against it, and to roll themselves in the dust before it, as if they were seeing not the picture, but the original, and were in this way, as if they were present in the holy places, performing the rites of pil- grimage, the great and the small ones. This is the cause which leads to the manufacture of idols, monuments in honour of certain much venerated persons, prophets, sages, angels, destined to keep alive their memory when they are absent or dead, to create for them a lasting place of grateful veneration in the hearts of men when they die. But when much time

Page 158

I12 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

passes by after the setting up of the monument, genera- tions and centuries, its origin is forgotten, it becomes a matter of custom, and its veneration a rule for general practice. This being deeply rooted in the nature of man, the. legislators of antiquity tried to influence them from this weak point of theirs. Therefore they made the veneration of pictures and similar monuments ob- ligatory on them, as is recounted in historic records, both for the times before and after the Deluge. Some people even pretend to know that all mankind, before Page 54. God sent them his prophets, were one large idolatrous body. The followers of the Thora fix the beginning of ido- latry in the days of Serûgh, the great-grandfather of Abraham. The Romans have, regarding this question, Story of the following tradition :- Romulus and Romanus (!), Romulus and Remus. the two brothers from the country of the Franks, on having ascended the throne, built the city of Rome. Then Romulus killed his brother, and the consequence was a long succession of intestine troubles and wars. Finally, Romulus humiliated himself, and then he dreamt that there would only be peace on condition that he placed his brother on the throne. Now he got a golden image made of him, placed it at his side, and henceforward he used to say, " We (not I) have ordered thus and thus," which since has become the general use of kings. Thereupon the troubles subsided. He founded a feast and a play to amuse and to gain over those who bore him ill-will on account of the murder of his brother. Besides, he erected a monument to the sun, consisting of four images on four horses, the green one for the earth, the blue for the water, the red for the fire, and the white for the air. This monument is still in Rome in our days. Idol-wor- Since, however, here we have to explain the system and ship as re- stricted to the theories of the Hindus on the subject, we shall now the low classes of mention their ludicrous views; but we declare at once people,

Page 159

CHAPTER XI. 113

that they are held only by the common uneducated people. For those who march on the path to liberation, or those who study philosophy and theology, and who desire abstract truth which they call sara, are entirely free from worshipping anything but God alone, and would never dream of worshipping an image manufac- tured to represent him. A tradition illustrative of this is that which Saunaka told the king Pariksha in these words :- There was once a king called Ambarisha, who had Story of obtained an empire as large as he had wished for. But barisha and King Am-

afterwards he came to like it no longer; he retired from Indra.

the world, and exclusively occupied himself with wor- shipping and praising God for a long time. Finally, God appeared to him in the shape of Indra, the prince of the angels, riding on an elephant. Ile spoke to the king: "Demand whatever you like, and I will give it you.' The king answered : " I rejoice in seeing thee, and I am thankful for the good fortune and help thou hast given; but I do not demand anything from thee, but only from him who created thee." Indra said: "The object of worship is to receive a noble reward. Realise, therefore, your object, and accept the reward from him from whom hitherto you have obtained your wishes, and do not pick and choose, saying, 'Not from thee, but from another.'" The king answered : "The earth has fallen to my lot, but I do not care for all that is in it. The object of my worship is to see the Lord, and that thou canst not give me. Why, therefore, should I demand the fulfil- ment of my desire from thee?" Indra said: "The whole world and whoever is upon it are obedient to me. Who are you that you dare to oppose me?" The king answered: "1, too, hear and obey, but I worship him from whom thou hast received this power, VOL. I. H

Page 160

114 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

who is the lord of the universe, who has protected thee against the attacks of the two kings, Bali and Hiran- yaksha. Therefore let me do as I like, and turn away from me with my farewell greeting." Indra said: " If you will absolutely oppose me, I will kill you and annihilate you." The king answered: "People say that happiness is envied, but not so misfortune. He who retires from the world is envied by the angels, and therefore they will try to lead him astray. I am one of those who have retired from the world and entirely devoted them- selves to worship, and I shall not give it up as long as Pago 55. I live. I do not know myself to be guilty of a crime for which I should deserve to be killed by thee. If thou killest me without any offence on my part, it is thy concern. What dost thou want from me ? If my thoughts are entirely devoted to God, and nothing else is blended with them, thou art not able to do me any harm. Sufficient for me is the worship with which I am occupied, and now I return to it." As the king now went on worshipping, the Lord appeared to him in the shape of a man of the grey lotus colour, riding on a bird called Garuda, holding in one of the four hands the sankha, a sea-shell which people blow when riding on elephants; in the second hand the cakra, a round, cutting, orbicular weapon, which cuts everything it hits right through; in the third an amulet, and in the fourth padma, i.e. the red lotus. When the king saw him, he shuddered from reverence, prostrated himself and uttered many praises. The Lord quieted his terrified mind and promised him that he should obtain everything he wished for. The king spoke: "I had obtained an empire which nobody disputed with me; I was in conditions of life not troubled by sorrow or sickness. It was as if the whole world belonged to me. But then I turned away from it, after I had understood that the good of the

Page 161

CHAPTER XI. 1I5

world is really bad in the end. I do not wish for any- thing except what I now have. The only thing I now wish for is to be liberated from this fetter." The Lord spoke: "That you will obtain by keeping aloof from the world, by being alone, by uninterrupted meditation, and by restraining your senses to yourself." The king spoke: "Supposing that I am able to do so through that sanctity which the Lord has deigned to bestow upon me, how should any other man be able to do so? for man wants eating and clothing, which connects him with the world. How is he to think of anything else?" The Lord spoke: "Occupy yourself with your empire in as straightforward and prudent a way as possible: turn your thoughts upon me when you are engaged in civilising the world and protecting its inhabitants, in giving alms, and in everything you do. And if you are overpowered by human forgetfulness, make to yourself an image like that in which you see me; offer to it perfumes and flowers, and make it a memorial of me, so that you may not forget me. If you are in sorrow, think of me; if you speak, speak in my name; if you act, act for me." The king spoke: "Now I know what I have to do in general, but honour me further by instructing me in the details." The Lord spoke: "That I have done already. I have inspired your judge Vasishtha with all that is required. Therefore rely upon him in all questions." Then the figure disappeared from his sight. The king returned into his residence and did as he had been ordered. From that time, the Hindus say, people make idols, some with four hands like the appearance we have described, others with two hands, as the story and description require, and conformably to the being which is to be represented.

Page 162

116 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Nárada and Another story of theirs is the following :- Brahman the voice from the had a son called Narada, who had no other desire but fire. that of seeing the Lord. It was his custom, when he walked about, to hold a stick. If he threw it down, it became a serpent, and he was able to do miracles with it. He never went without it. One day being engrossed in meditation on the object of his hopes, he saw a fire from afar. He went towards it, and then a voice spoke to him out of the fire: "What you demand and wish is impossible. You cannot see me save thus." When he looked in that direction, he saw a fiery appearance in something like human shape. Page 56. Hlenceforward it has been the custom to erect idols of certain shapes. The idol of A famous idol of theirs was that of Multân, dedicated MultAn call- ed Aditya. to the sun, and therefore called Aditya. It was of wood and covered with red Cordovan leather; in its two eyes were two red rubies. It is said to have been made in the last Kritayuga. Suppose that it was made in the very end of Kritayuga, the time which has since elapsed amounts to 216,432 years. When Muhammad Ibn Alkasim Ibn Almunabbih conquered Multân, he in- quired how the town had become so very flourishing and so many treasures had there been accumulated, and then he found out that this idol was the cause, for there came pilgrims from all sides to visit it. There- fore he thought it best to have the idol where it was, but he hung a piece of cow's-flesh on its neck by way of mockery. On the same place a mosque was built. When then the Karmatians occupied Multan, Jalam Ibn Shaibân, the usurper, broke the idol into pieces and killed its priests. He made his mansion, which was a castle built of brick on an elevated place, the mosque instead of the old mosque, which he ordered to be shut from hatred against anything that had been done under the dynasty of the Caliphs of the house of 'Umayya. When afterwards the blessed Prince Mah-

Page 163

CHAPTER XI. II7

mud swept away their rule from those countries, he made again the old mosque the place of the Friday- worship, and the second one was left to decay. At present it is only a barn-floor, where bunches of IIinna (Lawsonia incrmis) are bound together. If we now subtract from the above-mentioned num- ber of years the hundreds, tens, and units, i.e. the 432 years, as a kind of arbitrary equivalent for the sum of about 100 years, by which the rise of the Karmatians preceded our time, we get as the remainder 216,000 years for the time of the end of the Kritayuga, and about the epoch of the era of the Hijra. How, then, could wood have lasted such a length of time, and particularly in a place where the air and the soil are rather wet? God knows best ! The city of Taneshar is highly venerated by the The idol of Hindus. The idol of that place is called Cakrasramin. Taneshar called i.e. the owner of the cakra, a weapon which we have samin. Cakrą-

already described (page 114). It is of bronze, and is nearly the size of a man. It is now lying in the hippo- drome in Ghazna, together with the Lord of Somanath. which is a representation of the penis of Mahâdeva, called Linga. Of Somanath we shall hereafter speak in the proper place. This Cakrasvamin is said to have been made in the time of Bharata as a memorial of wars connected with this name. In Inner Kashmir, about two or three days' journey The idol from the capital in the direction towards the mouutains Sarada in of Bolor, there is a wooden idol called Sarada, which is Kashmir.

much venerated and frequented by pilgrims. We shall now communicate a whole chapter from the Quotation book Samhita relating to the construction of idols, Samhita of from the

which will help the student thoroughly to comprehend hira. Varâhami-

the present subject. Varahamihira says: "If the figure is made to repre- sent Râma the son of Dasaratha, or Bali the son of Virocana, give it the height of 120 digits," i.e. of idol

Page 164

118 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

digits, which must be reduced by one-tenth to become common digits, in this case 108. "To the idol of Vishnn give eight hands, or four, or two, and on the left side under the breast give him the figure of the woman Sri. If you give him eight hands, place in the right hands a sword, a club of gold or iron, an arrow, and make the fourth hand as if it were draw- Page 57. ing water; in the left hands give him a shield, a bow, a cahra, and a conch. "If you give him four hands, omit the bow and the arrow, the sword and shield. "If you give him two hands, let the right hand be drawing water, the left holding a conch. " If the figure is to represent Baladeva, the brother of Narayana, put earrings into his ears, and give him eyes of a drunken man. "If you make both figures, Narayana and Baladera, join with them their sister Bhagavati (Durga= Ekâ- nansa), her left hand resting on her hip a little away from the side, and her right hand holding a lotus. " If yon make her four-handed, place in therighthands a rosary and a hand drawing water; in the left hands, a book and a lotus. " If you make her eight-handed, place in the left hands the kamandalu, i.e. a pot, a lotus, bow and book ; in the right hands, a rosary, a mirror, an arrow, and a water- drawing hand. " If the figure is to represent Samba, the son of Vishnn, put only a club in his right hand. If it is to represent Pradynmna, the son of Vishnu, place in his right hand an arrow, in his left hand a bow. And if you make their two wives, place in their right hand a sword, in the left a buckler. " The idol of Brahman has four faces towards the four sides, and is seated on a lotus. "The idol of Skanda, the son of Mahadeva, is a boy riding on a peacock, his hand holding a sakti, a weapon

Page 165

CHAPTER XI. 119

like a double-edged sword, which has in the middle a pestle like that of a mortar. "The idol Indra holds in its hand a weapon called vajra of diamond. It has a similar handle to the sakti, but on each side it has two swords which join at the handle. On his front place a third eye, and make him ride on a white elephant with four tusks. " Likewise make on the front of the idol of Mahadeva a third eye right above, on his head a crescent, in his hand a weapon called śnla, similar to the club but with three branches, and a sword; and let his left hand hold his wife Gauri, the daughter of Himavant, whom he presses to his bosom from the side. "To the idol Jina, i.c. Buddha, give a face and limbs as beantiful as possible, make the lines in the palms of his hands and feet like a lotus, and represent him seated on a lotus; give him grey hair, and represent him with a placid expression, as if he were the father of creation. " If you make Arhaut, the figure of another body of Buddha, represent him as a naked youth with a fine face, beautiful, whose hands reach down to the knees, with the figure of Sri, his wife, under the left breast. "The idol of Revanta, the son of the sun, rides on a horse like a huntsman. "The idol of Yima, the angel of death, rides on a buffalo, and holds a club in his hand. "The idol of Kubera, the treasurer, wears a crown, has a big stomach and wide hips, and is riding on a man. "The idol of the sun has a red face like the pith of the red lotus, beams like a diamond, has protruding limbs, rings in the ears, the neck adorned with pearls which haug down over the breast, wears a crown of several compartments, holds in his hands two lotuses, and is clad in the dress of the Northerners which reaches down to the ankle. " If you represent the Seven Mothers, represent several rage 58. of them together in one figure, Brahmani with four faces

Page 166

120 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

towards the four directions, Kanmari with six faces, Vaishavî with four hands, Varahì with a hog's head on a human body, Indranî with many eyes and a club in her hand, Bhagavati (Durgâ) sitting as people generally sit, Camunda ugly, with protruding teeth and a slim waist. Further join with them the sons of Mahadeva, Kshetrapala with bristling hair, a sour face, and an ugly figure, but Vinayaka with an elephant's head on a human body, with fonr hands, as we have heretofore described." The worshippers of these idols kill sheep and buffaloes with axes (kutara), that they may nourish themselves with their blood. All idols are constructed according to certain measures determined by idol-fingers for every single limb, but sometimes they differ regarding the measnre of a limb. If the artist keeps the right measure and does not make anything too large nor too small, he is free from sin, and is sure that the being which he represented will not visit him with any mishap. "If he makes the idol one cubit high and together with the throne two cubits, he will obtain health and wealth. If he makes it higher still, he will be praised. "But he must know that making the idol too large, especially that of the Sun, will hurt the ruler, and making it too small will hnrt the artist. If he gives it a thin belly, this helps and fnrthers the famine in the country ; if he gives it a lean belly, this ruins property. " If the hand of the artist slips so as to produce some- thing like a wound, he will have a wound in his own body which will kill him. " If it is not completely even on both sides, so that the one shoulder is higher than the other, his wife will perish. "If he turns the eye upward, he will be blind for lifetime; if he tnrns it downward, he will have many troubles and sorrows."

Page 167

CHAPTER XI. 12J

If the statne is made of some precious stone, it is better than if it were made of wood, and wood is better than clay. "The benefits of a statue of precious stone will be common to all the men and women of the empire. A golden statue will bring power to him who erected it, a statue of silver will bring him renown, one of bronze will bring him an increase of his rule, one of stone the acquisition of landed property." The Hindus honour their idols on account of those who erected them, not on account of the material of which they are made. We have already mentioned that the idol of Multan was of wood. E.g. the linga which Rama erected when he had finished the war with the demons was of sand, which he had heaped up with his own hand. But then it became petrified all at once, since the astrologically correct moment for the erecting of the monument fell before the moment when the workmen had finished the cutting of the stone monu- ment which Rama originally had ordered. Regarding the building of the temple and its peristyle, the cutting of the trees of four different kinds, the astrological determination of the favourable moment for the erec- tion, the celebration of the rites due on such an occa- sion, regarding all this Rama gave very long and tedious instructions. Further, he ordered that servants and priests to minister to the idols should be nominated from different classes of the people. "To the idol of Vishnu are devoted the class called Bhagavata; to the idol of the Sun, the Maga, i.c. the Magians; to the idol of Mahadeva, a class of saints, anchorites with long hair, who cover their skin with ashes, hang on their persons the bones of dead people, and swim in the pools. The Brahmana are devoted to the Eight Page 59. Mothers, the Shamanians to Buddha, to Arhant the class called Nagna. On the whole, to each idol certain people are devoted who constructed it, for those know best how to serve it."

Page 168

I22 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Quotations Onr object in mentioning all this mad raving was to from Gita showing teach the reader the accurate description of an idol, if that God is not to be confounded he happens to see one, and to illustrate what we have with the said before, that snch idols are erected only for unedu- idols. cated low-class people of little understanding; that the Hindus never made an idol of any supernatural being, much less of God; and, lastly, to show how the crowd is kept in thraldom by all kinds of priestly tricks and deceits. Therefore the book Gita says: "Many people try to approach me in their aspirations through some- thing which is different from me; they try to insinuate themselves into my favour hy giving alms, praise, and prayer to something besides me. J, however, confirm and help them in all these doings of theirs, and make them attain the object of their wishes, because I am able to dispense with them." In the same book Vasudeva speaks to Arjuna : " Do you not see that most of those who wish for something address themselves in offering and worshipping to the several classes of spiritual beings, and to the sun, moon, and other celestial bodies? If now God does not dis- appoint their hopes, though he in no way stands in need of their worship, if he even gives them more than they asked for, and if he gives them their wishes in such a way as though they were receiving them from that to which they had addressed their prayers-viz. the idol-they will proceed to worship those whom they address, because they have not learned to know him, whilst he, by admitting this kind of intermedia- tion, carries their affairs to the desired end. But that which is obtained by desires and intermediation is not lasting, since it is only as much as is deserved for any particular merit. Only that is lasting which is obtained from God alone, when people are disgusted with old age, death, and birth (and desire to be delivered there- from by Moleska)." This is what Vasudeva says. When the ignorant crowd

Page 169

CHAPTER XI. I23

get a piece of good luck by accident or something at which they had aimed, and when with this some of the preconcerted tricks of the priests are brought into con- nection, the darkness in which they live increases vastly, not their intelligence. They will rush to those figures of idols, maltreating their own figures before them by shedding their own blood and mutilating their own bodies. The ancient Greeks, also, considered the idols as mediators between themselves and the First Causc, and worshipped them under the names of the stars and the highest substances. For they described the First Cause, not with positive, but only with negative predicates, since they considered it too high to be described by human qualities, and since they wanted to describe it as free from any imperfection. Therefore they could not address it in worship. When the heathen Arabs had imported into their country idols from Syria, they also worshipped them, hoping that they would intercede for them with God. Plato says in the fourth chapter of the Bool: of Laus: " It is necessary to any one who gives perfect honours (to the gods) that he should take trouble with the mystery of the gods and Sakinat, and that he should not make special idols masters orer the ancestral gods. Further, it is the greatest duty to give honours as much as possible to the parents while they live." By mystery Plato means a special kind of dcvotion. The word is much used among the Sabians of HIarran, the dualistic Manichrans, and the theologians of the Hindus. Galenus says in the book De Indole Anime : " At the time of the Emperor Commodus, between 500-510 years after Alexander, two men went to an idol-mer- rage 60. chant and bargained with him for an idol of Hermes. The one wanted to erect it in a temple as a memorial of Hermes, the other wanted to erect it on a tomb as a

Page 170

I24 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

memorial of the deceased. However, they could not settle the business with the merchant, and so they postponed it until the following day. Theidol-merchant dreamt the following night that the idol addressed him and spoke to him : 'O excellent man! I am thy work. I have received through the work of thy hands a figure which is thought to be the figure of a star. Now I am no longer a stone, as people called me heretofore ; I am now known as Mercury. At present it stands in thy hands to make me either a memorial of something im- perishable or of something that has perished already.'" There is a treatise of Aristotle in which he answers certain questions of the Brahmins which Alexander had sent him. There he says : " If you maintain that some Greeks have fabled that the idols speak, that the people offer to them and think them to be spiritual beings, of all this we have no knowledge, and we cannot give a sentence on a subject we do not know." In these words he rises high above the class of fools and uneducated people, and he indicates by them that he does not occupy himself with such things. It is evident that the first cause of idolatry was the desire of commemo- rating the dead and of consoling the living; but on this basis it has developed, and has finally become a foul and pernicious abuse. The former view, that idols are only memorials, was also held by the Caliph Mu'awiya regarding the idols of Sicily. When, in the summer of A.H. 53, Sicily was conquered, and the conquerors sent him golden idols adorned with crowns and diamonds which had been captured there, he ordered them to be sent to Sind, that they should be sold there to the princes of the country ; for he thought it best to sell them as objects costing sums of so-and-so many denars, not having the slightest scruple on account of their being objects of abomin- able idolatry, but simply considering the matter from a political, not from a religious point of view.

Page 171

( 125 )

CHAPTER XII.

ON THE VEDA, THE PURANAS, AND OTHER KINDS OF THEIR NATIONAL LITERATURE.

VEDA means knowledge of that which was before un- Sundry known. It is a religious system which, according to ing to the notes relat-

the Hindus, comes from God, and was promulgated Veda.

by the mouth of Brahman. The Brahmins recite the Weda without understanding its meaning, and in the same way they learn it by heart, the one receiv- ing it from the other. Only few of them learn its explanation, and still less is the number of those who master the contents of the Veda and their interpretation to such a degree as to be able to hold a theological disputation. The Brahmins teach the Veda to the Kshatriyas. The latter learn it, but are not allowed to teach it, not even to a Brahmin. The Vaisya and Sudra are not allowed to hear it, much less to pronounce and recite it. If such a thing can be proved against one of them, the Brahmins drag him before the magistrate, and he is punished by having his tongue cut off. The Veda contains commandments and prohibitions, detailed statements about reward and punishment in- tended to encourage and to deter; but most of it con- tains hymns of praise, and treats of the various kinds of sacrifices to the fire, which are so numerous and difficult that you could hardly count them. They do not allow the Veda to be committed to The Veda writing, because it is recited according to certain modu- by memory. transmitted

Page 172

126 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

lations, and they therefore avoid the use of the pen, since it is liable to cause some error, and may occasion an addition or a defect in the written text. In eonse- quence it has happened that they have several times Page 61. forgotten the Veda and lost it. For they maintain that the following passage occurs in the conversations be- tween God and Brahman relating to the beginning of all things, according to the report of Sauuaka who had received it from the planet Venus: "You will forget the Veda at the time when the earth will be submerged; it will then go down to the depths of the earth, and none but the fish will be able to bring it out again. Therefore I shall send the fish, and it will deliver the Veda into your hands. And I shall send the boar to raise the earth with its tusks and to bring it ont of the water." Further, the Hindus maintain that the Veda, together with all the rites of their religion and country, had been obliterated in the last Dvapara-yuga, a period of time of which we shall speak in the proper place, until it was renewed by Vyasa, the son of Parasara. The Vishnu Purana says: "At the beginning of each Manvantara period there will be created anew a lord of a period whose children will rule over the whole earth, and a prince who will be the head of the world, and angels to whom men will bring fire-offerings, and the Great Bear, who will renew the Veda which is lost at the end of each period." Vasukra This is the reason why, not long before our time, connnits the Veda to Vasukra, a native of Kashmir, a famous Brahmin, has writing. of his own account undertaken the task of explaining the Veda and committing it to writing. He has taken on himself a task from which everybody else would have recoiled, but he carried it out because he was afraid that the Veda might be forgotten and entirely vanish out of the memories of men, since he observed that the characters of men grew worse and worse, and

Page 173

CHAPTER XII. 127

that they did not care much for virtue, nor even for duty. There are certain passages in the Veda which, as they maintain, must not be recited within dwellings, since they fear that they would cause an abortion both to women and the cattle. Therefore they step ont into the open field to recite them there. There is hardly a single verse free from such and similar minatory injunctions. As we have already mentioned, the books of the Hindus are metrical compositions like the Rajaz poems of the Arabs. Most of them are composed in a metre called sloka. The reason of this has already been explained. Galenus also prefers metrical composi- tion, and says in his book Karù yen: "The single signs which denote the weights of medicines become corrupt by being copied; they are also corrupted by the wanton mischief of some envious person. Therefore it is quite right that the books of Damocrates on medi- cines should be preferred to others, and that they should gain fame and praise, since they are written in a Greek metre. If all books were written in this way it wonld be the best ; " the fact being that a prose text is much more exposed to corruption than a metrical one. The Veda, however, is not composed in this common metre, śloka, but in another. Some Hindus say that no one could compose anything in the same metre. However, their scholars maintain that this is possible indeed, but that they refrain from trying it merely from veneration for the Veda. According to their tradition, Vyasa divided it into The four four parts : Rigveda, Yujurveda, Samaveda, and Athar- Vyasa and pupils of

vaņaveda. the four Vedas. Vyâsa had four sishya, i.e. pupils. He tanght a sepa- rate Veda to each of them, and made him carry it in his memory. They are enumerated in the same order as the four parts of the Veda: Paila, Vaisampayana, Jaimini, Sumantu.

Page 174

128 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

On the Rig- Each of the four parts has a peculiar kind of recita- veda. tion. The first is Rigveda, consisting of metrical com- positions called ric, which are of different lengths. It is called Rigveda as being the totality of the ric. Page 6z. It treats of the sacrifices to the fire, and is recited in three different ways. First, in a uniform manner of reading, just as every other book is read. Secondly, in such a way that a pause is made after every single word. Thirdly, in a method which is the most meri- torious, and for which plenty of reward in heaven is promised. First you read a short passage, each word of which is distinctly pronounced; then you repeat it together with a part of that which has not yet been recited. Next you recite the added portion alone, and then you repeat it together with the next part of that which has not yet been recited, &c., &c. Continuing to do so till theend, you will have read the whole text twice. On the The Yajurveda is composed of kandin. The word Y'ajurveda. is a derivative noun, and means the totality of the kandin. The difference between this and the Rigveda is that it may be read as a text connected by the rules of Samdhi, which is not allowed in the case of Rigveda. The one as well as the other treats of works connected with the fire and the sacrifices. I have heard the following story about the reason why the Rigveda cannot be recited as a text connected by the rules of Samdhi :- The story of Yâjnavalkya stayed with his master, and his master Yâjna- valkya. had a Brahmin friend who wanted to make a journey. Therefore he asked the master to send somebody to his house to perform there during his absence the rites to IIoma, i.e. to his fire, and to prevent it from being extinguished. Now the master sent his pupils to the house of his friend one after the other. So it came to be the turn of Yajnavalkya, who was beautiful to look at and handsomely dressed. When he began the work which he was sent for, in a place where the wife of the

Page 175

CHAPTER XII. 129

absent .nan was present, she conceived an aversion to bis fine attire, and Yâjnavalkya became aware of it, thongh she concealed it. On having finished, he took the water to sprinkle it over the head of the woman, for this holds with them the place of the blowing after an incantation, since blowing is disliked by them and considered as something impure. Then the woman said, "Sprinkle it over this column." So he did, and at once the column became green. Now the woman repented having missed the blessing of his pious action ; there- fore on the following day she went to the master, asking him to send her the same pupil whom he had sent the day before. Yâjnavalkya, however, declined to go except in his turn. No urging had any effect upon him; he did not mind the wrath of his master, but simply said, " Take away from me all that you have tanght me." And scarcely had he spoken the word, when on a sudden he had forgotten all he knew before. Now he turned to the Sun and asked him to teach him the Veda. The Sun said, " How is that possible, as I must perpetually wander, and you are incapable of doing the same?" But then Yajnavalkya clung to the chariot of the Sun and began to learn the Veda from him; but he was compelled to interrupt the recitation here and there on account of the irregularity of the motion of the chariot. The Samaveda treats of the sacrifices, command- Samaveda ments, and prohibitions. It is recited in a tone like vanaveda. and Athar.

a chant, and hence its name is derived, because snman means the swcetness of recitation. The cause of this kind of recital is, that Nrayana, when he appeared on earth in the shape of Vamana, and came to the king Bali, changed himself into a Brahman and began to recite the Samaveda with a tonching melody, by which he exhilarated the king, in consequence of which there happened to him the well-known story. The Atharvanaveda is as a text connected by the VOL. I. I

Page 176

130 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

rules of Samdhi. It does not consist of the sa.ne com- positions as the Rig and Yajur Vedas, but of a third kind called bhara. It is recited according to a melody with a nasal tone. This Veda is less in favour with the Hindus than the others. It likewise treats of the sacrifices to the fire, and contains injunctions regarding the dead and what is to be done with them.

List of the As to the Puranas, we first mention that the word Puranas. means first, eternal. There are eighteen Puranas, most of them called by the names of animals, human or Page 63. angelic beings, because they contain stories about them, or because the contents of the book refer in some way to them, or because the book consists of answers which the creature whose name forms the title of the book has given to certain questions. The Puranas are of human origin, composed by the so-called Rishis. In the following I give a list of their names, as I have heard them, and committed them to writing from dictation :-

I. Âdi-puruna, i.e. the first. 2. Mutsya-purana, i.c. the fish. 3. Kurma-purana, i.e. the tortoise. 4. Varaha-purana, i.e. the boar. 5. Narasimha-purana, i.e. a human being with a lion's head. 6. Vamana-purana, i.e. the dwarf. 7. Vayu-purana, i.e. the wind. S. Nanda-purana, i.e. a servant of Mahadeva. 9. Skanda-purana, i.e. a son of Mahadeva. 10. Aditya-purana, i.e. the sun. I1. Soma-purana, i.c. the moon. 12. Samba-purana, i.e. the son of Vishnu. 13. Brahmanda-prana, i.e. beaven. 14. Markandeya-purana, i.e. a great Rishi. 15. Turkshya-purana, i.c. the bird Garuda. 16. Vishnu-purana, i.c. Naravana. 17. Brahma-puruna, i.e. the nature charged with the preserva- tion of the world. 18. Bhavishya-purana, i.e. future things.

Of all this literature I have only seen portions of the Matsya, Âditya, aud Vâyu Purânas.

Page 177

CHAPTER XII. 131

Another somewhat different list of the Puranas has been read to me from the Vishnu-Purana. I give it here in extenso, as in all questions resting on tradition it is the duty of an anthor to give those traditions as completely as possible :-

I. Brahma. 2. Padma, i.c. the red lotus. 3. Vishnu. 4. S'ira, i.c. Mahadeva. 5. Bhagavata, i.c. Vasudeva. 6. Narada, i.c. the son of Brabma. 7. Markandeya. 8. Agni, i.c. the fire. 9. Bhavishya, i.c. the future. IO. Brahmaraivurta, i.c. the wind. II. Linga, i.c. an image of the atoota of Mabadeva. I2. Varaha. 13. Skanda. I4. Vâmana. 15. Karma. 16. Matsya, i.e. the fish. 17. Garuda, i.c. the bird on which Vishnu rides. 18. Brahmanda.

These are the names of the Puranas according to the Vishnu-Purana. The book Smriti is derived from the Veda. It con- A list tains commandments and prohibitions, and is composed vooks. by the following twenty sons of Brahman :-

I. Âpastamba. II. Yajnavalkya. 2. Parâsara. 12. Atri. 2. Satatapa. 13. Harita. 4. Samvarta. I4. Likbita. 5. Daksba. I5. Sankba. 6. Vasishtha. 16. Gautama. 7. Angiras. 17. Vribaspati. 8. Yama. 18. Katyâyana. 9. Vishņu. 19. Vyâsa. IO. Manu. 20. Usanas.

Besides, the Hindus have books about the jurispru- dence of their religion, on theosophy, on ascetics, on the process of becoming god and seeking liberation

Page 178

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

from the world, as, e.g. the book composed by Gamdla the anchorite, which goes by his name; the book Sam- lya, composed by Kapila, on divine snbjects ; the book of Patanjuli, on the search for liberation and for the union of the sonl with the object of its meditation; the book Nyayabhusha, composed by Kapila, on the Veda and its interpretation, also showing that it has been created, and distinguishing within the Veda be- tween such injunctions as are obligatory only in cer- tain cases, and those which are obligatory in general; further, the book Mimamst, composed by Jaimini, on the same subject; the book Laukayata, composed by Brihaspati, treating of the subject that in all investiga- tions we must exclusively rely upon the apperception of the senses; the book Agastyamata, composed by Agastya, treating of the subject that iu all investigations we must use the apperception of the senses as well as tradi- tion ; and the book Vishnu-dharma. The word dharma means reward, but in geueral it is used for religion ; so that this title means The religion of God, who in this case is understood to be Narayana. Further, there are the books of the six pupils of Vyasa, viz. Derala, Sukra, Bhargava, Vrihaspati, Yijnaralkya, and Manu. The Hindus have numerous books about all the branches of science. How could anybody know the titles of all of them, more especially if he is not a Hindu, but a foreigner ? Maha- Besides, they have a book which they hold in such tharato. veneration that they firmly assert that everything which occurs in other books is found also in this book, but not all which occurs in this book is found in other books. It is called Bhurata, and composed by Vyâsa the son of Parasara at the time of the great war between the children of Pandu and those of Kuru. The title itself gives an indication of those times. The book has 100,000 Ślokas in eighteen parts, each of which is called Parvan. Here we give the list of them :-

Page 179

CHAPTER XII. I33

I. Sabha-parva, i.e. the king's dwelling. 2. Aranya, i.e. going out into the open field, meaning the cxodus of the children of Pandu. 3. Virata, i.e. the name of a king in whose realm they dwelt during the time of their concealment. 4. Uilyoga, i.e. the preparing for battle. 5. Bhishma. 6. Drone the Brahmin. 7. Karna the son of the Sun. 8. Salya the brother of Duryodhana, some of the greatest heroes who did the fighting, one always coming forward after his predecessor had been killed. 9. Gada, i.e. the club. I0. Sauptita, i.e. the killing of the sleepers, when Asvatthaman the son of Drona attacked the city of Pancala during the night and killed the inhabitants. II. Jalapradanika, i.c. the successive drawing of water for the dead, after people have washed off the impurity cansed by the touching of the dead. 12. Stri, i.c. the lamentations of the women. 13. S'anti, containing 24,000 Slokas on eradicating hatred from the heart, in four parts : (I.) Rajadharma, on the reward of the kings. (2.) Danadharma, on the reward for almsgiving. (3-) ipaddharma, on the reward of those who are in nced and trouble. (4.) Mokshadharma, on the reward of him who is liberated from the world. 14. Asramedha, i.c. the sacrifice of the horse which is sent out togcther with an army to wander through the world. Then they proclaim in public that it belongs to the king of the world, and that he who does not agrecthereto is to come forward to fight. The Brahmans follow the horse, and celebrate sacrifices to the fire in those places where the horse drops its dung. 15. Mausala, i.e. the fighting of the Yadavas, the tribe of Vasu- deva, among themselves. 16. isramavtsa, i.c. leaving one's own country. 17. Prasthana, i.e. quitting the realm to seck liberation. 18. Svargarohana, i.c. journeying towards Paradise.

These eighteen parts are followed by another one which is called Harivamsa-Parvan, which contains the traditions relating to Vasudeva. In this book there occur passages which, like riddles, admit of manifold interpretations. As to the reason of Page 65.

Page 180

134 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

this the Hindus relate the following story :- Vyasa asked Brahman to procure him somebody who might write for him the Bharata from his dictation. Now he intrnsted with this task his son Vinâyaka, who is re- presented as an idol with an elephant's head, and made it obligatory on him never to cease from writing. At the same time Vyasa made it obligatory on him to write only that which he understood. Therefore Vyasa. in the conrse of his dictation, dictated such sentences as compelled the writer to ponder over them. and thereby V'yasa gained time for resting awhile.

Page 181

135

CHAPTER XIII.

THEIR GRAMMATICAL AND METRICAL LITERATURE.

THE two sciences of grammar and metrics are auxiliary List of to the other sciences. Of the two, the former, grammar, grammar. books on

holds the first place in their estimate, called ryakarand, i.e. the law of the correctness of their speech and ety- mological rules, by means of which they acquire an eloquent and classical style both in writing and reading. We Muslims cannot learn anything of it, since it is a branch coming from a root which is not within our grasp-I mean the language itself. That which I have been told as to titles of books on this science is the following :-

I. Aindre, attributed to Iudra, the head of the angels. 2. Candra, composed by Candra, one of the red-robe-wearing sect, the followers of Buddha. 3. Sakata, so called by the name of its author. lfis tribe, too, is called by a name derived from the same word, viz. S'akatayana. 4. Panini, so called from its anthor. 5. Katantra, composed by Sarvavarman. 6. S'asideverritti, composed by Sasideva. 7. Durgarirpitti. 8. Sishyahitarritti, composed by Ugrabhnti.

I have been told that the last-mentioned author was Shah Anan- the teacher and instructor of Shah Anandapala, the son his master dapala and

of Jayapala, who ruled in our time. After having com- Ugrabhūti.

posed the book he sent it to Kashmir, but the people there did not adopt it, being in such things haughtily con- servative. Now he complained of this to the Shah, and

Page 182

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

the Shah, in accordance with the duty of a pupil towards his master, promised him to make him attain his wish. So he gave orders to send 200,000 dirham and presents of a similar value to Kashmîr, to be distributed among those who studied the book of his master. The con- sequence was that they all rushed upon the book, and would not copy any other grammar but this one, show- ing themselves in the baseness of their avarice. The book became the fashion and highly prized. Tale relat- Of the origin of grammar they give the following ing to the origin of account :- One of their kings, called Samalvahana, i.e. grammar. in the classical language, Sâtavahana, was one day in a pond playing with his wives, when he said to one of them " Maudalam dehi," i.e. do not sprinkle the water on me. The woman, however, understood it as if he had said modakan dehi, i.e. bring swectmeats. So she went away and brought him sweetmeats. And when the king disapproved of her doing so, she gave him an angry reply, and used coarse langnage towards him. Now he was deeply offended, and, in consequence, as is their custom, he abstained from all food, and concealed him- self in some corner until he was called upon by a sage, who consoled him, promising him that he would teach people grammar and the inflexions of the language. Thereupon the sage went off to Mahadeva, praying, praising, and fasting devoutly. Mahadeva appeared to him, and communicated to him some few rules, the like of which A bul'aswad Addu'ali has given for the Arabic language. The god also promised to assist him in the further development of this science. Then the sage returned to the king and taught it to him. This was the beginning of the science of grammar. The pre- Grammar is followed by another science, called dilection of the Hindus chandas, i.e. the metrical form of poetry, corresponding for metrical comp.osi. to our metrics-a science indispensable to them, since tions. all their books are in verse. By composing their books Page 66. in metres they intend to facilitate their being learned

Page 183

CHAPTER XIII. 137

by heart, and to prevent people in all questions of science ever recurring to a written text, save in a case of bare necessity. For they think that the mind of man sympathises with everything in which there is symmetry and order, and has an aversion to everything in which there is no order. Therefore most Hindus are passionately fond of their verses, and always desirous of reciting them, even if they do not understand the meaning of the words, and the audience will snap their fingers in token of joy and applause. They do not want prose compositions, although it is much easier to under- stand them. Most of their books are composed in Śloka, in which I am now exercising myself, being occupied in compos- ing for the Hindus a translation of the books of Euclid and of the Almagest, and dictating to them a treatise on the construction of the astrolabe, being simply guided herein by the desire of spreading science. If the Hin- dus happen to get some book which does not yet exist among them, they set at work to change it into Slokas, which are rather unintelligible, since the metrical form entails a constrained, affected style, which will become apparent when we shall speak of their method of ex- pressing numbers. And if the verses are not sufficiently affected, their authors meet with frowning faces, as having committed something like mere prose, and then they will feel extremely unhappy. God will do me jus- tice in what I say of them. The first who invented this art were Pingala and Books on EA- (?C L T). The books on the subject are nu- metrics.

merous. The most famous of them is the book Gaisita (? G-AI-S-T), so called from its author, famous to such a degree that even the whole science of metrics has been called by this name. Other books are that of Mrigalanchana, that of Pingala, and that of &W, (? t (Au)-L-Y-A-N-D). I, however, have not seen auy of these books, nor do I know much of the chapter

Page 184

138 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

of the Brahma-siddhanta which treats of metrical cal- culations, and therefore I have no claim to a thorongh knowledge of the laws of their metrics. Nevertheless, I do not think it right to pass by a snbject of which I have only a smattering, and I shall not postpone speak- ing of it until I shall have thoroughly mastered it. On the In counting the syllables (ganachandas) they nse meaning of the teclini- similar figures to those used by Alkhalil Ibn Ahmad and cal terms laghu and our metricians to denote the consonant without vowel and the consonant with vowel, viz. these two signs, | and >, the former of which is called laghu, i.c. light; the latter, guru, i.c. heavy. In measuring (matrachandas), the guru is reckoned donble of a laghu, and its place may be filled by two laghu. Further, they have a syllable which they call long (dirgha), the measure or prosody of which is eqnal to that of a guru. This, I think, is a syllable with a long vowel (like ha, kt, lnt). Here, however, I must confess that up to the present moment I have not been able to gain a clear idea of the nature of both laghu and guru, so as to be able to illustrate them by similar elements in Arabic. However, I am in- clined to think that laghu does not mean a consonant without vowrl, nor guru a consonant with vowel, but that, on the contrary, laghu means a consonant with a short vowel (e.g. ka, ki, ku), and guru means the same with a vowelless consonant (e.g. kat, kit, kut), like an element in Arabic metrics called Sabab (i.e .- or w, a long syllable the place of which may be taken by two short ones). That which makes me donbt as to the first- mentioned definition of laghu is this circumstance, that the Hindus nse many laghu one after the other in an uninterrupted succession. The Arabs are not capable of pronouncing two vowelless consonants one after the other, but in other langnages this is possible. The Per- sian metricians, for instance, call such a consonant moved by a light vowel (i.e. pronounced with a sound like

Page 185

CHAPTER XIII. 139

the Hebrew Schwa). Bnt, in any case, if such conso- nants are more than three in number, they are most difficult, nay, even impossible to pronounce; whilst, on the other hand, there is not the slightest difficulty in pronouncing an uinterrupted series of short syllables consisting of a consonant with a short vowel, as when you say in Arabic, " Badanuka kamathali sifatika wafa- muka bisd ati shafatika ' (i.c. Thy body is like thy description, and thy month depends upon the width of thy lip). Further, although it is difficult to pronounce Page 67. a vowelless consonant at the beginning of a word, most nouns of the Hindus begin, if not exactly with vowel- less consonants, still with such consonants as have only a Schwa-like vowel-sound to follow them. If such a consonant stands at the beginning of a verse, they drop it in counting, since the law of the guru demands that in it the vowelless consonant shall not precede but fol- low the vowel (va-t, ki-t, ku-t). Further, as our people have composed out of the feet Defiuition (Jhatil) certain schemes or types, according to which of matro

verses are constructed, and have inrented signs to denote the component parts of a foot, i.e. the consonant with and without a vowel, in like manner also the Hindus use certain names to denote the feet which are composed of laghu and yuru, either the former preced- ing and the latter following or vice versa, in such a way, however, that the mcasure must always. be the same, whilst the number of syllables may vary. By these names they denote a certain conventional prosodic unity (i.e. certain feet). By measure, I mean that laghu is reckoned=one matra, i.c. measure, and guru=two mutra. If they represent a foot in writing, they only express the measure of the syllables, not their number, as, e.g. (in Arabic) a double consonant (kka) is counted as a consonant without vowel plus a consonant with vowel, and a consonant followed by Tanwin (un) is connted as a consonant with a vowel plus a consonant

Page 186

140 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

without vowel, whilst in writing both are represented as one and the same thing (i.e. by the sign of the con- sonant in question). Names of Taken alone by themselves, laghu and guru are laghu and garu. called by various names : the former, la, kali, rupa, camara, and graha ; the latter, ga, nivra, and a half amsaka. The latter name shows that a complete amsaka is equal to two guru or their equivalent. These names they have invented simply to facilitate the ver- sification of their metrical books. For this purpose they have invented so many names, that one may fit into the metre if others will not. The single The feet arising out of combinations of laghu and feet. yuru are the following :- Twofold both in number and measure is the foot ||, i.c. two syllables and two mutrit. Twofold in number, not in measure, are the feet, | < and < |; in measure they are = three mutra | | | (bnt, in number, only two syllables). The second foot < | (a trochee) is called krittilat. The quaternary feet are in each book called by dif- ferent names :

< < paksha, i.e. the half month. Il < jvalana, i.c. the fire. 1 <1 madhyu (? madhu). <11 parvata, i.e. the mountain, also called hâre and rasa. Illl ghana, i.e. the cube.

The feet consisting of five matra have manifold forms ; those of them which have special names are the following :- | << hastin, i.c. the elephant. <| kma, i.e. the wish. < < | (? lacuna). |11 < kusuma. A foot consisting of six mutr@ is <<<. Some people call these feet by the names of the chess figures, viz. : jvalana = the elephant. parvata = the pawn. madhya = the tower. ghana = the borse.

Page 187

CHAPTER XIII.

In a lexicographical work to which the anthor On the ar- rangement (? llaribhatta) has given his own name, the feet Quotation of the feet.

composed of three laghu or guru are called by single from Hari- bhatta. consonants, which in the following diagram are written on their left :-- Diagram. < < < sixfold (i.e. containing six matra). 1< < hastin. < 1 < kuma. < < (? lacuna).

-' jvalana. madhya. V bh < pareata. 1 threefold (i.e. containing three mutra). By means of these signs the author teaches how to construct these eight feet by an inductive method (a kind of algebraic permutation), saying : "Place one of the two kinds (gurw and laghu) in the first line unmixed (that would be <<< , if we Page 68. begin with a guru). Then mix it with the second kind, and place one of this at the beginning of the second line, whilst the two other elements are of the first kind (| << ). Then place this element of admix- ture in the middle of the third line (<|<), and lastly at the end of the fourth line (< <I). Then yon have finished the first half. "Further, place the second kind in the lowest line, unmixed (II D, and mix up with the line above it one of the first kind, placing it at the beginning of the line (< ID), then in the middle of the next following line (| < I), and lastly at the end of the next following line (| | <). Then the second half is finished, and all the possible combinations of three matra have been ex- hansted."

I. < < < 5- 11< 2. | < < 6. | < 1 3. < | < First half. 7 .< 11 Second half.

  1. < < 1 8. This system of composition or permutation is correct,

Page 188

142 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

but his calculation showing how to find that place which every single foot occupies in this series of per- mutations is not in accordance with it. For he says: "Place the numeral 2 to denote each element of a foot (i.e. both guru and laghu), once for all, so that every foot is represented by 2, 2, 2. Multiply the left (number) by the middle, and the product by the right one. If this multiplier (i.e. this number of the right side) is a laghu, then leave the product as it is; but if it is a gura, subtract one from the product." The author exemplifies this with the sixth foot, i.e. I < I. He multiplies 2 by 2, and from the product (4) he subtracts I. The remaining 3 he multiplies by the third 2, and he gets the product of 6. This, however, is not correct for most of the feet, and I am rather inclined to believe that the text of the manuscript is corrupt. The proper order of the feet would accordingly be the following :

I. II. III. I. III.

I. < 5. < V 2. 6. - V = 3- 7. 4. 8.

The micture of the first line (No. I.) is such that one kind always follows the other. In the sccond line (No. II.) two of one kind are followed by two of the other; and in the third line (No. III.) four of one kind are followed by four of the other. Then the author of the above-mentioned calculation goes on to say : "If the first element of the foot is a geru, subtract one before you multiply. If the multi- plier is a guru, subtract one from the product. Thus you find the place which a foot occupies in this order." On the As the Arabic verse is divided into two halves or padas. hemistichs by the arud, i.e. the last foot of the first

Page 189

CHAPTER XIII.

hemistich, and the darb, i.e. the last foot of the second hemistich, in like manner the verses of the Hindus are divided into two halves, each of which is called foot (pâda). The Greeks, too, call them feet (lacuna),- those words which are composed of it, ovdAaßn, and the consonants with or without vowels, with long, short, or doubtful vowels. The verse is divided into three, or more commonly On the into four pada. Sometimes they add a fifth pida in Aryâ. metre

the middle of the verse. The padas have no rhyme, but there is a kind of metre, in which the I and 2 pudas end with the same consonant or syllable as if rhyming on it, and also the padas 3 and 4 end with the same consonant or syllable. This kind is called Aryu. At the end of the puda a laghu may become a Page 69. guru, though in general this metre ends with a laghu. The different poetical works of the Hindus contain a great number of metres. In the metre of 5 pâda, the fifth puda is placed between padas 3 and 4. The names of the metres differ according to the number of syllables, and also according to the verses which fol- low. For they do not like all the verses of a long poem to belong to one and the same metre. They use many metres in the same poem, in order that it should appear like an embroidered piece of silk, The construction of the four padas in the four-pada metre is the following :-

< < paksha= I amśaka. ADA III. < < paksha. <|1 parvata. < | parvata. | | < jvalana. < < paksha. PADA I.

< < paksha. < < paksha. V PÂDA IV. jvalana. jvalana. V V 1 < 1 madhya. 1<1 madhya. < || parvata. < | | parvata. < < paksha. jvalana. V PÂDA II

Page 190

I44 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

This is a representation of a species of their metres, called Skandha, containing four pada. It consists of two halves, and each half has eight amsaka. Of the single amsaka, the Ist, 3d, and 5th can never be a madhya, i.e. <|, and the 6th must always be either a madhya or a ghana. If this condition is adhered to, the other amsakas may be anything at all, just as accident or the fancy of the poet wills it. However, the metre must always be complete, neither more nor less. Therefore, observing the rules as to the formation of certain amsakas in the single pâdas, we may repre- sent the four padas in the following manner :- Pâda I. < < Pâda II. << || < |<1 <11 <<. Pâda III. << < I <<. Pâda IV. << << | <I <1111 <. According to this pattern the verse is composed. Arab and If you represent an Arabic metre by these signs of llindu nota- tion of a the Hindus, you will find that they mean something metre. entirely different from what the Arabic signs mean which denote a consonant with a short vowel and a consonant without a vowel. (The Arabic sign | means a consonant without a vowel; the Hindu sign | means a short syllable; the Arabic sign o means a consonant followed by a short vowel; the llindn sign < means a long syllable.) As an example, we give a representation of the regular complete Khafif metre, representing each foot by derivations of the root Li. Metrum Klueftf. فاعلانن (١٠) represented by derivations of the root lt. (2.) loloolo loololo 1oloolo, represented by Arabic signs. (3.) << 1< <I << << I<, represented by the signs of the Hindus.

Page 191

CHAPTER XIII. 145

We give the latter signs in an inverted order, since the Hindus read from the left to the right. I have already once pleaded as my excuse, and do so here a second time, that my slender knowledge of this science does not enable me to give the reader a complete insight into the subject. Still I take the greatest pains with it, though I am well aware that it is only very little I can give. The name Vritta applies to each four-pada metre in On the which the signs of both the prosody and the number of Vritta. the syllables are like each other, according to a certain correspondence of the padas among themselves, so that if you know one pada, you know also the other ones, for they are like it. Further, there is a law that a pâda cannot have less than four syllables, since a puda with less does not occnr in the Veda. For the same reason the smallest number of the syllables of a puda is four, the largest twenty-six. In consequence, there are twenty-three varieties of the Vritta metre, which we shall here enumerate :-

I. The pada has four heary syllables (guru), and here you can- not put two laghu in the place of one guru. 2. The nature of the second kind of the puda is not clear to me, so I omit it. 3. This pâda is built of ghana + paksha. 1111 <<

  1. = 2 guru + 2 laghu + 3 guru. << <<< It would be better to describe this púda as = paksha + jralana + paksha.

  2. = 2 krittika + jralana + paksha. <<

  3. = ghana madhya + paksha. Page 71. + - <<

  4. = ghana + parvata + jralana. <11 VOL. I. K

Page 192

J46 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

  1. = kâma, kusuma, jvaluna, guru. <|< <

  2. = paksha, hastin, jralana, madhya, 2 guru. << I << <<

IO. = paksha, parcata, jvalana, madhya, paksha. << 1<1 << V

II. = paksha, madhya, 2 jvalana, hastin. <<

  1. = ghana, jvalana, paksha, 2 hastin. << I << | <<

  2. = parvata, ktma, kusnma, madhya, jvalana. <|<

  3. = hastin, paksha, parrata, kusuma, parrata, laghu, guru. V <

  4. = 2 paksha, parvata, knsuma, 2 kama, gure.

V

  1. = palsha, purrata, kama, kusuma, palsha, laghu, guru. << <|I <|< Il|< << / <

  2. = 2 paksha, parvata, ghana, jralanu, palsha, kusuma. <<<< <||

  3. = 2 paksha, parvata, ghana, jvalana, 2 kama, guru. II ||< <|< <|< <

  4. = guru, 2 pakshn, parrata, ghana, jvalana, 2 kama, guru. < << << <|| /||| ||< <1< <|< <

  5. = 4 paksha, jvalana, madh ya, paksha, 2 madhya, guru. <<<<<<<< ||< |<| << | << |<

  6. = 4 palsha, 3 jralana, 2 medhya, guru. <

  7. = 4 paksha, kusuma, madhya, jrulana, 2 madhya, guru.

  8. = S guru, I0 layhu, kama, jralana, laghu, guru.

Page 193

CHAPTER XIII. 147

We have given such a lengthy account, though it be only of scanty use, in order that the reader may see for himself the example of an accumulation of laghus, which shows that laghu means a consonunt followed by a short rowcl, not a consonant without a vowel. Further, he will thereby learn the way in which they represent a metre and the method of their scanning a verse. Lastly, he will learn that Alkhalil Ibn Abmad exclu- sively drew from his own genius when he invented the Arabic metrics, though, possibly, he may have heard, as some people think, that the Hindus use certain metres in their poetry. If we here take so much tronble with Indian metrics, we do it for the purpose of fixing the laws of the Sloka, since most of their books are composed in it. The Sloka belongs to the four-pada metres. Each Theary of pada has eight syllables, which are different in all four the Sloka.

pudas. The last syllable of each of the four pdas must be the same, viz. a guru. Further, the fifth syllable in each puda must always be laghu, the sixth syllable guru. The seventh syllable must be laghu in the second and fourth pada, guru in the first and third padas. The other syllables are entirely dependent upon accident or the writer's fancy. In order to show in what way the Hindus use Quotation arithmetic in their metrical system, we give in the from Brah- magupta. following a quotation from Brahmagupta: "The first kind of poetry is gayatrt, a metre consisting of two padas. If we now suppose that the number of the syllables of this metre may be 24, and that the smallest number of the syllables of one pâda is 4, we describe the two padas by 4 - 4, representing their smallest possible number of syllables. As, however, their largest possible number is 24, we add the difference between these 4 + 4 and 24, i.e. 16, to the right-side number, and get 4 + 20. If the metre had three pâdas, it would be represented by 4 + 4 + 16. The right-side

Page 194

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

pada is always distinguished from the others and called by a separate name; but the preceding padas also are connected, so as to form one whole, and likewise called by a separate name. If the metre had four padas, it would be represented by 4 + 4 + 4 + 12. " If, however, the poet does not use the padas of 4, i.e. the smallest possible number of syllables, and if we

Page 72. want to know the number of combinations of the 24 syllables which may occur in a two-pâda metre, we write 4 to the left and 20 to the right; we add I to 4, again I to the sum, &c. ; we subtract I from 20, again I from the remainder, &c. ; and this we continue until we get both the same numbers with which we com- menced, the small number in the line which commenced with the greater number, and the greater number in the line which commenced with the small number. See the following scheme :-

4 20 5 19 6 IS 7 17 16

9 15 10 14 11 I3 12 12 I3 14 10 15 16 8 17 7 18 6 19 5 20 4

The number of these combinations is 17, i.e. the dif- ference between 4 and 20 plus I. " As regards the three-puda metre with the presnp- posed number of syllables, i.e. 24, its first species is

Page 195

CHAPTER XIII. 149

that in which all three padas have the smallest pos- sible number of syllables, i.e. 4 + 4 + 16. "The right-side number and the middle number we write down as we have done with the padas of the two- pada metre, and we make with them the same calcula- tion as we have done above. Besides, we add the left- side number in a separate column, but do not make it undergo any changes. See the following scheme :-

4 4 16

5 15 4 6 14 4 7 13 4 8 12

4 9 II 4 IO 10 98765 II 12

4 13 7 14 6

4 15 16 5 4

" This gives the number of 13 permutations, but by changing the places of the numbers forwards and back- wards in the following method, the number may be increased sixfold, i.e. to 78 :-- "I. The right-side number keeps its place; the two other numbers exchange their places, so that the middle number stands at the left side; the left-side number occupies the middle :-

I.

4 16 5 I + 14 7 13 &c.

" II .- III. The right-side number is placed in the middle between the other two numbers, which first

Page 196

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

keep their original places, and then exchange them with each other :-

II.

4 16 4 15 5 14 4 13 7 &c.

III.

4 16 + 5 4 14 4 7 13 4 &e.

"IV .- V. The right-side number is placed to the left, and the other two numbers first keep their original places, and then exchange them with each other :-

IV. 16 45 4 I5 4 14 4 I3 4 7 &c.

V. 16 4 4 15 5 14 6 13 7 4 &e.

" Because, further, the numbers of the syllables of a puda rise like the square of 2, for after 4 follows 8, we may represent the syllables of the three padas in this way: 8+8+8 (=4+4+16). However, their arith- metical peculiarities follow another rule. The four- pada metre follows the analogy of the three-pada metre." Of the above-mentioned treatise of Braumagupta I have only seen a single leaf: it contains, no doubt, important elements of arithmetic. God affords help

Page 197

CHAPTER XIII.

and sustains by his mercy, i.e. I hope one day to learn those things. As far as I can guess with regard to the literature of the Greeks, they used in their poetry similar feet to the Hindus ; for Galenus says in his book kaTa yevn: "The medicine prepared with saliva dis- Page 73. covered by Menecrates has been described by Damo- crates in a poem composed in a metre consisting of three parts."

Page 198

( 152 )

CHAPTER XIV.

HINDU LITERATURE IN THE OTIIER SCIENCES, ASTRONOMY, ASTROLOGY, EIC.

Times un- THE number of sciences is great, and it may be still favourable to the greater if the public mind is directed towards them at progress of sciencc. snch times as they are in the ascendancy and in general favour with all, when people not only honour science itself, but also its representatives. To do this is, in the first instance, the duty of those who rule over them, of kings and princes. For they alone could free the minds of scholars from the daily anxieties for the necessities of life, and stimulate their energies to earn more fame and favour, the yearning for which is the pith and mar- row of human nature. The present times, however, are not of this kind. They are the very opposite, aud therefore it is quite impossible that a new science or any new kind of research should arise in our days. What we have of sciences is nothing but the scanty remains of bygone better times. If a science or an idea has once conquered the whole earth, every nation appropriates part of it. So do also the Hindus. Their belief about the cyclical revolutions of times is nothing very special, but is simply in accord- ance with the results of scientific observation. On the The science of astronomy is the most famous among Siddhantas. them, since the affairs of their religion are in varions ways connected with it. If a man wants to gain the title of an astronomer, he must not only know scientific

Page 199

CHAPTER XIV. 153

or mathematical astronomy, but also astrology. The book known amoug Muslims as Sindhind is called by them Siddhanta, i.e. straight, not crooked nor changing. By this name they call every standard book on astro- nomy, even such books as, according to our opinion, do not come up to the mark of our so-called Zij, i.e. handbooks of mathematical astronomy. They have five Siddhantas :- I. Surya-siddhanta, i.c. the Siddhanta of the sun, composed by Lâta. II. Vasishtha-siddhanta, so called from one of the stars of the Great Bear, composed by Vishnucandra. III. Pulisa-siddhanta, so called from Paulisa, the Greek, from the city of Saintra, which I suppose to be Alexandria, composed by Pulisa. IV. Romaka-siddhanta, so called from the Rum, i.c. the subjects of the Roman Empire, composed by Śrîsheņa. V. Brahma-siddhanta, so called from Brahman, com- posed by Brahmagupta, the son of Jishnu, from the town of Bhillamala between Multan and Anhilwara, 16 yojana from the latter place (?). The authors of these books draw from one and the same source, the Book Paithamaha, so called from the first father, i.e. Brahman. Varahamihira has composed an astronomical hand- book of small compass called Pañca-siddhantika, which name onght to mean that it contains the pith and mar- row of the preceding five Siddhantas. But this is not the case, nor is it so much better than they as to be called the most correct one of the five. So the name does not indicate anything but the fact that the number of Siddhântas is five. Brahmagupta says: "Many of the Siddhantas are Sûrya, others Indu, Pulisa, Romaka, Vasishtha, and Yavana, i.e. the Greeks; and though the Siddhantas are many, they differ only in words, not in the subject-

Page 200

154 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

matter. He who studies them properly will find that they agree with each other." Up to the present time I have not been able to pro- cure any of these books save those of Pulisa and of Brahmagupta. I have commenced translating them, but have not yet finished my work. Meanwhile I shall Page 74. give liere a table of contents of the Brahma-siddhantu, which in any case will be useful and instructive. Contents of Contents of the twenty-four chapters of the Brahma- the Brahma- siddhinta. siddhânta- I. On the nature of the globe and the figure of heaven and earth. 2. On the revolutions of the planets; on the calcula- tion of time, i.e. how to find the time for different longi- tudes aud latitudes; how to find the mean places of the planets; how to find the sine of an arc. 3. On the correction of the places of the planets. 4. On three problems: how to find the shadow, the bygone portion of the day and the ascendens, and how to derive one from the other. 5. On the planets becoming visible when they leave the rays of the sun, and their becoming invisible when entering them. 6. On the first appearance of the moon, and about her two cusps. 7. On the lunar eclipse. 8. On the solar eclipse. 9. On the shadow of the moon. IO. On the meeting and conjunction of the planets. II. On the latitudes of the planets. 12. A critical investigation for the purpose of dis- tinguishing between correct and corrupt passages in the texts of astronomical treatises and handbooks. 13. On arithmetic; on plane measure and cognate subjects. 14. Scientific calculation of the mean places of the planets.

Page 201

CHAPTER XIV. I55

  1. Scientific calculation of the correction of the places of the planets. 16. Scientific calculation of the three problems (v. chap. 4). 17. On the deflection of eclipses. 18. Scientific calculation of the appearance of the new moon and her two cusps. 19. On Kuttaka, i.e. the pounding of a thing. The pounding of oil-producing substances is here compared with the most minute and detailed research. This chapter treats of algebra and related subjects, and besides it contains other valuable remarks of a more or less arithmetical nature. 20. On the shadow. 21. On the calculation of the measures of poetry and on metrics. 22. On cycles and instruments of observation. 23. On time and the four measures of time, the solar, the civil, the lunar, and the sidereal. 24. About numeral notation in the metrical books of this kind. These, now, are twenty-four chapters, according to his own statement, but there is a twenty-fifth one, called Dhyana-graha-adhyaya, in which he tries to solve the problems by speculation, not by mathematical calculation. I have not enumerated it in this list, because the pretensions which he brings forward in this chapter are repudiated by mathematics. I am rather inclined to think that that which he produces is meant to be the ratio mctaphysica of all astronomical methods, otherwise how could any problem of this science be solved by anything save by mathematics? Such books as do not reach the standard of a Sid- On the dhanta are mostly called Tuntra or Karand. The Tantras and literature of

former means ruling under u gorernor, the latter means Karanas.

following, i.e. following behind the Siddhanta. Under yovernors they understand the icaryas, i.e. the sages, anchorites, the followers of Brahman.

Page 202

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

There are two famous Tantras by Aryabhata and Balabhudra, besides the Rasayana-tantra by Bhanu- yasas (?). About what Rasayana means we shall give a separate chapter (chap. xvii.). As for Karanas, there is one (lacuna) called by his name, besides the Karana-khanda-khadyaka by Brah- magupta. The last word, khanda, means a kind of their sweetmeats. With regard to the reason why he gave his book this title, I have been told the follow- ing :- Sugrîva, the Buddhist, had composed an astrono- mical handbook which he called Dadhi-sagara, i.e. the sea of sour-milk; and a pupil of his composed a book of the same kind which he called Kûra-babaya (?), i.e. a mountain of rice. Afterwards he composed an- other book which he called Laana-mushti, i.e. a hand- ful of salt. Therefore Brahmagupta called his book the Sweetmeat-khadyaka-in order that all kinds of victuals (sour-milk, rice, salt, &c.) should occur in the titles of the books on this science. The contents of the book Karana-khanda-khadyaka Page 75. represent the doctrine of Argabhata. Therefore Brah- magupta afterwards composed a second book, which he called Uttara-khanda-khadyaka, i.e. the explanation of the Khanda-khadyaka. And this book is again followed by another one called Khanda-khadyaka-tippa (sic), of which I do not know whether it is composed by Brah- magupta or somebody else. It explains the reasons and the nature of the calculations employed in the Khanda-khadyaka. I suppose it is a work of Bala- bhadra's. Further, there is an astronomical handbook composed by Vijayanandin, the commentator, in the city of Benares, entitled Karana-tilaka, i.e. the blaze on the front of the Karanas; another one by Vittesvara the son of Bhadatta (? Mihdatta), of the city of Nagarapura, called Karana-sara, i.e. that which has been derived

Page 203

CHAPTER XIV. 157

from the Karana; another one, by Bbanuyakas (?), is called Karana-para-tilaka, which shows, as I am told, how the corrected places of the stars are derived from one another. There is a book by Utpala the Kashmirian called Rahunrakarana (?), i.e. breaking the Karanas; and another called Kuranu-pata, i.e. killing the Karanas. Besides there is a book called Karana-endamuni of which I do not know the author. There are more books of the same kind with other titles, e.g. the great Munasa, composed by Manu, and the commentary by Utpala; the small Manasa, an epitome of the former by Puncala (?), from the southern country ; Dasagitika, by Aryabhata; Aryashtasata, by the same; Lokananda, so called from the name of the anthor ; Bhat- !ila (?), so called from its author, the Brabman Bhattila. The books of this kind are nearly innumerable. As for astrological literature, each one of the follow- On astrolo- ing authors has composed a so-called Samhita, viz .:- gical litera- ture, the Mâņdavya. Balabhadra. so-called. Samnhitas. Parâśara. Divyatattva. Garga. Varâhamihira. Brahman. Samhita means that which is collected, books containing something of everything, e.g. forewarnings relating to a journey derived from meteorological occnrrences; pro- phecies regarding the fate of dynasties; the knowledge of lucky and unlucky things; prophesying from the lines of the hand; interpretation of dreams, and taking auguries from the flight or cries of birds. For Hindu scholars believe in such things. It is the custom of their astronomers to propound in their Samhitâs also the whole science of meteorology and cosmology. Each one of the following authors has composed a The Jata- book, Jataka, i.e. book of nativities, viz. :- kas, i.e. books on Parâśara. Jîvašarman. nativities

Satya. Mau, the Greek. Manittha.

Page 204

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Varahamihira has composed two Jatakas, a small and a large one. The latter of these has been explained by Balabhadra, and the former I have translated into Arabic. Further, the Hindus have a large book on the science of the astrology of nativities called Saravalt, i.e. the chosen one, similar to the Vuztdaj (= Persian gizida?), composed by Kalyana-Varman, who gained high credit for his scientific works. But there is another book still larger than this, which comprehends the whole of astrologicai sciences, called Ynrana, i.e. belonging to the Greeks. Of Varahamihira there are several small books, e.g. Shat-pancasiltt, fifty-six chapters on astrology; Hora- peñcn-hotriya (?), on the same subject. Travelling is treated of in the book Yogayatra and the book Tikani(?)-yatra, marriage and marrying in the book Viraha-putala, architecture in the book (lacuna). The art of taking auguries from the flight or cries of birds, and of the foretelling by means of piercing a needle into a book, is propounded in the work called Srudhara (? śrotavya), which exists in three different copies. Malâdeva is said to be the anthor of the first, Vimalabuddhi the author of the second, and Bangala the author of the third. Similar subjects are treated in the book Gadhamana (?), i.e. the knowledge of the un- known, composed by Buddha, the originator of the sect of the red robe-wearers, the Shamanians; and in the book Prasna Gudhamana (?), i.e. questions of the science of the unknown, composed by Utpala. Besides, there are Hindu scholars of whom we know Page 76. the names, but not the title of any book of theirs, viz. :--

Pradyumna. Sarasvata. Sangabila (Srinkhala ?). Piruvâna (?). Divâkara. Devakirtti. Parêsvara. Prithudaka-svamin.

Medical Medicine belongs to the same class of sciences as literature. astronomy, but there is this difference, that the latter

Page 205

CHAPTER XIV. 159

stands in close relation to the religion of the Hindus. They have a book called by the name of its author, i.c. Caraka, which they consider as the best of their whole literature on medicine. According to their belief, Caraka was a Rishi in the last Dvapara-yuga, when his name was Agnivesa, but afterwards he was called Caraka, i.e. the intelligent one, after the first elements of medicine had been laid down by certain Rishis, the children of Sutra. These latter had received them from Indra, Indra from Asvin, one of the two physicians of the Devas, and Asvin had received them from Praja- pati, i.e. Brahman, the first father. This book has been translated into Arabic for the princes of the house of the Barmecides. The Hindus cultivate numerous other branches of Ou Panea- science and literature, and have a nearly boundless tantra.

literature. I, however, could not comprehend it with my knowledge. I wish I could translate the book Pancatantra, known among us as the book of Kalila and Dimna. It is far spread in various languages, in P'ersian, Hindi, and Arabic-in translations of people who are not free from the suspicion of having altered the text. For instance, 'Abdallah Ibn Almukaffa' has added in his Arabic version the chapter abont Barzoya, with the intention of raising doubts in the minds of people of feeble religious belief, and to gain and prepare them for the propagation of the doctrines of the Mani- chæans. And if he is open to suspicion in so far as he has added something to the text which he had simply to translate, he is hardly free from suspicion in his capacity as translator.

Page 206

A 160

CHAPTER XV.

NOTES ON IIINDU METROLOGY, INTENDED TO FACILITATE THE UNDERSTANDING OF ALL KINDS OF MEASURE- MENTS WHICH OCCUR IN THIS BOOK.

The Hindu COUNTING is innate to man. The measure of a thing system of weights. becomes known by its being compared with another thing which belongs to the same species and is assumed as a unit by general consent. Thereby the difference between the object and this standard becomes known. By weighing, people determine the amount of gravity of heavy bodies, when the tongue of the scales stands at right angles on the horizontal plane. Hindus want the scales very little, becanse their dirhams are deter- mined by number, not by weight, and their fractions, too, are simply counted as so-and-so many fuluts. The coinage of both dirhams and fulits is different accord- ing to towns and districts. They weigh gold with the scales only when it is in its natural state or such as has been worked, e.g. for ornaments, but not coined. They use as a weight of gold the surarna= If tola. They use the tola as frequently as we use the mithkal. According to what I have been able to learn from them, it corresponds to three of our dirhams, of which IO equal 7 mithkal. Therefore I tola = 210 of our mithkal. The greatest fraction of a tola is a, called masha. Therefore 16 musha = I suvarna.

Page 207

CHAPTER XV. 161

Further, I masha = 4 andt (eranda), i.c. the seed of a tree called Gaura. I andt = 4 yara. I yava = 6 kala. I kalâ = 4 pâda. I pâda = 4 mdrt (?).

Arranged differently we have --

I suvarna = 16 masha = 64 andt = 256 yara = 1600 kala = 6400 pada = 25,600 mdrt (?).

Six mashas are called I drankshana. If you ask them about this weight, they will tell you that 2 drank- shana = I mithkal. But this is a mistake; for I mithkal=53 masha. The relation between a drank- shana and a mithkal is as 20 to 21, and therefore I drankshana = 1,6 mithkal. If, therefore, a man gives the answer which we bave just mentioned, he seems to have in mind the notion of a mithkal as a weight which does not much differ from a drankshana; but by doubling the amount, saying 2 draakshanas instead of I, he entirely spoils the comparison. Since the unit of measure is not a natural unit, Page 77. but a conventional one assumed by general consent, it admits of both practical and imaginary division. Its subdivisions or fractions are different in different places at one and the same time, and at different periods in one and the same country. Their names, too, are different according to places and times; changes which are produced either by the organic development of lan- guages or by accident. A man from the neighbourhood of Somanath told me that their mithkal is equal to ours; that

I mith kal S ruvu. I ruvu = 2 pali. I páli = 16 yara, i.e. barley-corn. Accordingly I mithkul = 8 ruru = 16 pali = 256 yara.

This comparison shows that the man was mistaken VOL. I. L

Page 208

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

in comparing the two mithkals; that what he called mithkuls is in reality the tola, and that he calls the muisha by a different name, viz. ruru. Varâhami- If the Hindus wish to be particularly painstaking in hira on weights. these things, they give the following scale, based on the measurements which Varahamihira prescribes for the constrnctiou of idols :-

I renu or particle of dust = I raja. S raja I balagra, i.e. the end of a hair. S balúgra I lil:hyn, i.e. the egg of a louse. S likhya S yakit I yaka, i ... a louse. I yara, i.e. a barley-corn.

Hence, Varahamihira goes on to ennmerate the measures for distances. His measures of weight are the same as those which we have already mentioned. He says:

4 yava I andt. 4 andt I masha. 16 mrtsha I surarna, i.e. gold. 4 surarna I pala.

The measures of dry substances are the following :-

4 pala I kudara. 4 kudara I prastha. 4 prastha I adhuka.

The measnres of liquid substances are the following :-

8 pala = I kudara. 8 kudara = I prastha. 4 prastha I adhaka. 4 adhaka = I drona.

Weights The following weights occur in the book Caraka. I according to the book give them here according to the Arabic translation, as Caralo. I have not received them from the Hindus viva voce. The Arabic copy seems to be corrupt, like all other books of this kind which I know. Snch corruption mnst of necessity occnr in onr Arabic writing, more particnlarly at a period like onrs, when people care

Page 209

CHAPTER XV.

so little about the correctness of what they copy. " Âtreya says : 6 particles of dust = I murici. 6 marici = I mustard-seed (rajika). S mustard-seeds = I red rice-corn. 2 red rice-corns = I pea. 2 pcas And I andi is equal to 4 danal, according to the scale by which 7 danal are equal to one dirham. Further : 4 andî = I masha. S masha = I cana (?).

2 cana ( I kursha or suvnrna of the =1 weight of 2 dirhums. 4 suvarna = I pala. 4 prtla = 1 kudara. 4 kudara = 1 prastha. 4 prastha = I adhaka. 4 ndhaka = I drona. 2 dronit = 1 s@rpa. 2 sarpa = I juna (?)." The weight pala is much used in all the business dealings of the Hindus, but it is different for different wares and in different provinces. According to some, I palo = 1s mand; according to others, I pala = 14 mithkal; but the mand is not equal to 210 mithlal. According to others, I pala = 16 mithhal, but the mand is not equal to 240 mithkal. According to others, I pala = 15 dirham, but the mand is not equal to 225 dirham. In reality, however, the relation between the ple and the manct is different. Further, Atreya says: " I adhaka = 64 mila = 128 Page 78. dirham = I ratl. But if the andt is equal to danak, one suerne contains 64 andf, and then a dirhom has 32 andi, which, as each ondi is equal to } danak, are equal to 4 danak. The double amount of it is if dir- ham " (sie). Such are the results when people, instead of trans- lating, indulge in wild conjecture and mingle together different theories in an uncritical manner.

Page 210

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

As regards the first theory, resting on the assumption of one surarna being equal to three of our dirhams, people in general agree in this-that

I suvarna = } pala. I pala = 12 dirham. I pala = r's mana. I mana = 180 dirham.

This leads me to think that i surerna is equal to 3 of our mithkal, not to 3 of our dirham. Varions Varahamihira says in another place of his Samhith: anthors on weights. " Make a round vase of the diameter and height of one yard, and then expose it to the rain until it ceases. All the water that has been collected in it of the weight of 200 dirham is, if taken fourfold, equal to I adhaka." This, however, is only an approximate statement, becanse, as we have above mentioned in his own words, I adhaka is equal to 768 either dirham, as they say, or mithkal, as I suppose. Śripala relates, on the authority of Varahamihira, that 50 pla = 256 dirham = I adhaka. But he is mistaken, for here the number 256 does not mean dirhams, but the number of the suvarna contained in one adhaka. And the number of pala contained in I adhaka is 64, not 50. As I have been told, Jivasarman gives the following detailed account of these weights:

4 pala = I kudura. 4 kudarn = I prastha. 4 prustha = I adhaku. 4 adhuka = I drona. 20 drona = I khart.

The reader must know that 16 masha are I suvarna, but in weighing wheat or barley they reckon 4 sucarpa = I pala, and in weighing water and oil they reckon 8 sucarna = I pala. The Hindu The balances with which the Hindus weigh things balance. are xaptoTiwres, of which the weights are immovable, whilst the scales move on certain marks and lines.

Page 211

CHAPTER XV.

Therefore the balance is called tulit. The first lines mnean the units of the weight from I to 5, and farther on to 1O; the following lines mean the tenths, 10, 20, 30, &c. With regard to the cause of this arrangement they relate the following saying of Vasudeva :- " I will not kill Sisupala, the son of my aunt, if he has not committed a crime, but will pardon him until ten, and then I shall call him to account." We shall relate this story on a later opportunity. Alfazarî uses in his astronomical handbook the word pala for day-minutes (i.c. sixtieth parts of a day). Ihave not found this use anywhere in Hindu literature, but they use the word to denote u correction in a mathe- matical sense. The Hindus have a weight called bhâra, which is mentioned in the books about the conquest of Sindh. It is equal to 2000 pala ; for they explain it by 100 X 20 pala, and as nearly equal to the weight of an ox. This is all I have lighted on as regards Hindu weights. By measuring (with dry measures) people determine Dry the body and the bulk of a thing, if it fills up a certain measures.

measure which has been gauged as containing a certain quantity of it, it being understood that the way in Page 79. which the things are laid out in the measure, the way in which their surface is determined, and the way in which, on the whole, they are arranged within the measure, are in every case identical. If two objects which are to be weighed belong to the same species, they then prove to be equal, not only in bulk, but also in weight ; but if they do not belong to the same species, their bodily extent is equal, but not their weight. They have a measure called bist (? sibt), which is mentioned by every man from Kanauj and Somanath. According to the people of Kanauj-

4 bist = I prastha. Į bisî = I kuduvu.

Page 212

166 ALBERUNPS INDIA.

According to the people of Somanath- 16 bist = I pantt. 12 puntt = I mora. According to another theory- 12 bist = I kalast. } bist = I mânu. From the same source I learnt that a mana of wheat is nearly equal to 5 mand. Therefore I bist (?) is equal to 20 mana. The bist corresponds to the Khwâ- rizmian measure sukhkh, according to old style, whilst the kalast corresponds to the Khwarizmian ghur, for I ghur = 12 sukhkh. Measures of Mensuration is the determination of distances by distances. lines and of superficies by planes. A plane ought to be measured by part of a plane, but the mensuration by means of lines effects the same purpose, as lines determine the limits of planes. When, in quoting Varahamihira, we had come so far as to determine the weight of a barley-corn (p. 162), we made a digression into an exposition of weights, where we used his authority about gravity, and now we shall return to him and consult him about distances. He says- 8 barley-corns put together = I angula, i.e. finger. 4 fingers = I râma (?), i.e. the fist. 24 fingers = I hattha, i.e. yard, also called dustu. 4 yards = I dhanu, i.c. arc = a fathom. 40 arcs = I nulva. 25 nalra = I krośa.

Hence it follows that I kroh = 4000 yards; and as our mile has just so many yards, I mile = 1 kroh. Pulisa the Greek also mentions in his Siddhanta that I krol = 4000 yards. The yurd is equal to 2 mikyas or 24 fingers; for the Hindus determine the śuiku, i.e. milyas, by idol-fingers. They do not call the twelfth part of a mikyas a finger in general, as we do, but their mikyas is always a span. The span, i.c. the distance between the ends of the

Page 213

CHAPTER XV.

thumb and the small finger at their widest possible stretching, is called vitasti and also kishku. The distance between the ends of the fourth or ring- finger and the thumb, both being stretched out, is called gokarņa. The distance between the ends of the index-finger and of the thumb is called karabha, and is reckoned as equal to two-thirds of a span. The distance between the tops of the middle finger and of the thumb is called tala. The Hindus maintain that the height of a man is eight times his tala, whether he be tall or small; as people say with regard to the foot, that it is one-seventh of the height of a man. Regarding the construction of idols, the book Sarthita says :- "The breadth of the palm has been determined as 6, the length as 7: the length of the middle finger as 5, that of the fourth finger as the same ; that of the index- finger as the same minus ; (i.e. 41); that of the small finger as the same minus } (i.e. 33); that of the thumb as equal to two-thirds of the length of the middle finger (i.e. 33), so that the two last fingers are of equal length." By the measurements and numbers of this passage, Page 80. the author means idol-fingers. After the measure of the krosa has been fixed and The relation found to be equal to our mile, the reader must learn yojana, mile, between

that they have a measure of distances, called yojana, and farsakh.

which is equal to 8 miles or to 32,000 yards. Perhaps somebody might believe that I kroh is = } fursakh, and maintain that the fursakhs of the Hindus are 16,000 yards long. But such is not the case. On the contrary, I broh = 1 yojana. In the terms of this measure, Alfazari has determined the circumfer- ence of the earth in his astronomical handbook. He calls it jun, in the plural 'ajwun. The elements of the calculations of the Hindus on Relation the circumference of the circle rest on the assumption betwecn

Page 214

168 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

cireumfer- that it is thrice its diameter. So the Matsya-Purana cnee and diameter. says, after it has mentioned the diameters of the sun and moon in yojanas: "The circumference is thrice the diameter." The Aditya-Purana says, after it has mentioned the breadth of the Dvipas, i.e. the islands and of their surrounding seas: "The circumference is thrice the diameter." The same occurs also in the Vayu-Purana. In later times, however, Hindus have become aware of the fraction following after the three wholes. According to Brahmagupta, the circumference is 3} times the diameter; but he finds this number by a method peculiar to himself. He says : " As the root of 10 is nearly 31, the relation between the diameter and its circumference is like the relation between I and the root of 10." Then he multiplies the diameter by itself, the product by 10, and of this product he takes the root. Then the circumference is solid, i.e. consists of integers, in the same way as the root of ten. This calculation, however, makes the fraction larger than it really is. Archimedes defined it to be something between 18 and 11. Brahmagupta relates with regard to Aryabhata, criticising him, that he fixed the circumference as 3393 ; that he fixed the dia- meter in one place as 1080, in another place as 1050. According to the first statement, the relation between diameter and circumference would be like 1 : 3156. This fraction (,16) is by ,17 smaller than 4. However, as regards the second statement, it contains no doubt a blunder in the text, not of the author; for according to the text, the relation would be like 1 : 31 and some- thing over. Pulisa employs this relation in his calculations in the proportion of I : 3 . This fraction is here by so much smaller than one- seventh as it is according to Aryabhata, i.c. by I'r.

Page 215

CHAPTER XV.

The same relation is derived from the old theory, which Ya'kub Ibn Tarik mentions in his book, Com- positio Sphararum, on the authority of his Hindu informant, viz. that the circumference of the zodiac 1s 1,256,640,000 yojana, and that its diameter is 400,000,000 yojana. These numbers presuppose the relation between cir- 56,640,000 cumference and diameter to be as I : 3 100,000,000' These two numbers may be reduced by the common divisor of 360,000. Thereby we get 177 as numerator and 1250 as denominator. And this is the fraction () which P'ulisa has adopted.

Page 216

175 )

CIIAPTER XVI.

NOTES ON THE WRITING OF THE HIINDUS, ON THEIR ARITIMETIC AND RELATED SUBJECTS, AND ON CER- Page 81. TAIN STRANGE MANNERS AND CUSTOMS OF THEIRS.

On various THE tongue communicates the thought of the speaker kinds of writing to the hearer. Its action has therefore, as it were, a material. momentary life only, and it would have been impos- sible to deliver by oral tradition the accounts of the events of the past to later generations, more particularly if they are separated from them by long periods of time. This has become possible only by a new dis- covery of the human mind, by the art of writing, which spreads news over space as the winds spread, and over time as the spirits of the deceased spread. Praise therefore be unto Him who has arranged creation and created everything for the best ! The Hindns are not in the habit of writing on hides, like the Greeks in ancient times. Socrates, on being asked why he did not compose books, gave this reply : "I do not transfer knowledge from the living hearts of men to the dead hides of sheep." Muslims, too, used in the early times of Islam to write on hides, e.g. the treaty between the Prophet and the Jews of Khaibar and his letter to Kisra. The copies of the Koran were written on the hides of gazelles, as are still nowadays the copies of the Thora. There occurs this passage in the Koran (Sûra vi. 91): "They make it kara!is," i.e. Topapia. The kirtas (or charta) is made in Egypt,

Page 217

CHAPTER XVI. I7I

being cut out of the papyrus stalk. Written on this material, the orders of the Khalifs went out into all the world until shortly before our time. Papyrus has this advantage over vellum, that you can neither rub ont nor change anything on it, because thereby it would be destroyed. It was in China that paper was first manu- factured. Chinese prisoners introduced the fabrication of paper into Samarkand, and thereupon it was made in various places, so as to meet the existing want. The Hindus have in the south of their country a slender tree like the date and cocoa-nut palms, bearing edible fruits and leaves of the length of one yard, and as broad as three fingers one put beside the other. They call these leaves turi (tala or tar= Borassus fla- belliformis), and write on them. They bind a book of these leaves together by a cord on which they are arranged, the cord going through all the leaves by a hole in the middle of each. In Central and Northern India people use the bark of the tiz tree, one kind of which is used as a cover for bows. It is called bhurja. They take a piece one yard long and as broad as the outstretched fingers of the hand, or somewhat less, and prepare it in various ways. They oil and polish it so as to make it hard and smooth, and then they write on it. The proper order of the single leaves is marked by numbers. The whole book is wrapped up in a piece of cloth and fastened between two tablets of the same size. Such a book is called puthi (cf. muesta, pustaka). Their letters, and whatever else they have to write, they write on the bark of the tiz tree. As to the writing or alphabet of the Hindus, we have On the already mentioned that it once had been lost and for- alphabet. Hindn

gotten ; that nobody cared for it, and that in conse- quence people became illiterate, sunken into gross ignorance, and entirely estranged from science. But then Vyasa, the son of Parasara, rediscovered their

Page 218

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

alphabet of fifty letters by an inspiration of God. A letter is called akeshara. Some people say that originally the number of their letters was less, and that it increased only by degrees. This is possible, or I should even say necessary. As for the Greek alphabet, a certain Astdhas (sic) had formed sixteen characters to perpetuate science about the time when the Israelites ruled over Egypt. Thereupon Ktmush (sic) and Agenon (sic) brought them to the Greeks. By adding four new signs they obtained an alphabet of twenty letters. Later on, about the time when Socrates was poisoned, Simonides added four Page 82. other signs, and so the Athenians at last had a complete alphabet of twenty-four letters, which bappened during the reign of Artaxerxes, the son of Darius, the son of Artaxerxes, the son of Cyrus, according to the chrono- graphers of the West. The great number of the letters of the Hindu alpha- bet is explained, firstly, by the fact that they express every letter by a separate sign if it is followed by a vowel or a diphthong or a hamza (visarga), or a small extension of the sound beyond the measure of the vowel; and, secondly, by the fact that they have con- sonants which are not found together in any other langnage, though they may be found scattered through different languages-sounds of such a nature that our tongnes, not being familiar with them, can scarcely pro- nounce them, and that our ears are frequently not able to distinguish between many a cognate pair of them. The Hindus write from the left to the right like the Greeks. They do not write on the basis of a line, above which the heads of the letters rise whilst their tails go down below, as in Arabic writing. On the contrary, their ground-line is above, a straight line above every single character, and from this line the letter hangs down and is written under it. Any sign above the line is nothing but a grammatical mark to

Page 219

CHAPTER XVI. 173

denote the pronunciation of the character above which it stands. The most generally known alphabet is called Siddha- On the local mutrika, which is by some considered as originating the Hindus. alphahets of

from Kashmir, for the people of Kashmir use it. But it is also used in Varanasi. This town and Kashmir are the high schools of Hindu sciences. The same writing is used in Madhyadesa, i.c. the middle conntry, the country all around Kanauj, which is also called Arya- varta. In Malava there is another alphabet called Nngara, which differs from the former only in the shape of the characters. Next comes an alphabet called Ardhanagari, i.e. half- nagara, so called because it is compounded of the former two. It is used in Bhatiya and some parts of Sindh. Other alphabets are the Malwart, used in Malwashau, in Southern Sind, towards the sea-coast ; the Saindhava, used in Bahmanwa or Almansura; the Karnata, used in Karnâtadeśa, whence those troops come which in the armies are known as Kannara ; the Andhri, used in Andhradesa ; the Dirwari (Dravidt), used in Dirwara- deśa (Dravidadeśa); the Lart, used in Lâradeśa (Lâta- deśa); the Gauri (Gaudi), used in Pûrvadeśa, i.e. the Eastern country ; the Bhaikshukf, used in Udunpur in Purvadesa. This last is the writing of Buddha. The Hindus begin their books with Om, the word of On the creation, as we begin them with " In the name of word Om.

God." The figure of the word om is OV This figure does not consist of letters; it is simply an image invented to represent this word, which people use, believing that it will bring them a blessing, and meaning thereby a confession of the unity of God. Similar to this is the manner in which the Jews write the name of God, viz. by three Hebrew yods. In the Thora the word is written YHVH and pronounced

Page 220

174 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Adonai; sometimes they also say Yah. The word Adonai, which they pronounce, is not expressed in writing. On their The Hindus do not use the letters of their alphabet nnmeral signs. for numerical notation, as we use the Arabic letters in the order of the Hebrew alphabet. Asin different parts of India the letters have different shapes, the numeral signs, too, which are called anka, differ. The numeral Page 83. signs which we use are derived from the finest forms of the Hindu signs. Signs and figures are of no use if people do not know what they mean, but the people of Kashmîr mark the single leaves of their books with figures which look like drawings or like the Chinese characters, the meaning of which can only be learned by a very long practice. However, they do not use them when reckoning in the sand. In arithmetic all nations agree that all the orders of numbers (e.g. one, ten, hundred, thousand) stand in a certain relation to the ten; that each order is the tenth part of the following and the tenfold of the preceding. I have studied the names of the orders of the numbers in varions languages with all kinds of people with whom I have been in contact, and have found that no nation goes beyond the thousand. The Arabs, too, stop with the thousand, which is certainly the most correct and the most natural thing to do. I have written a separate treatise on this subject. Those, however, who go beyond the thousand in their numeral system are the Hindus, at least in their arithmetical technical terms, which have been either freely invented or derived according to certain etymolo- gies, whilst in others both methods are blended together. They extend the names of the orders of numbers until the 18th order for religions reasons, the mathematicians being assisted by the grammarians with all kinds of etymologies. The 18th order is called Parardha, i.e. the half of

Page 221

CHAPTER XII. 175

heaven, or, more accurately, the half of that which is above. For if the Hindus construct periods of time out of Kalpas, the unit of this order is a day of God (i.e. a half nychthemeron). And as we do not know any body larger than heaven, half of it (parúrdha), as a half of the greatest body, bas been compared with a half-of the greatest day. By doubling it, by uniting night to day, we get the whole of the greatest day. There can be no doubt that the name Parurdha is accounted for in this way, and that parur means the whole of heaven. The following are the names of the eighteen orders of The eight. numbers :- een orders of munera- tion. I. Elvnh. 10. Pudma. 2. Dasmit. II. Kharra. 3. Natom. 12. Nikharn. 4. Sahusramh. 13. Mahapadma. 5. A yuta. 14. S'miku. 6. Laksha. 15. Sumudra. 7. Prayuta. 16. Mudhya. 8. Koļi. 17. Antya. 9. Nyarbuda. IS. Purardha.

I shall now mention some of their differences of opinion relating to this system. Some Hindus maintain that there is a igth order Variations beyond the Parardha, called Bhuri, and that this is the in the oceurring

limit of reckoning. But in reality rechoning is unlimited ; orders. eiglteen

it has only a technical limit, which is conventionally adopted as the last of the orders of numbers. By the word reckoning in the sentence above they seem to mean nomenclature, as if they meant to say that the language has no name for any reckoning beyond the 19th order. It is known that the unit of this order, i.c. one bhûri. is equal to one-fifth of the greatest day. but on this subject they have no tradition. In their tradition there are only traces of combinations of the greatest day, as we shall hereafter explain. Therefore this 19th order is an addition of an artificial and hyper-accurate nature.

Page 222

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

According to others, the limit of reckoning is koti ; and starting from koti the succession of the orders of numbers would be kofi, thousands, hundreds, tenths; for the number of Devas is expressed in kotis. Ac- cording to their belief there are thirty-three kotis of Devas, eleven of which belong to each of the three beings, Brahman, Narayana, and Mahadeva. The names of the orders beyond that of the 18th have been invented by the grammarians, as we have said already (p. 174). Further, we observe that the popular name of the 5th order is Dasa sahasra, that of the 7th order, Dasa laksha; for the two names which we have mentioned in the list above (Ayuta Prayuta) are rarely used. The book of Aryabhata of Kusumapura gives the following names of the orders from the ten till 10 coti :- Ayutam. Koti padma Niyutamn. Parapadma. Prayutam.

Further, it is noteworthy that some people establish a kind of etymological relationship between the dif- ferent names; so they call the 6th order Niyuta, ac- cording to the analogy of the 5th, which is called Ayuta. Further, they call the 8th order Arbuda, according to the analogy of the 9th, which is called Nyarbuda. There is a similar relation between Nikharva and Kharva, the names of the 12th and IIth orders, and between Sanku and Mahasanku, the names of the 13th and 14th orders. According to this analogy Maha- padma ought to follow immediately after Padma, but this latter is the name of the 1oth, the former the name of the 13th order. These are differences of theirs which can be traced back to certain reasons; but besides, there are many differences withont any reason, which simply arise

Page 223

CHAPTER XVI. 177

from people dictating these names without observing any fixed order, or from the fact that they hate to avow their ignorance by a frank I do not know,-a word which is difficult to them in any connection whatsoever. The Pulisa-siddhanta gives the following list of the orders of the numbers :--

  1. Snhasram. 8. Koti. 5. A yutatin. 9. Arbudam. 6. Niyntam. 10. Kharca. 7. Pruyutanit.

The following orders, from the 11th till the 18th, are the same as those of the above-mentioned list. The Hindus use the numeral signs in arithmetic in Numeral the same way as we do. I have composed a treatise notation.

showing how far, possibly, the Hindus are ahead of us in this subject. We have already explained that the Hindus compose their books in Slokas. If, now, they wish, in their astronomical handbooks, to express some numbers of the various orders, they express them by words used to denote certain numbers either in one order alone or at the same time in two orders (e.g. a word meaning either 20 or both 20 and 200). For each number they have appropriated quite a great quantity of words. Hence, if one word does not suit the metre, you may easily exchange it for a synonym which suits. Brahmagupta says: "If you want to write one, express it by everything which is unique, as the earth, the moon ; two by everything which is double, as, c.g. black and white ; three by everything which is threefold; the nought by heaven, the twelve by the names of the sun." I have nnited in the following table all the ex- pressions for the numbers which I used to hear from them; for the knowledge of these things is most essential for deciphering their astronomical handbooks. VOL. I. M

Page 224

178 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Whenever I shall come to know all the meanings of these words, I will add them, if God permits! Page

0 = Kanya and kha, both mean- sumudra, sâgara, i.e. the ing point. sea. gagana, i.e. heaven. rbdhi. viyat, i.c. heaven. dadhi. ikasn, i.e. heaven. dis, i.e. the four cardinal rmbura, i.e. heaven. points. abhra, i.e. heaven. jalasnya.

= ndi, i.e. the beginning. krita. Page 86

susin. 5 = m.

indu. artha.

śttâ. indriya, i.e. the five

urvarâ, dharani. senses.

pitamaha, i.e. the first sâyaka.

father. candra, i.c. the moon. اخون

sttamśu, i.e. the moon. rúpa. bhata.

ruśmi. ishu. Pandara, i.e. the five royal 2 = yama. brothers. uśvin. pattrin, marganu. raricandri. locana, i.e. the two eyes. 6 = rasa.

akshi. angu.

dusra. shat.

yumala. '(?) ie. the year. paksha, i.e. the two halves ritu (?). of a month. masnrdham. netra, i.c. the two eyes. 7 = ag. 3 = triknla, ic. the three parts mahidhar.

of time. parenta, i.c. the moun-

trijagat. tains.

trayam. suptan.

pâvaka, raisvanara, da- nuga, i.c. the mountains. hana, tupana, hutasana, udri.

jralana, agni, i.e. fire. muni.

[triguna,]i.e. the three first 8 = vasu, ashta. forces. dht, margalu. loku, i.e. the worlds, earth, yaja, nâga. heaven and hell. dantin.

trikaļu. 9 = go, chidru. nunda, paruna. 4 = veda, i.e. their sacred code, rundhra, antara. because it has four parts. navan = 9. Page 87

Page 225

CHAPTER XVI. 179

J0 = dis, khendu. 14 = mumx, the lords of the asa, Raruna-sirds. fourteen manvanturas.

II = Rudra, the destroyer of the 15 = tithi, i.e. the lunar days in world. each half month. Mahader, i.e. the prince 16 = «shti. nripa, bhapa. of the angels. 17 = utyashļi.

ticara. 18 = dhriti. Page 88. akshauhint, i.c. the army 19 = «tidhriti. Kuru had. 20 = nakha, kriti.

12 = surya, because there arc 21 = utkriti. 22= twelve suns. âditya. 23 =

urka, i.c. the sun. 24 =

masa, bhanu. 25 = tattra, i.c. the twenty-

sahuśraiśu. five things, through the knowledge of which lib- 13 = viśra. eration is obtained.

As far as I have seen and heard of the Hindus, they do not usually go beyond twenty-five with this kind of numerical notation. We shall now speak of certain strange manners and Strange customs of the Hindus. The strangeness of a thing andeustoms manners

evidently rests on the fact that it occurs but rarely, and of the Hindus. that we seldom have the opportunity of witnessing it. Page 89.

If such strangeness reaches a high degree, the thing becomes a curiosity, or even something like a miracle, which is no longer in accordance with the ordinary laws of nature, and which seems chimerical as long as it has not been witnessed. Many Hindu customs differ from those of our country and of our time to snch a degree as to appear to us simply monstrons. One might almost think that they had intentionally changed them into the opposite, for our customs do not resemble theirs, but are the very reverse; and if ever a custom of theirs resembles one of ours, it has certainly just the opposite meaning. They do not cut any of the hair of the body. Originally they went naked in consequence of the heat, and by not cutting the hair of the head they intended to pre- vent sunstroke.

Page 226

180 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

They divide the moustache into single plaits in order to preserve it. As regards their not cutting the hair of the genitals, they try to make people believe that the cutting of it incites to lust and increases carnal desire. Therefore such of them as feel a strong desire for cohabitation never cut the hair of the genitals. They let the nails grow long, glorying in their idlo- ness, since they do not use them for any business or work, but only, while living a dolce far nientc life, they scratch their heads with them and examine the hair for lice. The Hindus eat singly, one by one, on a tablecloth of dung. They do not make use of the remainder of a meal, and the plates from which they have eaten are thrown away if they are earthen. They have red teeth in consequence of chewing areca- nuts with betel-leaves and chalk. They drink wine before having eaten anything, then they take their meal. They sip the stall of cows, but they do not eat their meat. They beat the cymbals with a stick. They use turbans for trousers. Those who want little dress are content to dress in a rag of two fingers' breadth, which they bind over their loins with two cords; but those who like much dress, wear trousers lined with so much cotton as would suffice to make a number of counterpanes and saddle-rugs. These trousers have no (visible) openings, and they are so huge that the feet are not visible. The string by which the trousers are fastened is at the back. Their sidar (a piece of dress covering the head and the upper part of breast and neck) is similar to the trousers, being also fastened at the back by buttons. The lappets of the kurtakas (short shirts from the shoulders to the middle of the body with sleeves, a

Page 227

CHAPTER XVI.

female dress) have slashes both on the right and left sides. They keep the shoes tight till they begin to pnt them on. They are turned down from the calf before walking (?). In washing they begin with the feet, and then wash the face. They wash themselves before cohabiting with their wives. Ceunt stantes velut palus vitis, dum mulieres ab imo sursum morentur relut occupatce in arando, maritus vero planc otiosus manet. On festive days they besmear their bodies with dung instead of perfumes. The men wear articles of female dress; they use cosmetics, wear earrings, arm-rings, golden seal-rings on the ring-finger as well as on the toes of the feet. Miscret cos catamiti et riri qui rebus venereis frui non potest pushandila dicti, qui penem bucca devorans semen elieit sorbendum. In cacando faciem vertunt versus murum reteyentes pudenda ul videantur a pretereuntibus. Sacra faciunt virilibus linga dictis, quee est imago veretri Mahadera. They ride without a saddle, but if they put on a saddle, they mount the horse from its right side. In travelling they like to have somebody riding behind them. They fasten the kuthara, i.c. the dagger, at the waist on the right side. They wear a girdle called yajnopartta, passing from the left shoulder to the right side of the waist. In all consultations and emergencies they take the Page go. advice of the women. When a child is born people show particular atten- tion to the man, not to the woman. Of two children they give the preference to the younger, particularly in the eastern parts of the country;

Page 228

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

for they maintain that the elder owes his birth to pre- dominant lust, whilst the younger owes his origin to mature reflection and a calm proceeding. In shaking hands they grasp the hand of a man from the convex side. They do not ask permission to enter a house, but when they leave it they ask permission to do so. In their meetings they sit cross-legged. They spit out and blow their noses without any respect for the elder ones present, and they crack their lice before them. They consider the ercpitus ventris as a good omen, sneezing as a bad omen. They consider as unclean the weaver, but as clean the cupper and the flayer, who kills dying animals for money either by drowning or by burning. They use black tablets for the children in the schools, and write upon them along the long side, not the broad side, writing with a white m terial from the left to the right. One would think that the author of the follow- ing verses had meant the Hindus :-

"How many a writer uses paper as black as charcoal, Whilst his pen writes on it with white colour. By writing he places a bright day in a dark night, Weaving like a weaver, but without adding a woof."

They write the title of a book at the end of it, not at the beginning. They magnify the nouns of their language by giving them the feminine gender, as the Arabs magnify them by the diminntive form. If one of them hands over a thing to another, he expects that it should be thrown to him as we throw a thing to the dogs. If two men play at Nurd (backgammon), a third one throws the dice between them. They like the juice which flows over the cheeks of

Page 229

CHAPTER XVI.

the rutting elephant, which in reality has the most horrid smell. In playing chess they move the elephant straight on, On the not to the other sides, one square at a time, like the chess. Indian

pawn, and to the four corners also one square at a time, like the queen (firsan). They say that these five squares (i.e. the one straight forward and the others at the corners) are the places occupied by the trunk and the four feet of the elephant. They play chess-four persons at a time-with a pair of dice. Their arrangement of the figures on the chess-board is the following :-

Tower (ruk.h). Horse. Elephant. King. Pawn. Tower,

Pawn. Pawn. Pawn. Pawn. Pawn. lIorse.

Pawn, Elephant.

Pawn. King.

King. Pawn.

Elephant. Pawn.

Horse. Pawn. Pawn, Pawn. Pawn, Pawn.

Tower. Pawn. King. Eleph ant. Horse. Tower.

Page 230

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

As this kind of chess is not known among us, I shall here explain what I know of it. The four persons playing together sit so as to form a square round a chess-board, and throw the two dice alternately. Of the numbers of the dice the five and Page 91. six are blank (i.e. do not count as such). In that case, if the dice show five or six, the player takes one instead of the five, and four instead of the six, because the figures of these two numerals are drawn in the following manner :-

6 4 3 2

so as to exhibit a certain likeness of form to 4 and I, viz. in the Indian signs. The name Shah or king applies here to the queen (firzûn). Each number of the dice causes a move of one of the figures. The I moves either the pawn or the king. Their moves are the same as in the common chess. The king may be taken, but is not required to leave his place. The 2 moves the tower (rukh). It moves to the third square in the direction of the diagonal, as the elephant moves in our chess. The 3 moves the horse. Its move is the generally known one to the third square in oblique direction. The 4 moves the elephant. It moves in a straight line, as the tower does in our chess, unless it be pre- vented from moving on. If this is the case, as some- times happens, one of the dice removes the obstacle, and enables it to move on. Its smallest move is one square, the greatest fifteen squares, because the dice sometimes show two 4, or two 6, or a 4 and a 6. In consequence of one of these numbers, the elephant moves along the whole side of the margin on the chess- board; in consequence of the other number, it moves

Page 231

CHAPTER XVI.

along the other side on the other margin of the board, in case there is no impediment in its way. In con- sequence of these two numbers, the elephant, in the conrse of his moves, occupies the two ends of the diagonal. The pieces have certain valnes, according to which the player gets his share of the stake, for the pieces are taken and pass into the hands of the player. The value of the king is 5, that of the elephant 4, of the horse 3, of the tower 2, and of the pawn I. He who takes a king gets 5. For two kings he gets 10, for three kings 15, if the winner is no longer in possession of his own king. But if he has still his own king, and takes all three kings, he gets 54, a number which represents a pro- gression based on general consent, not on an algebraic principle. If the Hindus claim to differ from us, and to be The innate something better than we, as we on our side, of course, of the Hindu perversits

do vice versi, we might settle the question by an ex- character.

periment to be made with their boys. I never knew a Hindu boy who had only recently come into Muham- madan territory who was not thoroughly versed in the manners and customs of the people, but at the same time he would place the shoes before his master in a wrong order, the right one to the left foot, and vice cerst ; he wonld, in folding, turn his master's garments inside out, and spread the carpets so that the under part is uppermost, and more of the kind. All of which is a consequence of the innate perversity of the Hindu nature. However, I must not reproach the Hindus only with Customs of their heathen practices, for the heathen Arabs too com- Arabs. the heathen

mitted crimes and obscenities. They cohabited with menstrnating and pregnant women ; several men agreed to cohabit with the same woman in the same period of menstruation; they adopted the children of others, of their guests, of the lover of their danghter, not to men-

Page 232

186 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

tion that in some kinds of their worship they whistled on their fingers and clapped with their hands, and that they ate unclean and dead animals. Islam has abolished all those things among the Arabs, as it has also abolished them in those parts of India the people of which have become Muhammadans. Thanks be unto God!

Page 233

CHAPTER XVII.

ON HINDU SCIENCES WHICH PREY ON THE IGNORANCE OF PEOPLE.

We understand by witchcraft, making by some kind of On alchemy delusion a thing appear to the senses as something dif- Ilindus in among the

ferent from what it is in reality. Taken in this sense, general.

it is far spread among people. Understood, however, Page 92. as common people understand it, as the producing of something which is impossible, it is a thing which does not lie within the limits of reality. For as that which is impossible cannot be prodnced, the whole affair is nothing but a gross deception. Therefore witch- craft in this sense has nothing whatever to do with science. One of the species of witchcraft is alchemy, though it is generally not called by this name. But if a man takes a bit of cotton and makes it appear as a bit of gold, what would you call this but a piece of witch- craft? It is quite the same as if he were to take a bit of silver and make it appear as gold, onls with this difference, that the latter is a generally-known process, i.e. the gilding of silver, the former is not. The Hindns do not pay particular attention to al- chemy, but no nation is entirely free from it, and one nation has more bias for it than another, which must not be construed as proving intelligence or ignorance; for we find that many intelligent people are entirely given to alchemy, whilst ignorant people ridicule the art and its adepts. Those intelligent people, though

Page 234

188 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

boisterously exulting over their make-believe science, are not to be blamed for occupying themselves with alchemy, for their motive is simply excessive eagerness for acquiring fortune and foravoiding misfortune. Once a sage was asked why scholars always flock to the doors of the rich, whilst the rich are not inclined to call at the doors of scholars. "The scholars," he answered, "are well aware of the use of money, but the rich are ignorant of the nobility of science." On the other hand, ignorant people are not to be praised, although they behave quite quietly, simply because they abstain from alchemy, for their motives are objectionable ones, rather practical results of innate ignorance and stupidity than anything else. The adepts in this art try to keep it concealed, and shrink back from intercourse with those who do not belong to them. Therefore I have not been able to learn from the Hindus which methods they follow in this science, and what element they principally use, whether a mineral or an animal or a vegetable one. I only heard them speaking of the process of sublimation, of calcination, of unalysis, and of the wrxing of tale, which they call in their language talaka, and so I guess that they incline towards the mineralogical method of alchemy.

The science They have a science similar to alchemy which is of Rasâyana. quite peculiar to them. They call it Rasayana, a word composed with rast, i.e. gold. It means an art which is restricted to certain operations, drugs, and compound medicines, most of which are taken from plants. Its principles restore the health of those who were ill beyond hope, and give back youth to fading old age, so that people become again what they were in the age near puberty; white hair becomes black again, the keenness of the senses is restored as well as the capa- city for juvenile agility, and even for cohabitation, and the life of people in this world is even extended to a

Page 235

CHAPTER XVII.

long period. And why not? Have we not already mentioned on the anthority of P'atañjali (v. p. SS) that one of the methods leading to liberation is Rasâyana ? What man would hear this, being inclined to take it for truth, and not dart off into foolish joy and not honour the master of such a wonderful art by popping the choicest bit of his meal into his mouth ? A famous representative of this art was Nagarjuna, a Nagarjuna, native of the fort Daihak, near Somanath. He excelled of a bouk on the anthor

in it, and composed a book which contains the sub- Rasâyana.

stance of the whole literature on this subject, and is very rare. He lived nearly a hundred years before our time. In the time of the King Vikramâditya, of whose era Page 93. we shall speak hereafter, there lived in the city of Ujain a man of the name of Vyadi, who had turned The alche- his whole attention to this science, and had ruined on in the time mist Vyâdi

account of it both his life and property, but all his ramâditya. of King Vik-

zeal did not even avail him so much as to help him to things which, under ordinary circumstances, are easily obtained. Becoming restricted in his means, he con- ceived a disgnst to that which had been the object of all his exertions, and sat down on the bank of a river sighing, sorrowful, and despairing. He held in his hand his pharmacopiia, from which he used to take the prescriptions for his medicines, but now he began to throw one leaf of it after the other into the water. A harlot happened to sit on the bank of the same river farther down, who, on seeing the leaves pass by, gathered them, and fished up some relating to Rasa- yana. Vyâdi did not notice her till all the leaves of his book had gone. Then the woman came to him, asking why he had done so with his book, whereupon he answered, " Because I have derived no advantage from it. I have not obtained what I ought to have obtained ; for its sake I have become bankrupt after having had great treasures, and now I am miserable

Page 236

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

after having so long been in the hope of obtaining hap- piness." The harlot spoke: " Do not give up a pursuit in which you have spent your life ; do not despair of the possibility of a thing which all sages before you have shown to be true. Perhaps the obstacle which prevents you from realising your plans is only of an accidental nature, which may perhaps be removed by an accident. I have much solid cash. It is all yours that yon may spend it on the realisation of your plans." Thereupon Vyâdi resumed his work. However, books of this kind are written in an enigmatic style. So he happened to misunderstand a word in the prescription of a medicine, which meant oil and human blood, both being required for it. It was written raktamala, and he thought it meant red myrobalanon. When he used the medicine it had no effect whatsoever. Now he began to concoct the various drugs, but the flame touched his head and dried up his brain. Therefore he oiled himself with oil, pouring it in great quantity over his skull. One day he rose to step away from the fireplace for some business or other, but as there happened to be a peg projecting from the roof right above his head, he knocked his head against it, and the blood began to flow. On account of the pain which he felt, he looked downward, and in consequence some drops of blood mixed with oil dropped from the upper part of his skull into the caldron without his noticing it. When, then, the concocting process was finished and he and his wife besmeared themselves with the concoction in order to try it, they both flew up into the air. Vikramaditya on hearing of this affair left his castle, and proceeded to the market-place in order to see them with his own eyes. Then the man shonted to him, " Open thy mouth for my saliva." The king, however, being disgusted, did not do it, and so the saliva fell down near the door, and immediately the threshold was filled with gold.

Page 237

CHIPTER XVII.

Vyadi and the woman flew to any place they liked. He has composed famous books on this science. People say that both man and wife are still alive. A similar tale is the following :- In the city of story about Dhara, the capital of Malava, which is in our days ruled silver in the the piece of

by Bhojadeva, there lies in the door of the Government- Govern- door of the

house an oblong piece of pure silver, in which the out- in Dhâra. ment-house

lines of the limbs of a man are visible. Its origin is accounted for by the following story :- Once in olden times a man went to a king of theirs, bringing him a Rasayana, the use of which would make him immortal, victorious, invincible, and capable of doing everything he desired. He asked the king to come alone to the Page 94. place of their meeting, and the king gave orders to keep in readiness all the man required. The man began to boil the oil for several days, until at last it acquired consistency. Then he spoke to the king : "Spring into it and I shall finish the process." But the king, terrified at what he saw, had not the courage to dive into it. The man, on perceiving his cowardice, spoke to him: "If you have not sufficient courage, and will not do it for yourself, will you allow me myself to do it?" Whereupon the king answered, " Do as you like." Now he produced several packets of drugs, and instructed him that when such and such symptoms should appear, he should throw upon him this or that packet. Then the man stepped forward to the caldron and threw himself into it, and at once he was dissolved and reduced into pulp. Now the king proceeded according to his instruction, but when he had nearly finished the process, and there remained only one packet that was not yet thrown into the mass, he began to be anxious, and to think what might happen to his realm, in case the man should return to life as an immortal, rictorious, inrincible person, as has abore been mentioned. And so he thought it preferable not to throw the last packet into the mass. The consequence

Page 238

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

was that the caldron became cold, and the dissolved man became consolidated in the shape of the said piece of silver. The Hindus tell a tale about Vallabha, the king of the sity of Vallabhi, whose era we have mentioned in the proper chapter. Story of the A man of the rank of a Siddha asked a herdsman fruit-seller Ranka and with reference to a plant called Thohar, of the species of the king Vallabha. the Lactaria, from which milk flows when they are torn off, whether he had ever seen Lactaria from which blood flows instead of milk. When the herdsman declared he had, he gave him some drink-money that he should show it to him, which he did. When the man now saw the plant, he set fire to it, and threw the dog of the herdsman into the flame. Enraged thereby, the herdsman caught the man, and did with him the same as he had done to his dog. Then he waited till the fire was extinguished, and found both the man and the dog, but turned into gold. He took the dog with him, but left the man on the spot. Now some peasant happened to find it. He cut off a finger, and went to a fruit-seller who was called Ranka, i.e. the poor, because he was an utter pauper, and evidently near bankruptcy. After the peasant had bought from him what he wanted, he returned to the golden man, and then he fonnd that in the place where the cut off finger had been, a new finger had grown. He cut it off a second time, and bought again from the same fruit-seller all that he wanted. But when the fruit-seller asked him whence he had the finger, he was stupid enough to tell him. So Ranka went out to the body of the Siddha, and brought it on a carriage to his house. He stayed in his old abode, but managed by degrees to buy the whole town. The king Vallabha desired to own the same town, and asked him to cede it to him for money, but Ranka declined. Being how- ever afraid of the king's resentment, he fled to the lord

Page 239

CHAPTER XVII. 193

of Almansura, made him presents of money, and asked him to help him by a naval force. The lord of Alman- sûra complied with his desire, and assisted him. So he made a night-attack upon the king Vallabha, and killed him and his people, and destroyed his town. Pele say that still in our time there are such traces ieft in that country as are found in places which were de- stroyed by an unexpected night-attack. The greediness of the ignorant Hindu princes for gold-making does not know any limit. If any one of them wanted to carry out a scheme of gold-making, and people advised him to kill a number of fine little children, the monster would not refrain from such a crime; he would throw them into the fire. If this precious science of Rasayana were banished to the ntmost limits of the world, where it is unattainable to anybody, it would be the best. According to the Eranian tradition, Isfandiyad is said An Eranian to have spoken when dying: " Kaus had been given the Page 9 ;. tradition.

power and the miraculous things mentioned in the Book of the Law. Finally he went to the mountain Kaf as a decrepit man, bent down by old age, but he returned thence as a lively youth of well-proportioned figure and full of force, haring made the clouds his carriage, as God allowed him." As regards charms and incantations, the Hindus have On the lird a firm belief in them, and they, as a rule, are much in- Guuda.

clined towards them. The book which treats of those things is considered as a work of Garuda, a bird on which Narayana rode. Some people describe this bird in such a way as to indicate a Sifrid-bird and its doings. It is an enemy of fish, catching them. As a rule, animals have by nature an aversion to their opponents, and try to beware of them ; here, however, there is an exception to this rule. For when this bird flutters above the water and swims on it, the fish rise from the VOL. I. N

Page 240

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

deep to the surface, and make it easy to him to catch them, as if he had bound them by his spell. Others describe it with such characteristics as might indi- cate a stork. The Vâyu Purâna attributes to it a pale colour. On the whole, Garuda comes nearer to a stork than to a Sifrid, as the stork is by nature, like Garuda, a destroyer of snakes. The effect of Most of their charms are intended for those who have charmis on the bite of been bitten by serpents. 'Their excessive confidence in serpents. them is shown by this, which I heard a man say, that he had seen a dead man who had died from the bite of a serpent, but after the charm had been applied he had been restored to life, and remained alive, moving about like all others. Another man I heard as he told the following story : "He had seen a man who had died from the bite of a serpent. A charm was applied, and in consequence he rose, spoke, made his will, showed where he had de- posited his treasures, and gave all necessary information about them. But when he inhaled the smell of a dish, he fell down dead, life being completely extinct." It is a Hindu custom that when a man has been bitten by a venomous serpent, and they have no charmer at hand, they bind the bitten man on a bundle of reeds, and place on him a leaf on which is written a blessing for that person who will accidentally light upon him, and save him by a charm from destruction. I, for my part, do not know what I am to say about these things, since I do not believe in them. Once a man who had very little belief in reality, and much less in the tricks of jugglers, told me that he had been poisoned, and that people had sent him some Hindus possessing the knowledge of charms. They sang their charms before him, and this had a quieting effect upon him, and soon he felt that he became better and better, whilst they were drawing lines in the air with their hands and with twigs.

Page 241

CHAPTER XVII. 195

I myself have witnessed that in hunting gazelles they Hunting caught them with the hand. One Hindu even went so practices.

far as to assert that he, without catching the gazelle, would drive it before him and lead it straight into the kitchen. This, however, rests, as I believe I have found ont, simply on the device of slowly and constantly accustoming the animals to one and the same melody. Our people, too, practise the same when hunting the ibex, which is more wild even than the gazelle. When they see the animals resting, they begin to walk round them in a circle, singing one and the same melody so long until the animals are accustomed to it. Then they make the circle more and more narrow, till at last they come near enough to shoot at the animals which lie there in perfect rest. The shooters of Kata-birds have a custom of beating copper-vessels during the night with one and the same kind of beat, and they manage to catch them with the hand. If, however, the beat is changed, the birds fly off in all directions. All these things are peculiar customs which have nothing whatsoever to do with charms. Sometimes the Page 96. Hindus are considered as sorcerers because of their plaring with balls on raised beams or on tight ropes, but tricks of this kind are common to all nations.

Page 242

CHAPTER XVII.

VARIOUS NOTES ON THEIR COUNTRY, THEIR RIVERS, AND THEIR OCEAN. ITINERARIES OF THE DISTANCES BE- TWEEN THEIR SEVERAL KINGDOMS, AND BETWEEN THE BOUNDARIES OF THEIR COUNTRY.

The inhabit- THE reader is to imagine the inhabitable world, able world and the olkovuery, as lying in the northern half of the earth, .ce:Mnl. and more accurately in one-half of this half-i.e. in one of the quarters of the earth. It is surrounded by a sea, which both in west and east is called the compre- hending one; the Greeks call its western part near their country dkeavos. This sea separates the inhabitable world from whatever continents or inhabitable islands there may be beyond it, both towards west and east; for it is not navigable on account of the darkness of the air and the thickness of the water, because there is no more any road to be traced, and because the risk is enormous, whilst the profit is nothing. Therefore people of olden times have fixed marks both on the sea and its shores which are intended to deter from enter- ing it. The inhabitable world does not reach the north on account of the cold, except in certain places where it penetrates into the north in the shape, as it were, of tongues and bays. In the south it reaches as far as the coast of the ocean, which in west and east is con- nected with the comprchending occan. This southern ocean is navigable. It does not form the utmost southern limit of the inhabitable world. On the con-

Page 243

CHAPTER XVIII. I97

trary, the latter stretches still more southward in the shape of large and small islands which fill the ocean. In this southern region land and water dispute with each other their position, so that in one place the con- tinent protrudes into the sea, whilst in another the sea penetrates deeply into the continent. The continent protrudes far into the sea in the west- ern half of the earth, and extends its shores far into the south. On the plains of this continent live the western negroes, whence the slaves are brought; and there are the Mountains of the Moon, and on them are the sources of the Nile. On its coast, and the islands before the coast, live the varions tribes of the Zanj. There are several bays or gulfs which penetrate into the continent on this western half of the earth-the bay of Berbera, that of Klysma (the Red Sea), and that of Persia (the Persian Gulf); and between these gulfs the western continent protrudes more or less into the ocean. In the eastern half of the earth the sea penetrates as deeply into the northern continent as the continent in the western half protrudes into the sonthern sea, and in many places it has formed bays and estuaries which run far into the continent-bays being parts of the sea, estnaries being the outlets of rivers towards the sea. This sea is mostly called from some island in it or from the coast which borders it. Here, however, we are concerned only with that part of the sea which is bordered by the continent of India, and therefore is called the Indian Occan. As to the orographic configuration of the inhabitable The orogra- world, imagine a range of towering mountains like the of Asia and phic system

vertebræ of a pine stretching through the middle lati- Europe.

tude of the earth, and in longitude from east to west, passing through China, Tibet, the country of the Turks, Kabul, Badhakhshân, Tokharistân, Bamiyan, Elghôr, Khurasan, Media, Adharbaijan, Armenia, the Roman

Page 244

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Empire, the country of the Franks, and of the Jalaliķa (Gallicians). Long as this range is, it has also a con- siderable breadth, and, besides, many windings which enclose inhabited plains watered by streams which descend from the mountains both towards north and south. One of these plains is India, limited in the south by the above-mentioned Indian Ocean, and on Page 97. all three other sides by the lofty mountains, the waters of which flow down to it. But if you have seen the India, a re- soil of India with your own eyes and meditate on its cent alluvial formation. nature-if you consider the rounded stones found in the earth however deeply you dig, stones that are huge near the mountains and where the rivers have a violent current; stones that are of smaller size at greater dis- tance from the mountains, and where the streams flow more slowly; stones that appear pulverised in the shape of sand where the streams begin to stagnate near their mouths and near the sea-if you consider all this, you could scarcely help thinking that India has once been a sea which by degrees has been filled up by the allu- vium of the streams. First orien The middle of India is the country round Kanoj garding Ma- (Kanauj), which they call Madhyadesa, i.c. the middle tation re- dhyadesa, Kanoj, of the realms. It is the middle or centre from a geo- Mahura, and Taneshar. graphical point of view, in so far as it lies half way be- tween the sea and the mountains, in the midst between the hot and the cold provinces, and also between the eastern and western frontiers of India. But it is a political centre too, because in former times it was the residence of their most famous heroes and kings. The country of Sindh lies to the west of Kanoj. In marching from our country to Sindh we start from the country of Nimroz, i.c. the country of Sijistan, whilst marching to Hind or India proper we start from the side of Kabul. This, however, is not the only possible road. You may march into India from all sides, sup- posing that you can remove the obstacles in the way.

Page 245

CHAPTER XVIII. 199

In the mountains which form the frontier of India towards the west there are tribes of the Hindus, or of people near akin to them-rebellious savage races- which extend as far as the farthermost frontiers of the Hindu race. Kanoj lies to the west of the Ganges, a very large town, but miost of it is now in ruins and desolate since the capital has been transferred thence to the city of Bari, east of the Ganges. Between the two towns there is a distance of three to four days' marches. As Kanoj (Kanyalubja) has become famous by the children of Pandu, the city of Mahura (Mathura) has become famous by Vasudeva. It lies east of the river Jaun (Yamuna). The distance between Mahura and Kanoj is 23 farsakh. Taneshar (Sthanesvara) lies between the two rivers to the north both of Kanoj and Mahura, at a distance of nearly So farsakh from Kanoj, and nearly 50 farsakh from Mahura. The river Ganges rises in the mountains which have already been mentioned. Its source is called Ganga- dvara. Most of the other rivers of the country also rise in the same mountains, as we have already mentioned in the proper place. As for the distances between the varions parts of Hindu India, those who have not themselves actually seen determining methed of

them must rely upon tradition ; but unfortunately it is distances.

of such a nature that already Ptolemy incessantly com- plains of its transmitters and their bias towards story- telling. Fortunately I have found out a certain rule by which to control their lies. The Hindus frequently estimate the burden an ox could bear at 2000 and 3000 mana (which is infinitely more than an ox could carry at once). In consequence they are compelled to let the caravan make the same march to and fro during many days-in fact, so long until the ox has carried the whole load assigned to it from one end of the route to

Page 246

200 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

the other, and then they reckon as the distance between the two places a march of such a number of days as the caravan has altogether spent in marching to and fro. It is only with the greatest exertion and caution that we can to some extent correct the statements of the Hindus. However, we could not make up our mind to suppress that which we know on account of that which we do not know. We ask the reader's pardon where there is anything wrong, and now we continue. From A man marching from Kanoj to the south between Kathnj to the Tree of the two rivers Jaun and Ganges passes the following Prayâga (Allahabad) well-known places :- Jajjaman, 12 farsakh from Kanoj, and to the eastern each farsakh being equal to four miles or one kuroh; coast. Page 98 Abhapurt, 8 farsakh; Kuraha, 8 farsakh ; Barhamshil, 8 farsakh; the Tree of Prayaga, 12 farsakh, the place where the water of the Jaun joins the Ganges, where the Hindus torment themselves with various kinds of tortures, which are described in the books about religious sects. The distance from Prayaga to the place where the Ganges flows into the sea is 12 farsakh (sic). Other tracts of country extend from the Tree of Prayaga south ward towards the coast. Arku-tirtha, 12 farsalh from Prayaga; the realm Vwaryahar, 40 far- salh; Urdabishar on the coast, 50 farsalh. Thence along the coast towards the east there are countries which are now under the sway of Jaur; first Daraur, 40 farsakh from Urdabishau; Kanjt, 30 far- sakh ; Malaya, 40 farsakh ; Kunk, 30 farsakh, which is the last of Jaur's possessions in this direction. From Bâri Marching from Bari along the Ganges on its eastern to the menth of side, you pass the following stations :- Ajodaha (Ayo- the Ganges. dhya, Oudh), 25 farsalh from Bari; the famous Bandt- rasi, 20 farsakh. Thence changing the direction, and marching east- ward instead of southward, you come to Sharucar, 35 farsakh from Banarasi; Pâtaliputra, 20 farsakh; Mungirt, 15 farsakh ; Junpa, 30 farsakh; Dugumpur,

Page 247

CHAPTER XVIII. 201

50 farsakh ; Gangasayara, 30 farsalh, where the Ganges flows into the sea. Marching from Kanoj towards the east, you come to Kanoj Bart, 10 farsalh ; Dugum, 45 farsakh ; the empire through Nepal to of Shilahat, IO fursakh ; the town Bihat, 12 farsakh. Bhoteshar.

Farther on the country to the right is called Tilwat, the inhabitants Taru, people of very black colour and flat-nosed like the Turks. Thence you come to the mountains of Kamru, which stretch away as far as the sea. Opposite Tilwat the country to the left is the realm of Naipal. A man who had travelled in those countries gave me the following report :- " When in Tanwat, he left the easterly direction and turned to the left. He marched to Naipal, a distance of 20 farsakh, most of which wras ascending country. From Naipal he came to Bhôteshar in thirty days, a distance of nearly 80 farsakh, in which there is more ascending than descend- ing country. And there is a water which is several times crossed on bridges consisting of planks tied with cords to two canes, which stretch from rock to rock, and are fastened to milestones constructed on either side. People carry the burdens on their shoulders over such a bridge, whilst below, at a depth of 100 yards, the water foams as white as snow, threatening to shatter the rocks. On the other side of the bridges, the burdens are trans- ported on the back of goats. My reporter told me that he had there seen gazelles with four eyes; that this was not an accidental misformation of nature, but that the whole species was of this nature. " Bhoteshar is the first frontier of Tibet. There the language changes as well as the costumes and the anthropological character of the people. Thence the distance to the top of the highest peak is 20 farsalth. From the height of this mountain, India appears as a black expanse below the mist, the mountains lying below this peak like small hills, and Tibet and Cbina

Page 248

202 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

appear as red. The descent towards Tibet and China is less than one farsakh." From Kanoj Marching from Kanoj towards the south-east, on the to Banavâs. western side of the Ganges, you come to the realm of Page 99. Jajahuti, 30 farsakh from Kanoj. The capital of the country is Kajuraha. Between this town and Kanoj there are two of the most famons fortresses of India, Gwaliyar (Gwalior) and Kalanjar. Dahala [-farsakh], a country the capital of which is Tiauri, and the ruler of which is now Gangeya. The realm of Kannakara, 20 fursakh. Apsur, Bana- vas, on the sea-coast. From Kanoj Marching from Kanoj towards the south-west, you to Bazana. come to Ast, 18 farsakh from Kanoj; Sahanya, 17 far- sakh ; Jandra, 18 farsakh; Rajauri, 15 farsakh; Bazana, the capital of Guzarat, 20 farsakh. This town is called Narayan by our people. After it had fallen into decay the inhabitants migrated to another place called Jadûra (?). From Ma- The distance between Mahura and Kanoj is the same húra to Dhâ. as that between Kanoj and Bazana, viz. 28 farsakh. If a man travels from Mahura to Ujain, he passes through villages which are only five farsukh and less dis- tant from each other. At the end of a march of 35 far- sakh, he comes to a large village called Dudahi ; thence to Bamahar, 17 farsakh from Dudahi; Bhailsan, 5 far- sakh, a place most famous among the Hindus. The name of the town is identical with that of the idol wor- shipped there. Thence to Ardin, 9 farsakh. The idol worshipped there is called Mahakala. Dhar, 7 farsakh. From Ba- Marching from Bazana southward, you come to Mai- zâna to Mandagir. war, 25 farsukh from Bazana. This is a kingdom the capital of which is Jattaraur. From this town to Malava and its capital, Dhar, the distance is 20 farsakh. The city of Ujain lies 7 farsakh to the east of Dhar. From Ujain to Bhailasân, which likewise belongs to Malava, the distance is I0 farsukh.

Page 249

CHAPTER XVIII. 203

Marching from Dhar southward, you come to Bhatmi- hara, 20 farsalth from Dhar; Kand, 20 farsalh ; Nama- wur, on the banks of the Narmada (Nerbudda), 10 farsakh ; Alispar, 20 farsakh ; Mandagir, on the banks of the river Godavar, 60 fursakh. Again marching from Dhar southward, yon come to From Dhar the valley of Namiyya, 7 farsakh from Dhar; Mahratta- to Tana. Desh, 18 farsakh; the province of Kunkan, and its capital, Tana, on the sea-coast, 25 farsakh. People relate that in the plains of Kunkan, called Notes about Danak, there lives an animal called sharara (Skr. various ani- mals of sarabha). It has four feet, but also on the back it has India.

something like four feet directed upwards. It has a small proboscis, but two big horns with which it attacks the elephant and cleaves it in two. It has the shape of a buffalo, but is larger than a ganda (rhinoceros). According to popular tales, it sometimes rams some animal with its horns, raises it or part of it towards its back, so that it comes to lie between its upper feet. There it becomes a putrid mass of worms, which work their way into the back of the animal. In consequence it continually rubs itself against the trees, and finally it perishes. Of the same animal people relate that sometimes, when hearing the thunder, it takes it to be the voice of some animal. Immediately it proceeds to attack this imaginary foe; in pursuing him it climbs up to the top of the mountain-peaks, and thence leaps towards him. Of course, it plunges into the depth and is dashed to pieces. The ganda exists in large numbers in India, more particularly about the Ganges. It is of the build of a buffalo, has a black scaly skin, and dewlaps hanging down under the chin. It has three yellow hoofs on each foot, the biggest one forward, the others on both sides. The tail is not long; the eyes lie low, farther down the cheek than is the case with all other animals. On the top of the nose there is a single horn which is

Page 250

204 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Page 100. bent upwards. The Brahmins have the privilege of eating the flesh of the ganda. Thave myself witnessed how an elephant coming across a young ganda was attacked by it. The ganda wounded with its horn a forefoot of the elephant, and threw it down on its face. I thought that the ganda was the rhinoceros (or karkadann), but a man who had visited Snfala, in the country of the Negroes, told me that the kark, which the Negroes call impila, the horn of which furnishes the material for the handles of our knives, comes nearer this description than the rhinoceros. It has various colours. On the skull it has a conical horn, broad at the root, but not very high. The shaft of the horn (lit. its arrow) is black inside, and white everywhere else. On the front it has a second and longer horn of the same description, which becomes erect as soon as the animal wants to ram with it. It sharpens this horn against the rocks, so that it cuts and pierces. It has hoofs, and a hairy tail like the tail of an ass. There are crocodiles in the rivers of India as in the Nile, a fact which led simple Aljahiz, in his ignorance of the courses of the rivers and the configuration of the ocean, to think that the river of Muhran (the river Sindh) was a branch of the Nile. Besides, there are other marvellous animals in the rivers of India of the crocodile tribe, makara, curious kinds of fishes, and an animal like a leather-bag, which appears to the ships and plays in swimming. It is called burlu (porpoise ?). I suppose it to be the dolphin or a kind of dolphin. People say that it has a hole on the head for taking breath like the dolphin. In the rivers of Southern India there is an animal called by various names, grâha, jalatantu, and tandua. It is thin, but very long. People say it spies and lies in wait for those who enter the water and stand in it, whether men or animals, and at once attacks them. First it circles round the prey at some distance, until

Page 251

CHAPTER XVIII. 205

its length comes to an end. Then it draws itself together, and winds itself like a knot round the feet of the prey, which is thus thrown off its legs and perishes. A man who had seen the animal told me that it has the head of a dog, and a tail to which there are attached many long tentacles, which it winds round the prey, in case the latter is not weary enough. By means of these feelers it drags the prey towards the tail itself, and when once firmly encircled by the tail the animal is lost. After this digression we return to our subject. Marching from Bazana towards the south-west, you Fromn Ba- come to Anhilvara, 60 farsakh from Bazana; Soma- Somanath. zâna to

nath, on the sea-coast, 50 fursakh. Marching from Anhilvara southward, you come to From Aubil- Lardesh, to the two capitals of the conntry, Bihroj and muâni. våra to Lo-

Rihanjur, 42 fursakh from Anhilvara. Both are on the sea-coast to the east of Tâna. Marching from Bazana towards the west, you come to Ma tan, 50 farsakh from Bazana; Bhatt, 15 farsakh. Marching from Bhati towards the sonth-west, you come to Aror, 15 farsakh from Bhati, a township be- tween two arms of the Sindh River ; Bamhanui Alman- sura, 20 farsakh; Loharanf, at the mouth of the Sindh River, 30 farsakh. Marchiug from Kanoj towards the north-north-west, From Kanoj you come to Shirsharaha, 50 farsalh from Kanoj; to Kashmir.

Pinjaur, IS farsalh, situated on the mountains, whilst opposite it in the plain there lies the city of Tanêshar; Dahmala, the capital of Jalandhar, at the foot of the mountains, IS farsakh; Ballawar, 10 fursakh; thence marching westward, you come to Ladda, 13 fursalh; the fortress Rajagiri, S fursakh ; thence marching north- ward, you come to Kashmir, 25 farsakh. Marching from Kanoj towards the west, you come From Kanoj to Diyamau, 10 fursalh from Kanoj; Kutt, 10 forsakh ; Page tor. to Ghazna. AAnar, 10 fursalth ; Mirat, 10 fursakh ; Panipal, 10

Page 252

206 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

farsakh. Between the latter two places flows the river Jaun ; Kauital, 10 fursakh ; Sunnam, 10 farsakh. Thence marching towards the north-west, you come to Adittahaur, 9 farsakh ; Jujjanir, 6 farsakh ; Manda- hîthatr, the capital of Lauhawur, east of the river Irawa, 8 farsakh; the river Candraha, 12 farsakh; the river Juilam, west of the river Biyatta, 8 fursakh ; Waihind, the capital of Kandhar, west of the river Sindh, 20 farsalh ; Purshawar, 14 farsakh; Dunpar, 15 farsakh ; Kabul, 12 farsakh ; Ghacna, 17 farsakh. Notes about Kashmir lies on a plateau surrounded by high inac- Kashmir. cessible mountains. The south and east of the country belong to the Hindus, the west to various kings, the Bolar-Shah and the Shuguan-Shah, and the more remote parts up to the frontiers of Badhakhshan, to the Wakhân- Shah. The north and part of the east of the country belong to the Turks of Khoten and Tibet. The distance from the peak of Bhoteshar to Kashmir through Tibet amounts to nearly 300 farsakh. The inhabitants of Kashmir are pedestrians, they have no riding animals nor elephants. The noble among them ride in palankins called katt, carried on the shoulders of men. They are particularly anxious about the natural strength of their country, and there- fore take always much care to keep a strong hold upon the entrances and roads leading into it. In consequence it is very difficult to have any commerce with them. In former times they used to allow one or two foreigners to enter their country, particularly Jews, but at present they do not allow any Hindu whom they do not know personally to enter, much less other people. The best known entrance to Kashmir is from the town Babrahan, half way between the rivers Sindh and Jailam. Thence to the bridge over the river, where the water of the Kusnari is joined by that of the Mahwî, both of which come from the mountains of Shamilan, and fall into the Jailam, the distance is 8 farsakh.

Page 253

CHAPTER XVIII.

Thence yon reach in five days the beginning of the ravine whence the river Jailam comes; at the other end of this ravine is the watch-station Drar, on both sides of the river Jailam. Thence, leaving the ravine, yon enter the plain, and reach in two more days Addishtan, the capital of Kashmir, passing on the road the village Ushkâra, which lies on both sides of the valley, in the same manner as Baramûla. The city of Kashmir covers a space of four farsalh, being built along both banks of the river Jailam, which are connected with each other by bridges and ferry- boats. The Jailam rises in the mountains Haramakot, where also the Ganges rises, cold, impenetrable regions where the snow never melts nor disappears. Behind them there is Mahactn, i.c. Great China. When the Jailam has left the monntains, and has flowed two days' journey, it passes throngh Addishtan. Four far- sakh farther on it enters a swamp of one square fursukh. The people have their plantations on the borders of this swamp, and on such parts of it as they manage to reclaim. Leaving this swamp, the Jailam passes the town Ushkara, and then enters the above-mentioned ravine. The river Sindh rises in the mountains Unang in the The upper territory of the Turks, which you can reach in the the sindh course of

following way :- Leaving the ravine by which you the north niver and

enter Kashmir and entering the plateau, then you have and north- west fron- for a march of two more days on your left the mountains India. tiers of

of Bolor and Shamilan, Turkish tribes who are called Bhattararyan. Their king has the title Bhatta-Shab. Their towns are Gilgit, Aswira, and Shiltas, and their language is the Turkish. Kashmir suffers much from their inroads. Marching on the left side of the river, yon always pass through cultivated ground and reach Page 102. the capital; marching on the right side, you pass through villages, one close to the other, sonth of the capital, and thence you reach the mountain Kularjak,

Page 254

208 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

which is like a cupola, similar to the mountain Dun- bawand. The snow there never melts. It is always visible from the region of Takeshar and Lauhawar (Lahore). The distance between this peak and the plateau of Kashmir is two farsakh. The fortress Raja- girî lies sonth of it, and the fortress Lahûr west of it, the two strongest places I have ever seen. The town Rajawari is three farsakh distant from the peak. This is the farthest place to which our merchants trade, and beyond which they never pass. This is the frontier of India from the north. In the western frontier mountains of Indiathere live various tribes of the Afghans, and extend np to the neighbourhood of the Sindh Valley. The west- The southern frontier of India is formed by the ern and southern ocean. The coast of India begins with Tiz, the capital of frontiers of India. Makran, and extends thence in a sonth-eastern direction towards the region of Al-daibal, over a distance of 40 farsakh. Between the two places lies the Gulf of Tûrân. A gulf is like an angle or a winding line of water penetrating from the ocean into the continent, and is dangerons for navigation, specially on acconnt of ebb and flood. An estuary is something similar to a gulf, bnt is not formed by the ocean's penetrating into the continent. It is formed by an expanse of flowing water, which there is changed into standing water and is connected with the ocean. These estnaries, too, are dangerous for the ships, becanse the water is sweet and does not bear heavy bodies as well as salt water does. After the above-mentioned gulf follow the small Munha, the great Munha, then the Bawarij, i.c. the pirates of Kacch and Somanath. They are thus called because they commit their robberies on sea in ships called bira. The places on the coast are :- Tawalleshar, 50 farsakh from Daibal; Loharani, 12 farsakh ; Baga, 12 farsakh ; Kacch, where the mukl-tree grows, and Buroi, 6 farsakh; Somanath, 14 farsakh; Kanbayat,

Page 255

CHAPTER XVIII.

30 farsakh; Asawil, 2 days; Bihrôj, 30 farsakh (?) ; Sandan, 50 fursakh ; Subara, 6 farsakh; Tana, 5 farsalh. Thence the coast-line comes to the country Laran, in which lies the city of Jimtr, then to Vallabha, Kanji, Darvad. Next follows a great bay in which Singaldib lies, i.e. the island Sarandib (Ceylon). Round the bay lies the city of Panjayavur (sic). When this city had fallen into rnins, the king, Jaur, built instead of it, on the coast towards the west, a new city which he called Padnar. The next place on the coast is Ummalnara, then Râm- sher (Rameshar ?) opposite Sarandib; the distance of the sea between them is 12 farsakh. The distance from Panjayavar to Ramsher is 40 farsakh, that between Râm- sher and Setubandha 2 farsakh. Setubandha means bridye of the occan. It is the dike of Rama, the son of Daśaratha, which he built fromthe continent to the castle Lankâ. At present it consists of isolated mountains between which the ocean flows. Sixteen farsakh from Setnbandha towards the east is Kihlind, the mountains of the monkeys. Every day the king of the monkeys comes out of the thicket together with his hosts, and settles down in particular seats prepared for them. The inhabitants of that region prepare for them cooked rice, and bring it to them on leaves. After having eaten it they return into the thicket, but in case they are neglected, this would be the ruin of the country, as they are not only numerous, but also savage and aggres- sive. According to the popular belief, they are a race of men changed into monkeys on account of the help which they had afforded to Rama when making war against the demons; he is believed to have bequeathed those villages to them as a legacy. When a man happens to fall in with them, and he recites to them the poetry of Rama and pronounces the incantations of Rama, they will quietly listen to him ; they will even VOL. I. 0

Page 256

210 XALBERUNIS INDIA.

lead on the right path him who has gone astray and give him meat and drink. At all events, thus the matter stands according to popular belief. If there is Page 103. any truth in this, the effect must be produced by the melody, the like of which we have already mentioned in connection with the hunting of gazelles (v. p. 195). Islands in The eastern islands in this ocean, which are nearer to the Indian and Chinese China than to India, are the islands of the Zabaj, called Seas. by the Hindus Suvarna-dvipa, i.e. the gold islands. The western islands in this ocean are those of the Zanj (Negroes), and those in the middle are the islands Ramm and the Diva islands (Malediva, Laccadiva), to which belong also the Kumair islands. It is peculiar to the Diva islands that they rise slowly ; first, there appears a sandy tract above the surface of the ocean ; it rises more and more and extends in all directions, till at last it becomes a firm soil, whilst at the same time another island falls into decay and melts away, finally is submerged and disappears in the ocean. As soon as the inhabitants become aware of this process, they search for a new island of increasing fertility, transport there their cocoa-nut palms, date palms, cereals, and house- hold goods, and emigrate to it. These islands are, according to their products, divided into two classes, the Diva-kudha, i.e. the Diva of the kauri-shells, because there they gather kauri-shells from the branches of the cocoa-nut palms which they plant in the sea, and Diva- lanbar, i.e. the Diva of the cords twisted from cocoa- nut fibres, and used for fastening together the planks of the ships. The island of Alwakwal belongs to the Kumair islands. Kumair is not, as common people believe, the name of a tree which produces screaming human heads instead of fruits, but the name of a people the colour of whom is whitish. They are of short stature and of a build like that of the Turks. They practise the religion of the Hindus, and have the custom of piercing their

Page 257

CHAPTER XVIII. 211

ears. Some of the inhabitants of the Wakwlk island are of black colour. In our countries there is a great demand for them as slaves. People fetch from thence the black ebony-wood; it is the pith of a tree, the other parts of which are thrown away, whilst the kinds of wood called mulamma and shauhat and the yellow sandal-wood are brought from the country of the Zanj (Negroes). In former times there were pearl-banks in the bay of Sarandib (Ceylon), but at present they have been abandoned. Since the Sarandib pearls have disap- peared, other pearls have been found at Sufala in the country of the Zanj, so that people say the pearls of Sarandib have migrated to Sufala. India has the tropical rains in summer, which is called On the rarshakala, and these rains are the more copious and India. rainfallin

last the longer the more northward the situation of a province of India is, and the less it is intersected by ranges of mountains. The people of Multan used to tell me that they have no varshakala, but the more northern provinces nearer the mountains have the var- shakala. In Bhatal and Indravedi it begins with the month Ashadha, and it rains continually for four months as though water-buckets were poured out. In provinces still farther northward, round the mountains of Kashmîr up to the peak of Judart between Dunpûr and Barshawar, copious rain falls during two and a half months, beginning with the month Sravana. However, on the other side of this peak there is no rainfall; for the clouds in the north are very heavy, and do not rise much above the surface. When, then, they reach the mountains, the mountain-sides strike against them, and the clouds are pressed like olives or grapes, in conse- quence of which the rain pours down, and the clouds never pass beyond the mountains. Therefore Kashmir has no varshakala, but continual snowfall during two and a half months, beginning with Magha, and shortly

Page 258

212 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

after the middle of Caitra continual rain sets in for a few days, melting the snow and cleansing the earth. This rule seldom has an exception ; however, a certain amount of extraordinary meteorological occurrences 1s peculiar to every province of India.

Page 259

( 213 )

CHAPTER XIX.

ON THE NAMES OF THE PLANETS, THE SIGNS OF THE ZODIAC, TIIE LUNAR STATIONS, AND RELATED SUB- JECTS.

WE have already mentioned, near the beginning of the book, that the language of the Hindus is extremely Page 104. rich in nouns, both original and derivative, so that in some instances they call one thing by a multitude of different names. So I have heard them saying that they have a thousand names all meaning sun ; and, no doubt, each planet has quite as many, or nearly as many names, since they could not do with less (for the purposes of versification). The names of the week-days are the best known The names names of the planets connected with the word bara, of the days of the week. which follows after the planet's name, as in Persian the word shambih follows after the number of the week- day (dashambih, sihshambih, &c.). So they say-

Adityu bara, i.c. Sunday. Brihaspati bara, i.e. Thursday. Soma bara, i.e. Monday. Sukra bara, i.e. Friday. Mnngala bara, i.e. Tuesday. I Sanaiscara bara, i.e. Saturday. Budha bara, i.f. Wednesday.

And thus they go on counting, beginning anew with Sunday, Monday, &c. Muslim astronomers call the planets the lords of the On the days, and, in counting the hours of the day, they begin dierum. Domini

with the dominus of the day, and then count the planets in the order from above to below. For instance, the sun is the dominus of the first day, and at the same time the

Page 260

214 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

dominus of its first hour. The second hour is ruled by the planet of the sphere next under the sphere of the sun, i.e. Venus. The third hour is ruled by Mercury, and the fourth by the moon. Therewith the descending from the sun to the cther, i.e. the atmosphere of the earth, has an end, and in counting they return to Saturn. According to this system, the dominus of the twenty- fifth hour is the moon, and this is the first hour of Monday. So the moon is not only the dominus of the first hour of Monday, but also the dominus of the whole day. Οη ώραι In all this there is only one difference between our καιρικαί and ώραι- system and that of the Hindus, viz. that we use the &pa Ισημεριναί. katpiai, so that the thirteenth planet, counted from the dominus diei, is the dominus of the succeeding night. This is the third planet if you count in an opposite direction, i.e. ascending from the lower planet-spheres to the higher. On the contrary, the Hindus make the dominus diei the dominus of the whole vvxOnpepov, so that day and night follow each other withont having each a separate dominus. This, at all events, is the practice of the people at large. Sometimes, however, their chronological methods make me think that the Spar kaiptkai were not entirely unknown to them. They call the hour hora, and by the same name they call the half of a zodiacal sign in the calculation of the nimbahra. The following cal- culation of the dominus horc is derived from one of their astronomical handbooks :- " Divide the distance between the sun and the degree of the ascendens measured by equal degrees, by 15, and add to the quotient I, dropping a fraction if there be any. This sum is then counted off from the dominus diei, according to the succession of the planets from above to below." (The planet you arrive at in the end is the dominus of the hour in question.) This calcula- tion is more of a nature to make us think of &pal

Page 261

CHAPTER XIX. 215

katptkui as having been used, than of Spat ionpte- ριναί. It is a custom of the Hindus to enumerate the planets Order of the in the order of the week-days. They will persist in their nota- plamets and

using it in their astronomical handbooks, as well as in tion.

other books, and they decline to use any other order, though it be much more correct. The Greeks mark the planets with figures, to fix thereby their limits on the astrolabe in an easily intel- ligible manner, images which are not letters of the alphabet. The Hindus use a similar system of abridge- ment; however, their figures are not images invented for the purpose, but the initial characters of the names of the planets, e.g. a= Iditya, or the sun ; c=Cundra, or the moon ; b= Budha, or Mercury. The following table exhibits the commonest names of the seven planets :-

The Phheta Their Names in the Indian Language. Page 105.

Sun . Âditya, sûrya, bhânu, arka, divâkara, ravi, bibatâ (?), heli.

Moon Soma, candra, indu, himagu, śitaraśmi, himaraśmi, śîtâmśu, śîtadidhiti, himamayûkha.

Mars. Mangala, bhaumya, kuja, âra, vakra, âvaneşa, mâheya, krûrâkshi (?), rakta.

Mercury Budha, saumya, cândra, jña, bodhana, vitta (?), hemna.

Jupiter Vrihaspati, guru, jîva, devejya, devapurohita, deva- i mantrin, angiras, suri, devapita.

Venus Šukra, bhrigu, sita, bhargava, asbati (?), danavaguru, bhriguputra, âsphujit (?). -

Sat urn Sanaiscara. manda, asita, koņa, adityaputra, saura, ârki, suryaputra.

The multiplicity of names of the sun as exhibited On the in the previous table was the cause which led the twelve suns.

theologians to assume also a multiplicity of suns, so

Page 262

216 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

that according to them there are twelve suns, each of which rises in a particular month. The book Vishnu- dharma says: "Vishnu, i.e. Narayana, who is without beginning in time and without end, divided himself for the angels into twelve parts, which became sons .to Kasyapa. These are the suns rising in the single months." Those, however, who do not believe that the multiplicity of names is the source of this theory of twelve suns, point ont that the other planets also have many names, but each only one body, and that, besides, the names of the sun are not only twelve, but many more. The names are derived from words with generic meanings, e.g. Aditya, i.e. the beginning, because the sun is the beginning of the whole. Savitri means every being which has a progeny, and since all progeny in the world originates with the sun, he is called Savitri. Further, the sun is called Ravi, because he dries wet substances. The juice in the plants is called rasa, and he who takes it out of them is called ravi. Names of The moon too, the companion of the sun, has many the moon. Page 106. names, e.g. Soma, because she is lucky, and everything lucky is called somagraha, whilst all that is unlucky is called papagraha. Further, Nisesa, i.e. lord of the night, Nakshatranatha, i.e. lord of the lunar stations, Drijesvara, i.e. lord of the Brahmins, Sitarisu, i.e. having a cold ray, because the moon's globe is watery, which is a blessing to the earth. When the solar ray meets the moon, the ray becomes as cool as the moon herself, then, being reflected, it illuminates the darkness, makes the night cool and extingnishes any hurtful kind of combustion wrought by the sun. Similarly the moon is also called Candra, which means the left eye of Narayana, as the sun is his right eye. The names The following table exhibits the names of the months of the months. Disturbances and differences in lists of these names pro- ceed from the causes which we shall mention (v. p. 228) when speakingof theenumeration of the different earths.

Page 263

Their Suns The Sans according to the The Meaning of theso Names according to the Vishnu-dharma. according to the Vernacular . The oith= Veshna-dharma. Aditya-pnrana. Names.

Caitra Vishņu. Moving about in heaven, not resting . Amhsomant Ravi.

Vaišakha . Aryaman Pnnishing and beating the rebels. In con eqnence ) they do not oppose him, from fear Savitri . Vishmu.

Jyaishtha Vivasvant He looks at the whole in general, not in detail . Bhanu Dhatri. C

shâdha Having rays Vivasvant Vidhâtri.

Srâvana Parjanya Affording help like the rain Vishnu Aryaman. R X Bhâdrapada Varua Ie prepares the whole Indra Bhaga.

Âśvayuja Indra Companion and lord Dhâtri Savitri.

Karttika Dhâtri lle gives benefits to men and rules them Bhaga Poshan.

Mârgasîrsha Mitra Beloved by the world . Pushan Tvashtri.

Pausha Pâshan Nourishment, for he nourishes men Mitra Arka.

Mâgha Bhaga Lovely, desired by the nniverse Varuna Divâkara.

l'hâlguna . Tvashtri He provides the whole with good Aryaman Amśu. 2 7 -

Page 264

218 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Page 107. People think, with regard to the order of the names of suns as given by the Vishnn-dharma, that it is The names correct and undisturbed; for Vâsudeva has a separate of the months name in each month, and his worshippers begin the derived from those months with Margasirsha, in which his name is Kesara. of the lunar mansions. If you count bis names one after the other, yon find that one which he has in the month Caitra, Vishnu, in accord- ance with the tradition of the Vishnu-dharma. The names of the months are related to those of the Innar stations. As two or three stations belong to each month, the name of the month is derived from one of them. We have in the following table written these particular stations with red ink (in this translation with an asterisk), in order to point out their relationship with the names of the months. If Jupiter shines in some lunar station, the month to which this station belongs is considered as the dominant of the year, and the whole year is called by the name of this month. If the names of the month given in the following table differ in some respects from those used heretofore, the reader must know that the names which we have hitherto used are the vernacular or vulgar ones, whilst those given in this table are the classical :-

The Months. The Lunar The Months. The Lnnar Stations. Stations.

Kurttika 3 Krittikâ .* VaisAkha 16 Visākhâ .* 4 Rohinî. Mrigastrsha .* 17 Anurâdhâ. Margasirsha 5 I8 Jyeshthâ. * 6 Ardrâ. Jyaishtha IC Mala.

Pausha 7 Punarvasu. 20 8 l'ushya .* Âshâdha Pûrvâshadba * 2I Uttarashadha. Mâgha 9 Âślesha. Maghâ. * S'râvaņa 22 S'ravana .* . IO II Parva-phal- 23 Dhanishta. 24 S'atabhishaj.

Phâlguna gunî .* I2 Uttara-phal- Bhadrapada 25 Porva-bhadra- padâ .* gunî. 26 Uttara-bhadra- I3 Hasta. Caitra. 14 Citra .* padâ. 2 Revatî. 15 Svati. Âśvayuja I Aśvinî .* 2 Bharanî.

Page 265

CHAPTER XIX. 219

The signs of the zodiac have names corresponding to On the the images which they represent, and which are the the signs of names of

same among the Hindus as among all other nations. Page 108. the Zediac.

The third sign is called Mithund, which means a pair consisting of a boy and a girl; in fact, the same as the Twins, the well-known image of this sign. Varâhamihira says in the larger book of nativities that the word applies to a man holding a lyre and a club, which makes me think that he identified Mithuna with Orion (Aljabbar). And this is the opinion of common people in general, to such a degree that the station is known as Aljauza (instead of the T'wins), though Aljauza does not belong to the image of this sign. The same author explains the image of the sixth sign as a ship, and in its hand an ear of corn. I am inclined to think that in our manuscript there is a lacuna in this place, for a ship has no hand. The Hindus call this sign Kanya, i.e. the virgin girl, and perhaps the passage in question ran originally thus: " A viryin in a ship holding an ear of corn in her hand." This is the lunar station Alsimak Al'u'sal (Spica). The word ship makes one think that the author meant the lunar station Al'awwa (B, ], y, 8, €, Virginis), for the stars of Al'awwa form a line, the end of which is a curve (like the keel of a ship). The image of the seventh sign he declares to be fire. It is called Tuld = balance. Of the tenth sign Varthamihira says that it has the face of a goat, whilst the remainder is a makara (hippo- potamus). However, after having compared the sign with a mabara, he might have saved himself the trouble of attributing to it the face of a goat. Only the Greeks require the latter description, because they consider the sign as composed of two animals, as a goat in the part above the breast and as a fish in the lower part. But the aquatic animal called makura, as people describe

Page 266

220 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

it, does not require to be explained as a composition of two animals. The image of the eleventh sign he calls a bucket, and the name, Kumbha, corresponds to this statement. How- ever, if they sometimes enumerate this sign or part of it among the human figures, this proves that they, fol- lowing the example of the Greeks, see in it Aquarius. The image of the twelfth sign he describes as the figure of two fishes, although the name of the sign in all languages signifies only one fish. Besides the well-known names, Varahamihira men- tions also certain Indian names of the signs which are not generally knowD. We have united both kinds in the following table :-

Their ChinThof

0 Mesha. Kriya. 6 Tula. Jûga.

Vrishan. Tambiru. 7 Vriścika. Kaurba.

2 Mithuna. Jituma. S Dhanu. Tauksbika.

3 Karkata, Kulira. 9 Makara. Agokiru.

4 Simnba. Liyaya. 10 Kumbah. Udruvaga.

5 Kanya. Pârtîna. Mîna. Anta, also Jitu.

It is the custom of the Hindus in enumerating the zodiacal signs not to begin with o for Aries and I for Taurus, but to begin with I for Aries and 2 for Taurus, &c., so that Pisces are No. 12.

Page 267

( 221

CHAPTER XX.

BRAHMANDA means the egg of Brahman, and applies in The egg of reality to the whole of hearen (aiip), on acconnt of its its coming Brahman,

being round, and of the particular kind of its motion, the water forth from

It applies even to the whole world, in so far as it is Page 109. divided into an upper and an under part. When they enumerate the heavens, they call the sum of them Brahmanda. The Hindus, however, are devoid of train- ing in astronomy, and have no correct astronomical notions. In consequence, they believe that the earth is at rest, more particularly as they, when describing the bliss of paradise as something like worldly happi- ness, make the earth the dwelling-place of the different classes of gods, angels, &c., to whom they attribute loco- motion and the direction from the upper worlds to the lower. According to the enigmatic expressions of their tradi- tion, the water was before every other thing, and it filled the space of the whole world. This was, as I understand them, at the beginning of the day of the soul (purushathoratra, p. 332), and the beginning of formation and combination. Further, they say the water was roll- ing and foaming. Then something white came forth from the water, of which the Creator created the egg of Brahman. Now, according to some, the egg broke; Brahman came forth from it, the one half became the heaven, the other the earth, and the broken bits between the two halves became the rains. If they said moun-

Page 268

222 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

tains instead of rains, the matter would be somewhat more plausible. According to others, God spoke to Brahman : " I create an egg, which I make for thy dwelling in it." He had created it of the above men- tioned foam of the water, but when the water sank and was absorbed, the egg broke into two halves. Greek par- Similar opinions were held by the ancient Greeks allel : Ascle- pius. regarding Asclepins, the inventor of the medical art; for, according to Galenus, they represent him as holding an egg in his hand, whereby they mean to indicate that the world is round, the egg an image of the universe, and that the whole world needs the medical art. Ascle- pius does not hold a lower position in the belief of the Greeks than Brahman in the belief of the Hindus, for they say that he is a divine power, and that his name is derived from his action, i.e. protecting against dryness, which means death, because death occurs when dryness and cold are prevalent. As for his natural origin, they call him the son of Apollo, the son of Phlegyas (?), and the son of Kronos, i.e. the planet Saturn. By this system of affiliation they mean to attribute to him the force of a threefold god. Water the The theory of the Hindus, that the water existed first ele. ment of before all creation, rests on this, that it is the cause of creation. The egg of the cohesion of the atoms of everything, the cause of Brahman broken in the growing of everything, and of the duration of life in two halves. every animated being. Thus the water is an instrument in the hand of the Creator when he wants to create something out of matter. A similar idea is propounded by the Koran xi. 9: " And his (God's) throne was on the water." Whether you explain it in an external way as an individual body called by this name, and which God orders us to venerate, or whether you give it the intrinsic meaning of rcalm, i.e. God's realm, or the like, in any case the meaning is this, that at that time beside God there was nothing but the water and his throne. If this our book were not restricted to

Page 269

CHAPTER XX.

the ideas of one single nation, we should produce from the belief of the nations who lived in ancient times in and round Babel ideas similar to the egg of Brahman, and even more stupid and unmeaning than that. The theory of the division of the egg into two halves proves that its originator was the contrary of a scientific man, one who did not know that the heaven compre- hends the earth, as the shell of the egg of Brahman comprehends its yolk. He imagined the earth to be below and the heaven in only one of the six directions from the earth, i.e. above it. If he had known the truth, he might have spared himself the theory of the breaking of the egg. However, he wished by his theory to describe one half of the egg as spread out for the earth, and the other half as placed upon it for a cupola, Page IIo. trying to outvie Ptolemy in the planispheric represen- tation of a globe, but without snccess. There have always been similar fancies afloat, which Quotation everybody interprets as best suits his religion and Tinueue, from Plato's

philosophy. So Plato says in his Timceus something like the Brahmanda : " The Creator cut a straight thread into halves. With each of them he described a circle, so that the two circles met in two places, and one of them he divided into seven parts." In these words he hints, as is his custom, at the original two motions of the universe (from east to west in the diurnal rotation, and from west to east in the precession of the equi- noxes), and at the globes of the planets. Brahmagupta says in the first chapter of the Brahma- Quotation siddhanta, where he enumerates the heavens, placing magupta. from Brah-

the moon in the nearest heaven, the other planets in the following ones, aud Saturn in the seventh: "The fixed stars are in the eighth heaven, and this has been created round in order to last for ever, that in it the pious may be rewarded, the wicked be punished, since there is nothing behind it." He indicates in thischapter that the heavens are identical with the spheres, and he

Page 270

224 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

gives them in an order which differs from that of the traditional literature of their creed, as we shall show hereafter in the proper place. He indicates, too, that the round can only be slowly influenced from without. He evinces his knowledge of the Aristotelic notions regarding the round form and the rotating motion, and that there is no body in existence behind the spheres. If it is of this description, evidently Brahmânda is the totality of the spheres, i.e. the alop, in fact, the uuiverse, for retribution in another life takes place, ac- cording to the ideas of the Hindus, within it. Quotation Pulisa says in his Siddhanta: "The totality of the from the Siddhánta world is the sum of earth, water, fire, wind, and heaven. of Pulisa. The latter was created behind the darkness. It appears to the eyes as blue, because it is not reached by the rays of the sun and not illuminated by them like the watery non-igneous globes, i.e. the bodies of the planet and the moon. When the rays of the sun fall upon these and the shadow of the earth does not reach them, their darkuess disappears and their figures become visi- ble in the night. The light-giver is only one, all the others receive the light from him." In this chapter Pulisa speaks of the utmost limit that can be reached, and calls it heaven. He places it in darkness, since he says that it exists in a place which is not reached by the rays of the sun. The question as to the blue-grey colour of heaven which is perceived by the eye is of too great an extent to be touched upon here. Quotations Brahmagupta says in the above-mentioned chapter: from Brah- magupta, "Multiply the cycles of the moon, a.e. 57,753,300,000, Balabhadra, by the number of the yojana of her sphere, i.e. 324,000, Vasishtha, and Arya- bhața. and you get as the product 18,712,069,200,000,000, i.e. the number of the yojana of the sphere of the zodiac." Of the yojuna as a measure of distance we have already spoken in the chapter on metrology (ch. xv. p. 167). We give the just-mentioned calculation of Brabma- gupta, simply reproducing his words withont any re-

Page 271

CHAPTER XX.

sponsibility of onr own, for be has not explained on what reason it rests. Vasishtha says that the Brah- manda comprehends the spheres, and the just-mentioned numbers are the measure of the Brahmanda, since the sphere of the zodiac is connected with it. The com- mentor Balabhadra says: " We do not consider these numbers as a measure of heaven, for we cannot define its greatness, but we consider them as the utmost limit to which the human power of vision can penetrate. 'T'here is no possibility of human perception reaching abore it; but the other spheres differ from each other in greatness and smallness, so as to be visible in various degrees." The followers of Aryabhata say : " It is suffi- age In. cient for us to know the space which is reached by the solar rays. We do not want the space which is not reached by the solar rays, though it be in itself of an enormous extent. That which is not reached by the rays is not reached by the perception of the senses, and that which is not reached by perception is not knowable." Let us now examine the bearing of the words of these Criticisms authors. The words of Vasishtha prove that the Brah- different on the

manda is a globe comprehending the eighth or so called The question theories. zodiacal sphere, in which the fixed stars are placed, and splere. of the ninth

that the two spheres touch each other. Now we on our own part were already obliged to assume an eighth sphere, but there is no reason why we should suppose a ninth one. On this head the opinions of people are divided. Some hold the existence of a ninth sphere to be a neces- sity on account of the rotation from east to west, in so far as it moves in this direction and compels everything which it comprehends to move in the same direction. Others assume the ninth sphere on account of the same motion, but suppose that it by itself is motionless. The tendency of the representatives of the former theory is perfectly clear. However, Aristotle has proved VCL, I, P

Page 272

226 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

that each moving body is brought into motion by some- thing moving which is not within itself. So also this ninth sphere would presuppose a mover outside itself. What, however, should prevent this mover from putting the eight spheres into motion withont the intermedia- tion of a ninth sphere? Aristotle, As regards the representatives of the second view, Ptolemy, Johannes one might almost think that they had a knowledge of Grammati- cus. the words of Aristotle which we have quoted, and that they knew that the first mover is motionless, for they represent the ninth sphere as motionless and as the source of the east to west rotation. However, Aristotle has also proved that the first mover is not a body, whilst he must be a body, if they describe him as a globe, as a sphere, and as comprehending something else within itself and motionless. Thus the theory of the ninth sphere is proved to be an impossibility. To the same effect are the words of Ptolemy in the preface of his Almagest: " The first cause of the first motion of the universe, if we consider the motion by itself, is according to our opinion an in- visible and motionless god, and the stndy of this sub- ject we call a divine one. We perceive his action in the highest heights of the world, but as an altogether different one from the action of those substances which can be perceived by the senses." These are the words of Ptolemy on the first mover, withont any indication of the ninth sphere. But the latter is mentioned by Johannes Grammaticus in his refutation of Proclus, where he says: " Plato did not know a ninth, starless sphere." And, according to Jo- hannes, it was this, i.e. the negation of the ninth sphere, which Ptolemy meant to say. Finally, there are other people who maintain that behind the last limit of motion there is an infinite rest- ing body or an infinite vacuum, or something which they declare to be neither a vacuum nor a plenum. These

Page 273

CHAPTER XX.

theories, however, have no connection whatsoever with our subject. Balabhadra gives us the impression of holding the same opinion as those who think that heaven or the heavens are a compact body holding in equilibrium all heavy bodies and carrying them, and that it is above the spheres. To Balabhadra it is just as easy to prefer tradition to eyesight, as it is difficult to us to prefer doubt to a clear proof. The truth is entirely with the followers of Aryabhata who give us the impression of really being men of great scientific attainments. It is perfectly evident that Brahmanda means the uitip, together with all products of creation in it.

Page 274

( 228 )

CHAPTER XNI.

DESCRIPTION OF EARTII AND HIEAVEN ACCORDING TO THE RELIGIOUS VIEWS OF THE HINDUS, BASED UPON THEIR TRADITIONAL LITERATURE.

On the THE people of whom we have spoken in the preceding seven earths. chapter think that the earths are seven like seven Page 112, covers one above the other, and the npper one they divide into seven parts, differing from onr astronomers, who divide it into «Aiuara, and from the Persians, who divide it into Kishvar. We shall afterwards give a clear explanation of their theories derived from the first authorities of their religious law, to expose the matter to fair criticism. If something in it appears strange to us, so as to require a commentary, or if we perceive some coincidence with others, even if both parties missed the mark, we shall simply put the case before the reader, not with the intention of attacking or reviling the Hindus, but solely in order to sharpen the minds of those who study these theories. Differences They do not differ among themselves as to the num- in the seqnence of ber of earths nor as to the number of the parts of the explained as upper earth, but they differ regarding their names and the earths

resulting from the th: order of these names. I am inclined to derive this copiousness of the difference from the great verbosity of their language, for langnage they call one and the same thing by a multitude of names. For instance, they call the sun by a thousand different names according to their own statement, just as the Arabs call the lion by nearly as many. Some of these names are original, while others are derived from the changing conditions of his life or his actions and facul- ties. The Hindus and their like boast of this copious- ness, whilst in reality it is one of the greatest faults of

Page 275

CHAPTER XXI. 229

the langnage. For it is the task of language to give a name to everything in creation and to its effects, a name based on general consent, so that everybody, when hear- ing this name prononnced by another man, understands what he means. If therefore one and the same name or word means a variety of things. it betrays a defect of the language and compels the hearer to ask the speaker what he means by the word. And thus the word in question must be dropped in order to be replaced either by a similar one of a sufficiently clear meaning, or by an epithet describing what is really meant. If one and the same thing is called by many names, and this is not occasioned by the fact that every tribe or class of people uses a separate one of them, and if, in fact, one single name would be sufficient, all the other names save this one are to be classified as mere nonsense, as a means of keeping people in the dark, and throwing an air of mystery about the subject. And in any case this copiousness offers painful difficulties to those who want to learn the whole of the language, for it is entirely use- less, and only results in a sheer waste of time. Frequently it has crossed my mind that the authors of books and the transmitters of tradition have an aver- sion to mentioning the earths in a definite arrangement, and limit themselves to mentioning their names, or that the copyists of the books have arbitrarily altered the text. For those men who explained and translated the text to me were well versed in the language, and were not known as persons who would commit a wanton fraud. The following table exhibits the names of the earths, The earths as far as I know them. We rely chiefly on that list, according to the Aditya- which has been taken from the Aditya-mirana, because Purana.

it follows a certain rule, combining every single earth and heaven with a single member of the members of the sun. The heavens are combined with the members from the skull to the womb, the earths with the members from the navel to the foot. This mode of comparison illus- trates their sequence and preserves it from confusion :-

Page 276

Page 113. 230

VII. VI. V. IV. III. II. I. The Number of the Earths.

The calves. The navel. What Menibers

The feet. I The ankles. Under the : The thighs. of the Sun they Âditya-Purana.

knees. The knees. Represent,

Viśâla (?) Mahâkhya (?)

Rasâtala. Mrittâla. Âśâla (?) Sutâla.

Pâtâla. Tâla. Their Names. ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Gabhastimat.

Jâgara (?) Nitala. Vitala. Atala.

Sutala. Vishnu-Purdna. Vayu-Purana.

Patala. Sutala. Mahâtala. Gabhastala. Nitala. Ilà (?) Âbhâstala. Their Names.

Suvarna-varna, S'iltala, Pasha a-bhumi, Pita-bhumi, Rakta-bhumi, S'ukla-bhttmi. Krishna-bhûmi.

the gold- the earth of : the earth of the yellow the red the bright the dark Their Epithets.

coloured earth. brick. marble. earth, earth. earth. earth.

1 Gabhastimat. Ambaratala.

S'arkara (?) (Sakkaru).

Mahâtala. Amśu (?)

Rasâtala. Sutala. Vernacnlar Names.

Page 277

CHAPTER XXI. 231

THE SPIRITUAL BEINGS LIVING ON THE SEVEN Page 114 EARTHS ACPORDING TO THE VAYU-PURANA. Of the Dânavas-Namuci, Sankukarņa, Kabandha (?), Nishku- kda (?), Sûladanta, Lohita, Kalinga, Svâpada; and the master of the serpents-Dhanañjaya, KAliya. Of the Daityas-Surakshas, Mahajambha, Haragriva, Krishna, Janarta (?), Sankhakhsha, Gomukha; and of the Rakshasa -- Nila, Megha, Krathanaka, Mahoshnisha, Kambala, Asvatara. Takshaka. Of the Danavas-Rada (?), Anublada, Agnimukha, Tarakaksha, Trisira, Sisumara; and of the Rakshasa-Cyavana, Nanda, Visala. And there are many cities in this world. Of the Daityas-Kalanemi, Gajakarna, Unjara (?); and of the Rakshasa-Sumali, Munja, Vrikavaktra, and the large birds called Garuda. Of the Daityas-Virocana, Jayanta (?), Agnijihva, Hiranyâksha; and of the Rakshasa-Vidyujjihva, Mahamegha; the serpent Karmâra, Svastikajaya. Of the Daityas-Kesari; and of the Rakshasa-Urdhvakuja (?), Satasirsha, i.e. having a hundred heads, a friend of Indra; Vasuki, a serpent. The king Bali; and of the Daitya Mucukunda. In this world there are many houses for the Rakshasa, and Vishnu resides there, and Sesha, the master of the serpents.

After the earths follow the heavens, consisting of On the seven stories, one above the other. They are called hearens. loka, which means "gathering-pluce." In a similar from Quotations

manner also the Greeks considered the heavens as Grammati- Johannes

gathering-places. So Johannes Grammaticns says in and Aris. cus, Plato,

his refutation of Proclus: " Some philosophers thought totìe. that the sphere called yalagias, i.e. mill, by which they mean the milky way, is a dwelling-place for rational souls." The poet Homer says: "Thou hast made the pure heaven an eternal dwelling-place for the gods. The winds do not shake it, the rains do not wet it, and the snow does not destroy it. For in it there is resplendent clearness without any covering clond." l'lato says: "God spoke to the seven planets: You are the gods of the gods, and I am the father of the actions; I am he who made you so that no dissolution

Page 278

232 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Page 115. is possible; for anything bound, though capable of being loosened, is not exposed to destruction, as long as its order is good." Aristotle says in his letter to Alexander: "The world is the order of the whole creation. That which is above the world, and surrounds it on the sides, is the dwelling-place of the gods. Heaven is full of the gods to which we give the name of stars." In another place of the same book he says, "The earth is bounded by the water, the water by the air, the air by the fire, the fire by the aloip. Therefore the highest place is the dwelling-place of the gods, and the lowest, the home of the aquatic animals." There is a similar passage in the Vâyu-Purana to this effect, that the earth is held in its grasp by the water, the water by the pure fire, the fire by the wind, the wind by heaven, and heaven by its lord. The names of the lokas do not differ like those of the earths. There is a difference of opinion only re- garding their order. We exhibit the names of the lokas in a table similar to the former (p. 230).

What members of The Number of the the Sun they repre- Their Names

Heavcus. sent according to according to the

the Aditya-Purana. Aditya, Vayu and Vish yu Puranas.

I. The stomach. Bhurioka. II. The breast. Bhuvarloka. III. The month. Svarloka. IV. The esebrow. Mabarloka. V. The forehead. Janaloka. VI. f Above the ) Tapoloka. VII. 1 forehead. The skull. Sat yaloka.

Criticisms This theory of the earths is the same with all Hindus, meutatorof except alone the commentator of the book of Patanjali. on the com-

Patañjali. Page 116. He had heard that the Pitaras, or futhers, had their gathering-place in the sphere of the moon, a tradition built on the theories of the astronomers. In conse-

Page 279

CHAPTER XXI.

quence he made the lunar sphere the first heaven, whilst he ought to have identified it with Bharloka. And becanse by this method he had one heaven too many, he dropped the Srarloka, the place of reward. The same author differs besides in another point. As the seventh heaven, Satyaloka, is in the Puranas also called Brahmaloku, he placed the Brahmaloka above the Satyaloka, whilst it would have been much more reasonable to think that in this case one and the same thing is called by two different names. He ought to have omnitted the Brahmaloka, to have identified Pitriloka with Bhurloka, and not to have left out the Svarloka. So much about the seven earths and the seven hearens. We shall now speak of the division of the surface of the uppermost earth and of related subjects. Dip (deipa) is the Indian word for islond. Hence The system the words Sunguladtp (Simhaladvipa), which we call and seus. of Dripas

Serendib, and the Dibajat (Maledives, Laccadives). The latter are numerous islands, which become, so to speak, decrepit, are dissolved and flattened, and finally dis- appear below the water, whilst at the same time other formations of the same kind begin to appear above the water like a streak of sand which continually grows and rises and extends. The inhabitants of the former island leave their homes, settle on the new one and colonise it. According to the religious traditions of the Hindus, the earth on which we live is round and surrounded by a sea. On the sea lies an earth like a collar, and on this earth lies again a round sea like a collar. The number of dry collars, called islands, is seven, and likewise that of the seas. The size of both dripas and seas rises in such a progression that each dripe is the double of the preceding dripa, each sea the double of the preceding sea, i.e. in the progression of the powers of two. If the middle earth is reckoned as one, the

Page 280

234 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

size of all seven earths represented as collars is 127. If the sea surrounding the middle earth is counted as one, the size of all seven seas represented as collars is I27. The total size of both earths and seas is 254. The size of The commentator of the book of Patanjali has adopted the Deipas and seas, as the size of the middle earth 100,000 yojana. Accord- according to the com- ingly, the size of all the earths would be 12,700,000 mentator of Patañjali yojana. Further he adopts as the size of the sea which and the Vâyu- surrounds the middle earth 200,000 yojana. Accord- Purtaa. ingly, the size of all the seas would be 25,400,000 yojuna, and the total size of all the earths and seas 38, 100,000 yojana. However, the author himself has not made these additions. Therefore we cannot com- pare his numbers with ours. But the Vayu-Purana says that the diameter of the totality of earths and seas is 37,900,000 yojuna, a number which does not agree with the above-mentioned sum of 38,100,000 yojann. It cannot be accounted for, unless we suppose that the number of earths is only six, and that the progression begins with the number 4 instead of 2. Such a num- ber of seas (i.e. 6) may possibly be explained in this way, that the seventh one has been dropped, because the author only wanted to find the size of the contin- ents, which induced him to leave the last surrounding sea out of the calculation. But if he once mentions the continents he must also mention all the seas which surround them. Why he has commenced the pro- gression with 4 instead of 2, I cannot account for by any of the principles of the calculation as they have been laid down. Each dvipa and sea has a separate name. As far as we know them, we place them before the reader in the following table, and hope that the reader will excuse us ʻ for so doing.

Page 281

Matsya-Purâna. The Commentator of Patañjali- Vishun- Purant. Vernacular Names.

1-

Dvipas. Seas. Dvipas. Neas. Dvîpas. Seas. and Seas. The mmber of the Dvipas

I. Jambu-dvîpa. Lavana, i.e. Jambu, Kshara, i.e. salt. the name of a tree. salt. Jambu. Lavana-samndra.

HAPT R XXI. 11. Sâka-dvipa. Kshîrodaka, i.e. Plaksha, Ikshu, i.e. ) milk. the name of a tree. sugar-cane. Sâka. Ikshu.

III. Kuśa-dvîpa. Ghritamanda, i.e. Sâlmali, Surâ, i.c. butter. the name of a tree. wine. Kuśa. Sura.

IV. Krannca-dvîpa Dadhimanda, i.c. Kuśa, Sarpis, ic. thick milk, the name of a plant. butter. Kraunca, Sarpis.

V. Salmali-dvipa. Sura, i.c. Krauñea, Dadhi, i.c. rice-wine. the hosts. sour-milk. Sâlmali. Dadhisâgara.

VI. Ikshurasoda, i.e. Gomeda-dvipa- the jnice of Śâka, Kshira, i.e. the name of a tree. milk. Gomeda. Kshîra. sugar-cane.

235 VII. Pushkara- Svádûdaka, i.e. Pushkara, Svâddaka, i,c. dvîpa. sweet water. ,the name of a tree. sweet water. Pushkara. Pânîva.

7

Page 282

236 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Page 118. The differences of the traditions as exhibited by this table cannot be accounted for in any rational way. They can hardly have sprung from any other sonrce bnt from arbitrary, accidental changes of the ennmeratiou. The most appropriate of these traditions is that of the Matsya-Purana, because it enumerates the dvipas and seas one after the other according to a fixed order, a sea surronnding an island, an island surrounding a sea, the ennmeration proceeding from the centre to the periphery. We shall now in this place record some related sub- jects, thongh it would perhaps be more correct to treat of them in some other part of the book. Quotation The commentator of the book of Patanjali, wishing from the commenta- to determine the dimension of the world, begins from tor of Patañ- jali below and says : " The dimension of the darlness is one koti and 85 laksha yojana, i.e. 18,000,000 yojana. "Then follows Naraka, i.e. the hells, of the dimension of 13 loti and 12 laksha, i.e. 131,200,000 yojuna. "Then follows darkness, of one laksha, i.e. 100,000 yojana. " Above it lies the earth Vajra, so called on account of its hardness, becanse the word means a diamond, and the molten thunder-bolt, of 34,000 yojuna. "Above it lies the middle earth Garbha, of 60,000 yojana. " Above it lies the golden earth, of 30,000 yojana. " Above this the seven earths, each of 10,000 yojana, which makes the sum of 70,000 yojana. The upper one of them is that which contains the dripas and the seas. "Behind the sweet-water sea lies Lokaloka, which means a not-gathering-place, i.c. a place withont civilisa- tion and inhabitants. "Thereupon follows the gold-earth of one Koti, i.e. 10,000,000 yojana ; above it the Pitriloka of 6,134,000 yojuna. "The totality of the seven lokas, which is called Brah-

Page 283

CHAPTER XXI. 237

munda, has the dimension of 15 lo!i, i.e. 150,000,000 yojana. And above this is the darkness tamas, similar to the lowest darkness, of 18,500,000 yojana." We on our part found it already troublesome to enumerate all the seven seas, together with the seven earths, and now this author thinks he can make the sub- ject more easy and pleasant to us by inventing some more earths below those already enumerated by ourselves! The Vishnu-Purana, when treating of similar subjects, says: "There is a serpent under the seventh lowest earth, which is called Seshalhya, worshipped among the spiritual beings. It is also called Ananta. It has a thousand heads, and bears the earths without being molested by their heavy weight. These earths, one stored above the other, are gifted with good things and happiness, adorned with jewels, illuminated by their own rays, not by those of sun and moon. The latter two luminaries do not rise in them. Therefore their temperature is always equal, they have everlasting fragrant flowers, blossoms of trees and fruits; their in- habitants have no notion of time, since they do not become aware of any motions by counting them. Their dimension is 70,000 yojana, the dimensions of each being 10,000. Narada, the Rishi, went down in order to see them, and to acqnaint himself with thetwo kinds of beings which inhabit them, the Daitya and Danara. When he then found the bliss of paradise to be rather insignificant in comparison with that of these earths, he returned to the angels, giving his report to them, and rousing their admiration by his description." Further, the following passage: " Behind the sweet- water sea lies the gold earth, the double of the totality of the drfpas and seas; but not inhabited by men nor by demons. Behind it lies Lokaloka, a mountain of the height of 10,000 yojund, and of the same breadth. Its Page 119. whole dimension is 50 koti, i.c. 500,000,000 yojana." The totality of all this is in the lindu language

Page 284

238 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

sometimes called dhatri, i.e. holding all things, and sometimes vidhatri, i.c. letting loose all things. It is also called the dwclling-place of erery living being, and by various other names, which differ as people differ in their opinions about the vacuum. Those who believe in the vacuum make it the cause why all bodies are attracted towards it, whilst those who deny the vacuum declare that it is not the cause of the attraction. Then the author of the Vishnu-Purana returns to the Lokas and says: " Everything which a foot can tread upon and a ship sail in, is Bhurloka." This seems to be an indication of the surface of the uppermost earth. The air, which is between the earth and the sun, in which the Siddhas, the Munis, and the Gandharvas, the musicians, wander to and fro, is the Bhuvarloka. The whole of -these three earths is called the three prithivt. That which is above them is Vyasa-mandala, i.c. the realm of Vyasa. The distance between the earth and sun is 100,000 yojuna, that between the sun and the moon is the same. The distance between the moon and Mercury is two lakshas, i.c. 200,000 yojana, that between Mercury and Venus is the same. The distances between Venus and Mars, Mars and Jupiter, Jupiter and Saturn, are equal, each being 200,000 yojana. The distance between Saturn and the Great Bear is 100,000 yojuna, and that from the Great Bear to the pole is 1000 yojana. Above it is Maharloka, at a distance of 20 millions of yojana; above it, the Jina- loka, at a distance of 8o millions; above it, Pitriloha, at a distance f 480 millions; above it, Satyaloka." This sum, however, is more than thrice the sum which we have mentioned on the authority of the com- mentator of the book of Patañjali, i.c. 150,000 yojana. But such is the custom of the copyists and scribes in every nation, and I cannot declare the students of the Purânas to be free from it, for they are not men of exact learning.

Page 285

( 239 )

CHAPTER XXII.

TRADITIONS RELATING TO THE POLE.

THE pole, in the language of the Hindus, is called The origin dhruve, and the axis sulako. The Hindus, with the pole, and of the south

exception of their astronomers, speak always only of Somadatta. the story of

one pole, the reason of which is their belief in the dome of heaven, as we have heretofore explained. According to Vayu-Purana, heaven revolves round the pole like a potter's wheel, and the pole revolves round itself, with- out changing its own place. This revolution is finished in 30 muhurta, i.e. in one nychthemeron. Regarding the south pole, I have heard from them only one story or tradition, viz. the following. They had once a king called Somadatta, who by his noble deeds had deserved paradise; bnt he did not like the idea of his body being torn away from his soul when he should depart into the other world. Now he called on the Rishi Vasishtha, and told to him that he loved his body, and did not wish to be separated from it; but the Rishi informed him that it was impossible to take along with oneself the material body from this world into paradise. Thereupon he laid his desire before the children of Vasishtha; however, these spat in his face, scoffed at him, and changed him into a candala with ear-rings in both ears, and elad in a kurtak (i.e. a short shirt worn by the women round the shonlders, reaching down to the middle of the body). When he came in this condition to the Rishi, Visramitra, the latter found him to be a disgusting spectacle, and asked him what

Page 286

2.10 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

was the reason of his appearing so, whereupon Soma- datta informed him, and told him the whole story. Now Visvamitra became very angry on his acconnt; he Page 120. ordered the Brahmans into his presence in order to per- form a great sacrifice, among those also the children of Vasishtha, and he spoke to them : " I wish to make a new world, and a new paradise for this pious king, that there he may obtain the fulfilment of bis wish." There- upon he began to make the pole and the Great Bear in the south, but then Indra, the ruler, and the spiritual beings began to fear him. They went to him, humbled themselves before him, and asked him to desist from the work he had commenced on this condition, that they would carry Somadatta with his body, just as it was, into paradise. This they did, and in consequence the Rishi desisted from making a second world, but that which he had already made up to that moment remained. It is well known that the north pole with us is called the Great Bear, the south pole Canopus. But some of our people (Muslims) who do not rise above the unedu- cated mass, maintain that in the south of heaven too there is a Great Bear of the same shape as the northern, which revolves round the southern pole. Such a thing would not be impossible nor even strange, if the report about it came from a trust- worthy man, who had made long sea-voyages. Cer- tainly in southern regions stars are seen which we do Śripla ob not know in our latitudes. So Sripala says that the the star Sila. Aljai. people of Multan see in summer time a red star a little hani on the below the meridian of Canopus, which they call Sula, fever-star. Brahma- gupta on the i.e. the beam of crucifirion, and that the Hindus consider Sisumâra. it as unlucky. Therefore, when the moon stands in the station Purvabhadrapada, the Iindus do not travel towards the south, because this star stands in the south. Aljaihauî relates, in his Book of Routes, that on the

Page 287

CHAPTER XXII. 241

island Langabalus there is a large star visible, known as the fever-star. It appears in winter abont morning dawn in the east as high as a date-palm tree, having an oblong shape, composed of the tail of the Small Bear and his back, and of some small stars situated there; it is called the axe of the mill. Brahmagupta mentions it in connection with the Fish. The Hindus tell rather ludicrous tales when speaking of the figure in which they represent this group of stars, viz. the figure of a four-footed aquatic animal, which they call Sukcarw and also Sisumara. I suppose that the latter animal is the great lizard, for in Persia it is called Susmâr, which sounds much like the Indian Sisumara. Of this kind of animals there is also an aquatic species, similar to the crocodile and the skink. One of those tales is the following. When Brahman wanted to create mankind, he divided The story.of himself into two halves, of which the right one was Dhruva.

called Viraj, the left one Manu. The latter one is the being from whom the period of time called Manvantara has received its name. Manu had two sons, Priyavrata and Uttanapada, the bow-legged king. The latter had a son called Dhrura, who was slighted by one of the wives of his father. On account of this, he was pre- sented with the power to turn round all the stars as he pleased. He appeared in the Manvantara of Svayam- bhuva, the first of all Manvantaras, and he has for ever remained in his place. The Vayu-Purana says: "The wind drives the stars Quotations round the pole, which are bound to it by ties invisible to Puruna and from Vêyu-

man. They move round like the beam in the olive-press, Vishņu- Dharma. for its bottom is, as it were, standing still, whilst its end is moving round. The Vishnu-Dharma says: "Vajra, one of the children of Balabhadra, the brother of Nârâyana, asked the Rishi Page 121. Markandeya as to the pole, upon which he answered: When God created the world, it was dark and desert. Q

Page 288

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Thereupon he made the globe of the sun shining, and the globes of the stars watery, receiving the light of the sun from that side of his which he turns towards them. Fourteen of these stars he placed round the pole in the shape of a sisumara, which drive the other stars round the pole. One of them, north of the pole, on the uppermost chin, is Uttanapada, on the lowest chin Yajna, on the head Dharma, on the breast Nârâ- yana, on the two hands towards the east the two stars Aśvinî the physicians, on the two feet Varuna, and Aryaman towards the west, on the penis Samwatsara, on the back Mitra, on the tail Agni, Mahendra, Marici, and Kaśyapa." The pole itself is Vishnn, the ruler of the inhabitants of paradise; he is, fnrther, the time rising, growing, getting old, and vanishing. Further, the Vishyu-Dharma says: "If a man reads this and knows it accurately, God pardons to him the sins of that day, and fourteen years will be added to his life, the length of which has been fixed before- hand." How simple those people are! Among us there are scholars who know between 1020 to 1030 stars. Should those men breathe and receive life from God only on account of their knowledge of stars ? All the stars revolve, whatever may be the position of the pole with regard to them. If I had found a Hindu able to point out to me with his finger the single stars, I should have been able to identify them with the star-figures knownamong Greeks and Arabs, or with stars in the neighbourhood in case they did not belong to any of these figures.

Page 289

( 243 )

CHAPTER XXIII.

ON MOUNT MERU ACCORDING TO THE BELIEF OF THE AUTHORS OF THE PURANAS AND OF OTHERS.

WE begin with the description of this mountain, since Brahmna- it is the centre of the Dvipas and seas, and, at the same the earth gupta on

time, the centre of Jambudvipa. Brahmagupta says: Meru. and Mount

" Manifold are the opinions of people relating to the description of the earth and to Mount Meru, particu- larly among those who study the Puranas and the reli- gious literature. Some describe this mountain as rising above the surface of the earth to an excessive height. It is situated under the pole, and the stars revolve round its foot, so that rising and setting depends upon Meru. It is called Meru because of its having the faculty of doing this, and because it depends alone upon the infuence of its head that sun and moon become visible. The day of the angels who inhabit Mern lasts six months, and their night also six months." Brahmagupta quotes the following passage from the book of Jina, i.e. Buddha: "Mount Meru is quad- rangular, not round." The commentator Balabhadra says: "Some people Balabhadra say that the earth is flat, and that Mount Meru is an subject. on the same

illuminating, light-giving body. However, if such were the case, the planets would not revolve round the horizon of the inhabitants of Meru, and if it were shining it would be visible because of its height, as the

Page 290

244 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

pole above it is visible. According to some, Meru con- sists of gold; according to others it consists of jewels. Aryabhata thinks that it has not absolute height, but only the height of one yojana, and that it is round, not quadrangular, the realm of the angels; that it is in- visible, although shining, because it is very distant from Page 122. the inhabited earth, being situated entirely in the high north, in the cold zone, in the centre of a desert called Nandana-vana. However, if it were of a great height, it would not be possible on the 66th degree of latitude for the whole Tropic of Cancer to be visible, and for the sun to revolve on it, being always visible without ever disappearing." The author All that Balabhadra produces is foolish both in words eriticises Balabhadra. and matter, and I cannot find why he felt himself called upon to write a commentary if he had nothing better to say. If he tries to refute the theory of the flatness of the earth by the planets revolving round the horizon of Meru, this argument would go nearer proving the theory than refuting it. For if the earth were a flat expanse, and everything high on earth were parallel to the perpendicular height of Meru, there would be no change of horizon, and the same horizon would be the equinox for all places on earth. The state- On the words of Aryabhata ments of Arşabhata as quoted by Balabhadra we examined by the make the following remarks. author. Let A B be the globe of the earth round the centre H. Further, A is a place on the earth in the 66th de- gree of latitude. We cut off from the circle the arc A B, equal to the greatest declination. Then B is the place in the zenith of which the pole stands. Further, we draw the line A C touching the globe in

Page 291

CHAPTER XXIII.

the point A. This line lies in the plane of the horizon as far as the human eye reaches round the earth. We join the points A and H with each other, and draw the line H B C, so that it is met in C by the line A C. Further, we let fall the perpendicular A Ton H C. Now, it is evident that-

A T is the sine of the greatest declination ; T B the versed sine of the greatest declination ; T HI the sine of the complement of the greatest declination. And as we here occupy ourselves with Aryabhata, we shall, according to his system, change the smes mn Pardaját. Accordingly- AT = 1397. TH = 3140. BT = 298. Because the angle II A C is a right angle, we have the equation- HT :TA = TA :TC. And the square of A T is 1,951,609. If we divide it by T H, we get as quotient 622. The difference between this number and T B is 324, which is B C. And the relation of B C to B H, the latter being sinus totus= 3438, is the same as the relation of the number of yojanas of B C to theyojanas of B II. The latter number is, according to Aryabhata, 800. If it is multiplied by the just-mentioned difference of 324 we get the sum of 259,200. And if we divide this number by the sinus totus we get 75 as quotient, which is the number of yojanas of B C, equal to 600 miles or 200 farsakh. If the perpendicular of a mountain is 200 farsalh, the ascent will be nearly the double. Whether Mount Mern has such a height or not, nothing of it can be visible in the 66th degree of latitude, and it would not cover anything of the Tropic of Cancer at all (so as to intercept from it the light of the sun). And if for those

Page 292

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

latitudes (66° and 23°) Meru is under the horizon, it is also under the horizon for all places of less latitude. If you compare Meru with a luminous body like the snn, you know that the sun sets and disappears under the earth. Indeed Meru may be compared with the earth. Page 123. It is not invisible to us because of its being far away in the cold zone, but because it lies below the horizon, because the earth is a globe, and everything heavy is attracted towards its centre. Aryabhata further tries to prove that Mount Meru has only a moderate height by the fact that the Tropic of Cancer is visible in places the latitude of which is equal to the complement of the greatest declination. We must remark that this argument is not valid, for we know the conditions of the lines of latitude and other lines in those countries only through ratiocination, not from eyesight nor from tradition, because they are unin- habited and their roads are impassable. If a man has come from those parts to Aryabhata and told him that the Tropic of Cancer is visible in that lati- tnde, we may meet this by stating that a man has also come to us from the same region telling us that one part of it is there invisible. The only thing which covers the Tropic of Cancer is this mountain Meru. If Meru did not exist, the whole tropic would be visible. Who, now, has been able to make out which of the two reports deserves most credit ? In the book of Aryabbata of Kusumapura we read that the mountain Meru is in Himavant, the cold zone, not higher than a yojuna. In the translation, however, it has been rendered so as to express that it is not higher than Himavant by more than a yojana. This author is not identical with the elder Arya- bhata, but he belongs to his followers, for he quotes him aud follows his example. I do not know which of these two namesakes is meant by Balabhadra. In general, what we know of the conditions of the

Page 293

CHAPTER XXIII. 247

place of this mountain we know only by ratiocination. About the mountain itself they have many traditions. Some give it the height of one yojana, others more; some consider it as quadrangular, others as an octagon. We shall now lay before the reader what the Rishis teach regarding this mountain. The Matsya-Purana says: "It is golden and shining Matsya- like fire which is not dulled by smoke. It has four on Mount Purana

different colours on its four sides. The colour of the Meru and the moun- eastern side is white like the colour of the Brahmins, the earth. tains of

that of the northern is red like that of the Kshatriya, that of the southern is yellow like the colour of the Vaisya, and that of the western is black like the colour of the Sûdra. It is 86,000 yojana high, and 16,000 of these yojana lie within the earth. Each of its four sides has 34,000 yojana. There are rivers of sweet water running in it, and beautiful golden houses inhabited by the spiritual beings, the Deva, by their singers the Gandharva, and their harlots the Apsaras. Also Asuras, Daityas, and Rakshasas are living in it. Round the mountain lies the pond Manasa, and around it to all four sides are the Lokapala, i.e. the guardians of the world and its inhabitants. Mount Meru has seven lnots, i.c. great mountains. the names of which are Mahendra, Malaya, Sahya, Śuktibâm (?), Rikshabâm (?), Vindhya, Pariyatra. The small mountains are nearly innumerable; they are those which are inhabited by mankind. "The great mountains round Meru are the follow- ing: Himavant, always covered with snow, inhabited by the Rakshasa, Pisaca, and Yaksha. Hemalúla, the golden, inhabited by the (andharva and Apsaras. Nishadha, inhabited by the Naga or snakes, which have the following seven princes: Ananta, Vasuki, Tak- shaka, Karkotaka, Mahâpadma, Kambala, Aśvatara. Nila, peacock-like, of many colours, inhabited by the Siddha and Brahmarshi, the anchorites. The mountain Page 124

Page 294

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Śccta, inhabited by the Daitya and Danava. The mountain Sringavant, inhabited by the Pitaras, the fathers and grandfathers of the Deva. Not far to the north of this mountain there are mountain-passes full of jewels and of trees which remain during a whole kalpa. And in the centre of these mountains is llavrita, the highest of all. The whole is called Purushaparvata. The region between the Himavant and the Sringavant is called Kailasa, the play-ground of the Rakshasa and Apsaras." Quotations The Vishņu-Purana says: "The great mountains of from the Vishnu, the middle earth are Sri-parvata, Malaya-parvata, Mâl- Vayu, and Âditya yavant, Vindhya, Trikuta, Tripurantika, and Kailâsa. Puranas. Their inhabitants drink the water of the rivers, and live in eternal bliss." The Vayu-Purana coutains similar statements about the four sides and the height of Meru as the hitherto quoted P'urânas. Besides, it says that on each side of it there is a quadrangular mountain, in the east the Mal- yavant, in the north Anila, in the west the Gandhama- dana, and in the south the Nishadha. The Aditya-Purana gives the same statement about the size of each of its four sides which we have quoted from the Matsya-Purana, but I have not found in it a statement about the height of Meru. According to this Purâna, its east side is of gold, the west of silver, the south of rubies, the north of different jewels. The com- The extravagant notions of the dimensions of Meru mentator of Patanjali would be impossible if they had not the same extrava- on the same subject. gant notions regarding the earth, and if there is no limit fixed to guesswork, guesswork may without any hindrance develop into lying. For instance, the com- mentator of the book of Patanjali not only makes Meru quadrangular, but even oblong. The length of one side he fixes at 15 koti, i.e. 150,000,000 yojana, whilst he fixes the length of the other three sides only at the third of this, i.e. 5 koti. Regarding the four sides of

Page 295

CHAPTER XXIII. 249

Meru, he says that on the east are the mountain Malava and the ocean, and between them the kingdoms called Bhadrasva. On the north are Nila, Sita, Śringâ- dri, and the ocean, and between them the kingdoms Ramyaka, Hiranmaya, and Kuru. On the west are the mountain Gandhamadana and the ocean, and between them the kingdom Ketumala. On the south are Mravarta (?), Nishadha, Hemakuta, Himagiri, and the ocean, and between them the kingdoms Bhâratavarsha, Kimpurusha, and Harivarsha. This is all I could find of Hindu traditions regarding Buddhistic Meru; and as I have never found a Buddhistic book, views

and never knew a Buddhist from whom I might have learned their theories on this subject, all I relate of them I can only relate on the authority of Alerânshahri, though, according to my mind, his report has no claim to scientific exactness, nor is it the report of a man who has a scientific knowledge of the subject. According to him, the Buddhists believe that Meru lies between four worlds in the four cardinal directions; that it is square at the bottom and round at the top; that it has the length of 80,000 yojuna, one half of which rises into heaven, whilst the other half goes down into the earth. That side which is next to our world consists of blue sapphires, which is the reason why heaven appears to us blue; the other sides are of rubies, yellow and white gems. Thus Meru is the centre of the earth. The mountain Kof, as it is called by our common people, is with the Hindus the Lokaloka. They main- Page 125. tain that the sun revolves from Lokaloka towards Meru, and that he illuminates only its inner northern side. Similar views are held by the Zoroastrians of Sog- A tradition diana, viz. that the mountain Ardiya surrounds the astrians of of the Zoro-

world; that outside of it is l'hom, similar to the pupil of Sogdiana.

the eye, in which there is something of everything, and that behind it there is a racuum. In the centre of the

Page 296

250 ALBERUNPS INDIA.

world is the mountain Girnagar, between our kAipa and the six other «Aipara, the throne of heaven. Be- tween each two there is burning sand, on which no foot could stand. The spheres revolve in the climala like mills, but in ours they revolve in an inclined course, because onr clima, that one inhabited by mankind, is the uppermost.

Page 297

CHAPTER XXIV.

TRADITIONS OF THE PURANAS REGARDING EACH OF THE SEVEN DVÎPAS.

WE must ask the reader not to take any offence if he beseription finds all the words and meanings which occur in the according to of the Dvipas

present chapter to be totally different from anything and Vishau the Matsya

corresponding in Arabic. As for the difference of words, Purūnas.

it is easily accounted for by the difference of languages ingeneral; and as regards the difference of the meanings, we mention them only either in order to draw attention to an idea which might seem acceptable even to a Mnslim, or to point out the irrational nature of a thing which has no foundation in itself. We have already spoken of the central Dvipa when describing the environs of the mountain in its centre. It is called Jambu-Dvipa, from a tree growing in it, the I Jambů- branches of which extend over a space of 100 yojana. In a later chapter, devoted to the description of the inhabitable world and its division, we shall finish the description of Jambu-Dvipa. Next, however, we shall describe the other Dripas which surround it, following, as regards the order of the names, the anthority of Matsya-Purana, for the above-mentioned reason (v. p. 236). But before entering into this subject we shall here insert a tradition of the Vayu-Purana regarding the central Dvipa (Jambû-Dvipa). According to this source, "there are two kinds of The inbabi. inhabitants in Madhyadesa. First the Kimpurusha. Madlya- tants of

Their men are known as the gold-coloured ones, their cording to defa, ac-

women as surenu. They live a long life without ever pa. Vâyu-Pur-

Page 298

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

being ill. They never commit a sin, and do not know envy. Their food is a juice which they express from the dates of the palm trees, called madya (?). The second kind are the Haripurusha, having the colour of silver. They live 11,000 years, are beardless, and their food is sugar-cane." Since they are described as beardless and silver-coloured, one might be inclined to take them for Turks; but the fact of their eating dates and sugar-cane compels us to see in them a more south- ern nation. But where do we find people of the colour of gold or silver? We know only of the colour of burnt silver, which occurs, e.g. among the Zanj, who lead a life without sorrow and envy, as they do not possess anything which gives birth to these passions. They live no doubt longer than we, but only a little longer, and by no means twice as long. The Zanj are so un- civilised that they have no notion of a natural death. If a man dies a natural death, they think he was poisoned. Every death is suspicious with them, if a man has not been killed by a weapon. Likewise it is regarded with suspicion by them, if a man is tonched by the breath of a consumptive person. 2. Śâka- We shall now describe Saka-Dvipa. It has, according Dvîpa. to the Matsya-Purana, seven great rivers, one of which equals the Ganges in purity. In the first ocean there are seven mountains adorned with jewels, some of which are inhabited by Devas, others by demons. One of them is a golden, lofty mountain, whence the clouds rise which bring us the rain. Another contains all the Page 126. medicines. Indra, the ruler, takes from it the rain. Another one is called Soma. Regarding this mountain they relate the following story :- The story of Kaśyapa had two wives, Kadrû, the mother of the Kadrû and Vinatâ. snakes, and Vinatâ, the mother of the birds. Both Garuda libe- rates his lived in a plain where there was a grey horse. How- means of the ever, the mother of the snakes maintained that the mother hy

Amrita. horse was brown. Now they made the covenant that

Page 299

CHAPTER XXIV. 253

she who was wrong should become the slave of the other, but they postponed the decision till the follow- ing day. In the following night the mother of the snakes sent her black children to the horse, to wind themselves round it and to conceal its colour. In con- sequence the mother of the birds became her slave for a time. The latter, Vinata, had two children, Anuru, the guardian of the tower of the sun, which is drawn by the horses, and Garuda. The latter spoke to his mother : " Demand from the children nourished at your breast what may restore you to liberty." This she did. People also spoke to her of the ambrosia (amrita), which is with the Devas. Thereupon Garuda flew to the Devas and demanded it from them, and they ful- filled his wish. For Amrita is one of those things peculiar to them, and if somebody else gets it, he lives as long as the Devas. He humbled himself before them in order to obtain the Amrita, for the purpose of freeing therewith his mother, at the same time promising to bring it back afterwards. They had pity upon him, and gave it him. Thereupon Garuda went to the mountain Soma, in which the Devas were living. Garuda gave the Amrita to the Devas, and thereby freed his mother. Then he spoke to them: "Do not come near the Amrita unless you have before bathed in the river Ganges." This they did, and left the Amrita where it was. Meanwhile Garuda brought it back to the Devas, and obtained thereby a high rank in sanctity, so that he became the king of all the birds and the riding-bird of Vishņu. The inhabitants of Saka-Dripa are pious, long-lived beings, who can dispense with the rule of kings, since they do not know envy nor ambition. Their lifetime, not capable of any change, is as long as a Tretayuga. T'he four colours are among them, i.c. the different castes, which do not intermarry nor mix with each other.

Page 300

254 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

They live in eternal joy, without ever being sorry. According to Vishnu-Puruna, the names of their castes are Aryaka, Kurura, Vivimsa (Vivamsa), and Bhavin (?), and they worship Vasudeva. 3. Kusa- Dvîpa. The third Dvipa is Kusa-Dvîpa. According to the Matsya-Purana it bas seven mountains containing jewels, fruit, flowers, odoriferous plants, and cereals. One of them, named Drona, contains famous medicines or drugs, particularly the risalyakaruna, which heals every wound instantaneously, and mritasamjtran, which restores the dead to life. Another one, called hari, is similar to a black cloud. On this mountain there is a fire called Mahisha, which has come out of the water, and will remain there till the destruction of the world ; it is this very fire which will burn the world. Kusa- Dvipa has seven kingdoms and innumerable rivers flowing to the sea, which are then changed by Indra into rain. To the greatest rivers belong Jaunu (Ya- muna), which purifies from all sins. About the in- habitants of this Dvipa, Matsya-Purana does not give any information. According to Vishnu-Purana the inhabitants are pious, sinless people, every one of them living 10,000 years. They worship Janardana, and the names of their castes are Damin, Sushmin, Sneha, and Mandeha. 4. Krannca- The fourth, or Kraunca-Dvipa, has, according to the Drîpa. Matsya-Purana, mountains containing jewels, rivers which are branches of the Ganges, and kingdoms the people of which have a white colour and are pious and Page 127. pure. According to Vishņu-Puruna the people there live in one and the same place without any distinction among members of the community, but afterwards it says that the names of their castes are Pushkara, Pushkala, Dhanya, and Tishya (?). They worship Janârdana. 5. Salmala- The fifth, or Salmala-Dvipa, has, according to the Dripa. Matsya-Purana, mountains and rivers. Its inhabitants

Page 301

CHAPTER XXIV. 255

are pure, long-lived, mild, and never angry. They never snffer from drought or dearth, for their food comes to them simply in answer to their wishes, with- out their sowing or toiling. They come into exist- ence without being born ; they are never ill nor sorry. They do not require the rule of kings, since they do not know the desire for property. They live contented and in safety; they always prefer that which is good and love virtue. The climate of this Dvipa never alters in cold or heat, so they are not bound to protect them- selves against either. They have no rain, but the water bubbles up for them out of the earth and drops down from the mountains. This is also the case in the following Dvipas. The inhabitants are of one kind, withont any distinction of caste. Every one lives 3000 years. According to the Vishnu-Purana they have beauti- ful faces and worship Bhagarat. They bring offerings to the fire, and every one of them lives 10,000 years. The names of their castes are Kapila, Aruna, Pita, and Krishņa. The sixth, or Gomeda-Dvipa, has, according to the 6. Gomeda- Matsya-Purana, two great mountains, the deep-black Dvîpa.

Sumanas, which encompasses the greatest part of the Dvipa, and the Kumuda, of golden colour and very lofty; the latter one contains all medicines. This Dvîpa has two kingdoms. According to Vishnn-Purana the inhabitants are pious and without sin and worship Vishnn. The names of their castes are Mriga, Magadha, Manasa, and Mandaga. The climate of this Dvipa is so healthy and pleasant that the inhabitants of paradise now and then visit it on account of the fragrancy of its air. The seventh, or Pnshkara-Dvipa, has, according to 7. Pushkara- the Matsya-Puranu, in its eastern part the mountain Dvîpa.

Citraśal, i.c. having a variegated roof with borns of jewels. Its height is 34,000 yojana, and its circum-

Page 302

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

ference 25,000 yojana. In the west lies the mountain Manasa, shining like the full moon; its height is 35,000 yojana. This mountain has a son who protects his father against the west. In the east of this Dvipa are two kingdoms where every inhabitant lives 10,000 years. The water bubbles up for them out of the earth, and drops down from the mountains. They have no rain and no flowing river; they know neither summer nor winter. They are of one kind, without any distinction of caste. They never suffer from dearth, and do not get old. Everything they wish for comes to them, whilst they live quiet and happy with- out knowing anything else but virtue. It is as if they were in the suburb of paradise. All bliss is given to them; they live long and are without ambition. So there is no service, no rule, no sin, no envy, no oppo- sition, no debating, no toiling in agriculture and dili- gence in trading. According to the Vishņu-Purana, Pushkara-Dvipa is so called from a large tree, which is also called nya- grodha. Under this tree is Brahma-rutpa, i.c. the figure of Brahman, worshipped by the Deva and Danava. The inhabitants are equal among each other, not claim- ing any superiority, whether they be human beings or beings associating with the Devas. In this Dvipa there is only a single mountain, called Manasottama, which rises in a round form on the round Dvipa. From its top all the other Dvipas are visible, for its height is 50,000 yojana, and the breadth the same.

Page 303

CHAPTER XXV.

ON TIE RIVERS OF INDIA, THEIR SOURCES AND COURSES.

THE Vayu-Purana enumerates the rivers rising in the Page 128. well-known great mountains which we have mentioned trom Vayu- Quotation

as the knots of Mount Meru (cide p. 247). To facili- Purana.

tate the study we exhibit them in the following table :-

The Great Knots. Namcs of the Rivers which rise in them in Nagarasamcritta.

Mahendra Trisaga, Rishikulya, Ikshula, Tripava (?), Ayana (!), Langulini, Vamsavara.

Malaya . Kritamala, Tamravarna, Pushpajati, Utpala- vatî (!).

Godavari, Bhimarathi, Krishna, Vainya, Sa- Sahya vañjulâ, Tungabhadrâ, Suprayogâ, Pâjaya (7), Kâverî.

Šukti Rishîka, Bâlûka (!), Kumârî, Mandavabinî, Kirpa (!), Palâsinî.

Sona, Mahânada, Narmadâ, Surasa, Kirva (?), Mandakini, Dasarna, Citrakuta, Tamasa, Riksha . P'ipyala, Sroni, Karamoda (?), Pisabika (?), Citrapala, Mahâvega, Banjula, Bâluvahiņî, Suktimatî, Shakruna (?), Tridivâ.

Tapi, Payoshni, Nirbindhya, Sirva (?), Nish-

Vindhya adha, Venva, Vaitaranî, Sini, Ilabu Kumudvatî, Antaśila. Toba, Mahagauri, Durga, (1)

Vedasmriti, Vedavati, Vritraghnî (?) Parnâsâ, Pâriyâtra Nandana, Saddana (?), Ramadi (?), Para, Carmanvatî, Lûpa (?), Vidisa.

VOL. I.

Page 304

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

The rivers of The Mutsya-Purana and Vayu-Purana mention the Europe and Asia rising rivers flowing in Jambu-Dvipa, and say that they rise in the Hima- laya and its in the mountains of Himavant. In the following table extensions to west and we simply enumerate them, without following any east. particular principle of arrangement. The reader must imagine that the mountains form the boundaries of India. The northern mountains are the snowy Hima- vant. In their centre lies Kashmir, and they are con- nected with the country of the Turks. This mountain region becomes colder and colder till the end of the inhabitable world and Mount Meru. Because this Page 129. mountain has its chief extension in longitude, the rivers rising on its north side flow through the countries of the Turks, Tibetans, Khazars, and Slavonians, and fall into the Sea of Jurjan (the Caspian Sea), or the sea of Khwârizm (the Aral Sea), or the Sea Pontus (the Black Sea), or the northern Sea of the Slavonians (the Baltic); whilst the rivers rising on the southern slopes flow through India and fall into the great ocean, some reaching it single, others combined. Rivers of The rivers of India come either from the cold moun- India. tains in the north or from the eastern mountains, both of which in reality form one and the same chain, ex- tending towards the east, and then turning towards the south until they reach the great ocean, where parts of it penetrate into the sea at the place called the Dike of Rama. Of course, these mountains differ very much in cold and heat. We exhibit the names of the rivers in the following table :-

Page 305

CHAPTER XXV. 259

Sindh or Biyatta C'andrabhâgâ Biyâha Iravati to S'atarudra the river of Vaiband. or Jailam. to the west the east of or Candrâha. of Lahore. Lahore. Shataldar.

Sarsat, fowing through Jaun. Gangâ. Sarayû Devika. the country or Sarwa. Kuhú.

Sarsat.

Gomati. Dhutapâpâ. Visala. Bâhndâ- sa (!). Kausiki. Niścirâ.

Gaņdakî. Lohita. Drishadvati. Tâmra Aruņa. Parnâśâ. Vedasmriti.

Vidâsinî. C'andanâ. Kâwanâ. Parâ. Carmanvati. Vidiśa.

S'ipra, rises in the Veņumati. Pariyâtrâ Karatoya. Shmabina. and passes Ujain.

In the mountains bordering on the kingdom of Kaya- Sindh river. bish, i.e. Kâbul, rises a river which is called Ghorwand, Page 130. on account of its many branches. It is joined by several affnents :- I. The river of the pass of Ghûzak. 2. The river of the gorge of Panchir, below the town of Parwân. 3, 4. The river Sharvat and the river Sawa, which latter flows through the town of Lanbaga, i.e. Lamghân; they join the Ghorvand at the fortress of Druta. 5, 6. The rivers Nur and Kira. Swelled by these affluents, the Ghorvand is a great river opposite the town of Purshavar, being there called the ford, from a ford near the village of Mahanara, on the eastern banks of the river, and it falls into the river Sindh near the castle of Bitûr, below the capital of Alķandahâr (Gandhâra), i.e. Vaihand. The river Biyatta, known as Jailam, from the city of

Page 306

260 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Rivers of this name on its western banks, and the river Canda- the Panjab. raha join each other nearly fifty miles above Jahravar, and pass along west of Multan. The river Biyah flows east of Multan, and joins after- wards the Biyatta and Candaraha. The river Irava is joined by the river Kaj, which rises in Nagarkot in the mountains of Bhatul. Thereupon follows as the fifth the river Shatladar (Satlej). After these five rivers have united below Multan at a place called Pañcanada, i.c. the meeting-place of the five rivers, they form an enormous watercourse. In flood-times it sometimes swells to such a degree as to cover nearly a space of ten farsakh, and to rise above the tree of the plains, so that afterwards the rubbish carried by the floods is found in their highest branches like birds-nests. The Muslims call the river, after it has passed the Sindhi city Aror, as a united stream, the ricer of Mihran. Thus it extends, flowing straight on, be- coming broader and broader, and gaining in purity of water, enclosing in its course places like islands, until it reaches Almansûra, situated between several of its arms, and flows into the ocean at two places, near the city Loharani, and more eastward in the province of Kacch at a place called Sindhu-sagara, i.e. the Sindh Sca.

Eranian As the name union of the fire rivers occurs in this tradition. part of the world (in Panjab), we observe that a similar name is used also to the north of the above-mentioned mountain chains, for the rivers which flow thence towards the north, after having united near Tirmidh and having formed the river of Balkh, are called the union of the seven rivers. The Zoroastrians of Sogdiana have confounded these two things; for they say that the whole of the seven rivers is Sindh, and its upper course Baridish. A man descending on it sees the sinking of the sun on his right side if he turns his

Page 307

CHAPTER XXV.

face towards the west, as we see it here on our left side (sic). The river Sarsati falls into the sea at the distance of Varions a bowshot east of Somanâth. rivers of India. The river Jaun joins the Ganges below Kanoj, which lies west of it. The united stream falls into the great ocean near Gangâsâgara. Between the mouths of the rivers Sarsati and Ganges is the mouth of the river Narmada, which descends from the eastern mountains, takes its course in a south- western direction, and falls into the sea near the town Bahroj, nearly sixty yojana east of Somanath. Behind the Ganges flow the rivers Rahab and Ka- wini, which join the river Sarwa near the city of Bari. The Hindus believe that the Ganges in ancient times flowed in Paradise, and we shall relate at a subsequent opportunity how it happened to come down upon earth. The Matsya-Purana says: "After the Ganges had Qnotation settled on earth, it divided itself into seven arms, the Matsya- from

middle of which is the main stream, known as the Page 131. Puraņa.

Ganges. Three flowed eastward, Nalini, Hradinî, and Pavani, and three westward, Sita, Cakshu, and Sindhu. The river Sita rises in the Himavant, and flows through these countries : Salila, Karstuba, Cina, Var- vara, Yavasa (?), Baha, Pushkara, Kulata, Mangala, Kavara, and Sangavanta (?); then it falls into the western ocean. South of Sita flows the river Cakshus, which irrigates the countries Cina, Maru, Kalika (?), Dhulika (?), Tuk- hara, Barbara, Kaca (?), Palhava, and Barwancat. The river Sindh flows through the countries Sindhu, Darada, Zindutunda (?), Gândhâra, Rûrasa (?), Krra (?), Śivapaura, Indramaru, Sabati (?), Saindhava, Kubata, Bahîmarvara, Mara, Mruna, and Sukûrda. The river Ganges, which is the middle and main

Page 308

262 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

stream, flows through the Gandharva, the musicians, Kimnara, Yakshas, Rakshasa, Vidyadhara, Uraga, i.e. those who creep on their breasts, the serpents, Kalâpa- grama, i.c. the city of the most virtuous, Kimpurusha, Khasa (?), the mountaineers, Kirâta, Pulinda, the hunters in the plains, robbers, Kuru, Bharata, Pancâla, Kaushaka (?), Matsya, Magadha, Brahmottara, and Tamalipta. These are the good and bad beings through whose territories the Ganges flows. After- wards it enters into branches of the mountain Vin- dhya, where the elephants live, and then it falls into the southern ocean. Of the eastern Ganges arms, the Hradini flows through the countries Nishaba, Ûpakâna, Dhivara, Prishaka, Nilamukha, Kikara, Ushtrakarņa, i.c. people whose lips are turned like their ears, Kirâta, Kalîdara, Vivarņa, i.e. the colourless people, so called on account of their intense blackness, Kushikâna, and Svargabhûmi, i.e. a country like Paradise. Finally it falls into the eastern ocean. The river Pâvani gives water to the Kupatha (?), who are far from sin, Indradyumnasaras, i.e. the cisterns of the king Indradyumna, Kharapatha, Bitra, and Sanku- patha. It flows through the steppe Udyanamarura, through the country of the Kusapravarana, and Indra- dvîpa, and afterwards it falls into the salt sea. The river Nalinî flows through Tamara, Hamsamarga, Samuhuka, and Purņa. All these are pious people who abstain from evil. Then it flows through the midst of mountains and passes by the Karnaprâvarana, i.e. people whose ears fall down on their shoulders, Asvamukha, i.e. people with horse-faces, Parvatamaru, mountainous steppes, and Rumimandala. Finally it flows into the ocean. Vishnu- The Vishnu-Purana mentions that the great rivers Purana. of the middle earth which flow into the ocean are Anutapata, Shikhi, Dipapa, Tridiva, Karma, Amrita and Sukrita.

Page 309

( 263 )

CHAPTER XXVI.

ON THE SHAPE OF HEAVEN AND EARTII ACCORDING TO Page 132. THE HINDU ASTRONOMERS.

THIS and similar questions have received at the hands of the Hindus a treatment and solution totally different from that which they have received among us Muslims. The sentences of the Koran on these and other subjects The Koran, necessary for man to know are not such as to require a and clear a certain

strained interpretation in order to become positive cer- research. basıs of all

tainties in the minds of the hearers, and the same may be said regarding the holy codes revealed before the Koran. The sentences of the Koran on the subjects necessary for man to know are in perfect harmony with the other religious codes, and at the same time they are perfectly clear, without any ambiguity. Besides, the Koran does not contain questions which have for ever been subjects of controversy, nor such questions the solution of which has always been despaired of, e.g. questions similar to certain puzzles of chronology. Islam was already in its earliest times exposed to the Islam machinations of people who were opposed to it in the I. Bs a falsified :

bottom of their heart, people who preached Islam with parts. Judaistic

sectarian tendencies, and who read to simple-minded audiences out of their Koran-copies passages of which not a single word was ever created (i.e. revealed) by God. But people believed them and copied these things on their authority, beguiled by their hypocrisy ; nay, they disregarded the trne form of the book which they had had until then, because the vulgar mind is

Page 310

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

always inclined to any kind of delusion. Thus the" pure tradition of Islam has been rendered confused by this Judaistic party. IL. By the Islam encountered a second mishap at the hands of dualists. the Zindiks, the followers of Mani, like Ibn Almukaffa, 'Abd-alkarîm Ibn 'Abi-al'auja', and others, who, being the fathers of criticism, and declaring one thing as just, another as admissible, &c., raised doubts in weak-minded people as to the One and First, i.c. the Unique and Eternal God, and directed their sympathies towards dualism. At the same time they presented the bio- graphy of Mani to the people in such a beautiful garb that they were gained over to his side. Now this man did not confine himself to the trash of his sectarian theology, but also proclaimed his views about the form of the world, as may be seen from his books, which were intended for deliberate deception. His opinions were far-spread. Together with the inventions of the above- mentioned Judaistic party, they formed a religious system which was declared to be the Islam, but with which God has nothing whatever to do. Whoso opposes it and firmly adheres to the orthodox faith in conformity with the Koran is stigmatised by them as an infidel and heretic and condemned to death, and they will not allow him to hear the word of the Koran. All these acts of theirs are more impious than even the words of Pharaoh, "I am your highest lord" (Sura, 79, 24), and "I do not know of any god for you save myself" (Sura, 28, 38). If party spirit of this kind will go on and rule for a long time, we may easily decline from the straight path of honour and duty. We, however, take our refuge with God, who renders firm the foot of every one who seeks Him, and who seeks the truth about Him.

Veneration The religious books of the Hindus and their codes of the Hindus for of tradition, the Puranas, contain sentences about the their as- tronomers. shape of the world which stand in direct opposition to

Page 311

CHAPTER XXVI.

scientific truth as known to their astronomers. By these books people are guided in fulfilling the rites of their religion, and by means of them the great mass of the' nation have been wheedled into a predilection for astronomical calculation and astrological predictions and warnings. The conseqnence is, that they show much affection to their astronomers, declaring that they are excellent men, that it is a good omen to meet them, and firmly believing that all of them come into Paradise and none into hell. For this the astronomers requite them Astrono- by accepting their popular notions as truth, by con- popular mers admit

forming themselves to them, however far from truth their notions into

most of them may be, and by presenting them with such doctrines.

spiritual stuff as they stand in need of. This is the reason why the two theories, the vulgar and the scientific. have become intermingled in the course of time, why the doctrines of the astronomers have been disturbed and confused, in particular the doctrines of those anthors-and they are the majority-who simply copy their predecessors, who take the bases of their science from tradition and do not make them the objects of independent scientific research. We shall now explain the views of Hindu astrono- General mers regarding the present subject, viz. the shape of ou the observations

heaven and earth. According to them, heaven as well of the earth, rotundity as the whole world is round, and the earth has a and Vada- eu Meru

globnlar shape, the northern half being dry land, the vamukha.

southern half being covered with water. The dimen- Page 133. sion of the earth is larger according to them than it is according to the Greeks and modern observations, and in their calculations to find this dimension they have entirely given up any mention of the traditional seas and Duipas, and of the enormous sums of yojana attri- buted to each of them. The astronomers follow the theologians in everything which does not encroach npon their science, e.g. they adopt the theory of Mount Meru being under the north pole, and that of the island

Page 312

266 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Vadavamukha lying under the south pole. Now, it is entirely irrelevant whether Meru is there or not, as it is only required for the explanation of the particular mill-like rotation, which is necessitated by the fact that to each spot on the plane of the earth corresponds a spot in the sky as its zenith. Also the fable of the southern island Vadavamukha does no harm to their science, although it is possible, nay, even likely, that each pair of quarters of the earth forms a coherent, uninterrupted unity, the one as a continent, the other as an ocean (and that in reality there is no such island under the south pole). Such a disposition of the earth is required by the law of gravitation, for according to them the earth is in the centre of the universe, and everything heavy gravitates towards it. Evidently on account of this law of gravitation they consider heaven, too, as having a globular shape. We shall now exhibit the opinions of the Hindu astronomers on this subject according to our translation of their works. In case, however, one word or other in our translation should be used in a meaning different from that which it generally has in our sciences, we ask the reader to consider only the original meaning of the word (not the technical one), for this only is meant. Quotation Pulisa says in his Siddhanta: "Paulisa the Greek from the Siddhanta. says somewhere that the earth has a globular shape, of Pulisa. whilst in another place he says that it has the shape of a corer (i.e. of a flat plane). And in both sentences he is right; for the plane or surface of the earth is round, and its diameter is a straight line. That he, however, only believed in the globular shape of the earth, may be proved by many passages of his work. Besides, all scholars agree on this head, as Varahamihira, Arya- bhata, Deva, Śrishena, Vishnucandra, and Brahman. If the earth were not round, it would not be girded with the latitudes of the different places on earth, day and night would not be different in winter and summer,

Page 313

CHAPTER XXVI.

and the conditions of the planets and of their rotations would be quite different from what they are. "The position of the earth is central. Half of it is clay, half water. Mount Mern is in the dry half, the home of the Deva, the angels, and above it is the pole. In the other half, which is covered by water, lies Vada- vâmukba, under the south pole, a continent like an island, inhabited by the Daitsa and Nâga, relatives of the Deva on Meru. Therefore it is also called Dait- yântara. "The line which divides the two earth-halves, the dry and the wet, from each other, is called Niralsha, i.e. having no latitude, being identical with our equator. In the four cardinal directions with relation to this line there are four great cities :-

Yamakoti, in the cast. Romaka, in the west. Lanka, in the south. Siddhapura, in the north.

"The earth is fastened on the two poles, and held by the axis. When the sun rises over the line which passes both through Meru and Lanka, that moment is noon to Yamakoti, midnight to the Greeks, and evening to Siddhapura." In the same manner things are represented by Ârya- bhața. Brahmagupta, the son of Jishnn, a native of Bhilla- Quetation mala, says in his Brahmasiddhanta: "Many are the Branmaid- from the

sayings of people about the shape of the earth, specially dhânta of Brahma- among those who study the Puranas and the religious gupta.

books. Some say that it is level like a mirror, others Page 134. say that it is hollow like a bowl. Others maintain that it is level like a mirror, inclosed by a sea, this sea being inclosed by an earth, this earth being inclosed by a sea, &c., all of them being round like collars. Each sea or earth has the double size of that which it incloses. The outside earth is sixty-four times as large as the central earth, and the sea inclosing the outside earth is

Page 314

268 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

sixty-four times as large as the sea inclosing the central earth. Several circumstances, however, compel us to attribute globular shape both to the earth and heaven, viz. the fact that the stars rise and set in different places at different times, so that, e.g. a man in Yama- koti observes one identical star rising above the western horizon, whilst a man in Rum at the same time observes it rising above the eastern horizon. Another argument to the same effect is this, that a man on Meru observes one identical star above the horizon in the zenith of Lanka, the country of the demons, whilst a man in Lankâ at the same time observes it above his head. Besides, all astronomical calculations are not correct unless we assume the globular figure of heaven and earth. Therefore we must declare that heaven is a globe, because we observe in it all the characteristics of a globe, and the observation of these characteristics of the world would not be correct unless in reality it were a globe. Now, it is evident that all the other theories about the world are futile." Quotations Âryabhata inquires into the nature of the world, trom various astrono- and says that it consists of earth, water, fire, and wind, mers. and that each of these elements is round. Likewise Vasishtha and Lâta say that the five ele- ments, viz. earth, water, fire, wind, and heaven, are round. Varahamihira says that all things which are per- ceived by the senses, are witnesses in favour of the globular shape of the earth, and refute the possibility of its having another shape. Âryabhata, Pulisa, Vasishtha, and Lâța agree in this, that when it is noon in Yamakoti, it is midnight in Rum, beginning of the day in Lanka, and beginning of the night in Siddhapura, which is not possible if the world is not round. Likewise the periodicity of the eclipses can only be explained by the world's being round.

Page 315

CHAPTER XXVI.

LAta says: "On each place of the earth only one-half of the globe of heaven is seen. The more northern our latitude is, the more Meru and the pole rise above the horizon ; as they sink down below the horizon, the more southern is our latitude. The equator sinks down from the zenith of places, the greater their latitude is both in north and south. A man who is north of the equator only sees the north pole, whilst the south pole is invi- sible to him, and vice cerst." These are the words of Hindu astronomers regarding Considera- the globular shape of heaven and earth, and what is garding the tions re.

between them, and regarding the fact that the earth, the eartli, rotundity of

situated in the centre of the globe, is only of a small of grarity the balance

size in comparison with the visible part of heaven. between the northern These thoughts are the elements of astronomy as con- ern halves, and south-

tained in the first chapter of Ptolemy's Almagest, and traction of and the at-

of similar books, though they are not worked out in gravitation. that scientific form in which we are accustomed to give them,

for the earth is more heavy than the water, and the (Laevna,)

water is flnid like the air. The globular form must be to the earth a physical necessity, as long as it does uot, by the order of God, take another form. Therefore the earth could not move towards the north, nor the water Page 135. move towards the south, and in consequence one whole half is not terra firma, nor the other half water, unless we suppose that the terra firma half be hollow. As far as our observation, based on induction, goes, the terra firma must be in one of the two northern quarters, and therefore we guess that the same is the case on the adjacent qnarter. We admit the possibility of the existence of the island Vadavamukha, but we do not maintain it, since all we know of it and of Meru is exclusively based on tradition. The equatorial line does not, in the quarter of the earth known to us, represent a boundary between terra

Page 316

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

firma and the ocean. For in certain places the con- tinent protrudes far into the ocean, so as to pass beyond the equator, e.g. the plains of the negroes in the west, which protrude far towards the south, even beyond the mountains of the moon and the sources of the Nile, in fact, into regions which we do not exactly know. For that continent is desert and impassable, and likewise the sea behind Sufala of the Zanj is unnavigable. No ship which ventured to go there has ever returned to relate what it had witnessed. Also a great part of India above the province of Sindh deeply protrudes far towards the south, and seems even to pass beyond the equator. In the midst between both lie Arabia and Yemen, but they do not go so far south as to cross the equator. Further, as the terra firma stretches far out into the ocean, thus the ocean too penetrates into terra firma, breaking into it in various places, and forming bays and gulfs. For instance, the sea extends as a tongue along the west side of Arabia as far as the neighbour- hood of Central Syria. It is narrowest near Kulzum, whence it is also called the Sea of Kulzum. Another and still larger arm of the sea exists east of Arabia, the so-called Persian Sea. Between India and China, also, the sea forms a great curve towards the north. Hence it is evident that the coast-line of these countries does not correspond to the equator, nor keep an invariable distance from it, (Lacuna,) and the explanation relating to the four cities will follow in its proper place. The difference of the times which has been remarked is one of the results of the rotundity of the earth, and of its occupying the centre of the globe. And if they attribute to the earth, though it be round, inhabitants- for cities cannot be imagined without inhabitants-the e.xistence of men on earth is accounted for by the

Page 317

CHAPTER XXVI. 271

attraction of everything heavy towards its centre, i.c. the middle of the world. Much to the same effect are the expressions of Vatyu- Quotations Purana, viz. that noon in Amaravati is sunrise in Vai- Fayu and from the

vasvata, midnight in Sukhâ, and sunset in Vibhâ. Matsya Pu- ránas. Similar, also, are the expressions of Matsya-Purana, for this book explains that east of Meru lies the city Amaravatipura, the residence of Indra, the ruler. and his wife; south of Meru, the city Samyamanipura, the residence of Yama, the son of the Sun, where he punishes and requites mankind ; west of Meru, the city Sukhapura, the residence of Varuna, i.c. the water; and north of Meru, the city Vibhavaripura, belonging to the Moon. Sun and planets revolve round Meru. When the sun has his noon position in Amaravatipura, it is the beginning of the day in Samyamanipura, midnight in Sukhâ, and the beginning of the night in Vibhâvari- pura. And when the sun has his noon position in Sainyamanîpura, he rises over Sukhapura, sets over Amaravatipura, and has his midnight position with relation to Vibhavaripura. Page 136. If the author of the Matsya-Purana says that the A noteufthe sun revolves round Meru, he means a mill-like rotation anthor on the passage round those who inhabit Meru, who, in consequence of Matsya-Pu- from the

this nature of the rotation, do not kuow east nor west. The sun does not rise for the inhabitants of Meru in one particular place, but in various places. By the word cast the author means the zenith of one city, and by west the zenith of another. Possibly those four cities of the Matsya-Purana are identical with those men- tioned by the astronomers. But the author has not mentioned how far they are distant from Mern. What we have besides related as notions of the Hindus is perfectly correct and borne out by scieutific methods ; however, they are wont never to speak of the pole unless they mention in the same breath also the mountain Meru. gupta and Brabma-

In the definition of what is low the Hindus agree hira on the Varabami-

with us, viz. that it is the centre of the world, but their gravitation, law oi

Page 318

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

expressions on this head are subtle, more particularly as this is one of the great questions which is only handled by the most eminent of their scholars. So Brahmagupta says : " Scholars have declared that the globe of the earth is in the midst of heaven, and that Mount Meru, the home of the Devas, as well as Vadavamukba below, is the home of their opponents; the Daitya and Danava belong to it. But this below is according to them only a relative one. Disregarding this, we say that the earth on all its sides is the same; all people on earth stand upright, and all heavy things fall down to the earth by a law of nature, for it is the nature of the earth to attract and to keep things, as it is the nature of water to flow, that of fire to burn, and that of the wind to set in motion. If a thing wants to go deeper down than the earth, let it try. The earth is the only low thing, and seeds always return to it, in whatever direction you may throw them away, and never rise upwards from the earth." Varahamihira says: " Mountains, seas, rivers, trees, cities, men, and angels, all are around the globe of the earth. And if Yamakoti and Rum are opposite to each other, one could not say that the one is low in its relation to the other, since the low does not exist. How could one say of one place of the earth that it is low, as it is in every particular identical with any other place on earth, and one place conld as little fall as any other. Every one speaks to himself with regard to his own self, ' I am above and the others are below,' whilst all of them are around the globe like the blossoms springing on the branches of a Kadamba-tree. They encircle it on all sides, but each individual blossom has the same position as the other, neither the one hanging downward nor the other standing upright. For the earth attracts that which is upon her, for it is the below towards all directions, and heaven is the abore towards all directions." As the reader will observe, these theories of the

Page 319

CHAPTER XXVI. 273

Hindus are based on the correct knowledge of the laws of nature, but, at the same time, they practise a little deceit upon their traditionalists and theologians. So Balabhadra the commentator says: "It is the most Quotations correct of the'opinions of people, many and different as bhadra, and from Bala-

they are, that the earth and Meru and the zodiacal eriticisms the author's

sphere are round. And the Apta (?)-purana-kara, i.e. on them.

the faithful followers of the Purana, say: 'The earth is like the back of a tortoise; it is not round from below.' They are perfectly right, because the earth is in the midst of tbe water, and that which appears above the water has the shape of a tortoise-back; and Page 137. the sea around the earth is not navigable. The fact of the earth being round is proved by eyesight." Here the reader must notice how Balabhadra declares the theory of the theologians as to the rotundity of the back to be true. He gives himself the air of not knowing that they deny that the womb, i.e. the other half of the globe, is round, and he busies himself with a traditional element (as to the earth being like the back of a tortoise), which, in reality, has no connection with the subject. Further, Balabhadra says : " Human eyesight reaches to a point distant from the earth and its rotundity the 96th part of 5000 yojana, i.e. 52 yojana (exactly 527'). Therefore man does not observe its rotundity, and hence the discrepancy of opinions on the subject." Those pious men (the Apta (?)-purana-kara) do not deny the rotundity of the back of the earth ; nay, they maintain it by comparing the earth to the back of a tortoise. Only Balabhadra makes them deny it (by the words, " the earth is not round from below," supra), since he understood their words as meaning that the water surrounds the earth. That which rises above the water may either be globular or a plain rising above the water like an inverted drum, i.e like a segment of a round pilaster. VOL. I. S

Page 320

274 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Further, the remark of Balabhadra (v. p. 273), that man, on account of the smallness of his stature, cannot observe the rotundity of the earth, is not true; because even if the human stature were as tall as the plumb-line of the highest mountain, if he were to make his observation only from one single point without going to other places, and without reasoning about the observations made at the different places, even such a height would be of no avail to him, and he would not be able to perceive the rotundity of the earth and its nature. What, however, is the connection of this remark with the popular theory? If he had concluded from analogy that that side of the earth which is opposed to the round one-I mean the lower half-was also round, and if he then had given his theory about the extent of the power of human vision as a result of reflection, not as a result of the perception of the senses, his theory would seem to have a certain foun- dation. Calenlation With regard to Balabhadra's definition of the extent on the ex. tent of which may be reached by the human eye, we propose human vision on the following calculation :- the eartb. Let A B round the centre H represent the globe of C the earth. B is the standing- point of the observer; his B stature is B C. Further, we draw the line C A, so that it T A touches the earth. Now it is evident that the field of vision is B A, which H we suppose to be equal to o'5 of the circle, i.c. 3ª degrees, if we divide the circle into 36o degrees. According to the method followed in the calculation of the mountain Meru (in chap. xxiii.), we divide the square of T A, i.e. 50,625, by

Page 321

CHAPTER XXVI. 275

HT, i.e. 3431'. So we get as quotient T C=o° 14' 45"; and B C, the stature of the observer, is 0° 7' 45". Our calculation is based on this, that H B, the sinus totus, is 3438'. However, the radius of the earth is, according to the circumference which we have men- tioned, 795' 27' 16" (yojana). If we measure B C by this measure, it is = I yojuna, 6 krosa, 1035 yards (= 57,035 yards). If we suppose B C to be eqnal to four yards, it stands in the same relation to A T, according to the measure of the sine, as 57,035, i.e. the yards which we have found as the measure of the stature, to A T according to the measure of the sine, i.c. 225. If we now calculate the sine, we find it to be o° o' I" 3'", and its arc has the same measure. However, each degree of the rotundity of the earth represents the measure of 13 yojana, 7 krosa, and 333} yards (sic). Therefore the field of vision on the earth is 291g yards (sic). Page 138. (For an erplanation of this calculation sce the notes.) The source of this calculation of Balabhadra's is the Pulisa-siddhanta, which divides the arc of the quarter of a circle into 24 kardajat. He says: "If anybody asks for the reason of this, he must know that each of these kardajat is vg of the circle =225 minutes (= 3ª degrees). And if we reckon its sine, we find it also to be= 225 minutes." This shows us that the sines are equal to their arcs in parts which are smaller than this kardaja. And because the sinus totus, according to Pulisa and Aryabhata, has the relation of the diameter to the circle of 360 degrees, this arithmetical equality brought Balabhadra to think that the arc was perpen- dicular; and any expanse in which no convexity pro- trndes preventing the vision from passing, and which is not too small to be seen, is visible. This, howerer, is a gross mistake; for the arc is never perpendicular, and the sine, however small it be, never equals the arc. This is admissible only for such degrees as are supposed for the convenience of

Page 322

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

calculation, but it is never and nowhere true for the degrees of the earth. The axis of If Polisa says (v. p. 267) that the earth is held according to by an axis, he does not mean thereby that in reality the earth

Pulisa, there exists such an axis, and that but for it the earth would fall. How could he say such a thing, since he is of opinion that there are four inhabited cities around the world, which is explained by the fact that every- thing heavy falls from all sides down towards the earth ? However, Pulisa holds this view, that the motion of the peripheric parts is the reason why the central parts are motionless, and that the motion of a globe presupposes two poles, and one line connecting them, which in the idea is the axis. It is as if he meant to say, that the motion of heaven keeps the earth in its place, making it the natural place for the earth, outside of which it could never be. And this place lies on the midst of the axis of motion. For the other diameters of the globe may also be imagined to be axes, since ev dvvapet they are all axes, and if the earth were not in the midst of an axis, there might be axes which did not pass through the earth. Hence one may say metaphorically that the earth is supported by the axes. Whether the As regards the resting of the earth, one of the ele- earth moves or is at rest, mentary problems of astronomy, which offers many and according to Brahma- great difficnlties, this, too, is a dogma with the Hindu gupta and the author. astronomers. Brahmagupta says in the Brahmasid- dhanta: "Some people maintain that the first motion Pagc 139. (from east to west) does not lie in the meridian, but belongs to the earth. But Varahamihira refutes them by saying: 'If that were the case, a bird would not return to its nest as soon as it had flown away from it towards the west.' And, in fact, it is precisely as Varâhamihira says." Brahmagupta says in another place of the same book : " The followers of Aryabhata maintain that the earth is moving and heaven resting. People have tried to

Page 323

CHAPTER XXVİ. 277

refnte them by saying that, if such were the case, stones and trees would fall from the earth." But Brahmagupta does not agree with them, and says that that would not necessarily follow from their theory, apparently becanse he thought that all heavy things are attracted towards the centre of the earth. He says: "On the contrary, if that were the case, the carth would not cie in keeping an eren and uniform pace with the minutes of hearen, the pranas of the times." There seems to be some confusion in this chapter, perhaps by the fault of the translator. For the minutes of heacen are 21,600, and are called prana, i.c. breaths. becanse according to them each minnte of the meridian revolves in the time of an ordinary human breath. Snpposing this to be true, and that the earth makes a complete rotation eastward in so many breaths as heaven does according to his (Brahmagupta's) view, we cannot see what should prevent the earth from keeping an even and uniform pace with heaven. Besides, the rotation of the earth does in no way im- pair the value of astronomy, as all appearances of an astronomic character can quite as well be explained according to this theory as to the other. There are, however, other reasons which make it impossible. This qnestion is most diflicnlt to solve. The most pro- minent of both modern and ancient astronomers have deeply stndied the question of the moving of the earth, and tried to refute it. We, too, have composed a book on the subject called Miftah-ilm-alhai'a (Key of Astronomy), in which we think we bave surpassed our predecessors, if not in the words, at all events in the matter.

Page 324

CHAPTER XXVII.

ON THE FIRST TWO MOTIONS OF THE UNIVERSE (THAT FROM EAST TO WEST ACCORDING TO ANCIENT ASTRONOMERS AND TIE PRECESSION OF THE EQUI- NOXES), BOTH ACCORDING TO HIINDU ASTRONOMERS AND THE AUTHORS OF THE PURÂNAS.

THE astronomers of the Hindus hold on this snbject mostly the same views as ourselves. We shall give quotations from them, bnt shall at once confess that that which we are able to give is very scanty indeed. Qnetation Pulisa says: "The wind makes the sphere of the on the subject fixed stars revolve; the two poles keep it in its place, from Pulisa. and its motion appears to the inhabitants of Mount Meru as a motion from the left to the right; to the inhabitants of Vadavamnkha as one from the right to the left." In another place he says: "If anybody asks for the direction of the motion of the stars which we see rising in the east and rotating towards the west until they set, let him know that the motion which ace see as a west- ward motion appears different according to the places which the spectators occupy. The inhabitants of Mount Mern see it as a motion from the left to the right, whilst the inhabitants of Vadavaimukha see it as the opposite, as a motion from the right to the left. The inhabitants of the equator see it exclnsively as a westward motion, and the inhabitants of the parts of the earth between the poles and the eqnator see it more or less depressed, as their places have more or

Page 325

CHAPTER XXVII. 279

less northern or southern latitude. The whole of this motion is caused by the wind, which makes the spheres revolve, and compels the planets and the other stars to rise in the east and to set in the west. This, however, is only an accidens. As for the essentia rei, the motions of the heavenly bodies are directed towards the east, from Alsharatan towards Albutain, the latter lying east of the former. But if the inquirer does not know the lunar stations, and is not capable of procuring for him- Page 140. self by their help an idea of this eastward motion, let him observe the moon herself, how she moves away from the sun once and a second time; how she then comes near him, till she finally joins him. This will give him an idea of the second motion." Brahmagupta says: "The sphere has been created Quotations as moving with the greatest rapidity possible about two Brabma- from

poles without ever slackening, and the stars have been Balabhadra, gupta and

created where there is no Batn-hat nor Sharalan, i.e. on the frontier between them, which is the vernal equinox." Balabhadra, the commentator, says: "The whole world hangs on two poles, and moves in a circular motion, which begins with a kalpa and ends with a kalpa. But people must not therefore say that the world, on account of the continuity of its motion, is without beginning and without end." Brahmagupta says: "The place without latitude (Niraksha), divided into sixty ghuțikt, is the horizon for the inhabitants of Meru. There east is west ; and behind that place (beyond the equator) towards the south is Vadavamukha and the ocean which surronnds it. When the spheres and the stars revolve, the meri- dian becomes an horizon common to the Devas (in the north) and the Daityas (in the south), which they see together. But the direction of the motion appears to them as different. The motion which the angels see as a motion to the right, the Daityas see as one to the left, and vice cersa, just as a man who has a thing on his

Page 326

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

right side, looking into the water, sees it on his left. The cause of this uniform motion which never increases nor decreases is a wind, bnt it is not the common wind which we feel and hear; for this is lulled, and roused, and varies, whilst that wind never slackens." In another place Brahmagupta says: "The wind makes all the fixed stars and the planets revolve towards the west in one and the same revolution; but the planets move also in a slow pace towards the east, like a dust-atom moving on a potter's-wheel in a direc- tion opposite to that in which the wheel is revolving. That motion of this atom which is visible is identical with the motion which drives the wheel round, whilst its individual motion is not perceived. In this view Lâța, Arsabhața, and Vasishtha agree, but some people think that the earth moves while the sun is resting. That motion which mankind conceives as a motion from east to west, the angels (Deva) conceive as a motion from left to right, the Daityas as one from right to left."

Criticisms This is all I have read in Indian books on the of the anthor. subject. The wind as the Their speaking of the wind as the motor (supra) motor of the sphere. has, I think, only the purpose of bringing the subject near to the understanding of people and to facilitate its study; for people see with their own eyes that the wind, when blowing against instruments with wings and toys of this kind, puts them into motion. But as soon as they come to speak of the first morer (God), they at once give np any comparison with the natural wind, which in all its phases is determined by certain causes. For thongh it puts things into motion, the moving is not its essence; and besides, it cannot move without being in contact with something, becanse the wind is a body, and is acted upon by external influences or means, its motion being commensurate with their force.

Page 327

CHAPTER XXVII. 281

Their saying that the wind does not rest, simply means that the moving power works perpetually, and does not imply rest and motion snch as are proper to bodies. Further, their saying that it does not slacken means that it is free from all kinds of accidents ; for slnckening and weakening only occur in such bodies or Page 141. beings which are composed of elements of conflicting qualities. The expression that the two poles keep the sphere of On the two the fixed stars (p. 278) means that they keep or pre- the sphere. poles keeping

serve it in its normal state of motion, not that they keep or preserve it from falliug down. There is a story of an ancient Greek who thought that once upon a time the Milky Way had been a road of the sun, and that afterwards he had left it. Such a thing would mean that the motions ceased to be normal, and to something like this the expression of the poles keeping the sphere of the fixed stars may be referred. The phrase of Balabhadra abont the ending of the On the motion (that it ends with a kalpa, &c., p. 279) means nature of relative

that everything which exists and may be determined time.

arithmetically has no doubt an end, for two reasons: first, because it has a beginning, for every number consists of one and its reduplications, whilst the one itself exists before all of them ; and, sccondly, becanse part of it exists in the present moment of time, for if days and nights increase in number through the con- tinuation of existence, they must necessarily have a beginning whence they started. If a man maintains that time does not exist in the sphere (as one of its immanent qualities), and thinks that day and night have only a relatire existence, exist only in relation to the earth and its inhabitants, that if, e.g., the earth were taken away out of the midst of the world, also night and day would cease to exist as well as the possibility of measuring elements composed of days, he would thereby impose upon Balabhadra the necessity of a

Page 328

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

digression, and compel him to prove the cause, not of the first, but of the second motion. The latter cause is the cycles of the planets, which have only a relation to the sphere, not to the earth. These cycles Balabhadra indicates by the word kalpa (v. p. 279), since it com- prehends them all, and since all of them begin with its beginning. The meri- If Brahmagnpta says of the meridian that it is dian divided into sixty divided into sixty parts (v. p. 279), it is as if any one of ghatika. us should say, the meridian is divided into twenty-four parts; for the meridian is a medium for measuring and counting time. Its revolution lasts twenty-four hours, or, as the Hindus will have it, sixty ghatika (or ghart). This is the reason why they have reckoned the risings of the zodiacal signs in ghafika, not in times of the mcridian (360 degrees). On the fixed If, further, Brahmagupta says that the wind canses stars. the fixed stars and the planets to revolve, if he besides, in particular, attributes a slow eastward motion to the planets (p. 280), he gives the reader to understand that the fixed stars have no such motion, or else he would have said that they, too, have the same slow eastward motion as the planets, not differing from them save in size and in the variation which they exhibit in the re- trograde motion. Some people relate that the ancients originally did not understand their (the fixed stars') motions until, in long periods of time, they became aware of them. This opinion is confirmed by the fact that Brahmagupta's book does not, among the various cycles, mention the cycles of the fixed stars, and that he makes their appearing and disappearing depend upon invariable degrees of the sun. The direc- If Brahmagnpta maintains (p. 278) that to the in- tion of the heavenly habitants of the equator the first motion is not a motion as scen from to the right and left, the reader must bear in mind the motion, different points of following. A man dwelling under either of the two the earth. poles, to whatever direction he turns, has always the

Page 329

CHAPTER XXVII.

moving heavenly bodies before himself, and as they move in one direction, they must necessarily first stand opposite one of his hands, and then, moving on, come to stand opposite his other hand. The direction of this motion appears to the inhabitants of the two poles just the very contrary, like the image of a thing in the water or a mirror, where its directions seem to be ex- changed. If the image of a man is reflected by the water or a mirror, he appears as a different man stand- ing opposite to the spectator, his right side opposite to Puge 143. the left of the spectator, and his left side opposite to the right of the spectator. Likewise the inhabitants of places of northern lati- tude have the revolving heavenly bodies before them- selves towards the south, and the inhabitants of places of southern latitude have them before themselves towards the north. To them the motion appears the same as to the inhabitants of Mern and Vadava- mukha. But as regards those living on the equator, the heavenly bodies revolve nearly abore their heads, so they cannot have them before themselves in any direction. In reality, however, they deviate a little from the eqnator, and in consequence the people there have a uniform motion before themselves on two sides, the motion of the northern heavenly bodies from right to left, and that of the southern bodies from left to right. So they unite in their persons the faculty of the inhabitants of the two poles (viz. of seeing the heavenly bodies moving in different directions), and it depends entirely upon their will, if they want to see the stars move from the right to the left or rice versâ. It is the line passing through the zenith of a man standing on the equator which Brahmagupta means when he says that it is divided into sixty parts (v. p. 279). The authors of the Puranas represent heaven as a

Page 330

ALBERUNIS INDİA.

dome or cupola standing on earth and resting, and the stars as beings which wander individually from east to west. How could these men have any idea of the second motion ? And if they really had such an idea, how could an opponent of the same class of men con- cede the possibility that one and the same thing indi- vidually moves in two different directions ? We shall here communicate what we know of their theories, although we are aware that the reader will not derive any profit from them, since they are simply useless. Qmotation The Matsya-Purena says: "The sun and the stars from the Matsya- pass along southward as rapidly as an arrow revolv- Purana. ing round Meru. The sun revolves round something like a beam, the end of which is burning when its revolution is very rapid. The sun does not really disappear (during the night); he is then invisible only to some people, to some of the inhabitants of the four cities on the four sides of Meru. He revolves round Meru, starting from the north side of Mount Lokaloka; he does not pass beyond Lokâloka, nor illuminate its south side. He is invisible during the night, because he is so far away. Man can see him at a distance of 1000 yojana, but when he is so far away, a small object sufficiently near to the eye can render him invisible to the spectator. "When the sun stands in the zenith of Pushkara- Dvipa, he moves along the distance of one-thirtieth part of the earth in three-fifths of an hour. In so much time he traverses 21 laksha and 50,000 yojana, i.c. 2,1 50,000 yojana. Then he turns to the north, and the distance he traverses becomes thrice as large. In consequence, the day becomes long. The distance which the sun traverses in a southern day is 9 kofi and 10,045 yojana. When he then returns to the north and revolves round Kshira, i.e. the Milky Way, his daily march is koți and 21 luksha yojana."

Page 331

CHAPTER XXVII.

Now we ask the reader to consider how confused Criticisms these expressions are. If the author of the Matsya- author on of the

Purana says "the stars pass as rapidly as an arrow," the theory of the Matsya- &c., we take this for a hyperbole intended for unedu- Purdna.

cated people; but we must state that the arrow-like motion of the stars is not peculiar to the south to the exclusion of the north. There are limits both in the north and south whence the sun returns, and the time of the sun's passing from the southern limit to the northern is equal to the time of his passing from the northern limit to the southern. Therefore his motion Page 143. northiard has the same right of being described as ns rapid as an arrow. Herein, however, lies a hint of the theological opinion of the author regarding the north pole, for he thinks the north is the abore and the south the bclow. Hence the stars glide down to the south like children on a see-saw plank. If, however, the author hereby means the second motion, whilst in reality it is the first, we must state that the stars in the sccond motion do not revolve round Meru, and that the plane of this motion is inclined towards the horizon of Meru by one-twelfth of the circle. Further, how far-fetched is this simile in which he connects the motion of the sun with a burning beam! If we held the opinion that the sun moves as an un- interrupted round collar, his simile would be useful in so far as it refutes such an opinion. But as we consider the sun as a body, as it were, standing in heaven, his simile is meaningless. And if he simply means to say that the sun describes a round circle, his comparing the sun to a burning beam is quite super- fluous, because a stone tied to the end of a cord describes a similar circle if it is made to revolve round the head (there being no necessity for describing it as burning). That the sun rises over some people and sets over others, as he describes it, is true; but here, too, he is not free from his theological opinions. This is shown

Page 332

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

by his mention of the mountain Lokaloka and his re- mark that the rays of the sun fall on it, on its human or north side, not on its wild or south side. Further, the sun is not hidden during the night on account of his great distance, but because he is covered by something-by the earth according to us, by Mount Meru according to the author of the Matsya-Purana. He imagines that the sun marches round Meru, whilst we are on one of its sides. In consequence we are in a varying distance from the sun's path. That this is originally his opinion is confirmed by the later follow- ing remarks. That the sun is invisible during the night has nothing whatever to do with his distance from us. The numbers which the author of the Matsya-Puranat mentions I hold to be corrupt, as they are not borne out by any calculation. He represents the path of the sun in the north as threefold that in the south, and makes this the cause of the difference of the length of the day. Whilst in reality the sum of day and night is always identical, and day and night in north and south stand in a constant relation to each other, it seems necessary that we should refer his remarks to a latitude where the summer-day is 45 ghatikd, the winter-day 15 ghatika long. Further, his remark that the sun hastens in the north (marches there more rapidly than in the south), re- quires to be proved. The places of northern latitude have meridians not very distant from each other, be- cause of their being near to the pole, whilst the meridians become more distant from each other the nearer they are to the equator. If, now, the sun hastens in traversing a smaller distance, he wants less time than for traversing the greater distance, more especially if on this greater distance his march is slackening. In reality the opposite is the case. By his phrase when the sun revolves abore Pushkara- dvipa (p. 284) is meant the line of the winter solstice.

Page 333

CHAPTER XXVII.

According to him, on this line the day must be longer than in any other place, whether it be the summer solstice or another. All this is unintelligible. Similar notions are also found in the Vayu-Puruna, Qnotation viz. "that the day in the south is twelve muhurta, in vayu- from the

the north eighteen, and that the sun between south and Purâna.

north has a declination of 17,221 yojana in 183 days, i.c. 94(78) yojana for each day." One muhurla is equal to four-fifths of an hour (=48 minutes). The sentence of the Vayu-Purana applies to a latitude where the longest day is 14g hours. Page 114. As regards the numbers of the yojanas mentioned by the Vayu-Purana, the author means evidently the portio of the double declination of the sphere. Accord- ing to him, the declination is twenty-four degrees; therefore the yojanas of the whole sphere would be 129,1572. And the days in which the sun traverses the double declination are half the solar year, no regard being had to the fractions of days, which are nearly five-eighths of a day. Further, the Vayu-Purana says "that the sun in the north marches slowly duriug the day and rapidly dur- ing the night, and in the south vice rersa. Therefore the day is long in the north, even as much as eighteen muhurta." This is merely the language of a person who has not the slightest knowledge of the eastern motion of the sun, and is not able to measure a day's arc by observation. The Vishnu-Dharma says: "The orbit of the Great Quotation Bear lies under the pole; under it the orbit of Saturn ; Vishau- from the

then that of Jupiter; next Mars, the Sun, Venus, Dharma.

Mercury, and the Moon. They rotate towards the east like a mill, in a uniform kind of motion which is peculiar to each star, some of them moving rapidly, others slowly. Death and life repeat themselves on them from eternity thousands of times." If you examine this statement according to scientific

Page 334

288 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

principles, you will find that it is confused. Conceding that the Great Bear is nder the pole and that the place of the pole is absolute height, the Great Bear lies below the zenith of the inhabitants of Meru. In this statement he is right, but he is mistaken with regard to the planets. For the word below is, accord- ing to him, to be understood so as to mean a greater or smaller distance from the earth; and thus taken, his statement (regarding the distances of the planets from the earth) is not correct, unless we suppose that Saturn has, of all planets, the greatest declination from the equator, the next greatest Jupiter, then Mars, the Sun, Venus, &c., and that at the same time this amount of their declination is a constant one. This, however, does not correspond to reality. If we take the sum total of the whole statement of the Vishnu-Dharma, the author is right in so far as the fixed stars are higher than the planets, but he is wrong in so far as the pole is not higher than the fixed stars. The mill-like rotation of the planets is the first motion towards the west, not the second motion indicated by the author. According to him, the planets are the spirits of individuals who have gained exaltation by their merits, and who have returned to it after the end of their life in a human shape. According to my opinion, the author uses a number in the words thousands of times (p. 287), either because he wanted to intimate that their existence is an existence in our meaning of the term, an evolution out of the drapis into the mpagts (hence something finite, subject to numeration or determination by measure), or because he meant to indicate that some of those spirits obtain moksha, others not. Hence their number is liable to a more or less, and everything of this description is of a finite nature.

Page 335

CHAPTER XXVIH.

ON THE DEFINITION OF THE TEN DIRECTIONS.

Tin extension of bodies in space is in three directions : length, breadth, and depth or hcight. The path of any real direction, not an imaginary one, is limited; there- fore the lines representing these three paths are limited, and their six end-points or limits are the directions. If you imagine an animal in the centre of these lines, i.c. where they cut each other, which turns its face towards one of them, the directions with relation to the animal are before, behind, right, left, abore, and below. If these directions are used in relation to the world, they acquire new names. As the rising and setting of Page 145. the heavenly bodies depend npon the horizon and the first motion becomes apparent by the horizon, it is the most convenient to determine the directions by the horizon. The four directions, cast, west, north, south (corresponding to before, behind, left, and right), are generally known, but the directions which lie be- tween each two of these are less known. These make eight directions, and, together with abore and below, which do not need any further explanation, ten directions. The Greeks determined the directions by the rising and setting places of the zodiacal signs, brought them into relation to the winds, and so obtained sixteen directions. VOL. 1.

Page 336

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Also the Arabs determined the directions by the blowing-points of the winds. Any wind blowing be- tween two cardinal winds they called in general Nakba. Only in rare cases they are called by special names of their own. The Hindus, in giving names to the directions, have not taken any notice of the blowing of a wind; they simply call the four cardinal directions, as well as the secondary directions between them, by separate names. So they have eight directions in the horizontal plane, as exhibited by the following diagram :-

South. S.E. S.W. Nairrita. Âgneya. Dakshiņa.

Paścima. Madhyadeśa, Parva. West. i.c. East. the middle country.

Vâyava. Uttara. Aisâna.

N.W. North. N.E.

Besides there are two directions more for the two poles of the horizontal plane, the abore and below, the former being called Upari, the second Adhas and Tala. These directions, and those in use among other nations, are based on general consent. Since the hori- zon is divided by innumerable circles, the directions also proceeding from its centre are innumerable. The

Page 337

CHAPTER XXVIII.

two ends of erery possible diameter may be considered as before and bhind, and therefore the two ends of the diameter cutting the former at right angles (and lying in the same plane) are right and left. The Hindus can never speak of anything, be it an object of the intellect or of imagination, without repre- senting it as a personification, an individual. They at once marry him, make him celebrate marriage, make his wife become pregnant and give birth to something. So, too, in this case.' The Vishnu-Dharma relates that Atri, the star who rules the stars of the Great Bear, married the directions, represented as one person, thongh they are eight in number, and that from her the moon was born. Another author relates : Dakska, i.c. Prajapati, mar- ried Dharma, i.c. the rerard, to ten of his daughters, i.c. the ten directions. From one of them he had many children. She was called Vasu, and her children the Vasus. One of them was the moon. No doubt our people, the Muslims, will laugh at such a birth of the moon. But I give them still more of this stuff. Thus, e.g. they relate: The sun, the son of Kaś- yapa and of Aditya, his wife, was born in the sixth Man- vantara on the lunar station Visakha; the moon, the son of Dharma, was born on the station Krittika; Mars, the son of Prajapati, on Purvashadha; Mercury, the son of the moon, on Dhanishtha; Jupiter, the son of Angiras, Page 146. on Purvaphalguni; Venns, the daughter of Bhrigu, on P'ushya; Saturn on Revati; the Bearer of the Tail, the son of Yama, the angel of death, on Aslesha, and the Head on Revati. According to their custom, the Hindus attribute certain dominants to the eight directions in the horizontal plane, which we exhibit in the following table :-

Page 338

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Their Dominants. The Directions. Their Dominants. The Directions.

Indra . East. Varuņa West.

The Fire. S.E. Vâyu N.W.

Yama . South. Kuru . . North.

Prithu S.W. Mahadeva N.E.

The Hindus constrnct a fignre of these eight direc- tions, called Rahucalra, i.e. the figure of the Head, by means of which they try to gain an omen or prophecy for hazard-playing. It is the following diagram :-

South.

S.W. S.E.

JUPITER

MOON MARS

.

East. SUN West.

SATURN VENUS

MERCURY

N.E. N.W.

North.

The figure is used in this way : First, you must know the dominant of the day in question, and its place in the present figure. Next you must know that one of the eight parts of the day in which you happen to be. These eighths are counted on the lines, beginning with

Page 339

CHAPTER XXVIII. 293

the dominant of the day, in uninterrupted succession from east to sonth and west. Thus you find the domi- nant of the eighth in question. If, e.g., you want to know the fifth eighth of Thursday whilst Jupiter is the dominus diei in the south, and the line proceeding from the south terminates in north-west, we find that the dominant of the first eighth is Jupiter, that of the second is Saturn, that of the third the sun, that of the fourth the moon, and that of the fifth Mercury in the north. In this way you go on counting the eighths through the day and the night till the end of the vuxOnpepov. When thus the direction of the eighth of the day in which you are has been found, it is considered rage 147. by them as Rahu ; and when sitting down to play, you must place yourself so that you have this direction at your back. Then you will win, according to their belief. It is no affair of the reader to despise a man who, on account of such an omen, in a variety of games stakes all his chances on one cast of the dice. Suffice it to leave to him the responsibility of his dice-playing.

Page 340

( 294 )

CHAPTER XXIX.

DEFINITION OF TIE INHABITABLE EARTII ACCORDING TO THE HINDUS,

The Rishi IN the book of the Rishi Bhuvanakosa we read that the Bhuvana- kośa on the inhabitable world stretches from Himavant towards the inhabitable world. south, and is called Bharala-varsha, so called from a man, Bharata, who ruled over them and provided for them. The inhabitants of this olkoruery are those to whom alone reward and punishment in another life are destined. It is divided into nine parts, called Nava- khanda-prathama, i.e. the primary nine parts. Between each two parts there is a sea, which they traverse from one khanda to the other. The breadth of the inhabit- able world from north to south is 1000 yojana. By Himavant the author means the northern moun- tains, where the world, in consequence of the cold, ceases to be inhabitable. So all civilisation must of necessity be south of these mountains. His words, that the inhabitants are subject to reward and punishment, indicate that there are other people not subject to it. These beings he must either raise from the degree of man to that of angels, who, in con- sequence of the simplicity of the elements they are composed of and of the purity of their nature, never disobey a divine order, being always willing to worship; or he must degrade them to the degree of irrational animals. According to him, therefore, there are no human beings outside the okovpern (i.e. Bharata- varsha).

Page 341

CHAPTER XXIX. 295

Bharatavarsha is not India alone, as Hindus think, according to whom their conntry is the world, and their race the only race of mankind: for India is not traversed by an ocean separating one khanda from the other. Fnrther, they do not identify these khanda with the dripas, for the author says that on those seas people pass from one shore to the other. Further, it follows from his statement that all the inhabitants of the earth and the Hindus are subject to reward and punishment, that they are one great religious community. The nine parts are called Prathamn, i.e. primary ones, because they also divide India alone into nine parts. So the division of the olkorpern is a primary one, but the division of Bharatavarsha a secondary one. Be- sides, there is still a third division into nine parts, as their astrologers divide each country into nine parts when they try to find the lucky and nnlncky places in it. We find a similar tradition in the Tayu-Purana, viz. Qnotation that "the centre of Jambu-dvipa is called Bharata- Purâna. from l'âyu-

varsha, which means those who acquire something and nourish themselrcs. With them there are the four yuga. They are subject to reward and punishment; and Himavant lies to the north of the country. It is divided into nine parts, and between them there are navigable seas. Its length is 9000 yojana, its breadth 1000; and because the country is also called Sam- nara (?), each ruler who rules it is called Samnara (?). The shape of its nine parts is as follows." Then the author begins to describe the mountains in the khanda between the east and north, and the rivers which rise there, but he does not go beyond this de- scription. Thereby he gives us to understand that, according to his opinion, this lhanda is the olkovuern. Page 148. But he contradicts himself in another place, where he

Page 342

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

says that Jambu-dvipa is the centre among the Nava- lhanda-prathama, and the others lie towards the eight directions. There are angels on them, men, animals, and plants. By these words he seems to mean the dripas. If the breadth of the olkovuery is 1000 yojana, its length must be nearly 2800. Further, the Vayu-Purana mentions the cities and countries which lie in each direction. We shall exhibit them in tables, together with similar information from other sources, for this method renders the study of the subject easier than any other. Here follows a diagram representing the division of Bharatavarsha into nine parts.

South. Nâgadvîpa. Tâmravarna. Gabhastimat.

Indradvîpa or East. Saumya. Madhyadesa, i.e. Kaśerumat. the middle country. West.

Gândharva. Nagarasamvritta. North.

On the We have already heretofore mentioned that that part Agure Kûrma- of the earth in which the olkovpévy lies resembles a cakra. tortoise, because its borders are round, because it rises above the water and is surrounded by the water, and because it has a globular convexity on its surface. However, there is a possibility that the origin of the name is this, that their astronomers and astrologers divide the directions according to the lunar stations.

Page 343

CHAPTER XXIX. 297

Therefore the country, too, is divided according to the lunar stations, and the fignre which represents this division is similar to a tortoise. Therefore it is called Kurma-calra, i.e. the tortoise-circle or the tortoise- shape. The following diagram is from the Samthita of Varâbamihira.

SOUTK

Uttaraphalguni. Hasta. Citrâ. Svâti. Parvaphalguni. Visâkha. Magha. Anuradhâ. Aślêsha. Agncya Nairrita.

Jyeshthâ. Nola. Pushya.

Pûrvâshâdhâ. P'unarvasu. EAST. Ardrâ. WEST.

Aisana Vâyava Uttarâshâdhâ. Sravana. Bharant. Dhanishthâ. Asvini. Revati. Śatabhishaj. Purvabhadrapada. NORTH Uttarabhadrapada. -

Varahamihira calls each of the Nara-hhanda a varga. Page 149. He says: "By them (the rargas) Bharatavarsha, i.e. of Bharata- The division

half of the world, is divided into nine parts, the cen- according to varsha

tral one, the eastern, &c." Then he passes to the sonth, hira. Varabami-

and thus round the whole horizon. That he under- stands by Bharatavarsha India alone is indicated by his saring that each rarga has a region, the king of

Page 344

298 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

which is killed when some mishap befalls it. So belong

To the rst or central varga, the region Pancala. 2d varga, Magadba. 3d varga, Kalinga. 4th varga, Avanti, i.c. Ujain. 5th varga, Ananta. 6th varga, Sindhu and Sauvira. 7th varga, Hârabaura. 8th varga, Madura. 9th varga, Kulinda.

All these countries are parts of India proper. On the Most of the names of countries under which they change of geographi. appear in this context are not those by which they are cal namcs. now generally known. Utpala, a native of Kashmir, says in his commentary on the book Samhitd regarding this subject: "The names of countries change, and particularly in the yugas. So Multan was originally called Kasyapapnra, then Hamsapura, then Bagapura, then Sambhapura, and then Mulasthana, i.e. the oriyi- nal place, for mula means root, origin, and tana means place." A yuga is a long space of time, but names change rapidly, when, for instance, a foreign nation with a different language occupies a country. Their tongues frequently mangle the words, and thus transfer them into their own language, as is, e.g. the custom of the Greeks. Either they keep the original meaning of the names, and try a sort of translation, but then they undergo certain changes. So the city of Shash, which has its name from the Turkish language, where it is called Tash-kand, i.e. stone-city, is called stone-tower in the book yewypadia. In this way new names spring up as translations of older ones. Or, secondly, the barbarians adopt and keep the local names, but with such sounds and in such forms as are adapted to their tongues, as the Arabs do in Arabising foreign names, which become disfigured in

Page 345

CHAPTER XXIX. 299

their mouth: e.g. Bashang they call in their books Fusanj, and Sakilkand they call in their revenne-books Furfuca (sic). However, what is more curions and strange is this, that sometimes one and the same lan- guage changes in the mouth of the same people who speak it, in consequence of which strange and uncouth forms of words spring up, not intelligible save to him who discards every rule of the language. And such changes are brought about in a few years, without there being any stringent canse or necessity for it. Of course, in all of this the Hindus are actnated by the desire to have as many names as possible, and to practise on them the rules and arts of their etymology, and they glory in the enormous copiousness of their language which they obtain by such means. The following names of countries, which we have taken from the Vayu-Purana, are arranged according to the four directions, whilst the names taken from the Sunihita are arranged according to the eight directions. All these names are of that kind which we have here described (i.c. they are not the names now in general use). We exhibit them in the following tables :-

The single countries of the middle realm, according to Page 150 the Vayu-Purana. Kuru, Pâñcâla, Salva, Jangala, Sûrasena, Bhadra- kâra (!), Bodha, Patheśrara, Vatsa, Kisadya, Kulya, Kuntala, Kâsi, Kośala, Arthayâshava (?), Puhlinga (!), Mashaka (1), Vrika. The people in the east :- Andhra, Vâka, Mudrakaraka (?), Prâtragira (?), Vahir- gira, Prathanga (?), Vangeya, Malava (!), Malavartika, Prâgjyotisha, Muņda, Abika (?), Tâmraliptika, Mâla, Magadha, Govinda (Gonanda ?). The people in the south :- Pândya, Kerala, Caulya, Kulya, Setuka, Mûshika, Rumana (?). Vanavasika, Maharashtra, Mahisha, Ka-

Page 346

300 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Page 151. linga, Abhîra, Îshika, Ațavya, Śavara (?), Pulindra, Vindhyamûli, Vaidarbha, Dandaka, Mûlika (!), Asmaka, Naitika (!), Bhogavardhana, Kuntala, Andbra, Udbhira, Nalaka, Alika, Dâkshinâtya, Vaideśa, Sûrpâkâraka, Kolavana, Durga, Tillita (?), Puleya, Krâla (1), Rûpaka, Tâmasa, Tarûpana (?), Karaskara, Nâsikya, Uttaranar- mada, Bhânukacchra (?), Maheya, Sâraswata (?), Kac- chîya, Surâshtra, Anartta, Hudvuda (?). The people in the west :- Malada (?), Karûsha, Mekala, Utkala, Uttamarņa, Baśârņa (!), Bhoja, Kishkinda, Kosala, Traipura, Vaidika, Tharpura (?), Tumbura, Shattumana (?), Padha, Kar- Page 152. napravarana (), Huna, Darva, Huhaka (!), Trigartta, Malava, Kirata, Tamara. The people in the north :- Vâhlika (!), Vadha, Vâna (?), Abhîra, Kalatoyaka, Aparânta (?), Pahlava, Carmakhandika, Gândhâra, Ya- vana, Sindhu, Sauvira, i.c. Multan and Jahrawar, Madhra (?), aka, Drihâla (?), Litta (Kulinda), Malla (?), Kodara (?), Atreya, Bharadva, Jângala, Daseruka (!), Lampâka, Tâlakûna (?), Sûlika, Jâgara.

The names of the countries for the tortoise-figure, as taken from the Samhitd of Varahamihira. I. The names of the countries in the centre of the realm :- Bhadra, Ari, Meda, Mândavya, Sâlvanî, Pojjihâna, Marn, Vatsa, Ghosha, the valley of the Yamuna, Sâras- vata, Matsya, Mâthura, Kopa, Jyotisha, Dharmâraņya, Sûrasena, Ganragrîva, Uddehika near Bazâna, Pâņdu, Page 153. Guda =Tânêshar, Asvattha, Paucâla, Sâketa, Kaņka, Kuru = Taneshar, Kalkoti, Kukura, Pariyatra, Andum- bara, Kapishthala, Gaja. II. The names of the countries in the east :- Añjana, Vrishabadhvaja, Padma-Tulya (sie), Vyâ- ghramukha, i.e. people with tiger-faces, Suhma, Kar- vata, Candrapura, Surpakarņa, i.e. people with ears like

Page 347

CHAPTER XXIX. 301

sieves, Khasha, Magadha, Mount Sibira, Mithilâ, Sama- tața, Odra, Aśvavadana, i.c. people with horse-faces, Dantura, i.e. people with long teeth, Pragjyotisha, Lohitya, Krira-samudra (sic), i.e. the milk-sea, Puru- shada, Udayagiri, i.e. the mountain of sunrise, Bhadra, Gauraka, Pauņdra, Utkala, Kaśi, Mekala, Ambashțha, Ekapada, i.e. the one-footed people, Tâmaliptika, Kau- salaka, Vardhamâna. III. The names of the countries of the south-east (.İgneya) :-- Kosala, Kalinga, Vanga, Upavanga, Jațhara, Anga, Saulika, Vidarbha, Vatsa, Andhra, Colika (?), Ûrdhva- karna, i.e. people whose ears are directed upwards, Vrisha, Nalikera, Carmadvipa, the mountain Vindhya, Tripuri, Śmaśrudhara, Hemakîtya, Vyalagriva, i.e. Page 154. people whose bosoms are snakes, Mahâgriva, i.c. people who have wide bosoms, Kishkindha, the country of the monkeys, Kaņdakasthala, Nishada, Râshtra, Dâsarņa, Purika, Nagnaparņa, Savara. IV. The names of the countries in the south :- Lanka, i.e. the cupola of the earth, Kalajina, Sairi- kîrņa (?), Talikața, Girnagara, Malaya, Dardura, Ma- hendra, Malindya, Bharukaccha, Kankata, Tankaņa, Vanavasi on the coast, Sibika, Phaņikara, Konkana near the sea, Abhira, Akara, Vena a river, Avanti, i.e. the cityof Ujain, Dasapura, Gonarda, Keralaka, Karņâta, Mahâțavi, Citrakūța, Nâsikya, Kollagiri, Cola, Krauñ- cadvîpa, Jațâdhara, Kauverya, Rishyamûka, Vaidûrya, Śankha, Mukta, Atri, Varicara, Jarmapatțana (sic), Dvipa, Gaņarâjya, Krishņavaidûrya, Šibika, Šûryâdri, Kuumanaga, Tumbavana, Karmaņeyaka, Yâmyodadhi, Page 155. Tapasâśrama, Rishika, Kancî, Marucîpatțana, Divârśa (!), Simhala, Rishabha, Baladevapattana, Daņdakavaņa, Timingilaśana (?), Bhadra, Kaccha, Kuñjaradari, Tâmra- parņa. V. The names of the countries in the south-west (Nairrita) :-

Page 348

302 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

Kamboja, Sindbu, Sauvira, i.e. Multan and Jahravar, Vadavâmukha, ravambashtha, Kapila, Pâraśava, i.e. the Persians, Sudra, Barbara, Kirata, Khanda, Kravya, Âbhîra, Cañcûka, Hemagiri, Sindhu, Kâlaka, Raivataka, Surashtra, Badara, Dramida, Maharņava, Narimukha, i.e. men with women's faces, i.e. the Turks, Anarta, Phenagiri, Yavana, i.e. the Greeks, Mâraka, Karņaprâ- varaņa. VI. The names of the countries in the west :- Maniman, Meghavan, Vanaugha, Astagiri, i.c. the country of sunset, Aparantaka, Santika, Haihaya, Pra- śastâdri, Vokkâņa, Pañcanada, i.e. the union of the five rivers, Mathara, Parata, Tarakruti (?), Jringa, Vaisya, Kanaka, Śaka, Mleccha, i.c. the Arabs. VII. The names of the countries in the north-west (Vayara) :- Mâņdavya, Tukhara, Talahala, Madra, Aśmaka, Kulû- l'age 156. talahada, Strirajya, i.e. women amongst whom no man dwells longer than half a year, Nrisimhavana, i.e. people with lion-faces, Khastha, i.e. people who are born from the trees, hanging on them by the navel-strings, Venu- matî (?), i.e. Tirmidh, Phalgulu, Guruha, Marukucca, Carmaranga, i.e. people with coloured skins, Ekavilo- cana, i.e. the one-eyed men, Sulika, Dirghagriva, i.e. people with long bosoms, which means with long necks, Dirghamukha, i.e. people with long faces, Dirghakeśa, i.e. people with long hair. VIII. The names of the countries in the north :- Kailasa, Himavant, Vasumant, Giri, Dhanushman (!), i.e. the people with bows, Krauuca, Meru, Kurava, Uttarakurava, Kshudramîna, Kaikaya, Vasâti, Yamuna, i.e. a kind of Greeks, Bhogaprastha, Arjunayana, Ag- nîtya, Adarsa, Antardvipa, Trigarta, Turaganana, i.c. people with horse-faces, Svamukha, i.e. people with dog-faces, Keśadhara, Capitanâsika, i.e. flat-noses, Dâ- sera, Kavatadhana, Saradhana, Takshasila, i.e. Marikala, Pushkalavatî, i.e. Pukala, Kailâvata, Kanthadhâna,

Page 349

CHAPTER XXIX. 303

Ambara, Madraka, Malava, Paurava, Kacchara, Danda, Pingalaka, Mânahala, Hûņa, Kohala, Sâtaka, Mândavya, Bhutapura, Gandhara, Yasovati, Hematala, Rajanya, Khajara, Yaudheya, Dâsameya, Śyâmâka, Kshema- dhûrta (?). IX. The names of the countries in the north-east (Aisana) :- Meru, Kanashtharajya, Paśupala, Kira, Kaśmira, Page 157. Abhi, Sarada, Tangana, Kuluta, Sairindha, Rashtra, Brahmapura, Darva, Damara, Vanarajya, Kirata, Cina, Kauninda, Bhalla, Palola, Jatasura, Kunațha, Khasha, Ghosha, Kucika, Ekacarana, i.c. the one-footed people, Anuvisva, Suvarnabhumi, i.e. the gold land, Arvasu- dhana (sic), Nandavishtha, Paurava, Ciranivasana, Trine- tra, i.c. people with three eyes, Puñjadri, Gandharva.

Ilindu astronomers determine the longitude of the On Romaka, inhabitable world by Lanka, which lies in its centre on and Siddha- Yamakonı,

the equator, whilst Yamakoti lies on its east, Romaka pura.

on its west, and Siddhapura on that part of the equator which is diametrically opposed to Lanka. Their remarks on the rising and setting of the heavenly bodies show that Yamakoti and Rum are distant from each other by half a circle. It seems that they assign the countries of the West (i.e. North Africa) to Rum or the Roman Empire, because the Rum or Byzantine Greeks occupy the opposite shores of the same sea (the Mediterranean); for the Roman Empire has much northern latitude and penetrates high into the north. No part of it stretches far southward, and, of course, nowhere does it reach the equator, as the Hindus say with regard to Romaka. We shall here speak no more of Lanka (as we are going to treat of it in a separate chapter). Yamakoti is, according to Yakub and Alfazari, the country where is the city Tara within a sea. I have not found the slightest trace of this name in Indian literature. As koi means castle and Yama is the angel of death, the

Page 350

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

word reminds me of Kangdiz, which, according to the l'ersians, had been built by Kaika'ts or Jam in the most remote east, behind the sea. Kaikhusrau tra- versed the sea to Kangdiz when following the traces of Afrasiab the Turk, and there he went at the time of his anchorite life and expatriation. For diz means in Persian castle, as koti in the Indian language. Abû- Mashar of Balkh has based his geographical canon on Kangdiz as the o° of longitude or first meridian. How the Hindus came to suppose the existence of Siddhapura I do not know, for they believe, like our- selves, that behind the inhabited half-circle there is nothing but unnavigable seas. The meri- In what way the Hindus determine the latitude of dian of Ujain the a place has not come to our knowledge. That the first meri- dian. longitude of the inhabitable world is a half-circle is a far-spread theory among their astronomers; they differ (from Western astronomers) only as to the point which Page 158. is to be its beginning. If we explain the theory of the Hindus as far as we understand it, their beginning of longitude is Ujain, which they consider as the eastern limit of one quarter (of the olkovpern), whilst the limit of the second quarter lies in the west at some distance from the end of civilisation, as we shall hereafter ex- plain in the chapter about the difference of the longi- tudes of two places. Other first The theory of the Western astronomers on this point meridians used by is a double one. Some adopt as the beginning of longi- Western as- tronomers. tude the shore of the (Atlantic) ocean, and they ex- tend the first quarter thence as far as the environs of Balkh. Now, according to this theory, things have been united which have no connection with each other. So Shapurkan and Ujain are placed on the same meridian. A theory which so little corresponds to reality is quite valueless. Others adopt the Islands of the Happy Ones as the beginning of longitude, and the quarter of the oikorpery they extend thence as far as the neighbour-

Page 351

CHAPTER XXIX. 305

hood of Jurjan and Nishapur. Both these theories are totally different from that of the Hindus. This subject, however, shall be more accurately investigated in a sub- sequent chapter (p. 311). If I, by the grace of God, shall live long enough, I shall devote a special treatise to the longitude of Nishâ- pur, where this subject shall be thoroughly inquired into.

VOL. I.

Page 352

(306_)

CHAPTER XXX.

ON LANKA, OR THE CUPOLA OF THE EARTH.

On the THE midst of the inhabitable world, of its longitudinal meaning of the term extension from east to west on the equator, is by the cupola of the earth. astronomers (of the Muslims) called the eupola of the carth, and the great circle which passes through the pole and this point of the equator is called the meridian of the cupola. We must, however, observe that whatever may be the natural form of the earth, there is no place on it which to the exclusion of others deserves the name of a cupola ; that this term is only a metaphorical one to denote a point from which the two ends of the inhabitable world in east and west are equidistant, comparable to the top of a cupola or a tent, as all things hanging down from this top (tent-ropes or walls) have the same length, and their lower ends the same distances therefrom. But the Hindus never call this point by a term that in our language must be inter- preted by cupola; they only say that Lanka is between the two ends of the inhabitable world and without The story of latitude. There Ravana, the demon, fortified him- Rama. self when he had carried off the wife of Râma, the son of Dasaratha. His labyrinthine fortress is called (?), whilst in our (Muslim) countries it is called Yavana-kofi, which has frequently been explained as Rome.

Page 353

CHAPTER XXX.

The following is the plan of the labyrinthine fort- ress :- --

THE CASTLEED

-0

Door of the road leading to the castle.

Rama attacked Ravana after having crossed the Page 159. ocean on a dyke of the length of 100 yojana, which he had constructed from a mountain in a place called Setubandha, i.e. bridge of the ocean, east of Ceylon. Ile fought with him and killed him, and Rama's brother killed the brother of Râvana, as is described in the story of Rama and Ramayana. Thereupon he broke the dyke in ten different places by arrow-shots. According to the Hindns, Lanka is the castle of the On the demons. It is 30 yojana above the earth, i.e. 80 far- Lanka, island of

stkh. Its length from east to west is 100 yojana; its breadth from north to south is the same as the height (i.c. thirty). It is on account of Lanka and the island of Vadara- mukha that the Hindus consider the south as foreboding evil. In no work of piety do they direct themselves

Page 354

308 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

southward or walk southward. The south occurs only in connection with impious actions. The first The line on which the astronomical calculations are meridian. based (as o° of longitude), which passes in a straight line from Lanka to Meru, passes- (1.) Through the city of Ujain (Ujjayini) in Malava (Mâlvâ). (2.) Through the neighbourhood of the fortress Rohi- taka in the district of Multan, which is now deserted. (3.) Through Kurukshetra, i.c. the plain of Taneshar (Sthanesvara), in the centre of their country. (4.) Through the river Yamuna, on which the city of Mathura is situated. (5.) Through the mountains of the Himavant, which are covered with everlasting snow, and where the rivers of their country rise. Behind them lies Mount Meru.

The sitna- The city of Ujain, which in the tables of the longi- tion of Ujain. tudes of places is mentioned as Uzain, and as situated on the sea, is in reality 100 yojana distant from the sea. Some undiscriminating Muslim astronomer has uttered the opinion that Ujain lies on the meridian of Al- shabûrkân in Al-jûzajân; but such is not the case, for it lies by many degrees of the equator more to the east than Al-shaburkan. There is some confusion about the longitude of Ujain, particularly among such (Muslim) astronomers as mix up with each other the different opinions about the first degree of longitude both in east and west, and are unable to distinguish them properly. No sailor who has traversed the ocean round the The author's place which is ascribed to Lanka, and has travelled in abont Lanka that direction, has ever given such an account of it as conjecture and Langa- bålûs. tallies with the traditions of the Hindus or resembles them. In fact, there is no tradition which makes the thing appear to us more possible (than it is according to the reports of the Hindns). The name Lanka, how- ever, makes me think of something entirely different,

Page 355

CHAPTER XXX.

viz. that the clove is called larang, because it is im- ported from a country called Langa. According to the uniform report of all sailors, the ships which are sent to this country land their cargo in boats, viz. ancient Western denars and various kinds of merchandise, striped Indian cloth, salt, and other usual articles of trade. These wares are deposited on the shore on leather sheets, each of which is marked with the name of its owner. Thereupon the merchants retire to their ships. On the following day they find the sheets covered with cloves by way of payment, little or much, as the natives happen to own. The people with whom this trade is carried on are demons according to some, savage men according to others. The Hindus who are the neighbours of those regions A certain (of Lanka) believe that the small-pox is a wind blowing cause of wind as the

from the island of Lanka towards the continent to carry small-pox.

off souls. According to one report, some men warn people beforehand of the blowing of this wind, and can exactly tell at what times it will reach the different parts of the country. After the small-pox has broken out, they recognise from certain signs whether it is virulent or not. Against the virulent small-pox they use a method of treatment by which they destroy only one single limb of the body, but do not kill. They use as medicine cloves, which .they give to the patient to drink, together with gold-dust; and, besides, the males tie the cloves, which are similar to date-kernels, Page 160. to their necks. If these precautions are taken, per- haps nine people out of ten will be proof against this malady. All this makes me think that the Lanka which the Hindus mention is identical with the clove-country Langa, though their descriptions do not tally. How- ever, there is no communication kept up with the latter, for people say that when perchance a merchant is left

Page 356

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

behind on this island, there is no more trace found of him. And this my conjecture is strengthened by the fact that, according to the book of Rama and Ramayana, behind the well-known country of Sindh there are cannibals. And, on the other hand, it is well known among all seamen that cannibalism is the cause of the savagery and bestiality of the inhabitants of the island of Langabâlûs.

Page 357

( 3II )

CHAPTER XXXI.

ON THAT DIFFERENCE OF VARIOUS PLACES WHICH WE CALL THE DIFFERENCE OF LONGITUDE.

HE who aims at accuracy in this subject must try to On the determine the distance between the spheres of the meri- method of Hindu

dians of the two places in question. Muslim astrono- longitnde. determining

mers reckon by equatorial times corresponding to the distance between the two meridians, and begin to count from one (the western one) of the two places. The sum of equatorial minutes which they find is called the difference betwcen the tio longitudes ; for they con- sider as the longitude of each place the distance of its meridian from the great cirele passing through the pole of the equator, which has been chosen as the limit of the olkouuern, and for this first meridian they have chosen the western (not the eastern) limit of the olkor- pery. It is all the same whether these equatorial times, whatsoever their number for each meridian may be, are reckoned as 360th parts of a circle, or as its 60th parts, so as to correspond to the day-minutes, or as farsakh or yojana. The Hindus employ in this snbject methods which do not rest on the same principle as ours. They are totally different; and howsoever different they are, it is perfectly clear that none of them hits the right mark. As we (Muslims) note for each place its longitude, the Hindus note the number of yojunns of its distance from the meridian of Ujain. And the more to the west the position of a place is, the greater is the number of

Page 358

312 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

yojanas ; the more to the east it is, the smaller is this number. They call it desantara, i.e. the difference between the places. Further, they multiply the desantara by the mean daily motion of the planet (the sun), and divide the product by 4800. Then the quotient repre- sents that amount of the motion of the star which corresponds to the number of yojana in question, i.e. that which must be added to the mean place of the sun, as it has been found for moon or midnight of Ujain, if you want to find the longitude of the place in question. On the cir- The number which they use as divisor (4800) is the of the earth. number of the yojanas of the circumference of the earth, cumference

for the difference between the spheres of the meridians of the two places stands in the same relation to the whole circumference of the earth as the mean motion of the planet (sun) from one place to the other to its whole daily rotation round the earth. If the circumference of the earth is 4800 yojanas, the diameter is nearly 1527; but Pulisa reckons it as 1600, Brahmagupta as 1581 yojanas, each of which is equal to eight miles. The same value is given in the astro- nomical handbook Al-arkand as 1050. This number, however, is, according to Ibn Tarik, the radius, whilst the diameter is 2100 yojanas, each yojana being reck- oned as equal to four miles, and the circumference is stated as 6596. yojanas. Page 161. Brahmagupta uses 4800 as the number of yojanas Quotations from the of the earth's circumference in his canon Khanda- Khanda- khadyaka khadyaka, but in the amended edition he uses, instead and the Karana- of this, the corrected circumference, agreeing with Pulisa. tilaka. The correction he propounds is this, that he multiplies the yojanas of the earth's circumference by the sines of the complement of the latitude of the place, and divides the product by the sinus totus; then the quotient is the corrected circumference of the earth, or the number of yojanas of the parallel circle of the place in question. Sometimes this number is called the collar of the meri-

Page 359

CHAPTER XXXI. 313

dinn. Hereby people are frequently misled to think that the 4800 yojunns are the corrected circumference for the city of Ujain. If we calculate it (according to Brahmagupta's correction), we find the latitude of Ujain to be 161 degrees, whilst in reality it is 24 degrees. The author of the canon Karana-tilaha makes this correction in the following way. He multiplies the diameter of the earth by 12 and divides the product by the equinoctial shadow of the place. The gnomon stands in the same relation to this shadow as the radius of the parallel circle of the place to the sine of the lati- tude of the place, not to the sinus totus. Evidently the author of this method thinks that we have here the same kind of equation as that which the Hindus call The equa- cyastatruirasika, i.e. the places with the retrograde motion. trairdsika, tion wyasta-

An example of it is the following. If the price of a harlot of 15 years be, e.g. 1O denars, how much will it be when she is 40 years old ? The method is this, that yon multiply the first number by the second (15 X 10 = 150), and divide the pro- duct by the third number (150: 40 = 34). Then the quotient or fourth number is her price when she has become old, viz. 32 denars. Now the author of the Karana-tilak, after having found that the straight shadow inerenses with the lati- tude, whilst the diameter of the circle decreases, thonght, according to the analogy of the just mentioned calcula- tion, that between this increase and decrease there is a certain ratio. Therefore he maintains that the diameter of the circle deereases, i.e. becomes gradually smaller than the diameter of the earth, at the same rate as the straight shadow inereases. Thereupon he calculates the corrected circumference from the corrected diameter. After having thus found the longitudinal difference between two places, he observes a lunar eclipse, and fixes in day-minutes the difference between the time of its appearance in the two places. Pulisa multiplies

Page 360

314 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

these day-minutes by the circumference of the earth, and divides the product by 60, viz. the minutes (or 60th parts) of the daily revolution. The quotient, then, is the number of the yojanas of the distance between the two places. This calculation is correct. The result refers to the great circle on which Lanka lies. Brahmagupta calculates in the same manner, save that he multiplies by 4800. The other details have already been mentioned. Caleulati on As far as this, one clearly recognises what the Hindu of the desantara astronomers aim at, be their method correct or fanlty. according to Alfazârî. However, we cannot say the same of their calculation of the desantara from the latitudes of two different places, which is reported by Alfazari in his canon in the fol- lowing manner :- " Add together the squares of the sines of the lati- tudes of the two places, and take the root of the sum. This root is the portio. "Further, square the difference of these two sines and add it to the portio. Multiply the sum by 8 and divide the product by 377. The quotient, then, is the distance between the two places, that is to say, according to a rough calculation. "Further, multiply the difference between the two latitudes by the yojanas of the circumference of the earth and divide the product by 360." Evidently this latter calculation is nothing but the transferring of the difference between the two latitudes from the measure of degrees and minutes to the mea- sure of yojanas. Then he proceeds :- " Now the square of the quotient is subtracted from the square of the roughly calculated distance, and of the remainder you take the root, which represents the straight yojanas." Pagc 162. Evidently the latter number represents the distance between the spheres of the meridians of the two places

Page 361

CHAPTER XXXI.

on the circle of latitude, whilst the roughly calculated number is the distance between the two places in longitnde. This method of calculation is found in the astrono- The author mical handbooks of the Hindus in conformity with the criticises this method. account of Alfazari, save in one particular. The here- mentioned portio is the root of the difference between the squares of the sines of the two latitudes, not the sum of the squares of the sines of the two latitudes. But whatever this method may be, it does not hit the right mark. We have fully explained it in several of our publications specially devoted to this subject, and there we have shown that it is impossible to determine the distance between two places and the difference of longitude between them by means of their latitudes alone, and that only in case one of these two things is known (the distance between two places or the differ- ence between the longitudes of them), by this and by means of the two latitudes, the third value can be found. Based on the same principle, the following calcula- Another tion has been found, there being no indication by whom of the caleulation

it was invented :- desntara.

" Multiply the yojanas of the distance between two places by 9, and divide the product by (lacuna); the root of the difference between its square and the sqnare of the difference of the two latitndes. Divide this number by 6. Then you get as quotient the number of day-minutes of the difference of the two longi- tudes." It is clear that the author of this calculation first takes the distance (between the two places), then he reduces it to the measure of the circumference of the circle. However, if we invert the calculation and re- duce the parts (or degrees) of the great circle to yojunas according to his method, we get the number 3200, i.e. 100 yojanns less than we have given on the authority of

Page 362

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Al-arkand (v. p. 312). The double of it, 6400, comes near the number mentioned by Ibn Tarik (i.e. 65961'%, v. p. 312), being only about 200 yojanas smaller. We shall now give the latitudes of some places, as we hold them to be correct. A criticism All canons of the Hindus agree in this that the line of Arya- bhata of connecting Lanka with Meru divides the olkovuévn Kusuma- pura on the lengthways in two halves, and that it passes through meridian of Ujain. the city of Ujain, the fortress of Rohitaka, the river Yamuna, the plain of Taneshar, and the Cold Moun- tains. The longitudes of the places are measured by their distance from this line. On this head I know of no difference between them except the following pas- sage in the book of Aryabhata of Kusumapura :- "People say that Kurukshetra, i.c. the plain of Taneshar, lies on the line which connects Lanka with Meru and passes throngh Ujain. So they report on the authority of Pulisa. But he was much too intelli- gent not to have known the subject better. The times of the eclipses prove that statement to be erroneous, and Prithusvamin maintains that the difference be- tween the longitudes of Kurukshetra and Ujain is I20 yojanas." These are the words of Aryabhata. On the lati- Ya'kub Ibn Tarik says in his book entitled The Com- tude of Ujain. position of the Spheres, that the latitude of Ujain is 48 degrees, but he does not say whether it lies in the north or the south. Besides, he states it, on the authority of the book Al-Arkand, to be 4% degrees. We, however, have found a totally different latitude of Ujain in the same book in a calculation relating to the distance between Ujain and Almansura, which the author calls Brahmaņavâta, i.e. Bamhanwâ, viz. latitude of Ujain, 22° 29'; latitude of Almanșûra, 24° 1'. According to the same book, the straight shadow in Lohâniyye, i.e. Loharânî, is 5 digits.

Page 363

CHAPTER XXXI.

On the other hand, however, all the canons of the Hindus agree in this, that the latitude of Ujain is 24 degrees, and that the sun culminates over it at the time of the summer solstice. Balabhadra, the commentator, gives as the latitude of Kanoj 26° 35'; as that of Taneshar, 30° 12'. Page 163. The learned Abu-Ahmad, the son of Catlaghtagin, calculated the latitude of the city of Karli (?), and found it to be 28° o', that of Taneshar 27', and both places to be distant from each other by three days' marches. What the cause of this difference is I do not know. According to the book Karana-sara, the latitude of Kashmir is 34° 9', and the straight shadow there Sao digits. I myself have found the latitude of the fortress Lauhur to be 34° 10'. The distance from Lauhûr to the capital of Kashmir is 56 miles, half the way being rugged conntry, the other half plain. What other lati- tudes I have been able to observe myself, I shall enumerate in this place :-

Ghazna . 33° 35' Lamghan 34° 43' Kâbul . Purshâvar Kandî, the guard-station . 33° 47' Waihand 34° 44' 34° 30' of the prince Dunpûr. . 33° 55' Jailam . . 34° 20' The fortress Nandna 33° 20' 32° o

The distance between the latter place and Multan is nearly 200 miles.

Sâlkot Mandakkakor 32° 5S' 3I° 50' Multan 29° 40'

If the latitudes of places are known, and the distances between them have been measured, the difference be- tween their longitudes also may be found according to the methods explained in the books to which we have referred the reader.

Page 364

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

We ourselves have (in our travels) in their country not passed beyond the places which we have mentioned, nor have we learned any more longitudes and latitudes (of places in India) from their literature. It is God alone who helps us to reach our objects!

Page 365

( 319 )

CHAPTER XXXII.

ON THE NOTIONS OF DURATION AND TIME IN GENERAL, AND ON THE CREATION OF THE WORLD AND ITS DESTRUCTION.

ACCORDING to the relation of Muhammad Ibn Zaka- On the no- .riyya Alrazi, the most ancient philosophers of the according to tion of time

Greeks thought that the following five things existed other philo- Alrazi and

from all eternity, the ercator, the universal soul, the first sophers.

iln, space in the abstract, and time in the abstract. On these things Alrazi has founded that theory of his, which is at the bottom of his whole philosophy. Further, he distinguishes between time and duration in so far as number applies to the former, not to the latter; for a thing which can be numbered is finite, whilst duration is infinite. Similarly, philosophers have explained fime as duration with a beginning and an end, and eternity as duration without beginning and end. According to Alrazi, those five things are necessary postulates of the actually existing world. For that which the senses perceive in it is the idn acquiring shape by means of combination. Besides, the uAn occupies some place, and therefore we must admit the existence of spacc. The changes apparent in the world of sense compel us to assume the existence of time, for some of them are earlier, others later, and the before and the afterwards, the earlier and the later, and the simultaneous can only be perceived by means of the

Page 366

320 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

notion of time, which is a necessary postulate of the existing world. Further, there are liviny beings in the existing world. Therefore we must assume the existence of the soul. Among these living beings there are intelligent ones, capable of carrying the arts to the highest perfection; and this compels us to assume the existence of a Creator, who is wise aud intelligent, who establishes and arranges everything in the best possible manner, and inspires people with the force of intelligence for the purpose of liberation. On the other hand, some sophists consider eternity and time as one and the same thing, and declare the motion which serves to measure time alone to be finite. Another one declares eternity to be the circular motion. No doubt this motion is indissolubly con- nected with that being which mores by it, and which is of the most sublime nature, since it lasts for ever. Thereupon he rises in his argumentation from the moving being to its mover, and from the moving mover to the first mover who is motionless. This kind of research is very subtle and obscure. But for this, the opinions would not differ to such an extent that some people declare that there is no time at all, while others declare that time is an independent substance. According to Alexander of Aphrodisias, Aristotle gives in his book voiky akpeaois the follow- ing argumentation : " Everything moving is moved by a mover ; " and Galenus says on the same subject that he could not understand the notion of time, much less prove it. The notions The theory of the Hindus on this subject is rather of Hindu philoso- poor in thought and very little developed. Varâhami- phers on time, hira says in the opening of his book Samhita, when speaking of that which existed from all eternity: " It has been said in the ancient books that the first primeval thing was darkness, which is not identical

Page 367

CHAPTER XXXII. 321

with the black colour, but a kind of non-existence like the state of a sleeping person. Then God created this world for Brahman as a cupola for him. He made it to consist of two parts, a higher and a lower one, and placed the sun and moon in it." Kapila declares: "God has always existed, and with him the world, with all its substances and bodies. He, however, is a cause to the world, and rises by the subtlety of his nature above the gross nature of the world." Kumbhaka says: "The primeval one is Mahabhuta, i.e. the com- pound of the five elements. Some declare that the primeval thing is time, others nature, and still others maintain that the director is karman, i.e. action." In the book Vishnu-Dharma, Vajra speaks to Mar- kandeya: " Explain to me the times ;" whereupon the latter answers: "Duration is atmapurusha," i.e. a breath, and purusha, which means the tord of the uni- vcrse. Thereupon, he commenced explaining to him the divisions of time and their dominants, just as we have propounded these things in detail in the proper chapters (chap. xxxiii. et scg.). The Hindus have divided duration into two periods, a period of motion, which has been determined as time, and a period of rest, which cau be determined only in an imaginary way according to the analogy of that which has first been determined, the period of motion. The Hindus hold the eternity of the Creator to be determinable, not measurable, since it is infinite. We, however, cannot refrain from remarking that it is extremely difficult to imagine a thing which is deter- minable but not measurable, and that the whole idea is very far-fetched. We shall here communicate so much as will suffice for the reader of the opinions of the Hindus on this subject, as far as we know them. The common notion of the Hindus regarding creation The Das of is a popular one, for, as we have already mentioned, period of Brahman a

they believe matter to be eternal. Therefore, they do Night of creation, the

VOL. I,

Page 368

322 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Brahman a not, by the word creation, understand a formation of period of non-crea- something out of nothing. They mean by creation only tion. the working with a piece of clay, working out various combinations and figures in it, and making such arrange- ments with it as will lead to certain ends and aims which are potentially in it. For this reason they at- tribute the creation to angels and demons, nay, even to human beings, who create either because they carry out some legal obligation which afterwards proves beneficial for the creation, or because they intend to allay their passions after having become envious and ambitious. So, for instance, they relate that Viśvâ- mitra, the Rishi, created the buffaloes for this purpose, that mankind should enjoy all the good and useful things which they afford. All this reminds one of the words of Plato in the book Timæus: "The Oeoi, i.e. the gods, who, according to an order of their father, carried out the creation of man, took an immortal soul and made it the beginning; thereupon they fashioned like a turner a mortal body upon it." Here in this context we meet with a duration of time which Muslim authors, following the example of the Hindus, call the years of the world. People think that at their beginnings and endings creation and destruc- tion take place as kinds of new formations. This, however, is not the belief of the people at large. Ac- cording to them, this duration is a day of Brahman and a consecutive night of Brahman; for Brahman is intrusted with creating. Further, the coming into existence is a motion in that which grows out of some- thing different from itself, and the most apparent of the causes of this motion are the meteoric motors, i.e. the stars. These, however, will never exercise regular influences on the world below them unless they move and change their shapes in every direction (= their aspeets). Therefore the coming into existence is limited to the day of Brahman, because in it only, as the

Page 369

CHAPTER XXXII. 323

Hindus believe, the stars are moving and their spheres Page 165. revolving according to their pre-established order, and in consequence the process of coming into existence is developed on the surface of the earth withont any interrnption. On the contrary, during the night of Brahman the spheres rest from their motions, and all the stars, as well as their apsides and nodes, stand still in one particular place. In consequence all the affairs of the earth are in one and the same unchanging condition, therefore thecoming into existence has ceased, because he who makes things come into existence rests. So both the processes of act- ing and of being acted upon are suspended; the elements rest from entering into new metamorphoses and com- binations, as they rest now in (lacuna ; perhaps: the night), and they prepare themselves to belong to new beings, which will come into existence on the following day of Brahman. In this way existence circulates during the life of Brahman, a subject which we shall propound in its proper place. According to these notions of the Hindus, creation Critical and destruction only refer to the surface of the earth. the author. remark of

By snch a creation, not one piece of clay comes into existence which did not exist before, and by such a destruction not one piece of clay which exists ceases to exist. It is quite impossible that the Hindus should have the notion of a creation as long as they believe that matter existed from all eternity. The Hindus represent to their common people the Brahman's two durations here mentioned, the day of Brahman and sleeping. waking and

the night of Brahman, as his waking and slecping ; and we do not disapprove of these terms, as they denote something which has a beginning and end. Further, the whole of the life of Brahman, consisting of a suc-

Page 370

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

cession of motion and rest in the world during such a period, is considered as applying only to existence, not to non-existence, since during it the piece of clay exists and, besides, also its shape. The life of Brahman is only a day for that being who is above him, i.e. Purusha (ef. chap. xxxv.). When he dies all compounds are dissolved during his night, and in consequence of the annihilation of the compounds, that also is suspended which kept him (Brahman) within the laws of nature. This, then, is the rest of Purusha, and of all that is under his control (lit. and of his vehicles). Vulgar and When common people describe these things, they scientific notions on make the night of Brahman follow after the night of the sleep of Brahman. Purusha ; and as Purusha is the name for a man, they attribute to him sleeping and waking. They derive destruction from his snoring, in consequence of which all things that hang together break asunder, and everything standing is drowned in the sweat of his forehead. And more of the like they produce, things which the mind declines to accept and the ear refuses to hear. Therefore the educated Hindus do not share these opinions (regarding the waking and sleeping of Brah- man), for they know the real nature of sleep. They know that the body, a compound of antipathetic humores, requires sleep for the purpose of resting, and for this purpose that all which nature requires, after being wasted, should be duly replaced. So, in consequence of the constant dissolution, the body requires food in order to replace that which had been lost by emacia- tion. Further, it requires cohabitation for the purpose of perpetuating the species by the body, as without cohabitation the species would die out. Besides, the body requires other things, evil ones, but necessary, while simple substances can dispense with them, as also He can who is above them, like to whom there is nothing.

Page 371

CHAPTER XXXII.

Further, the Hindus maintain that the world will Notions re- perish in consequence of the conjunction of the twelve eud of the garding the

suns, which appear one after the other in the different world.

months, ruining the earth by burning and calcining it, and by withering and drying up all moist substances. Further, the world perishes in consequence of the union of the four rains which now come down in the different seasons of the year ; that which has been calcined attracts the water and is thereby dissolved. Lastly, the world perishes by the cessation of light and by the prevalence of darkness and non-existence. By all this the world will be dissolved into atoms and be scattered. The Matsya-Purana says that the fire which burns the world has come out of the water; that until then it dwelt on Mount Mahisha in the Kusha-Dvipa, and was called by the name of this mountain. The Vishnu-Purana says that " Mabarloka lies above the pole, and that the duration of the stay there is one Page 166. kalpa. When the three worlds burn, the fire and smoke injure the inhabitants, and then they rise and emigrate to Janaloka, the dwelling-place of the sons of Brahman, who preceded creation, viz. Sanaka, Sananda, Sanandanada (?), Asuras, Kapila, Vodhu, and Pañća- śikha." The context of these passages makes it clear that Abu-Ma'- this destruction of the world takes place at the end of a Indian shar uses

kalpa, and hence is derived the theory of Abu-Ma'shar theories.

that a deluge takes place at the conjunction of the planets, because, in fact, they stand in conjunction at the end of each caturyuga and at the beginning of each kaliyuga. If this conjunction is not a complete one, the deluge, too, will evidently not attain the highest degree of its destructive power. The farther we advance in the investigation of these subjects, the more light will be shed on all ideas of this kind, and the better the reader will understand all words and terms occur- ring in this context.

Page 372

ALBERUNPS INDIA.

Buddhist Aleranshahri records a tradition, as representing the uotions from belief of the Buddhists, which much resembles the silly Aleran- shahrî. tales just mentioned. On the sides of Mount Meru there are four worlds, which are alternately civilised or desert. A world becomes desert when it is overpowered by the fire, in consequence of the rising of seven suns, one after the other, over it, when the water of the fountains dries up, and the burning fire becomes so strong as to penetrate into the world. A world becomes civilised when the fire leaves it and migrates to another world ; after it has left, a strong wind rises in the world, drives the clouds, and makes them rain, so that the world becomes like an ocean. Out of its foam shells are produced, with which the souls are connected, and out of these human beings originate when the water has sunk into the ground. Some Buddhists think that a man comes by accident from the perishing world to the growing world. Since he feels unhappy on account of his being alone, out of his thought there arises a spouse, and from this couple generation commences.

Page 373

( 327 )

CHAPTER XXXIII.

ON TIIE VARIOUS KINDS OF THE DAY OR NYCHTHEMERON, AND ON DAY AND NIGHT IN PARTICULAR.

ACCORDING to the general nsage of Muslims, Hindus, Definition and others, a day or nychthemeron means the dura- night. of day and

tion of one revolution of the sun in a rotation of the universe, in which he starts from the one half of a great cirele and returns to the same. Apparently it is divided into two halves: the day (i.c. the time of the sun's being visible to the inhabitants of a certain place on earth), and the night (i.e. the time of his being in- visible to them). His being visible and being invisible are relative facts, which differ as the horizons differ. It is well known that the horizon of the equator, which the Hindus call the country without latitude, cuts the circles parallel to the meridian in two halves. In con- sequence, day and night are always equal there. How- ever, the horizons which cut the parallel circles without passing throngh their pole divide them into two un- equal halves, the more so the smaller the parallel circles are. In consequence, there day and night are unequal, except at the times of the two equinoxes, when on the whole earth, except Meru and Vadavamukha, day and night are equal. Then all the places north and sonth of the line share in this peculiarity of the line, but only at this time, not at any other. The beginning of the day is the sun's rising above Manushsa. the horizon, the beginning of the night his disappearing horàtra.

below it. The Hindus consider the day as the first, the

Page 374

328 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

night as the second, part of the nychthemeron. There- fore they call the former Surana, i.e. a day depending on the rising of the sun. Besides, they call it Manu- shyahoratra, i.e. a human day, because, in fact, the great mass of their people do not know any other kind of day but this. Now, assuming the Sarana to be known to the reader, we shall in the following use it as a standard and gauge, in order thereby to determine all the other kinds of days. Day of the After the human day follows Pitrinam ahoratra, i.e. fathers, the nychthemeron of the forefathers, whose spirits, according to the belief of the Hindus, dwell in the sphere of the moon. Its day and night depend upon light and darkness, not upon the rising and setting in relation to a certain horizon. When the moon stands in the highest parts of the sphere with reference to them, this is a day to them; and when it stands in the lowest parts, it is night to them. Evidently their moon is the time of conjunction or full moon, and their mid- night is opposition or new moon. Therefore the nych- themeron of the forefathers is a complete lunar month, the day beginning at the time of half-moon, when the light on the moon's body begins to increase, and the night beginning at the time of half-moon, when her light begins to wane. This follows of necessity from the just-mentioned determination of the noon and mid- night of the nychthemeron of the forefathers. Besides, it may be brought near to the reader by a comparison, as the bright half of the light on the moon's body may be compared to the rising of half of the globe of the sun over the horizon, and the other half's setting below the horizon. The day of this nychthemeron extends from the last quarter of a month to the first quarter of the succeeding month ; the night from the first to the second quarter of one identical month. The totality of these two halves is the nychthemeron of the fore- fathers.

Page 375

CHAPTER XXXIII.

Thus the subject is explained by the author of Vishņu- Dharma both at large and in detail, but afterwards he treats it a second time with very little understanding, and identifies the day of the forefathers with the black half of the month from opposition to conjunction, and their night with its white half, whilst the correct state- ment is that which we have just mentioned. This view is also confirmed by their custom of offering gifts of food to the forefathers on the day of conjunction, for they explain noon to be the time of taking food. For this reason they offer food to the forefathers at the same time when they themselves take it. Next follows the Diryahoratra, i.c. the nychthemeron Day of the of the angels. It is known that the horizon of the Devas.

greatest latitude, i.r. that of 90 degrees, where the pole stands in the zenith, is the equator, not exactly, but approximately, because it is a little below the visible horizon for that place on earth which is occupied by Mount Meru; for its top and slopes the horizon in question and the equator may be absolutely identical, although the visible horizon lies a little below it (i.e. farther south). Further, it is evident that the zodiac is divided into two halves by being intersected by the equator, the one half lying above the equator (i.c. north of it), the second half below it. As long as the sun marches in the signs of northern declination it revolves like a mill, since the diurnal arcs which he describes are parallel to the horizon, as in the case of the sun- dials. For those who live under the north pole the sun appears above the horizon, therefore they have day, whilst for those living under the south pole the sun is concealed below the horizon, and therefore they have night. When, then, the sun migrates to the southern Page 168. signs, he revolves like a mill below the horizon (i.e. south of the equator); hence it is night to the people living under the north pole and day to those living under the south pole.

Page 376

330 ALBERUNPS INDIA.

The dwellings of the Devaka, i.e. the spiritual beings, are under the two poles; therefore this kind of day is called by their name, i.e. the nychthemeron of the Deva. Âryabhata of Kusumapura says that the Deva see one half of the solar year, the Danava the other; that the Pitaras see one half of the lunar month, human beings the other. So one revolution of the sun in the zodiac affords day and night both to the Deva and Danava, and their totality is a nychthemeron. In consequence our year is identical with the nych- themeron of the Deva. In it, however, day and night are not equal (as in the nychthemeron of the fore- fathers), because the sun moves slowly in the half of the northern declination about its apogee, by which the day becomes a little longer. However, this difference is not equal to the difference between the visible horizon and the real one, for this cannot be observed on the globe of the sun. Besides, according to Hindu notions, the inhabitants of those places are raised above the surface of the earth, dwelling on Mount Meru. Who- ever holds this view holds regarding the height of Meru the same opinions as those we have described in the proper place (in chap. xxiii.). In consequence of this height of Mount Meru, its horizon must fall a little lower (i.e. more southward than the equator), and in conseqnence the rate of the day's being longer than the night is lessened (as then the sun does not entirely reach his northern apogee, where he makes the longest days). If this were anything else but simply a reli- gious tradition of the Hindus, besides being one regard- ing which even they do not agree among themselves, we should try to find, by astronomical calculation, the amount of this depression of the horizon of Mount Meru below the equator, but as there is no use in this snbject (Mount Meru being simply an invention), we drop it.

Page 377

CHAPTER XXXIII. 331

Some uneducated Hindu heard people speak of the day of such a nychthemeron in the north, and of its night in the south. In connection with these elements he determined the two parts of the year by the two halves of the zodiac, the one which ascends from the winter solstice, called the northern, and the one which descends from the summer solstice, called the southern. Then he identified the day of this nychthemeron with the ascending half, and its night with the descending half. All of which he has eternised in his books. Not much better is what the author of the Vishnu- Dharma says :- "The half beginning with Capricornus is the day of the Asura, i.e. the Dânavas, and their night begins with the sign of Cancer." Previously he had said: "The half beginning with Aries is the day of the Deva." This author acted without any under- standing of the subject, for he simply confounds the two poles with each other (for according to this theory the half of the sun's revolution, beginning with Capri- cornns or the winter solstice, would be the day of the beings under the north pole or the Devas, not that of the beings under the south pole or Asuras, and the revolution of the sun beginning with Cancer or the summer solstice would be the day of the Asuras, not their night). If this autbor had really understood the sentence, and had known astronomy, he would have come to other conclusions. Next follows the Brahmahoratra, i.e. the nychtheme- Day of Brah- ron of Brahman. It is not derived from light and dark- man.

ness (as that of the forefathers), nor from the appearing or disappearing of a heavenly body (like that of the Devas), but from the physical nature of created things, in consequence of which they more in the day and rest in the night. The length of the nychthemeron of Brahman is 8,640,000,000 of our years. Dnring one half of it, i.e. during the day, the æther, with all that is in it, is moving, the earth is producing, and the

Page 378

332 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

changes of existence and destruction are constantly going on upon the surface of the earth. During the other half, i.c. the night, there occurs the opposite of everything which occurs in the day ; the earth is not changing, becanse those things which produce the changes are resting and all motions are stopped, as nature rests in the night and in the winter, and con- Page 169. centrates itself, preparing for a new existence in the day and in the summer. Each day of Brahman is a kalpa, as also each night, and a kalpa is that space of time which Muslim authors call the year of the Sindhind. Day of Lastly follows the Purushahoratra, i.e. the nychthe- Purusha. meron of the All-soul, which is also called Mahakalpa, i.e. the greatest kalpa. The Hindus only nse it for the purpose of determining duration in general by some- thing like a notion of time, but do not specify it as day and night. I almost feel inclined to think that the day of this nychthemeron means the duration of the soul's being connected with the udn, whilst the night means the duration of their being separated from each other, and of the resting of the souls (from the fatigue of being mixed np with the udy), and that that condition which necessitates the soul's being connected with the uln or its being separated from the uxn reaches its periodical end at the end of this nychthemeron. The Vishnu-Dharma says: "The life of Brahman is the day of Purusha, and the night of Purusha has the same length." The Hindus agree in assigning to the life of Brahman a hundred of his years. The number of our years which corresponds to one of his years betrays itself to be a multiplication of 360 with the number of our years, which correspond to one nychthemeron of his. We have already mentioned (p. 331) the length of the nychthemeron of Brahman. Now the length of a year of Brahman is 3, 110,400,000,000 of our years (i.e.

Page 379

CHAPTER XXXIII. 333

360 x 8,640,000,000). A hundred years of the same kind, reckoned in our years, are represented by the same number increased by two ciphers, so that you get in the whole ten ciphers, viz. 311,040,000,000,000. This space of time is a day of Purusha; therefore his nychthemeron is double of it, viz. 622,080,000,000,000 of our years. According to the Pulisa-Siddhanta, the life of Brah- Parardha- man is a day of Purusha. However, it has also been kalpa.

mentioned that a day of Purusha is a parardhalalpa. Other Hindus say that parardhakalpa is the day of lha, i.e. the point, by which they mean the first cause, on which all existence depends. The kalpa occupies the eighteenth place in the scale of the degrees of the num- bers (see p. 175). It is called parardha, which means the half of hearen. Now, the double of this would be the whole of heaven and the whole nychthemeron. Therefore kha is represented by the number 864, fol- lowed by twenty-four ciphers. this number representing our years (ef. p. 331). These terms must, on the whole, be rather considered as a philosophical means of conveying an abstract notion of time than as mathematical values composed of the various kinds of numbers, for they are derived from the processes of combination and dissolution, of procreation and destruction.

Page 380

( 334 )

CHAPTER XXXIV.

ON THE DIVISION OF THE NYCHTHEMERON INTO MINOR PARTICLES OF TIME.

Ghațî. THE Hindus are foolishly painstaking in inventing the most minnte particles of time, but their efforts have not resulted in a universally adopted and uniform system. On the contrary, you hardly ever meet with two books or two men representing the subject iden- tically. In the first instance, the nychthemeron is divided into sixty minntes or ghatt. We read in the book Srudhara by Utpala the Kashmirian: "If you bore in a piece of wood a cylindrical hole of twelve fingers' diameter and six fingers' height, it contains three mana water. If you bore in the bottom of this hole another hole as large as six plaited hairs of the hair of a young woman, not of an old one nor of a child, the three mand of water will flow out through this hole in one ghatt." Casbaka. Each minute is divided into sixty seconds, called cashaka or cakhaka, and also righatika. Prâņa. Each second is divided into six parts or prâna, i.e. l'age 170. breath. The above-mentioned book, Srudhara, explains the prana in the following manner: "It is the breath of a sleeping person who sleeps a normal sleep, and not like a man who is ill, who suffers from retention of the urine, who is hungry, or has eaten too much, whose mind is occupied with some sorrow or pain; for the breath of a sleeping person varies according to the

Page 381

CHAPTER XXXIV. 335

conditions of his soul, which originate either from desire or fear, according to the conditions of his body, depend- ing upon the emptiness or fulness of his stomach, and according to various accidents disturbing the kind of humor which is considered the most desirable." It is all the same whether we determine the prana according to this rnle (one nychthemeron = 21,600 prana), or if we divide each ghaff into 360 parts (60 × 360 = 21,600), or each degree of the sphere into sixty parts (360 x 60 = 21,600). As far as this all Hindus agree with each other in vinadi. the matter, though they use different terms. So, for instance, Brahmagupta calls the cashaka or seconds rinadt, likewise Aryabhata of Kusumapura. Besides the latter calls the minutes nudt. Both, however, did not use particles of time smaller than the prang, which correspond to the minutes of the sphere (60 x 360). For Pulisa says: " The minutes of the sphere, which are 21,600, resemble the normal breaths of man at the time of the equinoxes, and when man is in perfect health. During one breathing of man the sphere revolves as far as one minute." Other people insert between minute and second a Kshaņa. third measure, called kshana, which is equal to one- fourth of a minute (or fifteen seconds). Each lshana, is divided into fifteen kalâ, each of which is equal to one-sixtieth of a minute, and this is the cashaka, only called by another name. Among the lower orders of these fractions of time Nimesha, there occur three names which are always mentioned lava, trufi.

in the same sequence. The largest is the nimesha, i.e. the time during which the eye, in the normal state of things, is open between two consecutive looks. The lara is the mean, and the trufi the smallest part of time, the latter word meaning the cracking of the fore- finger against the inside of the thumb, which is with them a gesture expressive of astonishment or admira-

Page 382

336 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

tion. The relation between these three measures varies very much. According to mauy of the Hindus-

2 truti = I lara. 2 lava = I nimesha.

Further, they differ as to the relation between the nimesha and the next higher order of fractions of time, for according to some the latter (hashtha) contains fifteen, according to others thirty nimesha. Others, again, divide each of theso three measures into eighths, so that- S truti= I lara, 8 lara = I nimesha. 8 nimesha = I kashtha (?).

The latter system is used in the book Srudhara, and has also been adopted by & M Y (?), one of their learned astronomers. He makes this division still more subtle by adding a further measure, smaller than the truti, which is called anu, and eight of which are one truti. Kâshțhå, The next higher orders, parts of time larger than the kalå. nimesha, are kashtha and kala. We have said already (p. 335) that with some Hindus kald is only another name for cashaka, and is considered as equal to thirty kshtha. Further-

I kash tha= 15 nimesha. I nimesha =2 lara. I lava = 2 truți.

Others reckon thus-

I kala= Peth minute of the nychthemeron= 30 kushtha. I kashtha = 30 nimcshu.

And the further fractions such as those just men- tioned. Lastly, others reckon thus-

I cashak =6 nimesha. I nimesha = 3 lara.

Here ends the tradition of Utpala.

Page 383

CHAPTER XXXIV. 337

According to the Vayu-Purana-

I muharta = 30 kola. I kala = 30 kashtha. I kshtha = 15 nimesha.

The smaller fractions are disregarded by the Vayu Purána. Wehave no means of settling the question as to which rage 171 of these systems is the most authentic one. Therefore it is the best for us to adhere to the theory of Utpala and & M Y(?), i.c. to divide all measures of time smaller than a prana by eight-

I prâna = 8 nimeshu. I lava = S truți. I nimcshu = 8 lara. I truti = S anu.

The whole system is represented in the following table :-

The names of the mea- How many times the smaller one is con- sures of time. tained in the larger How mang of it are con- tained in one das. one.

Ghati, Nâdî 60 60 Kshana Cashaka, Vinadi, 4 240

Kalâ 15 3600 Prâna 6 21,600 Nimesha. S 172,800 Lava I,382,400 Truti 8 11,059.200 Anu 8 SS,473,600

The Hindus have also a popular kind of division of Prahara. the nychthemeron into eight prahara, i.e. changes of the watch, and in some parts of their country they have clepsydræ regulated according to the ghatt, by which the times of the eight watches are determined. After a watch which lasts seven and a half ghatt has elapsed, they beat the drum and blow a winding shell VOL. I.

Page 384

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

called sankha, in Persian sped-muhra. I have seen this in the town of Purshitr. Pious people have bequeathed for these clepsydræ, and for their administration, lega- cies and fixed incomes. Muhúrta. Further, the day is divided into thirty muhurta, but this division is not free from a certain obscurity ; for sometimes you think that the muhurtas have always the same length, since they compare them either with the yhati, and say that two ghatt are one muhurta, or with the watches, and say that one watch is three and three-quarters muhurta. Here the muhurtas are treated as if they were horce cquinoctiales (i.e. so and so many equal parts of the nychthemeron). However, the num- ber of such honrs of a day or of a night differs on every degree of latitnde, and this makes us think that the length of a muhurta during the day is different from its length during the night (for if four watches or fifteen muhurta represent a day or a night, the muhurtas cannot be of the same length in the day and in the night, except at the times of the equinoxes). On the other hand, the way in which the Hindus count the dominants of the muhurtas makes us more inclined to the opposite opinion, that, in fact, the muhurtas are of different length, for in the case of day and night they simply attribute to each of them fifteen dominants. Here the muhurtas are treated like the horæ obliquc temporales (i.e. twelve equal parts of the day and twelve equal parts of the night, which differ as day and night differ). The latter opinion is confirmed by a calculation of the Hindus which enables them to find the number of the mnthitrtas (which have elapsed of the day) by means of the digits which the shadow of a person at the time measures. From the latter number you subtract the digits of the shadow of the person at noon, and the remaining number you look out in the

Page 385

CHAPTER XXXIV. 339

middle column of the following diagram, which we have taken from some of their metrical compositions. The corresponding field of the upper or lower columns shows the number of muhurtas which you wanted to find.

The muhartas which ) have elapsed before 2 3 4 5 6 7 noon.

How many digits the) shadow in question is | larger than the noon- 96 60 12 6 5 3 2 0

shadow

The muhartas which) have elapscd after 14 13 12 II IO 9 8 noon

The commentator of the Siddhanta, Pulisa, comments Whether the on the latter opinion, and blames those who in general muharta is length of a

declare one muhurta to be equal to two ghatt, saying inrariable. variable or

that the number of the ghati of the nychthemeron Page 172. varies in the different parts of the year, whilst the number of its muhartas does not vary. But in another place he contradicts himself, where he reasons abont the measure of the muhurta. He fixes one muhurta as equal to 720 prana or breaths, one breath being com- posed of two things: the apana or the inhaling, and the prana or the exhaling of breath. Two other terms of the same meaning are nihsrasa and arasrasa. How- ever, if one thing is mentioned, the other is tacitly included and understood ; as, for instance, if yon speak of days, you include the nights, meaning to express days and nights. Accordingly a muhurta is 360 apana and 360 prâna. In the same manner, when speaking of the measure

Page 386

340 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

of a ghati, he only mentions the one species of breath, connoting the other, for he explains it in general as equal to 360 breaths (instead of 180 apâna and 180 prêna). If now the muhurta is measured by breaths, it is dependent upon the gha!t and the horce cquinoctiales as the gauges of its measure. But this is exactly the con- trary of what Pulisa intends, for he argues against his opponents who maintain that a day has fifteen muhitrtas only, if he who counts them dwells on the equator or somewhere else, but at the time of the equinoxes. Pulisa observes that the abhijit coincides with noon and the beginning of the second half of the day; that, therefore, if the number of the muhitrtas of the day varied, the number of the muhurta called abhijit and denoting noon would vary too (i.e. it would not always be called the eighth muhurta of the day). Vyasa says that the birth of Yudhishthira took place in the white half, at noon, at the eighth muhurta. If an opponent means to infer from this that it was the day of an equinox, we answer by referring him to the state- ment of Markandeya, viz. that the birth took place at full moon in the month Jyaishtha, a time of the year which is far distant from an equinox. Further, Vyasa says that the birth of Yudhishthira took place at the abhijit, when the youth of the night was yone, at midnight, at the eighth (muhurta) of the black half, in the month of Bhadrapada. This date, too, is far distant from an equinox. Story of Vasishtha relates that Vasudeva killed Śisupâla, the Šisupâla. son of the daughter of Kamsa, at the abhijit. The Ilindus tell the following story of Sisupala. He had been born with four hands, and one day his mother heard a voice from above saying, " When that person who will kill him touches him, his two superfluous

Page 387

CHAPTER XXXIV. 341

hands will fall off. Thereupon they put the child to the bosom of each of those who were present, and when it came to be touched by Vasudeva, the two hands fell off, as had been prophesied. Now the aunt spoke to him, " Assuredly you will one day kill my child ;" whereupon Vasudeva, who was still a child, answered, "I shall not do that except he deserve it for some crime committed intentionally, and I shall not call him to account util his misdeeds exceed ten." Some time afterwards Yndhishthira was occupied with preparing a sacrifice to the fire in the presence of the most famous personages. He consulted Vyasa as to the rank of the guests present and the honours due to the president of such an assembly, consisting in the presentation of water and roses in a cup, and Vyasa advised him to make Vasudeva the president. In this assembly also Sisupala, his cousin, was present, and now he began to rage, maintaining that he had a better claim to such an honour than Vasudeva. He boasted much and went even so far as to abuse the parent of Vasudeva. The latter called the present company to witness as to his bad behaviour, and let him do as he liked. However, when the affair lasted too long, and passed beyond the number of ten (muhurtas), Vasudeva took the cup and threw it at him, as people throw with the cakra, and cut off his head. This is the story of Śiśupâla. He who wants to prove the above-mentioned theory Criticisms (like Pulisa, viz. that the muhurtas are thirty equal on Pulisa.

parts of the nychthemeron), will not succeed unless he prove that the abhijit falls together with noon and with the middle of the eighth muhurta (so that the day consists of twice seren and a half equal muhurtas, and likewise the night). As long as he does not prove this, the muhurtus differ in length as days and nights, though just in India only very little, and it is possible

Page 388

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

that in times distant from the equinoxes noon falls either at the beginning or at the end of the eighth muhurta, or within it. How little exact is the learning of the author (Pulisa) who meant to prove this, is evident from the fact that among his arguments he produces a tradition from Garga to this effect, that at the abhijit of the equator Page 173. there is no shadow; for, in the first instance, it is not true save at the two days of the equinoxes; and, secondly, if it were true, it would not have anything to do with the subject he tries to prove (as the ques- tion of the different length of day and night and their divisions does not refer to the equator, where day and night always equal each other, but only to southern or northern latitndes of the earth).

Dominants We represent the dominants of the single muhurtas of the mu- hârtas. in the following table :-

The dominants of the Muhurtas The dominants of the Muhurtas in the in the day. night. of tho The nunher

I. Siva, i.e. Mahâdeva. Rudra, i.c. Mahadeva. 2. Bhujaga, i.e. the snake. Aja, i.e. the lord of all cloven-

Mitra. footed animals. 3 Ahirbudhnya, the lord of Uttara-

Pitri. bhadrapadâ. 4. Pûshan, the lord of Revatî. 5. Vasu. Dasra, the lord of Aśvini. 6. Apas, i.e. the water. Antaka, i.e. the angel of death. 7. Visva. Agni, i.e. the fire. 8. Virincya, i.e. Brahman. 9. Keśvara (?), i.c. Mahâdeva. Dhatri, i.e. Brahma the preserver.

IO. Indragnî. Soma, the lord of Mrigasirsha. Guru, i.e. Jupiter. II. Indra, the prince. Hari, i.c. Narâyana. 12. Nisakara, i.e. the moon. Ravi, i.e. the sun. 13. Varmma, i.e. the lord of the Y'ama, the angel of death. clouds. 14. Aryaman. 15. Bhâgeya (?). Tvashtri, the lord of Citrâ. Anila, i.e. the wind.

Page 389

CHAPTER XXXIV. 343

Nobody in India uses the hours except the astrologers, On the for they speak of the dominants of the hours, and, in Hindn as- hours in

consequence, also of dominants of the nychthemera. The trology.

dominant of the nychthemeron is at the same time the dominant of the night, for they do not separately establish a dominant for the day, and the night is, in this connection, never mentioned. They arrange the order of the dominants according to the horce temporales. They call the hour hord, and this name seems to indi- cate that in reality they use the horce obligucc tempo- rales ; for the Hindus call the media signorum (the centres of the signs of the zodiac) hord, which we Mus- lims call nimbahr (cf. chap. lxxx.). The reason is this, that in each day and each night always six signs rise above the horizon. If, therefore, the hour is called by the Page 174. name of the centre of a sign, each day and each night has twelve hours, and in consequence the hours used in the theory of the dominants of the hours are horce obliquee temporales, as they are used in our country and are inscribed on the astrolabes on account of these domi- nants. This opinion is confirmed by the following sentence of Vijayanandin in the Karana-tilaka, i.e. the first of the canons. After having explained the rule how to find the dominant of the year and of the month, he says : "To find the horadhipati, add the signs which have risen since the morning to the degree of the horoscope, the whole being reckoned in minutes, and divide the sum by 900. The quotient you get count off from the dominant of the nychthemeron, counting the planetary spheres from above to below. The dominant of a day you arrive at, is at the same time the dominant of the hour." He ought to have said, "To the quotient you get add one, and count off the sum from the dominant of the nychthemeron." If he had said, "Reckon the

Page 390

344 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

equatorial degrees which have risen," &c., the calcula- tion would have resulted in horc cquinoctiales. Names of The Hindus give certain names to the horc obliqua, the twenty. four horas. which we have united in the following table. We think they are taken from the book Śmtdhara.

-= Names of the Wbether Horas in the day. favourable Their names in the Whether

or unlucky. night. favourable or unlucky. uf the llonis! Tho nim bior;

I. Raudra. Unlucky. Kalaratri. Unlucky. 2. Saumya. Lucky. Rodhinî. Lucky. 3. Karâla. Unlucky. Vairahma (?). Lucky. 4. Sattra. Lucky. Trâsanîya. Unlucky. 5. Vega. Lucky. Gûbanîya (?). Lucky. 6. Vikala. Lucky. Unlucky. Unlucky. Mâyâ. 7- Mrityusara. Damarîya (?). Lucky. S. Subha. Lucky. Jivaharani. Unlucky. 9. Kroda. Lucky. Soshinf. Unlucky. IO. Candâla. Lucky. Vrishni. Lucky. II. Krittikā. Lucky. Dâhariya (?). The most unlucky of all. 12 Amrita. Lucky. Cântima (?). Lucky.

What time The book Vishnu-Dharma mentions, among the nagas is under the influence of or serpents, a serpent called Naga Kulika. Certain por- the serpent tions of the hours of the planets stand under its in- Kulika. Page 175. fluence. They are unlucky, and everything which is eaten during them hurts and is of no use for anything. Sick people who treat themselves with poisonous medi- cines do not recover, but die and perish. During these times no incantation is of any avail against the bite of a snake, for the incantation consists in the mention of the Garuda, and in those inauspicious times the stork himself cannot help in any way, much less the mention of his name. These times are represented in the following table

Page 391

CHAPTER XXXIV. 345

where the planetary hour is reckoned as consisting of 150 parts.

Tne Dominants of the Hours. Mo Mercury Jupiter Mars. St Natur Venus.

Number of the 150 parts of the hour be- fore the be- ginning of the time of Kulika 67 0 86 Number of the 71 0 144

parts during which the in- fluence of Kulika lasts. 16 8 37 2 6 64

1

Page 392

( 346 )

CHAPTER XXXV.

ON THE DIFFERENT KINDS OF MONTHS AND YEARS.

Defnitionof THE natural month is the period of the moon's syno- the lunar month. dical revolution. We call it physical because it de- velops in the same way as all natural phenomena, rising out of a certain beginning like non-existence, increasing by degrees, and growing, standing still when the climax is attained, then descending, waning away and decreasing, till at last they return to the non- existence whence they came. In the same manner the light develops on the body of the moon, since she appears after the moonless nights as a crescent, then as a young moon (after the third night), and as full moon, and thereafter returns through the same stages to the last night, which is like non-existence, at all events with reference to human senses. It is well known to everybody why the moon continues for some length of time in the moonless nights, but it is not equally known, not even to educated people, why she continues some time as full moon. They must learn how small the body of the moon is in comparison with that of the sun, that in consequence the enlightened portion by far exceeds the dark one, and that this is one of the causes why the moon must necessarily appear as full moon for some length of time. Effects of That the moon has certain effects on moist substances, moonlight. that they are apparently subject to her influences, that, for instance, increase and decrease iu ebb and flow

Page 393

CHAPTER XXXV. 347

develop periodically and parallel with the moon's phases, all this is well known to the inhabitants of sea- shores and seafaring people. Likewise physicians are well aware that she affects the humores of sick people, and that the fever-days revolve parallel with the moon's course. Physical scholars know that the life of animals and plants depends upon the moon, and experimen- talists know that she influences marrow and brain, eggs and the sediments of wine in casks and jugs, that she excites the minds of people who sleep in full moon- light, and that she affects (?) linen clothes which are exposed to it. Peasants know how the moon acts upon fields of cucumbers, melons, cotton, &c., and even make the times for the various kinds of sowing, planting, and grafting, and for the covering of the cattle depend upon the course of the moon. Lastly, astronomers know that Page 176. meteorologic occurrences depend upon the various phases through which the moon passes in her revolutions. This is the month, and twelve of them are in tech- nical language called a lunar year. The natural year is the period of a revolution of the Solar sun in the ecliptic. We call it the nutural, because it month.

comprehends all the stages in the process of generation which revolve through the four seasons of the year. In the course of it, the rays of the sun as passing through a window-glass and the shadows of the sun- dials reassume the same size, position, and direction in which, or from which, they commenced. This is the year, and is called the solar one, in antithesis to the lunar year. As the lunar month is the twelfth part of the lunar year, the twelfth part of the solar year is a solar month in theory, the calculation being based on the mean rotation of the sun. If, however, the calcula- tion is based on his varying rotation, a solar month is the period of his staying in one sign of the zodiac. These are the well-known two kinds of months and years.

Page 394

ALBERUNPS INDIA.

On luni- The Hindus call the conjunction amaasya, the solar caleulation. opposition ptrnima, and the two quarters ATVH (?). Some of them use the lunar year with lunar mouths and days, whilst others use the lunar year but solar months, beginning with o degree of each zodiacal sign. The sun's entering a sign is called sankrunti. This luni-solar calculation is, however, only an approxima- tive one. If they constantly used it, they would soon feel induced to adopt the solar year itself and solar months. In using this mixed system they had only this advantage, that they could dispense with inter- calation. Beginning Those who use lunar months begin the month with of the lunar mouth. conjunction or new moon, and this method is the canoni- cal one, whilst the others begin it with the opposition or full moon. I have heard people say that Varahamihira does the latter, but I have not yet been able to ascer- tain this from his books. The latter method is for- bidden. Still it seems as if it were rather old, because the Veda says : "Men say the moon has become com- plete, and by her becoming complete also the month has become complete. Thus they speak because they do not know me nor the interpretation of me, for the Creator of the world commenced creating with the white half, not with the black half." But possibly these words are only a saying of men (not really a sentence taken from the Veda). The month The numeration of the days of the month begins with counted as two balves. the new moon and the first lunar day is called BRBA, and again enumeration begins with full moon (i.c. they count twice fifteen days, beginning with new moon and full moon). Each two days which are equidistant from new moon or full moon have the same name (or num- ber). In them, light and darkness on the body of the moon are in corresponding phases of increasing and waning, and the hours of the rising of the moon in one day correspond to the hours of her setting in the other.

Page 395

CHAPTER XXXV. 349

For the purpose of finding these times they use the following calculation :- Multiply the elapsed lunar days of the month, if they are less than 15, or, in case they are more, the difference between them and 15, by the number of the ghatîs of the night in qnestion. Add 2 to the product, and divide the sum by 15. Then the quotient repre- sents the number of ghatis and minor fractions of time between the first night, and either the setting of the moon in the night in question, one of the nights of the white half, or the rising of the moon in the night in question, one of the nights of the black half. This calculation is based on the fact that the space of time between the first night and the rising or setting of the moon in some following night of the same luna- tion varies by two minutes (gha!f), and that the nights vary, lasting either a little longer or a little shorter than thirty minutes. If, therefore, you count thirty minutes for each nychthemeron, and you divide the product by half the number of the minutes, you get two minutes for each nychthemeron. As these two minutes, however, agree with the difference of the nights, they multiplied the number of nychthemera by the measure of the night, i.c. the number of its ghatts (see above, ll. 6, 7), whilst it would have been more accurate to multiply by the half of the sum of the ghatis of the night in question and of the first night of the lunation. It is nseless to add the two minutes, Page 177. for they represent the moment when the crescent of the moon first becomes visible, but if this moment were adopted as the beginning of the month, the two minutes would be transferred to the conjunction. As months are composed of days, there are as many various kinds of months as there are kiuds of days. Each montlis. kinds of

month has thirty days. We shall here nse the civil day (Sarana, v. chap. xxxiii.) as a standard. In agreement with the Hindu calculation of the re-

Page 396

350 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

volutions of sun and moon in a kalpa, a lunar month = 291$8005 nychthemera. You find this number by dividing the sum of the days of the kalpa by the number of its lunar months. The number of the lunar months of a kalpa represents the difference between the revolutions of sun and moon in it, viz. 53:433,300,000. A month has 30 lunar days, for this number is canonical, as the number of 360 is canonical for the number of days of a year. The solar month has 30 solar days and 301:362,987 5,118,183 civil days. The month of the fathers is equal to 30 of our months, and has 885183-410 civil days. The month of the angels is equal to 30 years, and has 10,957 civil days. The month of Brahman is equal to 60 kalpas, and has 94,674,987,000,000 civil days. The month of Purusha is equal to 2,160,000 kalpas, and has 3,408,299,532,000,000,000 civil days. The month of Kha has 9,497,498,700,000,000,000,000,000,000,000 civil days. Various By multiplying each of these months by twelve, we kinds of years. get the number of days of the corresponding year. The lunar year has 354 6364 civil days. The solur year has 365376 civil days. The year of the fathers has 360 lunar months, or 10,63 I TT5,11T civil days. The year of the angels has 360 of our years, or 131,493, civil days. The year of Brahman has 720 kalpas, or I, I36,099,844,000,000 civil days. The year of Purusha has 25,920,000 kalpas, or 40,899.594,384,co0,000,000 civil days. The year of Kha has I13,609,984.400,000,000,000,000,000,000,000 civildays. The latter number is mentioned by the Hindus, although it is written in their books that there is no The day of Purusha. combination of numbers beyond the day of Purusha, for

Page 397

CHAPTER XXXV. 351

it is the first and the last, and is without a beginning in the past and without 'an end in the future. The other kinds of days, of which months and years (those of the fathers, the angels, and Brahman) are composed, refer to beings who stand under Purusha in the order of beings, and whose duration is defined by certain limits of time. The day of Purusha is simply an abstraction of the Hindu mind to denote that which is above the sonl (atman), for they make no distinction between purusha and atman except in the order or sequence in which they enumerate them. They speak of Purusha in terms resembling those of the Sûfis, viz. the he is not the first, and is not something else. It is quite possible Page 178. in imagination to extend the idea of duration from the existing present moment towards both sides, i.e. towards the past which no longer exists, and towards the future which possibly will exist, and to measure duration; and if some part of it admits of being determined by days, imagination also admits reduplications of it in the guise of months and years. In all this it is the inten- tion of the Hindus that we should refer the years invented by them to certain periods of life, beginning with the coming into existence, and ending with de- struction and death. However, God the Creator is sublime beyond either, and also the simple substances (air, fire, earth, water) do not know coming into exist- ence nor destruction (in periodical returns). Therefore we stop with the day of Purusha, and do not think it necessary to use still larger periods of time. Things which do not rest on intrinsic necessity offer A tradition a wide field for difference of opinion and arbitrary relating to the years of systematising, so as easily to become the source of Bear and the Great

numerous theories. Some of them may be developed the pole. according to a certain order and rule, whilst others are devoid of such. In the latter class I reckon the follow- ing theory, but unfortunately I have forgotten from what source it has come to me: "33,000 human

Page 398

352 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

years are one year of the Great Bear; 36,000 human years are one year of Brahman, and 99,000 human years are one year of the pole." However, as regards the year of Brahman, we remember that Vasudeva speaks to Arjuna on the battlefield between the two ranks: "The day of Brahman is two kalpas;" and in the Brahmasiddhanta there is a tradition from Vyasa, the son of Parasara, and from the book Smriti, that kalpa is a day of Devaka, i.e. Brahman, and also a night of his. In consequence the there-mentioned theory is evidently wrong (one year of Brahman being infinitely longer than 36,000 years). Further, 36,000 years are the period of one revolution of the fixed stars in the ecliptic, since they pass one degree in 100 years, and the Great Bear belongs to them. However, in their traditional literature the Hindus separate the Great Bear from the fixed stars, and attribute to it a distance from the earth which differs from the real distance, and therefore they describe it by qualities and con- ditions which in reality do not belong to it. If the author of that theory meant by the year of the Great Bear one revolution of it, we do not see why it should revolve so much more rapidly than the other fixed stars (for, in that case, the diameter of its course would be much larger than that of the others), nor why it shonld form an exception to the laws of nature (according to which all fiked stars revolve at the same distance from the earth and in the same time); and the pole has no revolution which might be considered as a year of it. From all this I conclude that the author of the theory was a man entirely devoid of scientific education, and one of the foremost in the series of fools who simply invented those years for the benefit of people who worship the Great Bear and the pole. He had to invent a vast number of years, for the more outrageous it was, the more impression it would make.

Page 399

( 353 )

CHAPTER XXXVI.

ON THE FOUR MEASURES OF TIME CALLED MANA.

MANA and pramana mean measure. The four kinds of measures are mentioned by Ya'kub Ibn Tarik in his book Compositio Spherrarum, but he did not know them thoroughly, and, besides, the names are misspelled, if this is not the fault of the copyists. They are- Saura-mana, i.e. the solar measure. Savana-mana, i.e. the measure depending upon the rising (civil measure). Candra-mana, i.e. the lunar measure. Nakshatra-mana, i.e. the lubar-station measure (sidereal mea- sure). There are days of all four kinds of measure, days of an individual nature, which, when compared with other days, show a certain difference of measure. However, the number 360 is common to all of them (360 days of each class being a year). The civil days are used as a gauge to determine thereby the other days. As regards the saura-mana, it is known that the solar Measure. year has 365327 civil days. Dividing this sum by four differ- ment of the

360, or multiplying it by 1O seconds (= 360 day), you years and ent kinds of

get as the measure of the solar day 1,31,08. civil day. day s.

According to the Vishnu-Dharma, this is the time of Page 179. the sun's passing his bhukti. The civil day, based on the sarana-mana, is here used as the uit of a day, for the purpose of measuring thereby the other kinds of days. VOL, I,

Page 400

354 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

The lunar day, based on the candra mana, is called tithi. Dividing the lunar year by 360 or the lunar month by 30, you get as the measure of the lunar 5016.081 civil days (wrong: read 18;818;88 civil day). According to the Vishnu-Dharma, this is the time during which the moon is visible when she is far dis- tant from the sun. Nakshatra-mana is the period of the moon's passing through her twenty-seven stations, viz. 2731;858 days. This number is the quotient which you get by dividing the days of a kalpa by the number of the revolutions of the moon in a kalpa. Dividing it by 27, you get as the time of the moon's passing one station I3 Abog civil days. Multiplying the same number by 12, as we have done with the lunar month, we get 32747;981 civil days as the time of the moon's passing twelve times through all her stations. Dividing the first number by 30, we get as the measure of the sidereal day g18,731 civil days. According to the Vishnu-Dharma, the sidereal month has only twenty-seven days, whilst the months of the other measures have thirty days; and if a year is com- posed of these days, it has 32715,031 days (see above). Evidently there is a fault in the text of Vishņu-Dharma, as the month is reckoned too short. What use is The saura-mana is used in the computation of the saura-mana, years which compose the kalpa and the four yugas in made of the

candra- mana, and the caturyugas, of the years of the nativities, of the sâvana- mána. equinoxes and solstices, of the sixth parts of the year or the seasons, and of the difference between day and night in the nychthemeron. All these things are com- puted in solar years, months, and days. The candra-mana is used in the computation of the eleven karana (v. chap. Ixxviii.), in the determination of the leap month, in the computation of the sum of days of the unaratra (v. chap. li.), and of new moon and full moon for lunar and solar eclipses (v. chap. lix.).

Page 401

CHAPTER XXXVI. 355

In all these things the Hindus use lunar years, months, and days, which are called tithi. The snrana-mana is used in the calculation of the varn, i.c. the days of the week, of the ahargona, i.c. the sum of the days of an era (v. chap. li.); in determining the days of marriage and fasting (v. chap. Ixxv.); the sutakn, i.c. the days of childbed (v. chap. lxix.); the days of the uncleanness of the houses and the vessels of the dead (v. chap. lxxii.); the cikitsa, i.e. certain months and years in which Ifindu medical science pre- scribes the taking certain medicines; further in deter- mining the prayascitta, i.c. the days of the expiations which the Brahmans make obligatory for those who have committed some sin, times during which they are obliged to fast and to besmear themselves with butter and dung (v. chap. Ixxi.). All these things are deter- mined according to savnna-mana. On the contrary, they do not determine anything by the nakshatra-mana, since it is comprehended in the candra-mana. Every measure of time which any class of people may choose by general consent to call a day, may be considered as a mana. Some such days have already been mentioned in a preceding chapter (v. chap. xxxiii.). However, the four manas par excellence are those to the explanation of which we have limited the present chapter.

Page 402

( 356 )

CHAPTER XXXVII.

ON THE PARTS OF THE MONTH AND THE YEAR.

Ullara yana As the year is one revolution of the sun in the ecliptic, and dak- shinayana. it is divided in the same way as the ecliptic. The latter is divided into two halves, depending upon the two solstitial points. Correspondingly the year is divided into two halves, each of which is called nyana. Page 180. When the sun leaves the point of the winter solstice, he begins to move towards the north pole. Therefore this part of the year, which is nearly one half, is referred to the north and called uttarayana, i.e. the period of the sun's marching through six zodiacal signs beginning with Caper. In consequence, this half of the ecliptic is called makaradi, i.e. having Caper as beginning. When the sun leaves the point of the summer solstice he begins to move towards the south pole; therefore this second half is referred to the south and called dakshinayana, i.e. the period of the sun's marching through six zodiacal signs beginning with Caneer. In consequence, this half of the ecliptic is called karkadi, i.e. having Cancer as beginning. Uneducated people use only these two divisions or year-halves, because the matter of the two solstices is clear to them from the observation of their senses. Uttarakâla Further, the ecliptic is divided into two halves, ac- and doksha- Fūla. cording to its declination from the equator, and this division is a more scientific one, less known to the people at large than the former, because it rests on calculation and speculation. Each half is called kula.

Page 403

CHAPTER XXXVII. 357

That which has northern declination is called uttarakatla or meshadi, i.e. having Aries as beginning ; that which has southern declination is called dakshakla or tuladi, i.e. having Libru as beginning. Further, the ecliptic is by both these divisions divided The seasons. into four parts, and the periods during which the sun traverses them are called the scasons of the year-spring, summer, autumn, and winter. Accordingly, thezodiacal signs are distributed over the seasons. However, the Hindus do not divide the year into four, but into six parts, and call these six parts ritu. Each pitu com- prehends two solar months, i.c. the period of the sun's marching through two consecutive zodiacal signs. Their names and dominants are represented, according to the most widespread theory, in the following diagram. I have been told that in the region of Somanâth people divide the year into three parts, each consisting of four months, the first being curshakala, beginning with the month Ashâdha; the second, sttakala, i.e. the winter ; and the third, ushnakala, i.e. the summer.

The Zodiacal Signs Capricornus of the Ritu. ,and Amphora. Pisces and Taurus and Aries. Gemini.

Their name. S'iśira. Vasanta or Kusumâkara. Grishma or Nidâgha. or Angels. Their domi- Uttarayana,

nants. Narada. Agni the Fire. Indra the Ruler. belonging to the Devas

Scorpio and Sagittarius. Virgo and Libra. Cancer and The Zodiacal Signs Leo. of the Ritu.

Hemanta. S'arad. Varshakâla. Their names. or Fathers. Vaishņava. Prajâpati. Viśvedevâḥ. Their domi- Dakshinayana, nants. belonging to the Pitaras

Page 404

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Page 181. I am inclined to think that the Hindus divide the ecliptic by such an opening of the circle which divides the circumference of a circle into six parts, a measure which is equal to the radius, beginniug with the two solstitial points, and that therefore they use sixth parts of the ecliptic. If this is really the case, we must not forget that we, too, sometimes divide the ecliptic, be- ginning with the two solstitial points, at other times beginning with the equinoctial poiuts, and tbat we nse the division of the ecliptic in twelfth parts side by side with that in fourth parts.

The domin- The months are divided into halves from new moon anta of the singlehalves to full moon, and from full moon to new moon. The of months. Vishnu-Dharma mentions the dominants of the halves of the months, as we give them in the following table :- '

The Names of the The dominants of the The dominants of the months. Bright half of each Black half of each month. month.

Caitra Twashtri Vaiśâkha Indrâgnî Yâmya. Âgneya. Jyaishtha Śukra Raudra. Ashâdha Viśvedevâh Sârpa. Sravana Vishnu Pitrya. Bhâdrapada Asvayuja Aja Sânta. Asana (?) Maitra. Kârttika Sakra. Margasirsha Agni Saumya Nirriti. Pausha Jiva Vishņu. Magha Pitrya Varuna. Phâlguna Bhaga Pûshan.

Page 405

( 359 )

CHAPTER XXXVIII.

ON THE VARIOUS MEASURES OF TIME COMPOSED OF Page 182. DAYS, THE LIFE OF BRAHMAN INCLUDED.

THE day is called dimas (dimasu), in classical language Recapitula- divasa, the night ratri, and the nychthemeron ahoratra. single mea- tion of the

The month is called masa and its half paksha. The first time. sures of

or white half is called suklapaksha, because the first parts of its nights have moonlight at times when people do not yet sleep, when the light on the moon's body increases and the dark portion decreases. The other or black half is called Lrishnupaksha, because the first parts of its nights are moonless, whilst other parts have moonlight, but only then when people sleep. They are the nights when the light on the body of the moon wanes, whilst the dark part increases. The sum of two months is a ritu, but this is only an approximative definition, for the month which has two paksha is a lunar month, whilst that one the double of which is a ritu is a solar month. Six ritu are a year of mankind, a solar year, which is called barh or barkh or barsh, the three sounds I, kh, and sh being much confounded in the mouth of the Hindus (Skr. varsha). Three hundred and sixty years of mankind are one year of the angels, called dibba-barh (dirya-rarsha), and I2,000 years of the angels are unanimonsly reckoned as one caturyuga. There is a difference of opinion only regarding the four parts of the caturyuga and regarding the multiplications of it which form a manrantara and

Page 406

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

a kalpa. This subject will be fully explained in the proper place (v. chaps. xli. and xliv.). Two kalpas are a day of Brahman. It is the same if we say two kalpas or 28 manvantaras, for 360 days of Brahman are a year of Brahman, i.c. 720 kalpas or 10,080 manvantaras. Further, they say that the life of Brahman is 100 of his years, i.e. 72,000 kalpas or 1,008,000 manvantaras. In the present book we do not go beyond this limit. The book Vishnu-Dharma has a tradition from Mar- kandeya, who answers a question of Vajra in these words: "Kalpa is the day of Brahman, and the same is a night of his. Therefore 720 kalpas are a year of his, and his life has 100 such years. These 100 years are one day of Purusha, and the same is a night of his. How many Brahmans, however, have already preceded Purusha, none knows but he who can count the sand of the Ganges or the drops of the rain."

Page 407

CHAPTER XXXIX.

ON MEASURES OF TIME WHICH ARE LARGER THAN THE LIFE OF BRAHMAN.

ALL that is devoid of order or contradicts the rules laid Want of ays- down in the preceding parts of this book is repulsive ing the tem regard-

to our nature and disagreeable to our ear. But the measures of greatest

Hindus are people who mention a number of names, time.

all-as they maintain-referring to the One, the First, or to some one behind him who is only hinted at. When they come to a chapter like this, they repeat the same names as denoting a multitude of beings, measur- ing out lives for them and inventing huge numbers, The latter is all they want; they indulge in it most freely, and numbers are patient, standing as you place them. Besides, there is not a single subject on which the Hindus themselves agree among each other, and this prevents us on our part adopting the use of it. On the contrary, they disagree on these imaginary measures of time to the same extent as on the divisions of the day which are less than a prana (v. chap. xxxiv.). The book Srudhara by Utpala says that "a man- Page 183. vantara is the life of Indra the ruler, and 28 manran- measures of The greatest

taras are one day of Pitamaha, i.c. Brahman. His life mined by time deter-

is 10o years, or one day of Kesava. The life of the kalpas.

latter is 100 years, or one day of Mahadeva. The life of the latter is 100 years, or one day of Iśvara, who is near to the Supreme Being. His life is 100 years, or one day of Sadâsiva. The life of the latter is 100 years, or one day of Virancana, the Eternal, who will

Page 408

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

last for ever, even when the preceding five beings perish." We have already mentioned that the life of Brahman is as long as 72,000 kalpas. All numbers which we shall here mention are kalpas. If the life of Brahman is a day of Kesava, his year, consisting of three hundred and sixty days, has 25,920,000 kalpas, and his life, 2,592,000,000 kalpas. The latter is I day of Mahadeva; his life, therefore, 93,312,000,000,000 kalpas. The latter is I day of Îsvara; therefore his life 3,359.232,000,000,000,000 kalpas. The latter is I day of Sadâsiva; therefore his life 120,932,352,000,000,000,000,000 lalpas. The latter is one day of Virañcana, of which the parárdhakalpa is only relatively a very small part (v. p. 175). The same Whatever may be the nature of these calculations, determined by trutis. apparently the day and the centennium are the elements out of which the whole from beginning to end has been constructed. Others, however, build their system on the small particles of the day which we have pre- viously mentioned (in chap. xxxiv.). In consequence, these people differ among themselves regarding that which they compose, as they differ regarding the par- ticles out of which they compose. We shall here give one system of this kind as invented by those who use the following metrologic system :-

I ghati = 16 kala. I kula = 30 kashtha. I kashtha = 30 nimesha. I nimesha = 2 lara. I lava = 2 truti.

The reason of this division is, as they maintain, the fact that the day of Siva is composed out of similar particles; for the life of Brahman is one ghatt of Hari, i.e. Vâsudeva. The life of the latter is 100 years, or one kala of Rudra, i.c. Mahadeva; the life of the latter is 100 years, or one kushtha of Isvara; the life of the

Page 409

CHAPTER XXXIX. 363

latter is 100 years, or one nimesha of Sadasiva; the life of the latter is 100 years, or one lara of Sakti; the life of the latter is 100 years, or one trufi of Siva.

If, now, the life of Braliman is 72,000 kalpas, the life of Narâyana is 155,520,000,000 klpits ; the life of Rudra, 5,374,771,200,000,000,000; the life of Isvara, 5,572,562,780, 160,c00,000,000,000,000 ; the life of Sadasiva, 173,328,992,714,096,640,000,000,000,000,000,000,000 ; the life of Śakti, 10,782,449,978,758,523.781,120,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000. The latter number represents one trufi.

If you compose a day out of it according to the above- mentioned system, it has 37,264, 147,126,589,458,187, 550,720,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000 kal- pas. The latter number is one day of Siva, whom they describe as the eternalone, who is exemptfrom being pro- created and from procreating, free from all qualities and attributes which may be applied to created things. The last-mentioned number represents fifty-six orders of number (i.c. units, tens, hundreds, thousands, &c. &c.); but if those dreamershad more assiduouslystudied arith- metic, they would not have invented such outrageous numbers. God takes care that their trees do not grow into heaven.

Page 410

CHAPTER XL.

ON THE SAMDHI, THE INTERVAL BETWEEN TWO PERIODS OF TIME, FORMING THE CONNECTING LINK BETWEEN THIEM.

Page 184. THE original samdhi is the interval between day and Explanation of the two night, i.e. morning-dawn, called samdhi udaya, i.e. the samdhis. samdhi of the rising, and evening dawn, called samr- dhi astamana, i.e. the samdhi of the setting. The Hindus require them for a religious reason, for the Brahmans wash themselves during them, and also at noon in the midst between them for dinner, whence an uninitiated person might infer that there is still a third sandhi. However, none who knows the subject pro- perly will count more than two sanidhis. The Puranas relate the following story of King Hiran- yakasipu, of the class of the Daitya :- Story of By practising devotion for a long period, he had King Hiran- yakasipu earned the claim that any prayer of his should be and his son Prahlâda. granted. He asked for eternal life, but only long life was granted to him, for eternity is a quality of the Creator alone. Not having obtained the realisation of this wish, he desired that his death should not be effected by the hand of a human being, angel, or demon, and that it should not take place on earth nor in heaven, neither in the night nor in the day. By such clauses he meant to avoid death, which is unavoidable by man. His wish was granted to him. This wish reminds one of the wish of the devil that he should be allowed to live till the day of resurrection,

Page 411

CHAPTER XL.

because on that day all beings would rise from death. However, he did not attain his object, as it was only conceded to him to live till the day of the well-known time, of which it has been said that it is the last of the days of trouble. The king had a son called Prahlada, whom he in- trusted to a teacher when he grew np. One day the king ordered him into his presence to learn what he was stndying. Now the boy recited to him a poem, the meaning of which was that only Vishnu exists, whilst everything else is illusion. This went much against the opinions of his father, who hated Vishnn, and therefore he ordered the boy to be intrusted to another master, and that he should learn to distin- gnish a friend from an enemy. Thereupon he waited a certain time, and then examined him again, when the boy answered, " I have learned what yon have ordered, bnt I do not want it, for I am in friendship alike with everything, not in enmity with anything." Now his father became angry and ordered him to be poisoned. The boy took the poison in the name of God and thought of Vishnu, and lo! it did not hurt him. His father said, "Do you know witchcraft and incantations?" The boy answered, "No, but the God who has created me and given me to thee watches over me." Now the wrath of the king increased, and he gave orders to throw him into the deep sea. But the sea threw him out again, and he returned to his place. Then he was thrown before the king into a huge blazing fire, but it did not hurt him. Standing in the flame, he began to converse with his father on God and his power. When the boy by chance said that Vishnu is in every place, his father said, "Is he also in this column of the por- tico?" The boy said, " Yes." Then his father jumped against the column and beat it, wherenpon Narasimha came forth from it, a human figure with a lion's head, therefore neither a human being, nor an angel, nor a

Page 412

366 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

demon. Now the king and his people began to fight with Narasimha, who let them do so, for it was day- time. But when it was towards evening and they were in the sardhi or twilight, therefore neither in the day nor in the night, then Narasimha caught the king, raised him into the air, and killed him there ; therefore not on earth nor in heaven. The prince was taken out of the fire and ruled in his place. Hindu astrologers require the two samdhi, because used mn astrology. then some of the zodiacal signs exercise the most power- hira quoted. ful influence, as we shall explain hereafter in the proper Varahami-

place. They make use of them in a rather superficial way, simply reckoning the time of each samdhi as one muhurta =two ghatt=48 minutes. However, Varaha- mihira, excellent astronomer as he is, always only used day and night, and did not allow himself to follow the opinion of the crowd regarding the samdhi. He ex- plained the saridhi as that which it really is, viz. as the moment when the centre of the body of the sun Page 185. stands exactly over the horizontal circle, and this moment he establishes to be the time of the greatest power of certain zodiacal signs. On the Besides the two samdhi of the natural day, astrono- samdhi of the year-half mers and other people assume still other samdhis, and its com- bination which do not rest on a law of nature nor on observa- with the pre- cession of tion, but simply on some hypothesis. So they attribute the equi- noxes. a samidhi to each ayana, i.e. to each of the year-halves Other kinds of sandhi. in which the sun ascends and descends (v. chap. xxxvii.), a smmdhi of seven days before its real beginning. On this subject I have an idea which is certainly possible, and even rather likely, viz. that this theory is of recent origin, not of ancient date, and that it has been brought forward about 1300 of Alexander (= A.D. 989), when the Hindus found out that the real solstice precedes the solstice of their calcnlation. For Puñ- jala, the author of the Small Manasa, says that in the year 854 of the Sakakala the real solstice preceded his

Page 413

CHAPTER XL. 367

calculation by 6° 50', and that this difference will in- crease in future by one minute every year. These are the words of a man who either was him- self a most careful practical observer, or who examined the observations of former astronomers which he had at his disposal, and thereby found out the amount of the annual difference. No donbt, also, other people have perceived the same or a similar difference by means of the calculation of the noon-shadows. There- fore (as this observation was already mnch known) Utpala of Kashmir has taken this theory from Punjala. This conjecture of mine is confirmed by the fact that the Hindus prefix the smmdhis of the solstices to each of the six seasons of the year, in consequence of which they begin already with the twenty-third degree of the next preceding signs. The Hindus assume a samdhi, too, between the dif- ferent yugas and between the manvantaras; but as the bases of this theory are hypothetical, so everything else derived from them is hypothetical. We shall give a sufficient explanation of these things in the proper place.

Page 414

( 368 )

CHAPTER XLI.

DEFINITION OF THE TERMS "KALPA" AND " CATURYUGA," AND AN EXPLICATION OF THE ONE BY THE OTHER.

On the mea. TWELVE thousand Divya-years, the length of which has sure of a caturyuga already been explained (v. chap. xxxv.), are one catur- and a kalpa. yuga, and 1000 caturyugas are one kalpa, a period at the beginning and end of which there is a conjunction of the seven planets and their apsides and nodes in o° of Aries. The days of the kalpa are called the kalpa- ahargana, for ah means day, and argana means the sum. Since they are civil days derived from the rising of the sun, they are also called days of the earth, for rising presupposes an horizon, and an horizon is one of the necessary attributes of the earth. By the same name, kalpa-ahargana, people also call the sum of days of any era up to a certain date. Our Muslim authors call the days of the kalpa the days of the Sind-hind or the days of the world, counting them as 1,577,916,450,000 days (suvana or civil days), or 4,320,000,000 solar years, or 4,452,775,000 lunar years. The same sum of days converted into years of 360 civil days is equal to 4,383, 101,250 of them, and to 12,000,000 divya-years. The Aditya-Purana says: " Kalpana is composed of kal, which means the existence of the species in the world, and pana, which means their destruction and disappearance. The sum of this existing and perish- ing is a kalpa." Brahmagupta says: " Since the planets and mankind

Page 415

CHAPTER XLI.

in the world came into existence at the beginning of the day of Brahman, and since they both perish at the end of it, we must adopt this day of their existence as a kalpa, not another period." In another place he says : " A thousand caturyuga are Page 186. one day of Deraka, i.e. Brahman, and a night of his is of the same length. Therefore his day is equal to 2000 caturyuya. In the same way Vyasa the son of Parasara says : "He who believes that 1000 caturyugas are a day and 1000 caturyugas a night, knows Brahman." Within the space of a lulpa 71 caturyugas are egnal Relation be- to I manu, i.e. manrantara, or Manu-period, and 14 tween man- rantara and manus are equal to I Falpa. Multiplying 71 by 14, kalpa.

you get 994 caturyugas as the period of 14 manran- taras, and a remainder of 6 caturyugas till the end of the kalpa. If we, however, divide these 6 caturyugas by 15, in order to find the sardhi both at the beginning and end of each of the 14 mantantaras, the number of the sandhis being by I larger than that of the mantantaras, the quotient is §ths. If we now insert caturyuya between each two consecutive manrantaras, and add the same amount both at the beginning of the first and the end of the last manrantaras, the fraction of & disap- pears at the end of 15 manvantaras (gx 15=6). The fractions at the beginning and end of the kalpa repre- sent the smiidhi, i.e. a common link. A kalpa, includ- ing its samidhi, has 1000 caturyugas, as we have said in the first part of this chapter. The single parts of a kalpa stand in a constant rela- Condition:s tion to each other, one bearing witness regarding the ginning of of the be-

other. For it commences with the vernal equinox, a a kalpa.

Sunday, the conjunction of the planets, their apsides and nodes, which takes place there where there is neither Revati nor Asvinî, i.e. between them, at the beginning of the month Caitra, and in the moment of the sun's VOL. I.

Page 416

370 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

rising over Lanka. When there occurs an irregularity with one of these conditions, all the others become con- fused and are no longer valid. We have already mentioned the number of the days and the years of a kalpa. Accordingly a caturyuga, as 70b. th of a kalpa, has 1,577,916,450 days and 4,320,000 years. The numbers show the relation between a kalpa and a caturyuga, and show further how to determine the one by the other. All we have said in this chapter rests on the theory of Brahmagupta and on the arguments by which he supports it. Theories of Aryabhata the elder and Pulisa compose the manvan- Aryabhata the elder, tara from 72 caturyuyas, and the kalpa from 14 man- Pulisa, and Aryabhata vantaras, without inserting anywhere a samdhi. There- the younger. fore, according to them, a kalpa has 1008 caturyugas; further, 12,096,000 dirya ycars, or 4,354, 560,000 human years. According to Pulisa, a caturyuga has 1,577,917,800 ciril days. According to him, therefore, the sum of the days of a halpa would be 1,590,541,142,400. These are the numbers which he uses in his book. I have not been able to find anything of the books of Aryabhata. All I know of him I know through the quotations from him given by Brahmagupta. The latter says in a treatise called Critical Rescarch on the Basis of the Canons, that according to Aryabhata the sum of the days of a caturyuga is 1,577,917,500, i.e. 300 days less than according to Pulisa. Therefore Arya- bhata would give to a kalpa 1,590,540,840,000 days. According to Aryabhata and Pulisa, the kalpa and caturyuga begin with midnight which follows after the day the beginning of which is the beginning of the kalpa, according to Brahmagupta. Aryabhata of Kusumapura, who belongs to the school of the elder Aryabhata, says in a small book of his on Page 187. Al-ntf (?), that " 1008 caturyugas are one day of Brah-

Page 417

CHAPTER XLI. 371

man. The first half of 504 caturyugas is called utsar- pint, during which the sun is ascending, and the second half is called arasarpinf, during which the sun is de- scending. The midst of this period is called sama, i.e. equality, for it is the midst of the day, and the two ends are called durtama (?)." This is so far correct, as the comparison between day and kalpa goes, but the remark about the sun's ascend- ing and descending is not correct. If he meant the sun who makes our day, it was his duty to explain of what kind that ascending and descending of the sun is ; but if he meant a sun who specially belongs to the day of Brabman, it was his duty to show or to describe him to us. I almost think that the author meant by these two expressions the progressive, increasing develop- ment of things during the first half of this period, and the retrograde, decreasing development in the second half.

Page 418

( 372 )

CHAPTER XLIL.

ON THE DIVISION OF THE CATURYUGA INTO YUGAS, AND THE DIFFERENT OPINIONS REGARDING THE LATTER.

The single THE author of the Vishnu-Dharma says : "Twelve hun- parts of a caturyuga dred divya years are one yuga, called tishya. The double according to Vishnu- of it is a drapara, the triple a treta, the quadruple a Dharma and Brahma- krita, and all four yugas together are one caturyuga, i.e. gupta. the four yugas or sums. "Seventy-one caturyugas are one manrantara, and 14 manrantaras, together with a samdhi of the duration of one britayuga between each two of them, are one kalpa. Two kalpas are a nychthemeron of Brahman, and his life is a hundred years, or one day of Purusha, the first man, of whom neither beginning nor end is known." This is what Varuna, the lord of the water, communi- cated to Rama, the son of Dasaratha, in primeval times, since he knew these things thoroughly. The same information has also been given by Bhargava, i.e. Markandeya, who had such a perfect knowledge of time that he easily mastered every number. He is to the Hindus like the angel of death, who kills them with his seat, being aprati-dhrishya (irresistible). Brahmagupta says : " The book Smriti mentions that 4000 derala years are one Fritayuga, but together with a samdhi of 400 years and a samdhyamsa of 400 years, a kitayuga has 4800 deraka years. "Three thousandyears are one tretâyuga, but together

Page 419

CHAPTER XLII. 373

with a samdhi and a snmdhyamsa, each of 300 years, a tretayuga has 3600 years. "Two thousand years are a drôpara, but together with a saidhi and a samidhyamsa, each of 200 years, a drápara has 2400 years. "A thousand years are one kali, but together with a smndhi and a samdhyamsa, each of 100 years, a kali- yuga has 1200 years."

Smriti. This is what Brahmagupta quotes from the book

"Divya years are changed into human years by being Duration of multiplied by 360. Accordingly the four yugas have yugas. the single

the following sums of human years :-

A kritayuga has 1,440,000 years, Losides 144,000 samdhi, and L44,000 samdhyamin.

Sum total 1,728,000 years=one kriteyuga.

A tretâyuga has 1,080,000 years, besides 108,000 and 10S,000 srndh yarsa. Page ISS.

Sum total 1,296,000 years=one tretuyuga.

A dvapara has 720,000 years, besides 72,000 saidhi, and 72,000 sandhyamsa.

Sum tofal S64,000 years= one drapara.

A kali has 36o,oco years, besides 36,000 samdhi, and 36,000

Sum total 432,000 years=one kuliyugn.

"The sum of the krita and treti is 3,024,000 years, and the sum of the brita. treta, and drapara is 3,888,000 years." Further, Brahmagupta says that "Aryabhata con- Aryabhaļa siders the four yugas as the four equal parts of a catur- quoted by and Paulisa

yuga. Thus be differs from the doctrine of the book gupta. Brahma-

Smriti, just mentioned, and he who differs from us is an

Page 420

374 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

opponent." On the other hand, Brahmagupta praises Paulisa for what he does, since he does not differ from the book Smriti; for he subtracts 1200 from the 4800 years of the tritayuga, and diminishes the re- mainder still more and more, so as to get yugas which correspond with those of the Smriti, but yugas without samdhi and samdhyamsa. As regards the Greeks, we may notice that they have nothing like the tradition of the Smriti, for they do not measure time by yugas, manruntaras, or kalpas. So far the quotation from Brahmagupta. As is well known, there is no difference of opinion on the sum of the years of a complete caturyuga. There- fore, according to Aryabhata, the kaliyuga has 3000 dirya years or 1,080,000 human years. Each two yugas has 6000 dirya years or 2,160,000 human years. Eaclı three yugas has 9000 dirya years or 3,240,000 human years. The rule of There is a tradition that Paulisa in his Siddhanta Paulisa. specifies various new rules for the computation of these numbers, some of which may be accepted, whilst others are to be rejected. So in the rule for the computation of the yugas he puts 48 as the basis and subtracts one- fourth of it, so as to get 36. Then he again subtracts 12, for this number is his basis of subtraction, so as to get 24, and subtracting the same number a third time, he gets 12. These 12 he multiplies by 100, and the product represents the number of dirya years of the yugns. Criticism If he had made the number 60 the basis, for most thereon. things may be determined by it, and had made one-fifth of it the basis of subtraction, or if he had subtracted from 60 consecutive fractions of the remaining number, first } = 12, from the remainder } = 12, from the re- mainder } = 12, and from the remainder = 12, he would have obtained the same result which he has found by his method (60-}=48,-1=36,-}=24, - 1= 12).

Page 421

CHAPTER XLII. 375

It is possible that Paulisa simply mentions this method as one among others, and that it is not that one in par- ticular which he himself adopted. A translation of his whole work into Arabic has not hitherto yet been under- taken, because in his mathematical problems there is an evident religious and theological tendency. Pulisa deviates from the rule which he himself gives Puli-a cal- when he wants to compute how many of our years have enlates how much of the elapsed of the life of Brahman before the present kalpa. life of Brah. man has Up to the time of his writing, eight years five months fore the pre- elapsed be.

and four days of a new kalpa had elapsed. He counts sent kalpa.

6068 kalpas. As, according to him, a kalpa has 1008 caturyugas, he multiplies this number by 1008 and gets 6,116,544 caturyugas. These he changes into yugas by multiplying them by 4, and he gets 24.466, 176 yugas. As a yuga, according to him, has 1,080,000 years, he multiplies the number of yugas by 1,080,000, and gets Page 189. as the product 26,423,470,080,000, i.e. the number of years which have elapsed of the life of Brahman before the present kalpa. Perhaps it will seem strange to the followers of Criticisms Brahmagupta that he (Pulisa) has not changed the culation. on this cal-

caturyugas into exact yugas, but simply changed them into fourth parts (by dividing them by 4), and mul- tiplied these fourth parts by the number of years of a single fourth part. Now, we do not ask him what is the use of repre- senting the enturyngas as fourth parts, inasmuch as they have no fraction which, in this manner, must be reduced to wholes. The multiplication of the whole caturyugas by the years of one complete caturyuya, i.e. 4,320,000, would have been sufficiently lengthy. We, however, say that he would be correct in doing so if he had not been influenced by the wish of bringing the elapsed years of the present kalpa into relation with the last-mentioned number, and multiplied the complete elapsed manrantaras by 72 in agreement with his

Page 422

376 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

theory; further, if he had not multiplied the product by the years of a caturyuga, which gives the product of 1,866,240,000 years, and, moreover, had not multiplied the number of the complete caturyugas which have elapsed of the current manrantara by the years of a single caturyuga, which gives the product of 116,640,000 years. Of the current caturyuga there have elapsed three yugas, i.e. according to him, 3,240,000 years. The latter number represents three-fourths of the years of a caturyuga. He uses the same number when computing the week-day of a date by means of the number of the days of the here-mentioned number of years. If he believed in the above-mentioned rule, he would use it where it is required, and he would reckon the three yugas as nine-tenths of a caturyuya. Brahmagup- Now, it is evident that that which Brahmagupta re- ta's barsh criticisms lates on his authority, and with which he himself agrees, on Arya. bhata. is entirely unfounded ; but he is blind to this from sheer hatred of Aryabhata, whom he abuses excessively. And in this respect Aryabhata and Pulisa are the same to him. I take for witness the passage of Brahmagupta where he says that Aryabhata has subtracted something from the cycles of the Caput Draconis and of the apsis of the moon, and thereby rendered confused the com- putation of the eclipse. He is rude enough to compare Aryabhata to a worm which, eating the wood, by chance describes certain characters in it, without understanding them and without intending to draw them. " He, how- ever, who knows these things thoroughly stands oppo- site to Âryabhata, Śrîshena, and Vishņucandra like the lion against gazelles. They are not capable of letting him see their faces." In such offensive terms he attacks Âryabhata and maltreats him. Different We have already mentioned (v. chap. xli.) how many lengths of the solar civil days (savana) a caturyuga has according to the year. three scholars. Pulisa gives it 1350 days more than Brahmagupta, but the number of years of a caturyuga

Page 423

CHAPTER XLII. 377

is the same according to both. Therefore, evidently Pulisa gives the solar year more days than Brahma- gupta. To judge from the report of Brahmagupta, Aryabhata gives a caturyugo 300 days less than l'ulisa, and 1050 more than Brahmagupta. Accordingly, Arya- bhata must reckon the solar year longer than Brahma- gupta and shorter than Pulisa.

Page 424

( 378 )

CHAPTER XLIII.

A DESCRIPTION OF THE FOUR YUGAS, AND OF ALL THAT IS EXPECTED TO TAKE PLACE AT THE END OF THE FOURTH YUGA.

THE ancient Greeks held regarding the earth various opinions, of which we shall relate one for the sake of an example. On natural The disasters which from time to time befal the earth, cataciysms. both from above and from below, differ in quality and Page 190. quantity. Frequently it has experienced one so in- commensurable in quality or in quantity, or in both together, that there was no remedy against it, and that no flight or caution was of any avail. The catastrophe comes on like a deluge or an earthquake, bringing destruction either by the breaking in of the surface, or by drowning with water which breaks forth, or by burning with hot stones and ashes that are thrown out, by thunderstorms, by landslips, and typhoons ; fur- ther, by contagious and other diseases, by pestilence, and more of the like. Thereby a large region is stripped of its inhabitants; but when after a while, after the disaster and its consequences have passed away, the country begins to recover and to show new signs of life, then different people flock there together like wild animals, who formerly were dwelling in hiding-holes' and on the tops of the mountains. They become civilised by assisting each other against common foes, wild beasts or men, and furthering each other in the hope for a life in safety and joy. Thus they increase

Page 425

CHAPTER XLIII. 379

to great numbers; but then ambition, circling round them with the wings of wrath and envy, begins to dis- turb the serene bliss of their life. Sometimes a nation of such a kind derives its pedi- gree from a person who first settled in the place or distinguished himself by something or other, so that he alone continues to live in the recollection of the suc- ceeding generations, whilst all others beside him are forgotten. Plato mentions in the Book of Laus Zeus, i.e. Jupiter, as the forefather of the Greeks, and to Zeus is Pedigree of traced back the pedigree of Hippocrates, which is men- crates. Iippo-

tioned in the last chapters added at the end of the book. We must, however, observe that the pedigree contains only very few generations, not more than fourteen. It is the following :- Hippokrates-Gnosidikos-Nebros- Sostratos - Theodoros - Kleomyttades - Krisamis- Dardanas-Sostratos-Cwy-al! (?)-Hippolochos-Po- daleirios- Machaon-Asclepios-Apollo-Zeus-Kro- nos, i.f. Saturn. The Hindus have similar traditions regarding the Hindu Caturyuga, for according to them, at the beginning of botions regarding it, i.e. at the beginningof Kritayuga, there was happiness ages or the four

and safety, fertility and abundance, health and force, yugas.

ample knowledge and a great number of Brahmans. The good is complete in this age, like four-fourths of a whole, and life lasted 4000 years alike for all beings during this whole space of time. Thereupon things began to decrease and to be mixed with opposite elements to such a degree, that at the beginning of Tretayuga the good was thrice as much as the invading bad, and that bliss was three-quarters of the whole. There were a greater number of Kshat- riyas than of Brahmans, and life had the same length as in the preceding age. So it is represented by the Vishnu-Dharma, whilst analogy requires that it should be shorter by the same amount than bliss is smaller, i.c. by one-fourth. In this age, when offering to the fire,

Page 426

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

they begin to kill animals and to tear off plants, prac- tices which before were unknown. Thus the evil increases till, at the beginning of Dvâ- para, evil and good exist in equal proportions, and like- wise bliss and misfortune. The climates begin to differ, there is much killing going on, and the religions become different. Life becomes shorter, and lasts only 400 years, according to the Vishnu-Dharma. At the begin- ning of Tishya, i.e. Kaliyuga, evil is thrice as much as the remaining good. The Hindus have several well-known traditions of events which are said to have occurred in the Treta and Dvapara yugas, e.g. the story of Rama, who killed Ra- Page 191. vana ; that of Parasnrama the Brahman, who killed every Kshatriya he laid hold upon, revenging on them the death of his father. They think that he lives in heaven, that he has already twenty-one times appeared on earth, and that he will again appear. Further, the story of the war of the children of Pandu with those of Kuru. In the Kaliyuga evil increases, till at last it results in the destruction of all good. At that time the inhabi- tants of the earth perish, and a new race rises out of those who are scattered through the mountains and hide themselves in caves, uniting for the purpose of worship- ping and flying from the horrid, demoniac human race. Therefore this age is called Kritayuga, which means "Being ready for going away after having finished the work." Deseription In the story of Saunaka which Venus received from of the Kalişuga. Brahman, God speaks to him in the following words: "When the Kaliyuga comes, I send Buddhodana, the son of Suddhodana the pious, to spread the good in the creation. But then the Muhammira, i.e. the red-wear- ing ones, who derive their origin from him, will change everything that he has brought, and the dignity of the Brahmans will be gone to such a degree that a Śûdra, their servant, will be impudent towards them, and that

Page 427

CHAPTER XLIII.

a Sûdra and Candala will share with them the presents and offerings. Men will entirely be occupied with gathering wealth by crimes, with hoarding up, not re- fraining from committing horrid and sinful crimes. All this will result in a rebellion of the small ones against the great ones, of the children against their parents, of the servants against their masters. The castes will be in uproar against each other, the genealogies will become confused, the four castes will be abolished, and there will be many religions and sects. Many books will be composed, and the communities which formerly were united will on account of them be dissolved into single individuals. The temples will be destroyed and the schools will lie waste. Justice will be gone, and the kings will not know anything but oppression and spoliation, robbing and destroying, as if they wanted to devour the people, foolishly indulging in far-reaching hopes, and not considering how short life is in com- parison with the sins (for which they have to atone). The more the mind of people is depraved, the more will pestilential diseases be prevalent. Lastly, people main- tain that most of the astrological rules obtained in that age are void and false. These ideas have been adopted by Manî, for he says : Saying of " Know ye that the affairs of the world have been Máni.

changed and altered ; also priesthood has been changed since the oduipur of heaven, i.e. the spheres, have been changed, and the priest can no longer acquire such a knowledge of the stars in the circle of a sphere as their fathers were able to acquire. They lead mankind astray by frand. What they prophesy may by chance happen, but frequently it does not happen." The description of these things in the Vishnu-Dharma Description is much more copious than we have given it. P'eople tayuga of the Kri-

will be ignorant of what is reward and punishment ; Pishu- according to

they will deny that the angels have absolute know- Dharma. ledge. Their lives will be of different length, and none

Page 428

ALBERUNPS INDIA.

of them will know how long it is. The one will die as an embryo, the other as a baby or child. The pious will be torn away and will not have a long life, but he who does evil and denies religion will live longer. Śûdras will be kings, and will be like rapacions wolves, robbing the others of all that pleases them. The doings of the Brahmans will be of the same kind, but the inajority will be Sudras and brigands. The laws of the Brahmans will be abolished. People will point with their fingers at those who worry themselves with the practice of frugality and poverty as a curiosity, will despise them, and will wonder at a man worshipping Vishnu; for all of them have become of the same (wicked) character. Therefore any wish will soon be Page 192. granted, little merit receive great reward, and honour and dignity be obtained by little worship and service. But finally, at the end of the yuga, when the evil will have reached its highest pitch, there will come for- ward Garga, the son of J-S-V (?) the Brahman, i.e. Kali, after whom this yuga is called, gifted with an irresis- tible force, and more skilled in the use of any weapon than any other. Then he draws his sword to make good all that has become bad; he cleans the surface of the earth of the impurity of people and clears the earth of them. He collects the pure and pious ones for the purpose of procreation. Then the Kritayuga lies far behind them, and the time and the world return to purity, and to absolute good and to bliss. This is the nature of the yugns as they circle round through the Caturynga. The origin The book Caraka, as qnoted by 'Ali Ibn Zain of of medicine according to Țabaristan, says: " In primeval times the earth was the book Caraka. always fertile and healthy, and the elements or maha- bhuta were equally mixed. Men lived with each other in harmony and love, without any Inst and ambition, hatred and envy, without anything that makes soul and body ill. But then came envy, and lust followed.

Page 429

CHAPTER XLIII.

Driven by lust, they strove to hoard up, which was dif- ficult to some, easy to others. All kinds of thoughts, labours, and cares followed, and resulted in war, deceit, and lying. The hearts of men were hardened, the natures were altered and became exposed to diseases, which seized hold of men and made them neglect the worship of God and the furtherance of science. Igno- rance became deeply rooted, and the calamity became great. Then the pious met before their anchorite Krisa (?) the son of Atreya, and deliberated ; whereupon the sage ascended the mountain and threw himself on the earth. Thereafter God taught him the science of medicine." All this much resembles the traditions of the Greeks, Qnetation which we have related (in another place). For Aratus tus. from Ara-

says in his Parvopera, and in his intimations referring to the seventh zodiacal sign : " Look under the feet of the Herdsman, i.e. Al'uwwd, among the northern figures, and you see the Virgin coming with a blooming ear of corn in her hand, i.e. Alsimal Al'dcal. She belongs either to the star-race, which are said to be the fore- fathers of the ancient stars, or she was procreated by another race which we do not know. People say that in primeval times she lived among mankind, but only among women, not visible to men, being called Justice. She used to unite the aged men and those who stood in the market-places and in the streets, and exhorted them with a loud voice to adhere to the truth. She presented mankind with innumerable wealth and be- stowed rights upon them. At that time the earth was called golden. None of its inhabitants knew pernicious hypocrisy in deed or word, and there was no objection- able schism among them. They lived a quiet life, and did not yet navigate the sea in ships. The cows afforded the necessary sustenance. " Afterwards, when the golden race had expired and the silver race come on, Virgo mixed with them, but

Page 430

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

without being happy, and concealed herself in the mountains, having no longer intercourse with the women as formerly. Then she went to the large towns, warned their inhabitants, scolded them for their evil doings, and blamed them for ruining the race which the golden futhers had left behind. She foretold them that there would come a race still worse than they, and that wars, bloodshed, and other great disasters would follow. " After having finished, she disappeared into themoun- tains till the silver race expired and a bronze race came up. l'eople invented the sword, the doer of evil; they tasted of the meat of cows, the first who did it. By all this their neighbourhood became odious to Justice, and she flew away to the sphere." A seholion The commentator of the book of Aratus says: "This on Aratus. Virgin is the daughter of Zeus. She spoke to the people on the public places and streets, and at that time they were obedient to their rulers, not knowing the bad nor discord. Without any altercation or envy they lived from agriculture, and did not travel on sea for the sake of commerce nor for the lust of plunder. Their nature was as pure as gold. "But when they gave np these manners and no longer adhered to truth, Justice no longer had inter- course with them, but she observed them, dwelling in the mountains. When, however, she came to their meetings, though unwillingly, she threatened them, for they listened in silence to her words, and therefore she no longer appeared to those who called her, as she had formerly done. "When, then, after the silver race, the bronze race came up, when wars followed each other and the evil spread in the world, she started off, for she wanted on no account to stay with them, and hated them, and went towards the sphere. "There are many traditions regarding this Justice,

Page 431

CHAPTER XLIII.

According to some, she is Demeter, because she has the ear of corn ; according to others, she is Tixn." This is what Aratus says. The following occurs in the third book of the Laws Quotation of Plato :- from the Laws of "The Athenian said: ' There have been deluges, dis- Plato.

eases, disasters on earth, from which none has been saved but herdsmen and mountaineers, as the remnants of a race not practised in deceit and in the love of power.' "The Knossian said: 'At the beginning men loved each other sincerely, feeling lonely in the desert of the world, and because the world had sufficient room for all of them, and did not compel them to any exertion. There was no poverty among them, no possession, no contract. There was no greed among them, and neither silver nor gold. There were no rich people among them and no poor. If we found any of their books, they would afford us numerous proofs for all this.'"

VOL. 1. 2 B

Page 432

( 386 )

CHAPTER XLIV.

ON THE MANVANTARAS.

The single As 72,000 kalpas are reckoned as the life of Brahman, manvanta- ras, their the manvantara, i.e. period of Manu, is reckoned as the Indras, and the children life of Indra, whose rule ends with the end of the of Indra. period. His post is occupied by another Indra, who then rules the world in the new manvantara. Brahma- gupta says: "If a man maintains that there is no samdhi between two manvantaras, and reckons each manvan- tara as 71 caturyugas, he will find that the kalpa is too short by six caturyugas, and the minus below 1000 (i.e. in 994) is not better than the plus above 1000 (i.e. in 100S, according to Aryabhata). Both numbers, how- ever, differ from the book Smriti." Further he says: "Aryabhata mentions in two books of his, the one of which is called Dasagitikd, the other Aryastasata, that each manrantara is equal to 72 catur- yugas. Accordingly he reckons a kalpa at 100S catur- yugas (14 × 72)." In the book Vishnu-Dharma Markandeya gives to Vajra the following answer: "Purusha is the lord of Page 194. the universe; the lord of the kalpa is Brahman, the lord of the world; but the lord of the manvantara is Manu. There are fourteen Manus, from whom the kings of the earth, ruling at the beginning of each manvantara, descended." We have united their names in the following table :-

Page 433

The Names of the Manvantaras Their Names accord. Their Names taken The Names of Indra The Names of the childron of Manu, the kings of the carth who ruled at tho beginning according to the ing to the Vishnu-PurAna. Vishnu-Dharma. from other Sonrces. according to the Vishnn-Purana. of each period, according to the Vishņu- Purâņa.

Svayambhuva Svayambhuva Svâyambhuva Manu, as the ruler of the first manvantara, is Indra, who has nothing in common with any other being. 2 Svarocisha Svârociya Svarocisha Vipaścit The first of the children of Manu, Caitraka (?) 3 Auttami Anttami Auttami Suśanti Sudivya (?) CHAPTER XLIV: 4 Stâmasa (?) Stamasa Utâmasa (?) Šikhin Nara, KhyAti, Santahaya, Janujangha. Raivata Raivata Raivata Autata (?) Balabandhu, Susambhâvya, Satyaka,

Cakshkha Cakshusha Manojava Sindbu (?), Rebha (?) Câkshusha Puru, Muru, Satadyumna, Pramukha (?)

7 Vaivasvata Vaivasvata Vaivasvata Purandara Ikshvku, Nabasa (?), Dhrishņa, Saryâti. Sâvarni Sâvarņi Sâvarni Bali, the impri- Virajas, Aścârvari, Nirmogha.

9 Vishnu-Dharma | Brahma- soned king Daksha Mahâvirya Dhritaketu, Niramaya, P'ancahasta. putra IO Brabmasâvarņi Dharmaputra Vishnu- Sânti Sukshetra, Uttamaujas, Bhurishena. putra II Dharmasâvarņi Rudraputra Rudra- Vrisha Sarvatraga, Devânika, Sudharmâtman (?) Sâv rņi

Rudraputra Dakshaputra putra I2 Daksha- Ritadhaman Devata (?), Vânupadevaś-ca, Deva-

Raucya Raibhya (?) putra 13 Raibhya (?) Divaspati śreshtha. Citrasena, Vicitra-âdya (!) 387 These five are called 14 Bhautya Bhautya Bhûmi (?) Suci Urur, Gabhira, Budhnya-adya (!)

Page 434

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Page 195. The difference which the reader perceives in the enu- The tradi- tion of meration of the future manvantaras beyond the seventh Vishnu- Purrina re- one, arises, as I think, from the same cause whence lating to the the difference in the names of the Dvipas is derived manranta- Tas. (v. pp. 235, 236), viz. from the fact that the people care more for the names than for the order in which they are handed down to posterity. We may here rely on the tradition of the Vishnu-Purtina, for in this book their number, their names and descriptions, are given in such a way that renders it necessary to us to con- sider also the order in which it gives them as trust- worthy. But we have refrained from communicating these things in this place, since they offer only very little use. The same book relates that King Maitreya, a Ksha- triya, asked Parâsara, the father of Vyâsa, about the past and the futnre manvantaras. Thereupon the latter mentions the name by which each Manu is known, the same names which our table exhibits. According to the same book, the children of each Manu will rule the earth, and it mentions the first of them, the names of whom we have given in the table. According to the same source, the Manus of the second, third, fourth, and fifth manvantaras will be of the race of Priyavrata, an anchorite, who stood in such favour with Vishņu, that he honoured his children by raising them to this distinction.

Page 435

(.389_)

CHAPTER XLV.

ON THE CONSTELLATION OF THE GREAT BEAR.

THE Great Bear is in the Indian language called Soptar- A tradition shayas, i.e. the Seren Rishis. They are said to have been Arumndlati, relating to

anchorites who nourished themselves only with what it the wife of Vasishtha. is allowable to eat, and with them there was a pious woman, Al-suha (Ursa Major, star 8o by {). They plucked off the stalks of the lotus from the ponds to eat of them. Meanwhile came The Law (Dharma?) and concealed her from them. Every one of them felt ashamed of the other, and they swore oaths which were approved of by Dharma. In order to honour them, Dharma raised them to that place where they are now seen (sic). We have already mentioned that the books of the Hin- Quotation dus are composed in metres, and therefore the authors hamihira. from Varâ-

indulge in comparisons and epitheta ornantia, such as are admired by their countrymen. Of the same kind is a description of the Great Bear in the Samhita of Varahamihira, where it occurs before the astrological prognostics derived from this constellation. We give the passage according to our translation : 1_ "The northern region is adorned with these stars, as a beautiful woman is adorned with a collar of pearls strung together, and a necklace of white lotus flowers, a handsomely arranged one. Thus adorned, they are like maidens who dance and revolve round the pole as the pole orders them. And I say, on the authority of 1 Samkita, chap. xiii. v. 1-6.

Page 436

390 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

Garga, the ancient, the primeval one, that the Great Bear stood in Magha, the tenth lunar station, when Yudhishthira ruled the earth, and the Śakakala was 2526 years after this. The Great Bear remains in each lunar station 600 years, and it rises in the north-east. He (of the Seven Rishis) who then rules the east is Marici; west of him is Vasishtha, then Angiras, Atri, Pulastya, Pulaha, Kratu, and near Vasishtha there is a chaste woman called Arundhatî." As these names are sometimes confounded with each other, we shall try to identify them with the corre- sponding stars in the Great Bear :-- '

Marici is the 27th star of this constellation, Vasishtha ,, 26th Angiras , 25th Atri Kratu ,, 18th , 16th Pulaha „ 17th Pulastya ,, 19th

Criticisms These stars occupy in our time, i.c. in the 952nd year on Garga. of the Sakakala, the space between 13° of Leo and 132° of Spica (Virgo). According to the peculiar motion of the fixed stars, as we know it, the same stars occupied at the time of Yudhishthira the space between 83° Gemini and 20g° of Cancer. Page 196. According to the motion of the fixed stars, as adopted by the ancient astronomers and Ptolemy, these stars occupied at that time the space between 261° of Gemini and S3° of Leo, and the here-mentioned lunar station (Maghâ) occupied the space between o-Soo minutes in Leo. Therefore it would be much more suitable in the present time to represent the Seven Rishis as standing in Magha than in the time of Yudhishthira. And if the Hindus identify Magha with the Heart of the Lion, we can only say that this constellation at that time stood in the first degrees of Cancer.

Page 437

CHAPTER XLV. 391

The words of Garga are without any foundation ; they only show how little he knew of that which every one must know who wants to fix the places of the stars, either by eyesight or by means of astronomical observation on certain degrees of the signs of the zodiac. I have read in,the almanacs for the year 951 of the Note from a Śakakala which came from Kashmir the statement almanac. Kashmirian

that the Seven Rishis stand since seventy-seven years in the lunar station Anuradha. This station occupies the space between 35° and the end of 163° of Scorpio. However, the Seven Rishis precede this place by about a whole zodiacal sign and 20 degrees, i.c. by Ig signs (v. p. 390). But what man would be able to learn all the different theories of the Hindus, if he does not dwell among them! Let us now first suppose that Garga is right, that he Examina- has not stated the precise place in Magha which the statements tion of the

Seven Rishis occupy, and let us suppose that this place the position regarding

was o° of Magha, which would correspond to o° of Leo Bear. of the Great for our time. Further, between the time of Yudhish- thira and the present year, i.e. the year 1340 of Alex- ander, there is an interval of 3479 years. And lastly, let us suppose that Varahamihira is right in saying that the Seven Rishis dwell 600 years in each lunar station. Accordingly, they ought in the present year to stand in 17° 18' of Libra, which is identical with 10° 38' of Svâti. However, if we suppose that they stood in the midst of Magha (not in the beginning), they ought at present to stand in 3° 58' of Visakha. And if we suppose that they stood in the end of Magha, they ought at present to stand in 10° 38' of Viśakhâ. Hence it is evident that the statement of the Kash- mirian calendar does not agree with the statement in the Samhita. Likewise, if we adopt the rule of the said calendar regarding the precession of the equinoxes, and reckon with this measure backward, we do by no means

Page 438

392 ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

arrive at Magha as the lunar station in which the Seven Rishis stood in the time of Yudhishthira. Hitherto we used to think that in our time the revo- lution of the fixed stars is more rapid than in former times, and we tried to account for this by peculiarities of the shape of the celestial sphere. According to us, they move one degree in 66 solar rears. Therefore Varahamihira highly astonishes us, for, according to him, the rate of this motion would be one degree in forty-five years, i.e. much more rapid than at present, whilst his time precedes ours only by 525 years. Rule of the The author of the canon Karanasara gives the fol- Karaņasâra to find the lowing rule for the computation of the motion of the position of the Great Great Bear, and of the place which, at any given time, Bear at any time. it occupies :- " Subtract 821 from the Sakakala. The remainder is the basis, i.e. the number of years above 4000 which have elapsed since the beginning of the Kaliyuga. "Multiply the basis by 47, and add 68,000 to the product. Divide the sum by 10,000. The quotient re- presents the zodiacal signs and fractions of them, i.e. the position of the Great Bear which was sought." The addition of 68,000, prescribed in this rule, must be the original position of the Great Bear at the be- ginning of the basis, multiplied by 10,000. If we divide 68,000 by 10,000, we get the quotient 61, i.c. six zodiacal signs and twenty-fonr degrees of a seventh sign. It is evident that if we divide the 10,000 by 47, the Great Bear has wandered through one zodiacal sign in 212 years, 9 months, and 6 days, according to solar time. Accordingly it wanders through one degree of a sign in 7 years, I month, and 3 days, and through one lunar station in 94 years, 6 months, and 20 days. Now there is a great difference between the values of Varahamihira and those of Vittesvara, if there is not a fault in the tradition. If we, by way of an example,

Page 439

CHAPTER XLV. 393

make such a compntation for the present year (1030 A.D.), we get 9° 17' in the lunar station Anurâdha as the position of the Great Bear. The people of Kashmir believed that the Great Bear wanders through a lunar station in 100 years. There- fore the above-mentioned calendar says that of the present centennium of the motion of the Great Bear there is still a remainder of twenty-three years. Mistakes and confusion such as we have here laid Theological open arise, in the first place, from the want of the neces- mixed up opinions

sary skill in astronomical researches, and secondly, from astronomy. with

the way of the Hindus of mixing up scientific questions with religious traditions. For the theologians believe that the Seven Rishis stand higher than the fixed stars, and they maintain that in each manvantara there will appear a new Manu, whose children will destroy the earth; but the rule will be renewed by Indra, as also the different classes of the angels and the Seven Rishis. The angels are necessary, for mankind must offer sacri- fices to them and must briug to the fire the shares for them ; and the Seven Rishis are necessary, becanse they Page 197. must renew the Veda, for it perishes at the end of each manvantara. Our information on this subject we take from the The Seven Vishnu-Purana. From the same source we have taken different Rishis in the

the names of the Seven Rishis in each manrantara, as taras. manran-

exhibited by the following table :-

Page 440

The Seven Rishis, i.e. the Banat-Na'sh, or the Stars of the Great Bear in the Manvantaras.

94 of the Numbers Tanvantaras.

In this Manvantara there was neither Indra nor the Seven Rishis, but only Manu.

2 Ûrjastambha Prâna Datta Nirishabha Niśvara Ścorvarî (?) Vainśca (!)

AL RU 3 The Children of Vasishtha. Jyoti Dhaman Prithu Kâvya Caitra and Agni Varaka Pivara 4

Hiranyaroman Vedaśri Rurdhwa- bàhu (1) Apara (1) Vedabāhu Subahu Parjanya

6 Sumedhas Virajas Havishmat Madhu Atinâman Sahishņu Carshayah (!)

Vasishtha Kaśyapa Atri Jamadagni Gautama Viśvamitra Bharadvaja I D Diptimat Galava Kṛipa Asvatthaman Parâara Vyasa the son the son of Drona of Parâśara Rishyasringa

9 Savana Dyutimat Havya Vasu Medhadhriti Jyotishmat Satya

IO Havishmat Sukriti Satya Apâmmûrti Nabhâga Apratimaujas Sukshetra

II Niścara Agnidhra Vapushmat Vislmu Âruni Havishmant Nagha

I2 Tapasvin Sutaya Tapomûrti Taporati Tapodhriti Dyuti Iscânyah (!)

13 Nirmoha Tattvadarśica Nishprakampa Nirutsuka Dhritimant Vyaya Sutapas

I4 Agniba Śuci Sukra or Venns MAgadha Agnîdhra Yuktasta Jita

Page 441

( 395 )

CHAPTER XLVI.

ON NARÂYANA, HIIS APPEARANCE AT DIFFERENT TIMES, Page 193. AND HIS NAMES.

NARAYANA is according to the Hindus a supernatural On the power, which does not on principle try to bring about Naragana. nature of

the good by the good, nor the bad by the bad, but to prevent the evil and destruction by whatever means happen to be available. For this force the good exists prior to the bad, but if the good does not properly develop nor is available, it uses the bad, this being unavoidable. In so doing, it may be compared to a rider who has got into the midst of a cornfield. When he then comes back to his senses, and wants to avoid evil-doing and to get out of the mischief he has committed, he has no other means but that of turning his horse back and riding out on the same road on which he has entered the field, though in going out he will do as much mis- chief as he has done in entering, and even more. But there is no other possibility of making amends save this. The Hindus do not distinguish between this force and the First Cause of their philosophy. Its dwelling in the world is of such a nature that people compare it to a material existence, an appearance in body and colour, since they cannot conceive any other kind of appearance. Besides other times, Narayana has appeared at the end of the first manrantara, to take away the rule of the worlds from Valakhilya (?), who had given it the

Page 442

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

name, and wanted to take it into his own hands. Narayana came and handed it over to Satakratn, the performer of a hundred sacrifices, and made him Indra. Story of Another time he appeared at the end of the sixth of Virocana. manvantara, when he killed the King Bali, the son of Bal, the son

Virocana, who ruled the whole world and had Venus as his vazir. On having heard from his mother that the time of his father had been much better than his time, since it was nearer the kritayuga, when people enjoyed more profonnd bliss and did not know any fatigue, he became ambitions and desirous of vying with his father. Therefore he commenced doing works of piety, giving presents, distributing money, and per- forming sacrifices, which earn the rule of paradise and earth for him who finishes a hundred of them. When he was near this term, or had nearly finished the ninety- ninth sacrifice, the angels begau to feel uneasy and to fear for their dignity, knowing that the tribute which men bring them would cease if they stood no longer in need of them. Now they united and went to Nâra- yana, asking him to help them. He granted their wish, and descended to the earth in the shape of Vamana, i.e. a man whose hands and feet are too short in com- parison with his body, and in consequence his figure is thought to be hideous. Narayana came to the King Bali whilst he was offer- ing, his Brahmans standing round the fires, and Venus, his vazir, standing before him. The treasure-honses had been opened and the precions stones had been thrown out in heaps, to be given as presents and alms. Now Vamana commenced to recite the Veda like the Brahmans from that part which is now called Samaveda, in a melancholy, impressive kind of melody, persuading the king to grant him liberally what he would wish and demand. Uponthis Venus spoke stealthily to him : "This is Narayana. He has come to rob thee of thy

Page 443

CHAPTER XLVI. 397

rule." But the king was so excited that he did not mind the words of Venus, and asked Vamana what was his desire. Thereupon Vamana said, "As much as four paces of thy realm, that I may live there." The king answered, "Choose what you wish, and how you wish it;" and according to Hindu custom, he ordered water to be brought to pour it over his hands as a sign of the confirmation of the order he had given. Now Venns, because of her love to the king, brought in the jug, but had corked the spout, so that no water should flow out of it, whilst she closed the hole in the cork with the lusa grass of her ring-finger. But Venus Page 199. had only one eye; she missed the hole, and now the water flowed out. In consequence, Vamana made a pace towards east, another towards west, and a third towards above as far as Svarloka. As for the fourth pace, there was no more space in the world; he made, by the fourth pace, the king a slave, putting his foot between his shoulders as a sign of making him a slave. He made him sink down into the earth as far as Patala, the lowest of the low. He took the worlds away from him, and handed the rule over to Puramdara. The following occurs in the Vishņu-Purana :- Quotation "The King Maitreya asked Parasara about the yugas. from Vishnu- So the latter answered: They exist for the purpose Purana. that Vishnu should occupy himself with something in them. In the Kritayuga he comes in the shape of Kapila alone, for the purpose of spreading wisdom; in Tretayuga, in the shape of Rama alone, for the pur- pose of spreading fortitude, to conquer the bad, and to preserve the three worlds by force and the prevalence of virtuous action ; in Dvapara, in the shape of Vyasa, to divide the Veda into four parts, and to derive many branches from it. In the end of Dvapara he appears in the shape of Vasudeva to destroy the giants ; in the Kaliyuga, in the shape of Kali, the son of J-sh-v (?) the Brahman, to kill all, and to make the

Page 444

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

cycle of the yugas commence anew. That is his (Vishņu's) occupation.'" In another passage of the same book we read: "Vishnu, i.e. another name for Narayana, comes at the end of each dvapara to divide the Veda into four parts, because men are feeble and unable to observe the whole of it. In his face he resembles Vyâsa."

Enumera- We exhibit his names in the following table, though tion of the Vyasas of they vary in different sources, enumerating the Vyasas the seventh manvan- who have appeared in the caturyugas of the present or tara. seventh manvantara which have elapsed :-

Svayamn bhû 16 Dhanamjaşa 2 Prajâpati 17 Kritamjaya Uśanas IS Riņajyeshtha (?) 3 4 Bribaspati 19 Bharad vâja 5 Savitri 20 Gantama Mrityu 21 Uttama 7 Indra 22 Haryatman 8 Vasishtha 23 Veda-vyâsa 9 Sarasvata 24 Vajaśravas IO Tridbâman 25 Somasushma II Trivrisha 26 Bhargava 12 Bharadvā ja 27 Vâlmîki I3 Antariksha 28 Krishna I4 Vapra (?) 29 Asvatthaman the son 15 Trayyaruna of Drona

Krishna Dvaipayana is Vyasa the son of Parasara. The twenty-ninth Vyasa has not yet come, but will appear in future.

Quotation The book Vishan-Dharma says: "The names of trom Vishnu- Hari, i.e. Narayana, differ in the yugas. They are the Dharma. following : Vasudeva, Samkarshana, Pradyumna, and Aniruddha." I suppose that the author has not here preserved the proper sequence, for Vâsudeva belongs to the end of the four yugas. The same book says: " Also his colours differ in the yugas. In the Kritayuga he is white, in the Treta- yuga red, in the Dvapara yellow, the latter is the first

Page 445

CHAPTER XLVI. 399

phase of his being embodied in human shape, and in the Kaliyuga he is black." These colours are something like the three primary forces of their philosophy, for they maintain that Satya is transparent white, Rajas red, and Tamas black. We Page 200. shall in a later part of this book give a description of his last appearance in the world.

Page 446

( 400 )

CHAPTER XLVII.

ON VASUDEVA AND THE WARS OF TIIE BHARATA.

Analogies of THE life of the world depends upon sowing and pro- the course of nature to creating. Both processes increase in the course of the bistory of mankind. time, and this increase is unlimited, whilst the world is limited. When a class of plants or animals does not increase any more in its structure, and its peculiar kind is estab- lished as a species of its own, when each individual of it does not simply come into existence once and perish, but besides procreates a being like itself or several together, and not only once but several times, then this will as a single species of plants or animals occupy the earth and spread itself and its kind over as much terri- tory as it can find. The agriculturist selects his corn, letting grow as much as he requires, and tearing out the remainder. The forester leaves those branches which he perceives to be excellent, whilst he cuts away all others. The bees kill those of their kind who only eat, but do not work in their beehive. Nature proceeds in a similar way ; however, it does not distinguish, for its action is under all circumstances one and the same. It allows the leaves and fruit of the trees to perish, thus preventing them from realising that result which they are intended to produce in the economy of nature. It removes them so as to make room for others. If thus the earth is ruined, or is near to be ruined,

Page 447

CHAPTER XLVII. 401

by having too many inhabitants, its ruler-for it has a ruler, and his all-embracing care is apparent in every single particle of it-sends it a messenger for the par- pose of reducing the too great number and of ctting away all that is evil. A messenger of this kind is, according to the belief Story of the of the Hindus, Vasudeva, who was sent the last time in vasudeva. birth of

human shape, being called Vasudeva. It was a time when the giants were numerous on earth and the earth was full of their oppression; it tottered, being hardly able to bear the whole number of them, and it trembled from the vehemence of their treading. Then there was born a child in the city of Mathura to Vasudeva by the sister of Kamsa, at that time raler of the town. They were a Jatt family, cattle-owners, low Sudra people. Kaisa had learned, by a voice which he heard at the wedding of his sister, that he would perish at the hands of her child; therefore he appointed people who were to bring him every child of hers as soon as she gave birth to it, and he killed all her children, both male and female. Finally, she gave birth to Balabhadra, and Yasoda, the wife of the herdsman Nanda, took the child to herself, and managed to keep it concealed from the spies of Kamsa. Thereupon she became pregnant an eighth time, and gave birth to Vasudern in a rainy night of the eighth day of the black half of the month Bhadrapada, whilst the moon was ascending in the station Rohinî. As the guards had fallen into deep sleep and neglected the watch, the father stole the child and brought it to Nandakula, i.e. the stable of the cows of Nanda, the husband of Yasoda, near Mathura, but separated from this place by the river Yamuna. Vâsudeva exchanged the child for a daughter of Nanda, which happened to be born at the moment when Vasu- dera arrived with the boy. He brought this female child to the guards instead of his son. Kamsa, the VOL. I. 2 c

Page 448

402 ALBERUNIS INDIA.

ruler, wanted to kill the child, but she flew up into the air and disappeared. Vâsudeva grew up under the care of his foster- mother Yasoda without her knowing that he had been exchanged for her daughter, but Kamsa got some ink- ling of the matter. Now he tried to get the child into his power by cunning plans, but all of them turned out against him. Lastly, Kamsa demanded from his parents that they should send him (Vasudeva) to wrestle in his (Kamsa's) presence. Now Vasudeva began to behave overbearingly towards everybody. On the road he had already roused the wrath of his aunt by hurting a serpent which had been appointed to watch over the lotus flowers of a pond, for he had drawn a cord through its nostrils like a bridle. Further, he had killed his fuller, because the latter had refused to lend him clothes for the wrestling. He had robbed the girl who accom- Page 201. panied him of the sandal-wood with which she was ordered to anoint the wrestlers. Lastly, he had killed the rutting elephant which was provided for the pur- pose of killing him before the door of Kamsa. All this heightened the wrath of Kamsa to such a degree, that his bile burst, and he died on the spot. Then Vâsu- deva, his sister's son, ruled in his stead. The names Vâsudeva has a special name in each month. His of Vasudera in the differ. followers begin the months with Margasirsha, and each ent months. month they begin with the eleventh day, because on this day Vâsudeva appeared. The following table contains the names of Vâsudeva in the months :-

Page 449

CHAPTER XLVII. 403

The Months. The Names of Vasudera The Months. The Names of Vasudeva.

Margasirsha Keśava Jyaishtha Trivikrama Pausha Narasana Âshâdha Vâmana Mâgha Madhava Śrâvana Śrîdhara Phâlguna Govinda Bhâdrapada Hrishikeśa Caitra Vishņu Âsvayuja Padmanâbhi Vaiśakha Madbustdana Kârttika Dâmodara

. Now the brother-in-law of the deceased Kaisa be- Continua- came angry, went rapidly to Mathura, took possession story of tion of the

of the realm of Vasudeva, and banished him to the Vâsudeva.

ocean. Then there appeared near the coast a golden castle called Barodâ, and Vâsudeva made it his resi- dence. The children of Kaurava (i.e. Dhritarashtra) had the charge of their consins (the children of Pândn). Dhri- tarâshtra received them and played dice with them, the last stake being their whole property. They lost more and more, until he laid upon them the obligation of expatriation for more than ten years, and of conceal- ment in the remotest part of the conntry, where nobody knew them. If they did not keep this engagement they wonld be bound to return into banishment for a like number of years. This engagement was carried ont, bnt finally came the time of their coming forward for battle. Now each party began to assemble their whole number and to sne for allies, till at last nearly innnmerable hosts had gathered in the plain of Tâne- shar. There were eighteen akshauhini. Each party tried to gain Vasndeva as ally, wherenpon he offered either himself or his brother Balabhadra together with an army. Bnt the children of Pandn preferred him. They were five men-Yndhishthira, their leader, Arjuna, the bravest of them, Sahadeva, Bhimasena, and Naknla. They had seven akshauhinf, whilst their enemies were

Page 450

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

much stronger. Bnt for the cunning devices of Vâsu- deva and his teaching them whereby they might gain victory, they would have been in a less favourable situation than their enemies. But now they conquered; all those hosts were destroyed, and none remained ex- cept the five brothers. Thereafter Vasudeva returned to his residence and died, together with his family, who were called Yadava. Also the five brothers died before the year had reached its end, at the end of those wars. End of Vasu- Vasudeva had concerted with Arjuna the arrangement deva and of the five that they would consider the quivering of the left arm Pâņđu brothers. or left eye as a mysterious intimation that there was something happening to him. At that time there lived a pious Rishi called Durvasas. Now the brothers and relations of Vasudeva were a rather malicious, incon- siderate set of people. One of them hid under his coat a new frying-pan, went to the anchorite, and asked him what would be the result of his pregnancy, jeering at the pious man. The latter said, "In thy belly there is something which will be the cause of thy death and that of thy whole clan." When Vasudeva heard this he became sorry, because he knew that these words would be fulfilled. He gave orders that the pan should be filed away and be thrown into the water. This was done. There was only a small part of it left, which Page 202. the artisan who had done the filing considered as insig- nificant. Therefore he threw it, as it was, into the water. A fish devoured it; the fish was caught, and the fisherman found it in its belly. He thought it would be a good tip for his arrow. When the predestined time came, Vâsudeva rested on the coast under the shadow of a tree, one of his feet being crossed over the other; the fisherman took him for a gazelle, shot at him, and hit his right foot. This wound became the cause of the death of Vasudeva. At the same time the left side of Arjuna began to quiver,

Page 451

CHAPTER XLVII.

and then his arm. Now his brother Sahadeva gave orders that he should never any more embrace anybody, that he might not be bereft of his strength (?). Arjuna went to Vasudeva, but could not embrace him on account of the state in which he was. Vasudeva ordered his bow to be brought, and handed it over to Arjuna, who tried his strength at it. Vâsudeva ordered him to burn his body and the bodies of his relations when they had died, and to bring away his wives from the castle, and then he died. Out of the filings or bits of iron which had fallen off when the pan was filed a bardi bush had grown. To this there came the Yadavas, who tied together some bundles of its twigs to sit upon. Whilst they were drinking there arose a quarrel between them; they beat each other with the bardi bundles, and killed each other. All this happened near the mouth of the river Sarsatî, where it flows into the sea, near the situation of Somanâth. Arjuna had done all he had been ordered by Vâsu- deva. When he brought away the women, they were suddenly attacked by robbers. When, now, Arjuna was no longer able to bend his bow, he felt that his strength was going. He whirled the bow in a circle above his head, and all who stood under the bow were saved, while the others were seized by the robbers. Now Arjuna and his brothers saw that life was no more of any use to them, therefore they emigrated to the north and entered the mountains, the snow of which never melts. The cold killed them one after the other, till at last only Yudhishthira remained. He obtained the distinction of being admitted to paradise, but before that he was to pass through hell in consequence of the sole lie which he had spoken in his life, at the request of his brothers and of Vasudeva. These were the words which he had spoken within hearing of the Brahman Drona: "Asvatthaman, the elephant, has died." He

Page 452

ALBERUNI'S INDIA.

had made a pause between Asvatthaman and the ele- phant, by which he had led Drona to believe that he meant his son. Yudhishthira spoke to the angels: " If this must be, may my intercession be accepted on be- half of the people in hell; may they be freed from it." After this desire of his had been granted, he went into paradise.

Page 453

( 407 )

CHAPTER XLVIII.

AN EXPLANATION OF THE MEASURE OF AN AKSHACHINI.

Each akshauhint has I0 antkint. antkini 3 camat. cumâ 3 pritana. pritaná 3 vahint. rthint 3 gromt. gana 3 gulma. gulma 3 senamul.ha. senamukha 3 putti. pxitti I rutha.

IN chess, the latter is called rukh, whilst the Greeks call it chariot of war. It was invented by Mankalus (Myrtilos ?) in Athens, and the Athenians maintain that they were the first who rode on chariots of war. How- ever, before that time they had already been invented by Aphrodisios (sic) the Hindu, when he ruled over Egypt, about 900 years after the deluge. They were drawn by two horses. The following is a tale of the Greeks: Hephæstos loved Athene and desired to possess her, but she refused him, preferring to remain a virgin. Now he concealed himself in the country of Athens, and intended to seize her by force, but she pierced him with a spear and then he let her go. From a drop of his blood, which had dropped to the earth, there grew Erichthonios. He Page 203. arrived on a chariot like the tower of the sun, the holder of the reins riding together with him. Similar to this are the customs of the hippodrome, as they exist in our time, the rnnning and driving with carriages in the race.

Page 454

ALBERUNIS INDIA.

A ratha comprehends besides, one elephant, three riders, and five footmen. All these orders and divisions are necessary for the preparation for battle, for pitching camp and breaking up camp. An akshauhint has 21,870 chariots, 21,870 elephants, 65,610 riders, 109,350 footmen. To each chariot there belong four horses and their conductor, the master of the chariot, armed with arrows, his two companions armed with spears, a guard who protects the master from behind, and a cartwright. On each elephant there sits its conductor, and behind him the vice-conductor, a man who has to goad the elephant behind the chair, the master, armed with arrows, in the chair, and together with him his two spear-throwing companions and his jester, hauhava (?). who on other occasions runs before him. Accordingly the number of people who ride on chariots and elephants is 284,323 (sic). The number of those who ride on horses is 87,480. The number of elephants in an akshauhint is 21,870; the number of chariots, too, is 21,870; the number of horses is 153,090; the number of men, 459,283. The sum-total of the living beings of one akshauhint, elephants, horses, and men, is 634,243 ; the same num- ber for eighteen akshauhint is 11,416,374, viz. 393,660 elephants, 2,755,620 horses, 8,267,094 men. This is an explanation of the akshauhint, and of its single parts.

END OF VOL. I.

Printed by BALLANTYNE, HANSON & Co. Edinburgh & London.